OWNER'S MANUAL
Operation
Maintenance
Specifications
All information in this Owner's Manual is current at the time of publication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make changes at any time
so that our policy of continual product improvement may be carried out.
This manual applies to all models of this vehicle and includes descriptions and explanations of optional as well as standard equipment.
As a result, you may find material in this manual that does not apply to
your specific vehicle.
Please note that some models are equipped with Right-Hand Drive
(RHD). The explanations and illustrations for some operations in RHD
models are opposite of those written in this manual.
CAUTION: MODIFICATIONS TO YOUR HYUNDAI
Your HYUNDAI should not be modified in any way. Such modifications may adversely affect
the performance, safety or durability of your HYUNDAI and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limited warranties covering the vehicle. Certain modifications may also be in violation of regulations established by the Department of Transportation and other government
agencies in your country.
TWO-WAY RADIO OR CELLULAR TELEPHONE INSTALLATION
Your vehicle is equipped with electronic components. It is possible for an improperly
installed/adjusted two-way radio or cellular telephone to adversely affect electronic systems.
For this reason, we recommend that you carefully follow the radio manufacturer's instructions
or consult your HYUNDAI dealer for precautionary measures or special instructions if you
choose to install one of these devices.
F2
SAFETY AND VEHICLE DAMAGE WARNING
This manual includes information titled as DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION and NOTICE.
These titles indicate the following:
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result
in death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could
result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which, if not
avoided, could result in vehicle damage.
F3
FOREWORD
Congratulations, and thank you for choosing HYUNDAI.We are pleased to welcome you to the growing number of discerning people who drive HYUNDAIs.We are very proud of the advanced engineering and high-quality construction of
each HYUNDAI we build.
Your Owner’s Manual will introduce you to the features and operation of your new HYUNDAI. To become familiar with
your new HYUNDAI, so that you can fully enjoy it, read this Owner’s Manual carefully before driving your new vehicle.
This manual contains important safety information and instructions intended to familiarize you with your vehicle’s controls and safety features so you can safely operate your vehicle.
This manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance safe operation of the vehicle. It is recommended that all service and maintenance on your car be performed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.HYUNDAI dealers are prepared to provide high-quality service, maintenance and any other assistance that may be required.
This Owner’s Manual should be considered a permanent part of your vehicle, and should be kept in the vehicle so you
can refer to it at any time. The manual should stay with the vehicle if you sell it to provide the next owner with important
operating, safety and maintenance information.
HYUNDAI MOTOR COMPANY
CAUTION
Severe vehicle damage may result from the use of poor quality lubricants that do not meet HYUNDAI specifications.You must always use high quality lubricants that meet the specifications listed on Page 8-6 in the
Vehicle Specifications chapter of the Owner's Manual.
Copyright 2019 HYUNDAI Motor Company. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored
in any retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means without the prior written permission of HYUNDAI
Motor Company.
F4
Introduction
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
SAFETY MESSAGES
We want to help you get the greatest
possible driving pleasure from your
vehicle. Your Owner’s Manual can
assist you in many ways. We strongly recommend that you read the
entire manual. In order to minimize
the chance of death or injury, you
must read the WARNING and CAUTION sections in the manual.
Illustrations complement the words
in this manual to best explain how to
enjoy your vehicle. By reading your
manual, you will learn about features, important safety information,
and driving tips under various road
conditions.
The general layout of the manual is
provided in the Table of Contents.
Use the index when looking for a
specific area or subject; it has an
alphabetical listing of all information
in your manual.
Sections: This manual has eight
chapters plus an index. Each chapter
begins with a brief list of contents so
you can tell at a glance if that section
has the information you want.
Your safety, and the safety of others,
is very important. This Owner's
Manual provides you with many safety precautions and operating procedures. This information alerts you to
potential hazards that may hurt you
or others, as well as damage to your
vehicle.
Safety messages found on vehicle
labels and in this manual describe
these hazards and what to do to
avoid or reduce the risks.
Warnings and instructions contained
in this manual are for your safety.
Failure to follow safety warnings and
instructions can lead to serious injury
or death.
Throughout this manual DANGER,
WARNING, CAUTION, NOTICE and
the SAFETY ALERT SYMBOL will
be used.
This is the safety alert symbol. It is used to alert you to
potential physical injury hazards. Obey all safety messages that follow this symbol
to avoid possible injury or
death. The safety alert symbol precedes the signal words
DANGER, WARNING and
CAUTION.
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided,
will result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided,
could result in death or serious
injury.
F5
Introduction
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided,
could result in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation
which, if not avoided, could result
in vehicle damage.
F6
• This vehicle should not be modified. Modification of your vehicle
could affect its performance, safety
or durability and may even violate
governmental safety and vehicle
regulations.
In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from any
modification may not be covered
under warranty.
• If you use unauthorized electronic
devices, it may cause the vehicle to
operate abnormally, wire damage,
battery discharge and fire. For your
safety, do not use unauthorized
electronic devices.
RETURNING USED VEHICLES
(FOR EUROPE)
HYUNDAI promotes an environmentally sound treatment for end of life
vehicles and offers to take back your
HYUNDAI end of life vehicles in
accordance with the European Union
(EU) End of Life Vehicles Directive.
You can get detailed information
from your national HYUNDAI homepage.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Your vehicle at a glance
1
Safety system of your vehicle
2
Convenient features of your vehicle
3
Infotainment system
4
Driving your vehicle
5
What to do in an emergency
6
Maintenance
7
Specifications & Consumer information
8
Index
I
Electric Vehicle System Overview
Electric vehicle.........................................................H3
Charge indicator lamp for electric vehicle ........H17
Electric Vehicle ....................................................................H3
Characteristics of Electric Vehicles................................H3
Battery Information............................................................H3
Charging connector lock ......................................H18
Main components of electric vehicle ...................H4
Scheduled charging...............................................H19
Main Components of Electric Vehicle............................H4
High Voltage Battery (lithium-ion polymer).................H5
High Voltage Battery Warmer System...........................H6
Precautions for charging electric vehicle .........H20
EV mode ...................................................................H7
Nearby Stations...................................................................H7
Energy Information ............................................................H8
Charge Management ..........................................................H9
ECO Driving.........................................................................H11
EV Settings .........................................................................H12
Charge types for electric vehicle........................H14
Charging
Charging
Charging
Charging
Information .......................................................H14
Time Information.............................................H14
Types (Type A).................................................H15
Types (Type B).................................................H16
Charging Status .................................................................H17
Locking Charging Cable...................................................H18
Scheduled Charging..........................................................H19
Charging Precautions.......................................................H20
Charging electric vehicle (AC charge)
- Type A..................................................................H22
AC Charge ...........................................................................H22
Charging electric vehicle (DC charge)
- Type A..................................................................H28
DC Charge ...........................................................................H28
Charging electric vehicle (Trickle charge)
- Type A..................................................................H33
Trickle Charge....................................................................H33
Charging electric vehicle (AC charge)
- Type B..................................................................H45
AC Charge ...........................................................................H45
Charging electric vehicle (DC charge)
- Type B..................................................................H52
DC Charge ...........................................................................H52
Charging electric vehicle (Trickle charge)
- Type B..................................................................H57
Trickle Charge....................................................................H57
Charging the electric vehicle (Abrupt Stop) .....H69
Action to be taken when charging stops abruptly...H69
Driving electric vehicle .........................................H70
How to Start the Vehicle ................................................H70
How to Stop the Vehicle .................................................H71
Virtual Engine Sound System ........................................H71
Distance to Empty ............................................................H72
Tips for Improving Distance to Empty.........................H73
Power/Charge Gauge ......................................................H74
State of charge (SOC) gauge for
high voltage battery.........................................................H74
Warning and Indicator Lights
(related to electric vehicle) ............................................H75
LCD Display Messages.....................................................H77
Energy flow ......................................................................H84
Aux. Battery Saver+.........................................................H85
Utility Mode........................................................................H86
Safety precautions for electric vehicle .............H87
If an Accident Occurs ......................................................H87
Other Precautions for Electric Vehicle .......................H89
Service Plug .......................................................................H89
ELECTRIC VEHICLE
Electric Vehicle
An electric vehicle is driven using a
battery and an electric motor. While
general vehicles use an internal
combustion engine and gasoline as
fuel, electric vehicles use electrical
energy that is charged inside the
high voltage battery. As a result,
electric vehicles are eco-friendly in
that they do not require fuel and do
not emit exhaust gases.
Characteristics of Electric
Vehicles
1.It is driven using the electrical
energy that is charged inside the
high voltage battery. This method
prevents air pollution since fuel,
like gasoline, is not required,
negating the emission of exhaust
gases.
2.A high performance motor is used
in the vehicle as well. Compared to
standard, internal combustion
engine vehicles, engine noise and
vibrations are much more minimal
when driving.
3.When decelerating or driving
downhill, regenerative braking is
utilized to charge the high voltage
battery. This minimizes energy loss
and increases the distance to
empty.
4.When the battery charge is not sufficient, AC charge, DC charge and
trickle charge are available. (Refer
to “Charge Types for Electric
Vehicle” for details.)
i Information
What does regenerative braking do?
It uses an electric motor when decelerating and braking and transforms
kinetic energy to electrical energy in
order to charge the high voltage battery. (Torque is applied in the opposite
direction when decelerating to generate braking force and electric energy.)
Battery Information
• The vehicle is composed of a high
voltage battery that drives the
motor and air-conditioner, and an
auxiliary battery (12 V) that drives
the lamps, wipers, and audio system.
• The auxiliary battery is automatically charged when the vehicle is in
the ready (
) mode or the high
voltage battery is being charged.
H3
MAIN COMPONENTS OF ELECTRIC VEHICLE
Main Components of Electric Vehicle
• On-Board Charger (OBC) : A device that charges the high voltage battery
by converting AC power of the power grid to DC power.
• Inverter : Transforms direct current into alternate current to supply power
to the motor, and transforms alternate current into direct current to charge
the high voltage battery.
• LDC : Transforms power from the high voltage battery to low voltage (12 V)
to supply power to the vehicle (DC-DC).
• Motor : Uses electrical energy stored inside the high voltage battery to
drive the vehicle (functions like an engine in a standard vehicle).
• Reduction gear : Delivers rotational force of the motor to the tires at
appropriate speeds and torque.
• High voltage battery (lithium-ion polymer) : Stores and supplies power
necessary for the electric vehicle to operate (12 V auxiliary battery provides
power to the vehicle features such as lights and wipers).
❈ OBC : On-Board Charger
❈ LDC : Low Voltage DC-DC Converter
H4
WARNING
• Do not intentionally remove or
disassemble high voltage
components and high voltage
battery connectors and wires.
Also, be careful not to damage high voltage components
and the high voltage battery. It
may cause serious injury and
significantly impact the performance and durability of the
vehicle.
• When inspection and maintenance is required for high
voltage components and the
high voltage battery, we recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
High Voltage Battery
(lithium-ion polymer)
• The charge amount of the high
voltage battery may gradually
decrease when the vehicle is not
driving.
• The battery capacity of the high
voltage battery may decrease
when the vehicle is stored in
high/low temperatures.
• Distance to empty may vary
depending on the driving conditions, even if the charge amount is
the same. The high voltage battery
may expend more energy when
driving at high-speed or uphill.
These actions may reduce the distance to empty.
• The high voltage battery is used
when using the air-conditioner /
heater. This may reduce the distance to empty. Make sure to set
moderate temperatures when
using the air-conditioner/heater.
• Natural degradation may occur
with the high voltage battery
depending on the number of years
the vehicle is used. This may
reduce the distance to empty.
• When the charge capacity and distance to empty keep falling, we
recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
inspection and maintenance.
• If the vehicle will not be in use for
an extended period of time, charge
the high voltage battery once every
three months to prevent it from discharging. Also, if the charge
amount is not enough, immediately charge to full and store the vehicle.
• AC charge is recommended to
keep the high voltage battery in
optimal condition.
If the high voltage battery charge
amount is below 20%, you can
keep the high voltage battery performance in optimal condition if
you charge the high voltage battery
to 100%. (Once a month or more is
recommended.)
CAUTION
• Make sure to use a designated
charger when charging the
high voltage battery. Using different types of chargers may
have a serious impact on vehicle durability.
• Make sure that the high voltage battery charger gauge
does not reach ''L (Low) or 0".
If the vehicle is kept at ''L (Low)
or 0" for a long period, it may
damage the high voltage battery and the high voltage battery may have to be replaced
depending on the level of
degradation.
• If the vehicle is in a collision,
we recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer to inspect whether the
high voltage battery is still
connected.
H5
MAIN COMPONENTS OF ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
High Voltage Battery Warmer
System
The high voltage battery warmer
system prevents reduction of battery
output when battery temperature is
low. If the charging connector is connected, the warmer system automatically operate according to the battery temperature.
Charging time may shorten compare
to vehicles without the high voltage
battery warmer system. But, electricity charge may increase because of
high voltage battery warmer system
operation.
CAUTION
The high voltage battery warmer
system operates when the charging connector is connected to
the vehicle.
However, the high voltage
warmer system may not operate
when battery temperature drops
below -35°C (-31°F).
H6
EV MODE
Nearby Stations
If you select the "EV" menu at the
home screen you can enter EV
mode.
For details on EV Mode, refer to the
Multimedia manual that is provided
separately.
The EV mode has a total of 5 menus,
Nearby station, Energy information,
Charge management, ECO driving
and EV settings.
❈ EV mode menu may vary depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
Select ‘EV → Map → Charging stations’ on the screen. Stations around
the current location are searched.
Select a station to see detail information of the station.
H7
EV MODE (CONT.)
H8
Energy Information
Battery information
Energy consumption
Select ‘EV → Energy information’ on
the screen.
You can check battery information
and energy consumption.
You can check the reachable range,
total battery power remaining, and
expected charging time for each
charge type.
• The distance to empty is calculated based on the real-time fuel efficiency while driving. The distance
may change if the driving pattern
changes.
• The distance to empty may vary
according to the change of the
driving pattern even if the same
target battery charge level is set.
You can check the current energy
consumption for each system of the
vehicle.
➀ ‘Driving’ shows the total power and
energy consumption of the driving
motor’s driving energy and regenerative energy.
➁ ‘Climate’ shows the power and
energy consumption which are
used by the heater or air conditioner.
➂ ‘Electronics’ shows the power and
energy consumption which are
used by the vehicle systems
including the cluster, infotainment
system (speaker and navigation),
headlamp, vehicle control unit,
etc.
➃ ‘Battery care’ shows the momentary power and energy consumption which are used when:
• Operating the winter mode to
increase the battery temperature
during winter to improve the driving performance.
• Cooling down the battery temperature during summer to prevent
over temperature of the battery.
Charge Management
Charging and climate
You can set the date and time of
when to charge the battery and the
climate control temperature. Also,
you may select the time to start
charging using the off-peak time setting.
Departure time
1. Set anticipated departure time for
scheduled charging and target
temperature.
2. Select the day of the week to activate scheduled charging and target
temperature for departure time.
Select ‘EV → Charge management’
on the screen. You can set the date
and time of when to charge the battery, climate control temperature,
location-based charging options and
other various functions.
H9
EV MODE (CONT.)
Charging location
Target temperature settings
1. Set target temperature.
❈ Pre-schedule heating
If the target temperature (1) is set
with the cable connected, the cabin
temperature will be adjusted to the
target temperature at departure time.
In cold weather, pre-schedule heating helps enhance electric vehicle
performance by heating the vehicle
in advance.
H10
Off-peak time settings
1. If selected, starts charging only on
the designated off-peak time If
deselected, starts charging only
on the scheduled time
2. Set the most inexpensive time to
complete charging
3. • Off-peak tariffs priorised: If
selected, starts charging at offpeak time (may keep on charging
pass off-peak time to charge
100%)
• Off-peak tariffs only: If selected,
charges only within off-peak time
(may not charge 100%)
If location-based charging is selected, scheduled charging and target
temperature will be activated at the
location the driver has set. Also, the
charging current can be selected
when charged with AC charger.
❈ Scheduled charging function must
be turned on to activate when
location-based charging is selected.
Charging limit
• The target battery charge level can
be selected when charged with AC
charger or DC charger
• The charging level can be changed
by 10%.
• If the target battery charge level is
lower than the high voltage battery
charge level, the battery will not be
charged.
Charging current
ECO Driving
• You can adjust the charging current for an AC charger. Select an
appropriate charging current for
the charger used.
• If the charging process does not
start or abruptly stops in the middle, re-select another proper current and re-try charging the vehicle.
• Charging time varies depending on
which charging current is selected
Select ‘EV → ECO Driving’ on the
screen. You can check the Eco contribution and Fuel economy history.
Eco contribution
You can check Eco contribution information compared to the gasoline
vehicle of similar size.
H11
EV MODE (CONT.)
H12
Driving history
EV Settings
Winter mode
You can check the date, driving distance and the energy efficient rating
of the previous driving trips. The date
with the highest energy efficient driving is marked with a star shaped
icon.
Select ‘EV → ECO settings’ on the
screen. You can set the Winter mode,
Warning and EV route functions.
You can select or deselect the Winter
mode.
The Winter mode is efficient during
the winter time when the high voltage
battery temperature is low.
This mode is recommended to
improve driving and DC charging
performances during winter by raising the battery temperature to an
adequate level.
However, the driving distance may
be reduced as the energy is required
to increase battery temperature.
Also, if the battery temperature is low
during driving or when scheduled air
conditioner/heater is activated, this
mode is operated to improve driving
performance.
However, the mode is not operated
to ensure driving distance when the
battery level is low.
❈ This mode is available for the vehicles equipped with the battery
heater.
Warning
EV route
You can select or deselect the Range
Warning.
If EV route is selected, EV related
information will show on the route.
You can check the distance the vehicle can be driven with the current
battery amount along the route. An
icon is also indicated so the driver is
able to search for nearby charging
stations.
- Range Warning : If the destination
set in the navigation cannot be
reached with the remaining battery,
a warning message is displayed.
H13
CHARGE TYPES FOR ELECTRIC VEHICLE
Charging Information
• AC Charge :
The electric vehicle is charged by
plugging into a AC charger installed
in your home or a public charging
station. (For further details, refer to
the 'AC Charge'.)
• DC Charge (if equipped) :
You can charge at high speeds at
public charging stations. Refer to
the respective company's manual
that is provided for each DC charger type.
Battery performance and durability
can deteriorate if the DC charger is
used constantly.
Use of DC charge should be minimized in order to help prolong high
voltage battery life.
• Trickle Charge :
The Electric vehicle can be charged
by using household electricity. The
electrical outlet in your home must
comply with regulations and can
safely accommodate the Voltage /
Current (Amps) / Power (Watts) ratings specified on the portable
charge.
H14
Charging Time Information
Charging type
Takes approx. 6 hours 5 minutes at room
temperature when charged to 100%.
AC charge
DC charge
(if equipped)
Economical battery type
Takes about 54 minutes at room temperature
100 kW charger when charged to 80%.
Can be charged to 100%.
50 kW charger
Trickle charge
Takes about 57 minutes at room temperature
when charged to 80%.
Can be charged to 100%.
Takes approx. 17 hours 30 minutes at room
temperature when charged to 100%.
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery, charger
specifications, and ambient temperature, the time required for charging the
high voltage battery may vary.
Charging Types (Type A)
Category
Charging Inlet
(Vehicle)
Charging Connector
Charging Outlet
How to Charge
Use AC charger
installed in homes
or public charging
station
AC Charge
OAEEQ016020
OLFP0Q5006K
Charging Time
Approx. 6 hours 5 minutes (to fully charge,
100%)
OLFP0Q5007K
Use the DC charger 50 kw : approx. 57 min.
at public charging
100 kw : approx. 54 min.
station
(to charge 80%)
DC Charge
(if equipped)
OAEEQ016021
OAEEQ016022
OAEEQ016023
Approx. 17 hours 30
Use household curminutes (to fully charge,
rent
100%)
Trickle
Charge
OAEEQ016020
OLFP0Q5006K
OAEEQ016024
• Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery, charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for charging the high voltage battery may vary.
• Actual charger image and charging method may vary in accordance with the charger manufacturer.
H15
CHARGE TYPES FOR ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
Charging Types (Type B)
Category
Charging Inlet
(Vehicle)
Charging Connector
Charging Outlet
How to Charge
Use AC charger
installed in homes
or public charging
station
AC Charge
OAEEQ016020L
OAEEQ016078L
Charging Time
Approx. 6 hours 5 minutes (to fully charge,
100%)
OLFP0Q5007K
Use the DC charger 50 kw : approx. 57 min.
at public charging
100 kw : approx. 54 min.
station
(to charge 80%)
DC Charge
(if equipped)
OAEEQ016021L
OAEEQ016022L
OAEEQ016023
Approx. 17 hours 30
Use household curminutes (to fully charge,
rent
100%)
Trickle
Charge
OAEEQ016020L
OAEEQ016078L
OAEEQ016024
• Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery, charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for charging the high voltage battery may vary.
• Actual charger image and charging method may vary in accordance with the charger manufacturer.
H16
CHARGE INDICATOR LAMP FOR ELECTRIC VEHICLE
Charging Status
Operation of Charging Indicator Lamp
Details
OAEEQ016025
When charging the high voltage battery, the charge level can be checked
from outside the vehicle.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(OFF)
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
(OFF)
(ON)
Blink
(OFF)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
(ON)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
Blink
Blink
Error while charging
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
Charging 12 V auxiliary battery or scheduled air
conditioner is operating
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
Not Charged
0~33%
Charging
34~66%
67~99%
Fully charged (100%)(turns OFF in 5 seconds)
- Reserved charging is operating
(turns OFF after 3 minutes)
- Charging is temporarily interrupted
(e.g. power failure)
H17
CHARGING CONNECTOR LOCK
Locking Charging Cable
When the Charging Connector
is Locked
While
Do not lock
Always
charging
(if equipped)
OAEEQ019085R
You may select when the charging
connector can be locked and
unlocked in the charging inlet.
The driver can select the charge connector lock mode from the User
Settings in the LCD display by selecting 'User Settings ➝ Convenience ➝
Locking Charging Cable'.
H18
Before
charging
X
O
X
While
charging
O
O
X
Finished
charging
X
O
X
• Always mode :
The connector locks when the
charging connector is plugged into
the charging inlet. The connector is
locked until all doors are unlocked
by the driver. This mode can be
used to prevent charging cable
theft.
- If the charging connector is
unlocked when all doors are
unlocked, but the charging cable
is not disconnected within 15 seconds, the connector will be automatically locked again.
- If the charging connector is
unlocked when all doors are
unlocked, but all doors are locked
again, immediately, the connector
will be automatically locked
again.
• While charging mode :
The connector locks when charging starts. The connector unlocks
when charging is complete. This
mode can be used when charging
in a public charging station.
• Do not lock mode (if equipped) :
The connector unlocks regardless
of the state of charging.
Press the charging connector
release button, disconnect the connector.
Be careful to theft of the charging
cable.
SCHEDULED CHARGING
Scheduled Charging
(if equipped)
• You can set-up a charging schedule for your vehicle using the infotainment system or Blue Link application.
Refer to the infotainment system
manual or the Blue Link manual for
detailed information about setting
scheduled charging.
• Scheduled charging can only be
done when using a AC charger or
the portable charger (ICCB: InCable Control Box).
OAEEQ016026
OAEEQ019027
• When scheduled charging is set
and the AC charger or the portable
charger (ICCB: In-Cable Control
Box) is connected for charging, the
indicator lamp in the middle blinks
(for 3 minutes) to indicate that
scheduled charging is set.
• When scheduled charging is set,
charging is not initiated immediately when the AC charger or portable
charger (ICCB: In-Cable Control
Box) is connected. When immediate charging is required, use the
infotainment system to deactivate
the scheduled charge setting or
press schedule charging deactivation ( ) button.
• If you press the scheduled charging deactivation ( ) button to
immediately charge the battery,
charging must be initiated 3 minutes after the charging cable has
been connected.
When you press the scheduled
charging deactivation ( ) for immediate charging, the scheduled
charge setting is not completely
deactivated. If you need to completely deactivate the scheduled
charge setting, use the infotainment
system to finalize the deactivation.
Refer to "AC Charge or Trickle
Charge" for details about connecting
the AC charger and the portable
charger (ICCB: In-Cable Control Box).
H19
PRECAUTIONS FOR CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE
Charging Precautions
WARNING
■ AC Charger
OLFP0Q5007K
■ DC Charger
OAEEQ016023
Actual charger image and charging method may vary in accordance with the charger manufacturer.
H20
• Electromagnetic waves that
are generated from the charger can seriously impact medical electric devices such as
an implantable cardiac pacemaker.
When using medical electric
devices such as an implantable
cardiac pacemaker, make sure
to ask the medical team and
manufacturer whether charging your electric vehicle will
impact the operation of the
medical electric devices such
as an implantable cardiac
pacemaker.
• Check to make sure there is
no water or dust on the charging cable connector and plug
before connecting to the
charger and charging inlet.
Connecting while there is
water or dust on the charging
cable connector and plug may
cause a fire or electric shock.
WARNING
• Be careful not to touch the
charging connector, charging
plug, and the charging inlet
when connecting the cable to
the charger and the charging
inlet on the vehicle.
• Comply with the following in
order to prevent electrical
shock when charging:
- Use a waterproof charger.
- Be careful when touching
the charging connector and
charging plug with your
hands wet, or when standing
in water or snow while connecting the charging cable.
- Be careful when there is
lightning.
- Be careful when the charging connector and plug is
wet.
WARNING
• Immediately stop charging
when you find abnormal
symptoms (odor, smoke).
• Replace the charging cable if
the cable coating is damaged
to prevent electrical shock.
• When connecting or removing
the charging cable, make sure
to hold the charging connector handle and charging plug.
If you pull the cable itself
(without using the handle), the
internal wires may disconnect
or get damaged. This may lead
to electric shock or fire.
CAUTION
• Always keep the charging con-
•
•
•
•
nector and charging plug in
clean and dry condition. Be
sure to keep the charging
cable in a condition where
there is no water or moisture.
Make sure to use the designated charger for charging the
electric vehicle. Using any
other charger may cause failure.
Before charging the battery,
turn the vehicle OFF.
When the vehicle is switched
OFF while charging, the cooling fan inside the motor compartment may automatically
operate. Do not touch the cooling fan while charging.
Be careful not to drop the
charging
connector. The
charging connector can be
damaged.
H21
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (AC CHARGE) - TYPE A
How to Connect AC Charger
AC Charge
1.Depress the brake pedal and apply
the parking brake.
2.Turn OFF all switches, shift to P
(Park), and turn OFF the vehicle.
If charging is initiated without the
gear in P (Park), the charging will
start after the gear is automatically
shifted to P (Park).
■ AC Charger
OLFP0Q5007K
Actual charger image and charging method may vary in accordance with the charger manufacturer.
OAEEQ016030
3.Press center edge of the charging
door to open the charging door.
i Information
The charging door opens only when
the door is unlocked.
4. Check if there is dust on the
charging connector and charging
inlet.
H22
i Information
OAEEQ016031
5. Hold the charging connector handle and connect it to the vehicle
AC charging inlet. Push the connector until you hear a "clicking"
sound. If the charging connector
and charging terminal are not connected properly, this may cause a
fire.
Locking Charging Cable
The charging connector is locked in
the inlet at a different period according to which mode is selected.
• Always mode :
The connector locks when the
charging connector is plugged into
the charging inlet.
• While charging mode :
The connector locks when charging
starts.
• Do not lock mode (if equipped) :
The connector unlocks regardless of
the state of charging.
For more details, refer to “Locking
Charging Cable” in this chapter.
■ AC Charger
OLFP0Q5007K
6. Connect the charging plug to the
electric outlet at a AC charging
station to start charging.
H23
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (AC CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
i Information
OAEEQ019032
7. Check if the charging indicator
light of the high voltage battery in
the instrument cluster is turned
ON. Charging is not done when
the charging indicator lamp is
OFF.
When the charging connector and
charging plug are not connected
properly, reconnect the charging
cable to charge.
• Even though charging is possible
with the POWER button in the
ON/START position, for your safety, start charging when the POWER
button is in the OFF position and
the vehicle shifted to P (Park). After
charging has started, you can use
electrical components such as the
radio by pressing the POWER button to the ACC or ON position.
• During AC charging, the radio
reception may be bad.
• During charging, the gear cannot be
shifted from P (Park) to any other
gear.
OOSEV048133L
8. After charging has started, the estimated charging time is displayed on
the instrument cluster for about 1
minute.
If you open the driver seat door while
charging, the estimated charging
time is also displayed on the instrument cluster for about 1 minute.
When scheduled charging is set, the
estimated charging time is displayed
as "--" .
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery,
charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for
charging the battery may vary.
H24
Checking Charging Status
Operation of Charging Indicator Lamp
Details
OAEEQ016025
When charging the high voltage battery, the charge level can be checked
from outside the vehicle.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(OFF)
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
(OFF)
(ON)
Blink
(OFF)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
(ON)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
Blink
Blink
Error while charging
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
Charging 12 V auxiliary battery or scheduled air
conditioner is operating
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
Not Charged
0~33%
Charging
34~66%
67~99%
Fully charged (100%) (turns OFF in 5 seconds)
- Reserved charging is operating
(turns OFF after 3 minutes)
- Charging is temporarily interrupted
(e.g. power failure)
H25
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (AC CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
How to Disconnect AC Charger
i Information
■ AC Charger
OAEEQ016033
OLFP0Q5007K
1.When charging is complete, remove
the charging plug from the electrical
outlet of the AC charging station.
H26
2.Hold the charging connector handle and pull it while pressing the
release button (1).
To prevent charging cable theft, the
charging connector cannot be disconnected from the inlet when the doors
are locked. Unlock all doors to disconnect the charging connector from the
inlet.
However, if the vehicle is in the charging connector ‘While charging’ mode,
the charging connector automatically
unlocks from the inlet when charging
is completed.
For more details, refer to “Locking
Charging Cable” in this chapter.
Unlock Charging Connector in
Emergency
OAEEQ016060
OAEEQ016034
3. Make sure to completely close the
charging door.
If the charging connector does not
disconnect due to battery discharge
and failure of the electric wires, open
the hood and slightly pull the emergency cable. The charging connector
will then disconnect.
H27
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (DC CHARGE) - TYPE A
i Information
DC Charge
How to Connect DC Charger
If you use a DC charger when the
vehicle is already fully charged, some
DC chargers will send out an error
message. When the vehicle is fully
charged, do not charge the vehicle.
■ DC Charger
OAEEQ016023
You can charge at high speeds at
public charging stations. Refer to the
respective company's manual that is
provided for each DC charger type.
Battery performance and durability
can deteriorate if the DC charger is
used constantly.
Use of DC charge should be minimized in order to help prolong high
voltage battery life.
Actual charger image and charging method may vary in accordance with the charger manufacturer.
H28
OAEEQ019063L
1.Depress the brake pedal and apply
the parking brake.
2.Turn OFF all switches, shift to P
(Park), and turn OFF the vehicle.
3.Press the charging door open
switch ( ) to open the charging
door. Charging door open switch
can be operated only when vehicle
is turned off.
4.If you cannot open the charging
door due to freezing weather :
1) Remove any ice near the charging door.
2) Pull the emergency cable to
open the charging door.
(When the charging door does
not open, refer to “How to Unlock
Charging Door in Emergencies.”)
OAEEQ016037
5.Remove the charging inlet cover.
6.Check whether there is dust or foreign substances inside the charging connector and charging inlet.
OAEEQ016038
OAEEQ019032
7.Hold the charging connector handle and connect it to the vehicle
DC charging inlet. Push the connector until you hear a "clicking"
sound. If the charging connector
and charging terminal are not connected properly, this may cause a
fire.
Refer to the manual for each type
of DC charger for how to charge
and remove the charger.
8.Check if the charging indicator light
of the high voltage battery in the
instrument cluster is turned ON.
Charging is not done when the
charging indicator lamp is OFF.
When the charging connector is
not connected properly, reconnect
the charging cable to charge it
again.
During cold weather, DC charging
may not be available to prevent
high voltage battery degradation.
H29
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (DC CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
Unlock Charging Door in
Emergency
i Information
• Even though charging is possible
with the POWER button in the
ON/START position, for your safety, start charging when the POWER
button is in the OFF position and
the vehicle shifted to P (Park).
After charging has started, you can
use electrical components such as
the radio by pressing the POWER
button to ACC or ON position.
• During charging, the gear cannot be
shifted from P (Park) to any other
gear.
OOSEV048198L
9. After charging has started, the
estimated charging time is displayed on the instrument cluster
for about 1 minute.
If you open the driver seat door
while charging, the estimated
charging time is also displayed on
the instrument cluster for about 1
minute.
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery,
charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for
charging the battery may vary.
H30
OAEE046010
If the charging door does not open
due to battery discharge and failure
of the electric wires, open the tailgate and slightly pull the emergency
cable as shown above. The charging
door will then open.
Checking Charging Status
Operation of Charging Indicator Lamp
Details
OAEEQ016025
When charging the high voltage battery, the charge level can be checked
from outside the vehicle.
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery,
charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for
charging the battery may vary.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(OFF)
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
(OFF)
(ON)
Blink
(OFF)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
(ON)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
Blink
Blink
Error while charging
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
Charging 12 V auxiliary battery or scheduled air
conditioner is operating
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
Not Charged
0~33%
Charging
34~66%
67~99%
Fully charged (100%)(turns OFF in 5 seconds)
- Reserved charging is operating
(turns OFF after 3 minutes)
- Charging is temporarily interrupted
(e.g. power failure)
H31
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (DC CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
How to Disconnect DC Charger
OAEEQ016040
1. Remove the charging connector
when DC charging is completed,
or after you stop charging using
the DC charger. Refer to each
respective DC charger manual for
details about how to disconnect
the charging connector.
H32
OAEEQ016041
2. Make sure to install the charging
inlet cover (1).
3. Make sure to completely close the
charging door (2).
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE A
How to set the charge level of
the portable charger
Trickle Charge
■ Portable Charger
Plug
Electric Outlet
OOSEVQ018054
OAEEQ016042N
(1) Code and Plug (Code set)
(2) Control Box
(3) Charging Cable and Charging
Connector
Trickle Charge can be used when AC
Charge or DC Charge is not available by using household electricity.
OLFP0Q5020K
1. Check the rated current of the
electric outlet prior to connecting
the plug to the outlet.
2. Connect the plug to a household
electric outlet.
3. Check the display window on the
control box.
4. Press the button (1) on the back of
the control box for more than 1
second to adjust the charge level.
(Refer to charging cable type and
example for setting the charge
level.)
5. The display window on the control
box changes from 12A and 10A to
8A every time you press the button
(1).
6. When setting the charge level is
complete, start charging according to the trickle charge procedure.
H33
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
* Example for setting the ICCB charge level
(The example is only for reference and may vary according to the surrounding environment.)
Outlet current
ICCB charge
level
14-16A
12A
13-12A
10A
11-10A
8A
OLFP0Q5020K
6A
1. Connect the plug to a household
electric outlet.
9-8A
Control box display window
Plug
OOSEVQ018055
H34
How to Connect Portable Charger
(ICCB: In-Cable Control Box)
Electric Outlet
OOSEVQ018056
OAEEQ016031
2. Check if the power lamp (green)
illuminates on the control box.
3. Depress the brake pedal and
apply the parking brake.
4. Turn OFF all switches, shift to P
(Park), and turn OFF the vehicle.
If charging is initiated without the
gear in P (Park), the charging will
start after the gear is automatically
shifted to P (Park).
7. Hold the charging connector handle and connect it to the vehicle
AC charging inlet. Push the connector until you hear a "clicking"
sound. If the charging connector
and charging terminal are not connected properly, this may cause a
fire.
OAEEQ016030
5. Press center edge of the charging
door to open the charging door.
i Information
The charging door opens only when
the door is unlocked.
6.Check if there is dust on the charging connector and charging inlet.
H35
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
i Information
Locking Charging Cable
The charging connector is locked in
the inlet at a different period according to which mode is selected.
• Always mode :
The connector locks when the
charging connector is plugged into
the charging inlet.
• While charging mode :
The connector locks when charging
starts.
• Do not lock mode (if equipped) :
The connector unlocks regardless of
the state of charging.
For more details, refer to “Locking
Charging Cable” in this chapter.
H36
OOSEVQ018057
OAEEQ019032
8. Charging starts automatically
(charging lamp blinks).
9. Check if the charging indicator
light of the high voltage battery in
the instrument cluster is turned
ON. Charging is not done when
the charging indicator lamp is
OFF.
When the charging connector is
not connected properly, reconnect
the charging cable to charge it
again.
i Information
• Even though charging is possible
with the POWER button in the
ON/START position, for your safety, start charging when the POWER
button is in the OFF position and
the vehicle shifted to P (Park).
After charging has started, you can
use electrical components such as
the radio by pressing the POWER
button to ACC or ON position.
• During charging, the gear cannot be
shifted from P (Park) to any other
gear.
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery,
charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for
charging the battery may vary.
OOSEV048133L
10. After charging has started, the
estimated charging time is displayed on the instrument cluster
for about 1 minute.
If you open the driver seat door
while charging, the estimated
charging time is also displayed on
the instrument cluster for about 1
minute.
When scheduled charging is set,
the estimated charging time is
displayed as “--" .
H37
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
Checking Charging Status
Operation of Charging Indicator Lamp
Details
OAEEQ016025
When charging the high voltage battery, the charge level can be checked
from outside the vehicle.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(OFF)
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
(OFF)
(ON)
Blink
(OFF)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
(ON)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
Blink
Blink
Error while charging
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
Charging 12 V auxiliary battery or scheduled air
conditioner is operating
(OFF)
H38
Blink
(OFF)
Not Charged
0~33%
Charging
34~66%
67~99%
Fully charged (100%)(turns OFF in 5 seconds)
- Reserved charging is operating
(turns OFF after 3 minutes)
- Charging is temporarily interrupted
(e.g. power failure)
Charging Status Indicator Lamp for Portable Charger
Control Box
Indicator
PLUG
Details
(Green)
(Red)
On : Power on
Blink : Plug temperature sensor failure
On : Plug high temperature protection
Blink : Plug high temperature warning
POWER
On : Power on
CHARGE
Blink : Charging In power saving mode, only the CHARGE
indicator is illuminated.
FAULT
Blink : Charging interrupted
CHARGE LEVEL
Type A
Type B
Type C
12 A
10 A
8A
10 A
8A
7A
8A
6A
6A
The charging current
changes (3 level)
whenever the button
(1) is pressed for 1
sec with the charger
plugged into an
electrical outlet but
not the vehicle.
❈ Back of the control box
Charging connector plugged
(Green)
VEHICLE
Charging
(Blue)
Blink : Charging impossible
(Red)
H39
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
Charging Status Indicator Lamp for Portable Charger
NO
1
Control Box
Status / Diagnosis / Countermeasure
• Charging connector plugged into vehicle
(Green ON)
• Plug temperature sensor failure
(Green blink)
• Plug high temperature protection
(Red blink)
• Plug high temperature warning (Red ON)
NO
Control Box
Status / Diagnosis / Countermeasure
2
- Charging connector plugged into
vehicle (Green ON)
4
- Before plugging charging connector
into vehicle (Red blink)
• Abnormal temperature
• ICCB (In-Cable Control Box) failure
We recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3
- While charging
• Charge indicator (Green blink)
• Vehicle indicator (Blue ON)
We recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H40
Charging Status Indicator Lamp for Portable Charger
NO
5
Control Box
Status / Diagnosis / Countermeasure
- Plugged into vehicle (Red blink)
• Diagnostic device failure
• Current leakage
• Abnormal temperature
NO
7
Status / Diagnosis / Countermeasure
- After plugging charging connector
into vehicle (Red blink)
• Communication failure
6
We recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
We recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Plug temperature sensor failure
(Green blink)
• Plug high temperature protection
(Red blink)
• Plug high temperature warning (Red ON)
Control Box
8
- Power saving mode
• 3 minutes after charging starts
(Green blink)
We recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H41
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
How to Disconnect Portable
Charger (ICCB: In-Cable Control
Box)
H42
i Information
To prevent charging cable theft, the
charging connector cannot be disconnected from the inlet when the doors are
locked. Unlock all doors to disconnect
the charging connector from the inlet.
However, if the vehicle is in the charging
connector ‘While charging’ mode, the
charging connector automatically
unlocks from the inlet when charging is
completed.
For more details, refer to “Locking
Charging Cable” in this chapter.
OAEEQ016033
OAEEQ016034
1.Hold the charging connector handle and pull it while pressing the
release button (1).
2. Make sure to completely close the
charging door.
Unlock Charging Connector in
Emergency
Plug
Electric Outlet
OAEEQ016061
3.Disconnect the plug from the
household electric outlet. Do not
pull the cable when disconnecting
the plug.
4.Close the protective cover for the
charging connector so that foreign
material cannot get into the terminal.
5.Put the charging cable inside the
cable compartment to protect it.
OAEEQ016060
If the charging connector does not
disconnect due to battery discharge
and failure of the electric wires, open
the hood and slightly pull the emergency cable. The charging connector
will then disconnect .
Precautions for Portable
Charger (ICCB: In-Cable Control
Box)
• Use the portable charger that is
certified by HYUNDAI Motors.
• Do not try to repair, disassemble,
or adjust the portable charger.
• Do not use an extension cord or
adapter.
• Stop using immediately when failure occurs.
• Do not touch the plug and charging
connector with wet hands.
• Do not touch the terminal part of
the AC charging connector and the
AC charging inlet on the vehicle.
• Do not connect the charging connector to voltage that does not
comply with regulations.
• Do not use the portable charger if it
is worn out, exposed, or there
exists any type of damage on the
portable charger.
H43
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE A (CONT.)
• If the ICCB case and AC charging
connector is damaged, cracked, or
the wires are exposed in any way,
do not use the portable charger.
• Do not let children operate or touch
the portable charger.
• Keep the control box free of water.
• Keep the AC charging connector or
plug terminal free of foreign substances.
• Do not step on the cable or cord.
Do not pull the cable or cord and
do not twist or bend it.
• Do not charge when there is lightning.
• Do not drop the control box or
place a heavy object on the control
box.
• Do not place an object that can
generate high temperatures near
the charger when charging.
• Charging with the worn out or damaged household electric outlet can
result in a risk of electric shock. If
you are in doubt to the household
electric outlet condition, have it
checked by a licensed electrician.
H44
• Stop using the portable charger
immediately if the household electric outlet or any components is
overheated or you notice burnt
odors.
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (AC CHARGE) - TYPE B
How to Connect AC Charger
AC Charge
■ AC Charge
OLFP0Q5007K
Actual charger image and charging method may vary in accordance with the charger manufacturer.
3. Press the charging door open
switch ( ) to open the charging
door. Charging door open switch
can be operated only when vehicle is turned off.
4. If you cannot open the charging
door due to freezing weather :
1) Remove any ice near the
charging door.
2) Pull the emergency cable to
open the charging door.
(When the charging door does
not open, refer to “How to Unlock
Charging Door in Emergencies.”)
OAEEQ019117L
1. Depress the brake pedal and
apply the parking brake.
2. Turn OFF all switches, shift to P
(Park), and turn OFF the vehicle.
If charging is initiated without the
gear in P (Park), the charging will
start after the gear is automatically
shifted to P (Park).
H45
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (AC CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
i Information
H46
OAEEQ016064L
OAEEQ016031L
5. Remove the charging inlet cover
(1).
6. Check if there is dust on the
charging connector and charging
inlet.
7. Hold the charging connector handle and connect it to the vehicle
AC charging inlet. Push the connector until you hear a "clicking"
sound. If the charging connector
and charging terminal are not connected properly, this may cause a
fire.
Locking Charging Cable
The charging connector is locked in
the inlet at a different period according to which mode is selected.
• Always mode :
The connector locks when the
charging connector is plugged into
the charging inlet.
• While charging mode :
The connector locks when charging
starts.
For more details, refer to “Locking
Charging Cable” in this chapter.
i Information
■ AC Charger
OLFP0Q5007K
OAEEQ019032
8. Connect the charging plug to the
electric outlet at a AC charging
station to start charging.
9. Check if the charging indicator
light of the high voltage battery in
the instrument cluster is turned
ON. Charging is not done when
the charging indicator lamp is
OFF.
When the charging connector and
charging plug are not connected
properly, reconnect the charging
cable to charge.
• Even though charging is possible
with the POWER button in the
ON/START position, for your safety, start charging when the POWER
button is in the OFF position and
the vehicle shifted to P (Park). After
charging has started, you can use
electrical components such as the
radio by pressing the POWER button to the ACC or ON position.
• During AC charging, the radio
reception may be bad.
• During charging, the gear cannot be
shifted from P (Park) to any other
gear.
H47
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (AC CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery,
charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for
charging the battery may vary.
Unlock Charging Door in
Emergency
OOSEV048133L
10. After charging has started, the
estimated charging time is displayed on the instrument cluster
for about 1 minute.
If you open the driver seat door
while charging, the estimated
charging time is also displayed
on the instrument cluster for
about 1 minute.
When scheduled charging is set,
the estimated charging time is
displayed as “--" .
H48
OAEE046010
If the charging door does not open
due to battery discharge and failure
of the electric wires, open the tailgate and slightly pull the emergency
cable as shown above. The charging
door will then open.
Checking Charging Status
Operation of Charging Indicator Lamp
Details
OAEEQ016025
When charging the high voltage battery, the charge level can be checked
from outside the vehicle.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(OFF)
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
(OFF)
(ON)
Blink
(OFF)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
(ON)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
Blink
Blink
Error while charging
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
Charging 12 V auxiliary battery or scheduled air
conditioner is operating
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
Not Charged
0~33%
Charging
34~66%
67~99%
Fully charged (100%)(turns OFF in 5 seconds)
- Reserved charging is operating
(turns OFF after 3 minutes)
- Charging is temporarily interrupted
(e.g. power failure)
H49
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (AC CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
How to Disconnect AC Charger
i Information
■ AC Charger
OAEEQ016033L
OLFP0Q5007K
1.When charging is complete, remove
the charging plug from the electrical
outlet of the AC charging station.
H50
2.Hold the charging connector handle and pull it.
To prevent charging cable theft, the
charging connector cannot be disconnected from the inlet when the doors
are locked. Unlock all doors to disconnect the charging connector from the
inlet.
However, if the vehicle is in the charging connector While charging mode,
the charging connector automatically
unlocks from the inlet when charging
is completed.
For more details, refer to “Locking
Charging Cable” in this chapter.
Unlock Charging Connector in
Emergency
OAEEQ016034L
3. Make sure to install the charging
inlet cover.
4. Make sure to completely close the
charging door.
OAEEQ016057L
If the charging connector does not
disconnect due to battery discharge
and failure of the electric wires, open
the tailgate and slightly pull the
emergency cable. The charging connector will then disconnect.
H51
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (DC CHARGE) - TYPE B
DC Charge (if equipped)
i Information
How to Connect DC Charger
If you use a DC charger when the
vehicle is already fully charged, some
DC chargers will send out an error
message. When the vehicle is fully
charged, do not charge the vehicle.
■ DC Charger
OAEEQ016023
You can charge at high speeds at
public charging stations. Refer to the
respective company's manual that is
provided for each DC charger type.
Battery performance and durability
can deteriorate if the DC charger is
used constantly.
Use of DC charge should be minimized in order to help prolong high
voltage battery life.
Actual charger image and charging
method may vary in accordance
with the charger manufacturer.
H52
OAEEQ019117L
1.Depress the brake pedal and apply
the parking brake.
2.Turn OFF all switches, shift to P
(Park), and turn OFF the vehicle.
3.Press the charging door open
switch ( ) to open the charging
door. Charging door open switch
can be operated only when vehicle
is turned off.
4.If you cannot open the charging
door due to freezing weather :
1) Remove any ice near the charging door.
2) Pull the emergency cable to
open the charging door.
(When the charging door does
not open, refer to “How to Unlock
Charging Door in Emergencies.”)
OAEEQ016065L
OAEEQ019032
5.Remove the charging inlet cover
(1).
6.Check whether there is dust or foreign substances inside the charging connector and charging inlet.
7.Hold the charging connector handle and connect it to the vehicle
DC charging inlet. Push the connector until you hear a "clicking"
sound. If the charging connector
and charging terminal are not connected properly, this may cause a
fire.
Refer to the manual for each type
of DC charger for how to charge
and remove the charger.
8.Check if the charging indicator light
of the high voltage battery in the
instrument cluster is turned ON.
Charging is not done when the
charging indicator lamp is OFF.
When the charging connector is
not connected properly, reconnect
the charging cable to charge it
again.
During cold weather, DC charging
may not be available to prevent
high voltage battery degradation.
H53
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (DC CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
Unlock Charging Door in
Emergency
i Information
• Even though charging is possible
with the POWER button in the
ON/START position, for your safety, start charging when the POWER
button is in the OFF position and
the vehicle shifted to P (Park).
After charging has started, you can
use electrical components such as
the radio by pressing the POWER
button to ACC or ON position.
• During charging, the gear cannot be
shifted from P (Park) to any other
gear.
OOSEV048198L
9. After charging has started, the
estimated charging time is displayed on the instrument cluster
for about 1 minute.
If you open the driver seat door
while charging, the estimated
charging time is also displayed on
the instrument cluster for about 1
minute.
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery,
charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for
charging the battery may vary.
H54
OAEE046010
If the charging door does not open
due to battery discharge and failure
of the electric wires, open the tailgate and slightly pull the emergency
cable as shown above. The charging
door will then open.
Checking Charging Status
Operation of Charging Indicator Lamp
Details
OAEEQ016025
When charging the high voltage battery, the charge level can be checked
from outside the vehicle.
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery,
charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for
charging the battery may vary.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(OFF)
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
(OFF)
(ON)
Blink
(OFF)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
(ON)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
Blink
Blink
Error while charging
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
Charging 12 V auxiliary battery or scheduled air
conditioner is operating
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
Not Charged
0~33%
Charging
34~66%
67~99%
Fully charged (100%)(turns OFF in 5 seconds)
- Reserved charging is operating
(turns OFF after 3 minutes)
- Charging is temporarily interrupted
(e.g. power failure)
H55
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (DC CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
How to Disconnect DC Charger
1.Remove the charging connector
when DC charging is completed, or
after you stop charging using the
DC charger. Refer to each respective DC charger manual for details
about how to disconnect the charging connector.
OAEEQ016034L
2.Make sure to install the charging
inlet cover.
3.Make sure to completely close the
charging door.
H56
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE B
How to set the charge level of
the portable charger
Trickle Charge
■ Portable Charger
Plug
Electric Outlet
OOSEVQ01805
OAEEQ016042
(1) Code and Plug (Code set)
(2) Control Box
(3) Charging Cable and Charging
Connector
Trickle Charge can be used when AC
Charge or DC Charge is not available by using household electricity.
OLFP0Q5020K
1. Check the rated current of the
electric outlet prior to connecting
the plug to the outlet.
2. Connect the plug to a household
electric outlet.
3. Check the display window on the
control box.
4. Press the button (1) on the back of
the control box for more than 1
second to adjust the charge level.
(Refer to charging cable type and
example for setting the charge
level.)
5. The display window on the control
box changes from 12A and 10A to
8A every time you press the button
(1).
6. When setting the charge level is
complete, start charging according to the trickle charge procedure.
H57
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
* Example for setting the ICCB charge level.
(The example is only for reference and may vary according to the surrounding environment.)
Outlet current
ICCB charge
level
14-16A
12A
13-12A
10A
How to Connect Portable
Charger (ICCB: In-Cable Control
Box)
Control box display window
Plug
11-10A
8A
9-8A
6A
OLFP0Q5020K
OOSEVQ018055
H58
Electric Outlet
1.Connect the plug to a household
electric outlet.
5.Press the charging door open
switch ( ) to open the charging
door. Charging door open switch
can be operated only when vehicle
is turned off.
6.If you cannot open the charging
door due to freezing weather :
1) Remove any ice near the charging door.
2) Pull the emergency cable to
open the charging door.
(When the charging door does
not open, refer to “How to Unlock
Charging Door in Emergencies.”)
OOSEVQ018056
2.Check if the power lamp (green)
illuminates on the control box.
OAEEQ019117L
3.Depress the brake pedal and apply
the parking brake.
4.Turn OFF all switches, shift to P
(Park), and turn OFF the vehicle.
If charging is initiated without the
gear in P (Park), the charging will
start after the gear is automatically
shifted to P (Park).
H59
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
i Information
H60
OAEEQ016064L
OAEEQ016031L
7. Remove the charging inlet cover
(1).
8. Check if there is dust on the
charging connector and charging
inlet.
9. Hold the charging connector handle and connect it to the vehicle
AC charging inlet. Push the connector until you hear a "clicking"
sound. If the charging connector
and charging terminal are not connected properly, this may cause a
fire.
Locking Charging Cable
The charging connector is locked in
the inlet at a different period according to which mode is selected.
• Always mode :
The connector locks when the
charging connector is plugged into
the charging inlet.
• While charging mode :
The connector locks when charging
starts.
For more details, refer to “Locking
Charging Cable” in this chapter.
i Information
OOSEVQ018057
OAEEQ016032
10. Charging starts automatically
(charging lamp blinks).
11. Check if the charging indicator
light of the high voltage battery in
the instrument cluster is turned
ON. Charging is not done when
the charging indicator lamp is
OFF.
When the charging connector is
not connected properly, reconnect the charging cable to
charge it again.
• Even though charging is possible
with the POWER button in the
ON/START position, for your safety, start charging when the POWER
button is in the OFF position and
the vehicle shifted to P (Park).
After charging has started, you can
use electrical components such as
the radio by pressing the POWER
button to ACC or ON position.
• During charging, the gear cannot be
shifted from P (Park) to any other
gear.
H61
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
i Information
Depending on the condition and durability of the high voltage battery,
charger specifications, and ambient
temperature, the time required for
charging the battery may vary.
Unlock Charging Door in
Emergency
OOSEV048133L
12. After charging has started, the
estimated charging time is displayed on the instrument cluster
for about 1 minute.
If you open the driver seat door
while charging, the estimated
charging time is also displayed on
the instrument cluster for about 1
minute.
When scheduled charging is set,
the estimated charging time is
displayed as “--" .
H62
OAEE046010
If the charging door does not open
due to battery discharge and failure
of the electric wires, open the tailgate and slightly pull the emergency
cable as shown above. The charging
door will then open.
Checking Charging Status
Operation of Charging Indicator Lamp
Details
OAEEQ016025
When charging the high voltage battery, the charge level can be checked
from outside the vehicle.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(OFF)
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
(OFF)
(ON)
Blink
(OFF)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
(ON)
(ON)
(ON)
Blink
Blink
Blink
Error while charging
(OFF)
(OFF)
Blink
Charging 12 V auxiliary battery or scheduled air
conditioner is operating
(OFF)
Blink
(OFF)
Not Charged
0~33%
Charging
34~66%
67~99%
Fully charged (100%)(turns OFF in 5 seconds)
- Reserved charging is operating
(turns OFF after 3 minutes)
- Charging is temporarily interrupted
(e.g. power failure)
H63
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
Charging Status Indicator Lamp for Portable Charger
Control Box
Indicator
PLUG
Details
(Green)
(Red)
On : Power on
Blink : Plug temperature sensor failure
On : Plug high temperature protection
Blink : Plug high temperature warning
POWER
On : Power on
CHARGE
Blink : Charging In power saving mode, only the CHARGE
indicator is illuminated.
FAULT
Blink : Charging interrupted
CHARGE LEVEL
Type A
Type B
Type C
12 A
10 A
8A
10 A
8A
7A
8A
6A
6A
The charging current
changes (3 level)
whenever the button
(1) is pressed for 1
sec with the charger
plugged into an
electrical outlet but
not the vehicle.
Charging connector plugged
(Green)
VEHICLE
Charging
(Blue)
Blink : Charging impossible
(Red)
H64
❈ Back of the control box
Charging Status Indicator Lamp for Portable Charger
NO
1
Control Box
Status / Diagnosis / Countermeasure
• Charging connector plugged into vehicle
(Green ON)
• Plug temperature sensor failure
(Green blink)
• Plug high temperature protection
(Red blink)
• Plug high temperature warning (Red ON)
NO
Control Box
Status / Diagnosis / Countermeasure
2
- Charging connector plugged into
vehicle (Green ON)
4
- Before plugging charging connector
into vehicle (Red blink)
• Abnormal temperature
• ICCB (In-Cable Control Box) failure
We recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3
- While charging
• Charge indicator (Green blink)
• Vehicle indicator (Blue ON)
We recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H65
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
Charging Status Indicator Lamp for Portable Charger
NO
5
Control Box
Status / Diagnosis / Countermeasure
- Plugged into vehicle (Red blink)
• Diagnostic device failure
• Current leakage
• Abnormal temperature
NO
7
We recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H66
Status / Diagnosis / Countermeasure
- After plugging charging connector
into vehicle (Red blink)
• Communication failure
6
We recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
We recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Plug temperature sensor failure
(Green blink)
• Plug high temperature protection
(Red blink)
• Plug high temperature warning (Red ON)
Control Box
8
- Power saving mode
• 3 minutes after charging starts
(Green blink)
How to Disconnect Portable
Charger (ICCB: In-Cable Control
Box)
For more details, refer to “Locking
Charging Cable” in this chapter.
Plug
Electric Outlet
OAEEQ016061
OAEEQ016033L
OAEEQ016034L
1. Hold the charging connector handle and pull it.
2. Make sure to install the charging
inlet cover.
3. Make sure to completely close the
charging door.
i Information
To prevent charging cable theft, the
charging connector cannot be disconnected from the inlet when the doors are
locked. Unlock all doors to disconnect
the charging connector from the inlet.
However, if the vehicle is in the charging
connector ‘While driving’ mode, the
charging connector automatically
unlocks from the inlet when charging is
completed.
4. Disconnect the plug from the
household electric outlet. Do not
pull the cable when disconnecting
the plug.
5. Close the protective cover for the
charging connector so that foreign
material cannot get into the terminal.
6. Put the charging cable inside the
cable compartment to protect it.
H67
CHARGING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (TRICKLE CHARGE) - TYPE B (CONT.)
Unlock Charging Connector in
Emergency
OAEEQ016057L
If the charging connector does not
disconnect due to battery discharge
and failure of the electric wires, open
the tailgate and slightly pull the
emergency cable. The charging connector will then disconnect .
H68
Precautions for Portable Charger
(ICCB: In-Cable Control Box)
• Use the portable charger that is
certified by HYUNDAI Motors.
• Do not try to repair, disassemble,
or adjust the portable charger.
• Do not use an extension cord or
adapter.
• Stop using immediately when failure occurs.
• Do not touch the plug and charging
connector with wet hands.
• Do not touch the terminal part of
the AC charging connector and the
AC charging inlet on the vehicle.
• Do not connect the charging connector to voltage that does not
comply with regulations.
• Do not use the portable charger if it
is worn out, exposed, or there
exists any type of damage on the
portable charger.
• If the ICCB case and AC charging
connector is damaged, cracked, or
the wires are exposed in any way, do
not use the portable charger.
• Do not let children operate or touch
the portable charger.
• Keep the control box free of water.
• Keep the AC charging connector or
plug terminal free of foreign substances.
• Do not step on the cable or cord.
Do not pull the cable or cord and
do not twist or bend it.
• Do not charge when there is lightning.
• Do not drop the control box or
place a heavy object on the control
box.
• Do not place an object that can
generate high temperatures near
the charger when charging.
• Charging with the worn out or damaged household electric outlet can
result in a risk of electric shock. If
you are in doubt to the household
electric outlet condition, have it
checked by a licensed electrician.
• Stop using the portable charger
immediately if the household electric outlet or any components is
overheated or you notice burnt
odors.
CHARGING THE ELECTRIC VEHICLE (ABRUPT STOP)
Action to be taken when charging stops abruptly
When the high voltage battery does not charge, check the followings:
1. Check the charging setting for the vehicle. Refer to “Charge Management”, in this chapter
(e.g. When scheduled charging is set, charging is not initiated immediately when the AC charger or portable
charger (ICCB: In-Cable Control Box) is connected.)
2. Check the operation status of AC charger, portable charger and DC charger.
(Charging Status Indicator Lamp for Portable Charger, refer to “Checking Charging Status” for trickle charge in
this chapter.)
❈ Actual method for indicating the charging status may vary in accordance with the charger manufacturer.
3. When the vehicle does not charge and a warning message appears on the cluster, check the corresponding message. Refer to “LCD Display Messages”, in this chapter.
4. If the vehicle is properly charged when charged with another normally working charger, contact the charger manufacturer.
5. If the vehicle does not charge when charged with another normally working charger, we recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for inspection.
H69
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE
i Information
How to Start the Vehicle
1.Holding the smart key, sit in the driver's seat.
2.Fasten the seat belt before starting
the vehicle.
3.Make sure to engage the parking
brake.
4.Turn OFF all electrical devices.
5.Make sure to depress and hold the
brake pedal.
6.While depressing the brake pedal,
shift to P (Park).
7.Depress and hold the brake while
pressing the Power button.
H70
While the charging cable is connected,
the gear cannot be shift from P (Park)
to any other gear for safety reasons.
10.Release the parking brake and
slowly release the brake pedal.
Check if the vehicle slowly moves
forward, then depress the accelerator pedal.
OAEEQ019054
8.When the "
" indicator is ON,
you can drive the vehicle.
When the "
" indicator is OFF,
you cannot drive the vehicle. Start
the vehicle again.
9.Depress and hold the brake pedal
and shift to the desired position.
How to Stop the Vehicle
Virtual Engine Sound System
1. Hold down the brake pedal while
the vehicle is parked.
2. While depressing the brake pedal,
shift to P (Park).
3. While depressing the brake pedal,
engage the parking brake.
4. While depressing the brake pedal,
press the POWER button and turn
off the vehicle.
OAEEQ019055
5. Check if the "
" indicator is
turned OFF on the instrument
cluster.
When the "
" indicator is ON
and the gear is in a position other
than P (Park), the driver can accidently depress the accelerator
pedal, causing the vehicle to move
unexpectedly.
OAEPHQ049858L
The Virtual Engine Sound System
generates engine sound for pedestrians to hear vehicle sound because
there is no sound while the Electric
Vehicle (EV) is operating.
• The VESS may be turned ON or
OFF by pressing the VESS button.
(if equipped)
• If the vehicle is moving at low
speed, the VESS will operate.
• When the gear is shifted to R
(Reverse), an additional warning
sound will be heard.
H71
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
CAUTION
When destination is not set
Distance to Empty
• For safety reasons, do not turn
off the VESS system. If you are
in a situation that the system
needs to be turned off, check
whether there are pedestrians
around the vehicle.
• The vehicle is much quieter
while driving than a conventional gasoline-powered vehicle. Be aware of your surroundings and always drive
safely.
• After you park the vehicle or
while you are waiting at a traffic light, check whether there
are children or obstacles
around the vehicle.
• Check if there is something
behind the vehicle when driving in reverse. Pedestrians
may not hear the sound of the
vehicle.
H72
OAEE049215
The distance to empty is displayed
differently according to the selected
drive mode in the Drive Mode
Integrated Control System.
For more information, refer to “Drive
Mode Integrated Control System” in
chapter 5.
• On average, a vehicle can drive
about 271 km (168 miles). Under
certain circumstances where the
air conditioner/heater is ON, the
distance to empty is impacted,
resulting in a possible distance
range from 190~350 km (118~217
miles). When using the heater during cold weather or driving at high
speed, the high voltage battery
consumes a lot more electricity.
This may reduce the distance to
empty significantly.
• After “---” has been displayed, the
vehicle may be stopped depending
on heater/air conditioner, weather,
driving style, and other factors.
• Distance to empty that is displayed
on the instrument cluster after
completing a recharge may vary
significantly depending on previous operating patterns.
When previous driving patterns
include high speed driving, resulting in the high voltage battery
using more electricity than usual,
the estimated distance to empty is
reduced. When the high voltage
battery uses little electricity in ECO
mode, the estimated distance to
empty increases.
• Distance to empty may depend on
many factors such as the charge
amount of the high voltage battery,
weather, temperature, durability of
the battery, geographical features,
and driving style.
• Natural degradation may occur
with the high voltage battery
depending on the number of years
the vehicle is used. This may
reduce the distance to empty.
When destination is set
When the destination is set, the distance to empty may change. The distance to empty is recalculated using
the information of the destination.
However, the distance to empty may
vary significantly based on traffic
conditions, driving habits, and condition of the vehicle.
Tips for Improving Distance to
Empty
• If you operate the air conditioner
/heater too much, the driving battery uses too much electricity. This
may reduce the distance to empty.
Therefore, it is recommended that
you set the cabin temperature to
23°C AUTO. This setting that has
been certified by various assessment tests to maintain optimal
energy consumption rates while
keeping the temperature fresh.
Turn OFF the heater and air conditioner if you do not need them.
• Depress and hold the accelerator
pedal to maintain speed and drive
economically.
• Gradually depress and release the
accelerator pedal when accelerating or decelerating.
• Always maintain specified tire
pressures.
• Do not use unnecessary electrical
components while driving.
• Do not load unnecessary items in
the vehicle.
• Do not mount parts that may
increase air resistance.
H73
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
• CHARGE :
It shows the charging status of the
battery when it is being charged by
the regenerative brakes (decelerating or driving on a downhill road).
The more electric energy is charged,
the lower the gauge level.
Power/Charge Gauge
State of charge (SOC) gauge
for high voltage battery
■ Except Europe
■ For Europe
OAEEQ019087
The Power/Charge gauge shows the
energy consumption rate of the vehicle and the charge/discharge status
of the regenerative brakes.
• POWER :
It shows the energy consumption rate
of the vehicle when driving uphill or
accelerating. The more electric energy is used, the higher the gauge level.
H74
OAEEQ019088/OAEE049678L
• The SOC gauge shows the charging status of the high voltage battery.
“L (Low) or 0" position on the indicator indicates that there is not
enough energy in the high voltage
battery. “H (High) or 1“ position
indicates that the driving battery is
fully charged.
• When driving on highways or
motorways, make sure to check in
advance if the driving battery is
charged enough.
NOTICE
When the high voltage battery level
is low, the power down warning
illuminates and the power output
from the vehicle is limited. Charge
the battery immediately since your
vehicle may not drive uphill or skid
on a slope with the warning light
ON.
OAEEQ019089
When there are 4~5 gauge bars
(near the “L (Low) or 0" area) on the
SOC gauge, the warning lamp turns
ON to alert you of the battery level.
When the warning lamp turns ON,
the vehicle can drive an additional
30~40 km (18~25 miles) depending
on the driving speed, heater/air conditioner, weather, driving style, and
other factors. Charging is required.
Warning and Indicator Lights
(related to electric vehicle)
Ready Indicator
This indicator illuminates :
When the vehicle is ready to be driven.
- ON : Normal driving is possible.
- OFF : Normal driving is not possible,
or a problem has occurred.
- Blinking : Emergency driving.
When the ready indicator goes OFF
or blinks, there is a problem with the
system. In this case, we recommend
that you have your vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H75
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
Service Warning Light
This warning light illuminates :
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a problem with related parts of the electric vehicle control system, such as sensors, etc.
When the warning light illuminates
while driving, or does not go OFF
after starting the vehicle, we recommend that you have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
H76
Power Down Warning
Light
This warning light illuminates :
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When the power is limited for the
safety of the electric vehicle.
The power is limited for the following reasons.
- The high voltage battery level is
below a certain level or voltage is
decreasing
- The temperature of the motor or
high voltage battery is too high or
too low
- There is a problem with the cooling system, or a failure that may
interrupt normal driving
NOTICE
• Do not accelerate or start the
vehicle suddenly when the
power down warning light is ON.
• When the high voltage battery
level is low, the power down
warning illuminates and the
power output from the vehicle is
limited. Charge the battery
immediately since your vehicle
may not drive uphill or skid on a
slope with the warning light ON.
Charging Indicator Light
Regenerative Brake
Warning Light
(yellow)
This warning light illuminates :
• [RED] When charging the high voltage battery.
High Voltage Battery
Level Warning Light
This warning light illuminates :
• When the high voltage battery level
low.
When the warning light turns ON,
charge the battery immediately.
This warning light illuminates :
When the regenerative brake does
not operate and the brake does not
perform well. This causes the Brake
Warning light (red) and Regenerative
Brake Warning Light (yellow) to illuminate simultaneously.
In this case, drive safely and we recommend that you have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
The operation of the brake pedal may
be more difficult than normal and the
braking distance can increase.
LCD Display Messages
Shift to P to charge
OAEPHQ049833L
This message is displayed if you
connect the charging cable without
the gear in the P (Park) position.
Shift to P (Park) before connecting
the charging cable .
H77
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
Remaining time
■ AC charge
H78
Charging Door Open
Charging stopped.
Check the AC/DC charger
■ DC charge
OOSEV048133L/OOSEV048198L
OOSEV048130L
This message is displayed to notify
the remaining time to charge the battery to the selected target battery
charge level.
This message is displayed when the
vehicle is driven with the charging
door opened. Close the charging
door and then start driving.
OOSEV048131L/OOSEV048132L
• This warning message is displayed
when charging is stopped for the
reasons below:
- There is a problem with the external AC charger or DC charger
charger
- The external AC charger stopped
charging
- The charging cable is damaged
In this case, check whether there is
any problem with the external AC or
DC charger and charging cable.
If the same problem occurs when
charging the vehicle with a normally
operating AC charger or genuine
HYUNDAI portable charger, we recommend that you have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Charging stopped.
Check the cable connection
If the same problem occurs when
charging the vehicle with a replaced
charging cable or genuine HYUNDAI
portable charger, we recommend
that you have your vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OOSEV048196L
This warning message is displayed
when charging is stopped because
the charging connector is not correctly connected to the charging inlet
In this case, separate the charging
connector and re-connect it and
check whether there is any problem
(external damage, foreign substances, etc.) with the charging connector and charging inlet.
H79
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
Check regenerative brakes /
Stop vehicle and check brakes
Low Battery
Charge immediately.
Power limited
OOSEV048121L
OOSEV048118L/OOSEV048117L
This warning message is displayed
when the regenerative brake system
does not work properly.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H80
When the high voltage battery level
reaches below 10%, this warning
message is displayed.
The warning light on the instrument
cluster ( ) will turn ON simultaneously.
Charge the high voltage battery
immediately.
OOSEV048122L
When the high voltage battery level
reaches below 6%, this warning
message is displayed.
The warning light on the instrument
cluster ( ) and the power down
warning light ( ) will turn on simultaneously.
The vehicle’s power will be reduced
to minimize the energy consumption
of the high voltage battery. Charge
the battery immediately.
Low outside temp. may limit
power output. Charge EV battery/
Low battery temperature.
Power limited
A
B
NOTICE
Battery overheated! Stop safely
If this warning message is still displayed even after the ambient temperature has increased, we recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
OOSEV048213L
OOSEV048199L/OOSEV048126L
[A] : Displays when turning off vehicle.
[B] : Displays when turning on vehicle.
Both warning messages are displayed to protect electric vehicle system when outside temperature is
low. If the high voltage battery charging level is low and parked outside in
low temperature for a long time, vehicle power could be limited.
Charging the battery before driving
helps increase power.
This warning message is displayed
to protect battery and electric vehicle
system when the high voltage battery temperature is too high.
Turn off the POWER button and stop
the vehicle so that the battery temperature decreases.
H81
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
Power limited
NOTICE
• When this warning message is
displayed, do not accelerate or
start the vehicle suddenly.
• When the high voltage battery
level is low, the power down
warning illuminates and the
power output from the vehicle is
limited. Charge the battery
immediately since your vehicle
may not drive uphill or skid on a
slope with the warning light ON.
Stop vehicle and check power
supply
OOSEV048125L
In the following cases, this warning
message is displayed when the vehicle’s power is limited for safety.
• When the high voltage battery is
below a certain level, or voltage is
decreasing.
• When the temperature of the motor
or high voltage battery is too high
or too low.
• When there is a problem with the
cooling system or a failure that
may interrupt normal driving.
H82
OOSEV048200L
This warning message is displayed
when a failure occurs in the power
supply system.
In this case, park the vehicle in a
safe location and recommend that
you tow your vehicle to the nearest
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the vehicle inspected.
Check Active Air Flap System
Check Virtual Engine Sound
System
OOSEV048201L
This warning message is displayed
in the following situations:
- There is a malfunction with the
actuator flap
- There is a malfunction with the
actuator air flap controller
- The air flap does not open
Check electric vehicle system
OOSEV048124L
OOSEV048116L
This message is displayed when
there is a problem with the Virtual
Engine Sound System (VESS).
In this case, we recommend that you
have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This warning message is displayed
when there is a problem with the
electric vehicle control system.
Refrain from driving when the warning message is displayed.
In this case, we recommend that you
have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
When all of the above conditions are
fixed, the warning will disappear.
H83
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
EV Propulsion
Energy flow
Regeneration
The electric vehicle system informs
the drivers its energy flow in various
operating modes. While driving, the
current energy flow is specified in 3
modes.
Vehicle Stop
OAEPHQ049843L
The vehicle is stopped.
(No energy flow)
H84
OAEPHQ049844L
OAEPHQ049848L
Only the motor power is used to drive
the vehicle.
(Battery ➞ Wheel)
The high-voltage battery is charged
up by the regenerative brake system.
(Wheel ➞ Battery)
Aux. Battery Saver+
The Aux. Battery Saver+ is a function
that monitors the charging status of
the 12 V auxiliary battery.
If the auxiliary battery level is low, the
main high voltage battery charges
the auxiliary battery.
i Information
The Aux. Battery Saver+ function will
be ON when the vehicle is delivered. If
the function is not needed, you may
turn it off in the Users Settings mode
on the cluster. For more information,
refer to the following page.
Mode
• Cycle Mode :
When the vehicle is OFF with all
doors, hood and tailgate closed, the
Aux. Battery Saver+ periodically activates according to the auxiliary battery status.
• Automatic Mode :
When the POWER button is in the
ON position with the charging connector plugged in, the function activates according to the auxiliary battery status to prevent overdischarge
of the auxiliary battery.
System Setting
i Information
• The Aux. Battery Saver+ activates
maximum of 20 minutes. If the Aux.
Battery Saver+ function activates
more than 10 times consecutively, in
the Automatic Mode the function
will stop activating, judging that
there is a problem with the auxiliary
battery. In this case, drive the vehicle for some period of time. The
function will start activating if the
auxiliary battery returns to normal.
• The Aux. Battery Saver+ function
cannot prevent battery discharge if
the auxiliary battery is damaged,
worn out, used as a power supply or
unauthorized electronic devises are
used.
• If the Aux. Battery Saver+ function
was activated, the high voltage battery level may have decreased.
OAEPHQ049855L
The driver can activate the Aux.
Battery Saver+ function by placing
the POWER button to the ON position and by selecting:
'User Settings → Other → Aux.
Battery Saver+'
The Aux. Battery Saver+ function
deactivates, when the driver cancels
the system setting.
H85
DRIVING ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
WARNING
OAEEQ016025
When the function is activating
the third Charging Indicator
Lamp will blink and high voltage
electricity will be flowing in the
vehicle. Do not touch the high
voltage electric wire (orange),
connector, and all electric components and devices. This may
cause electric shock and lead to
injuries. Also, do not modify
your vehicle in any way. This
may affect your vehicle performance and lead to an accident.
H86
Utility Mode
The high voltage battery is used
instead of the 12V auxiliary battery
for operating the convenient features
of the vehicle. When driving is not
necessary such as while camping or
when stopping the vehicle for a long
time, it is possible to use the electrical devices (audio, lights, etc.) for
long hours.
System Setting and Activation
System setting
The driver can activate the Utility
Mode function when the following
conditions are satisfied.
• The vehicle is in the ready (
)
mode and the gear is shifted to P
(Park).
• The EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake) is applied.
• 'User Settings → Convenience →
Utility Mode' is selected in the cluster.
System Activation
When the system is activated:
• The
indicator will turn off and
the
indicator will illuminate on
the cluster.
• All electric devices are usable but
the vehicle cannot be driven.
• The EPB can be cancelled by
pressing the EBP switch.
• Gear cannot be shifted out of P
(Park). If a shift attempt is made, a
message “Shifting conditions not
met” will be displayed on the cluster.
System Deactivation
The Utility Mode can be deactivated
by pressing the POWER button to
the OFF position. The function cannot be deactivated from the User
Settings mode.
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS FOR ELECTRIC VEHICLE
If an Accident Occurs
WARNING
• When a vehicle accident
occurs, move the vehicle to a
safe place, turn OFF the vehicle
and remove the auxiliary battery (12 V) terminal to prevent
high voltage electricity from
flowing.
• If electric wires are exposed
from inside or outside the
vehicle, do not touch the
wires.
Also, do not touch the high
voltage electric wire (orange),
connector, and all electric
components and devices. This
may cause electric shock and
lead to injuries.
WARNING
• When a vehicle accident
occurs and the high voltage
battery is damaged, harmful
gas and electrolytes may leak.
Be careful not to touch the
leaked liquid.
When you suspect leakage of
inflammable gas and other
harmful gases, open the windows and evacuate to a safe
place. If any leaked fluid
comes in contact with your
eyes or skin, immediately
clean the affected area thoroughly with tap water or
saline solution and have doctors inspect it as soon as possible.
WARNING
• If a small scale fire occurs,
use a fire extinguisher (ABC,
BC) that is meant for electrical
fires. If it is impossible to
extinguish the fire in the early
stage, remain a safe distance
from the vehicle and immediately call your local fire emergency responders. Also,
advise them that an electric
vehicle is involved.
If the fire spreads to the high
voltage battery, large amount
of water is needed to put out
the fire. Using small amount
of water or fire extinguishers
not meant for electrical fires
could cause serious injury or
death from electrical shocks.
H87
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS FOR ELECTRIC VEHICLE (CONT.)
WARNING
If you cannot put out the fire
immediately, the high voltage
battery may explode. Evacuate
to a safe place and do not let
other people approach the site.
Contact the fire department and
notify them of an electric vehicle fire.
• If the vehicle is flooded with
water, immediately turn OFF
the vehicle and evacuate to a
safe place. Contact the fire
department or an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
WARNING
• Flatbed Towing
• Tires Locked Towing
OAEE069019
Dolly
• Tires Locked Towing
Dolly
OAEE069018
• If towing is required, lift all
four wheels off the ground
and tow the vehicle. If you
must tow the vehicle using
only two wheels, lift the front
wheels off the ground and tow
the vehicle.
H88
• If you tow the vehicle while
the front wheels are touching
the ground, the vehicle motor
may generate electricity and
the motor components may
be damaged or a fire may
occur.
• When a vehicle fire occurs
due to the battery, there is a
risk of a second fire. Contact
the fire department when towing the vehicle.
Other Precautions for Electric
Vehicle
• When you paint or apply heat treatment to the vehicle as a result of
an accident, the performance of
the high voltage battery can be
reduced.
If heat treatment is required, we
recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• When you clean the motor compartment, do not use high pressure
water to wash. This may cause an
electric shock due to a discharge in
high voltage electricity, or damage
the vehicle's electric system.
• Do not use, remodel, or install nongenuine parts. This may damage
the electric power system.
Service Plug
OAEEQ016057
DANGER
Never touch the service plug in
the luggage compartment. The
service plug is attached to high
voltage battery system.
Touching the service plug will
result in death or serious injury.
Service personnel should follow procedures in service manual.
H89
Your vehicle at a glance
1
Your vehicle at a glance
Exterior overview (front view) ............................1-2
Exterior overview (rear view)..............................1-4
Interior overview (I) ..............................................1-6
Interior overview (II) .............................................1-7
Instrument panel overview (I)..............................1-8
Instrument panel overview (II).............................1-9
Motor compartment.............................................1-10
Your vehicle at a glance
EXTERIOR OVERVIEW (FRONT VIEW)
■ Type A
1. Hood ..................................................3-32
2. Headlamp ..........................................7-55
3. Daytime running light (DRL) ....3-89, 7-63
4. Tires and wheels ........................7-28, 8-4
5. Outside rearview mirror .....................3-19
6. Sunroof ..............................................3-27
7. Front windshield wiper blades ...........7-22
8. Windows ............................................3-22
9. Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system...............................3-104
10. AC charge ........................................H22
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAEE019001L
1-2
EXTERIOR OVERVIEW (FRONT VIEW)
■ Type B
1
2. Headlamp ..........................................7-55
3. Daytime running light (DRL) ....3-89, 7-63
4. Tires and wheels ........................7-28, 8-4
5. Outside rearview mirror .....................3-19
6. Sunroof ..............................................3-27
7. Front windshield wiper blades ...........7-22
8. Windows ............................................3-22
9. Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system...............................3-104
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAEE019014L
1-3
Your vehicle at a glance
1. Hood ..................................................3-32
Your vehicle at a glance
EXTERIOR OVERVIEW (REAR VIEW)
■ Type A
1. Antenna ...............................................4-2
2. Doors ...................................................3-8
3. Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system...............................3-104
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system .............................................3-100
4. Rear combination lamp .....................7-63
5. High mounted stop lamp ...................7-66
6. Rear view monitor .............................3-98
7. Tailgate ..............................................3-33
8. Towing hook.......................................6-23
9. DC charge ..........................................H28
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAEE019002L
1-4
EXTERIOR OVERVIEW (REAR VIEW)
■ Type B
1
2. Doors ...................................................3-8
3. Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system...............................3-104
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system .............................................3-100
4. Rear combination lamp .....................7-63
5. High mounted stop lamp ...................7-66
6. Rear view monitor .............................3-98
7. Tailgate ..............................................3-33
8. Towing hook.......................................6-23
9. AC/DC charge ............................H45/H52
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAEE019013L
1-5
Your vehicle at a glance
1. Antenna ...............................................4-2
Your vehicle at a glance
INTERIOR OVERVIEW (I)
■ Left-hand drive
1. Door lock/unlock button ......................3-9
2. Driver position memory system ........3-13
3. Outside rearview mirror folding
switch ................................................3-21
4. Outside rearview mirror control
switch ................................................3-20
5. Central door lock switch ....................3-10
6. Power window switches ....................3-22
7. Power window lock switch ................3-26
8. Headlight leveling device ..................3-90
9. Instrument panel illumination
control switch ......................................3-36
10. Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW)..5-73
11. Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) ..............5-65
12. ESC OFF button..............................5-39
13. VESS (Vehicle Engine Sound System)
button ..............................................H71
14. Charging door opener....H27, 45, 52, 59
15. Scheduled charging deactivation
button ..............................................H19
16. Hood release lever ..........................3-31
17. Fuse box..........................................7-41
18. Steering wheel tilt/telescope lever......3-16
19. Steering wheel ................................3-15
20. Seat ..................................................2-4
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAEE019003L
1-6
INTERIOR OVERVIEW (II)
■ Right-hand drive
1
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OAEE019003R
1-7
Your vehicle at a glance
1. Door lock/unlock button ......................3-9
2. Driver position memory system ........3-13
3. Outside rearview mirror folding
switch ................................................3-21
4. Outside rearview mirror control
switch ................................................3-20
5. Central door lock switch ....................3-10
6. Power window switches ....................3-22
7. Power window lock switch ................3-26
8. Headlight leveling device ..................3-90
9. Instrument panel illumination
control switch ......................................3-36
10. Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW)..5-73
11. Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) ..............5-65
12. ESC OFF button..............................5-31
13. VESS (Vehicle Engine Sound System)
button ..............................................H71
14. Charging door opener....H27, 45, 52, 59
15. Scheduled charging deactivation
button ..............................................H19
16. Hood release lever ........................3-31
17. Fuse box..........................................7-41
18. Steering wheel ................................3-15
19. Seat ..................................................2-4
Your vehicle at a glance
INSTRUMENT PANEL OVERVIEW (I)
■ Left-hand drive
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
1-8
1. Instrument cluster ....................................3-35
2. Horn .........................................................3-17
3. Driver's front air bag ................................2-53
4. POWER button ..........................................5-4
5. Light control/Turn signals .........................3-81
6. Wiper/Washer ..........................................3-95
7. Infotainment system...................................4-2
8. Hazard warning flasher..............................6-2
9. Automatic climate control system ............3-110
10. Passenger's front air bag .......................2-53
11. Driver’s knee air bag..............................2-53
12. Glove box .............................................3-128
13. Reduction gear (shift button) ................ 5-11
14. Wireless cellular phone charging system .3-133
15. Cigarette lighter ...................................3-135
16. USB and iPod® port .................................4-2
17. Power outlet .........................................3-132
18. Seat warmer/Air ventilation seat ............2-22
19. Heated steering wheel ...........................3-16
20. Auto hold ...............................................5-33
21. Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning
ON button.............................................3-104
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
OFF button ............................................3-102
22. Drive mode integrated control system ...5-46
23. Electronic Parking Brake (EPB).............5-28
24. Cup holder ...........................................3-130
25. Steering wheel audio controls/ ................4-3
Bluetooth® wireless technology
hands-free controls ..................................4-4
26. Speed limiter/...................................... 5-133
Cruise controls/......................................5-91
Smart Cruise Control (SCC) (stop&go)....5-97
OAEE019004L
INSTRUMENT PANEL OVERVIEW (II)
■ Right-hand drive
1-9
1
Your vehicle at a glance
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
1. Instrument cluster ....................................3-35
2. Horn .........................................................3-17
3. Driver's front air bag ................................2-53
4. POWER button ..........................................5-4
5. Light control/Turn signals .........................3-81
6. Wiper/Washer ..........................................3-95
7. Infotainment system...................................4-2
8. Hazard warning flasher..............................6-2
9. Automatic climate control system ............3-110
10. Passenger's front air bag .......................2-53
11. Driver’s knee air bag..............................2-53
12. Glove box .............................................3-128
13. Reduction gear (shift button) ................ 5-11
14. Wireless cellular phone charging system .3-133
15. Cigarette lighter ...................................3-135
16. USB and iPod® port .................................4-2
17. Power outlet .........................................3-132
18. Seat warmer/Air ventilation seat ............2-22
19. Heated steering wheel ...........................3-16
20. Auto hold ...............................................5-33
21. Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning
ON button.............................................3-104
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
OFF button ............................................3-102
22. Drive mode integrated control system ...5-46
23. Electronic Parking Brake (EPB).............5-28
24. Cup holder ...........................................3-130
25. Steering wheel audio controls/ ................4-3
Bluetooth® wireless technology
hands-free controls ..................................4-4
26. Speed limiter/...................................... 5-133
Cruise controls/......................................5-91
Smart Cruise Control (SCC) (stop&go)....5-97
OAEE019004R
Your vehicle at a glance
MOTOR COMPARTMENT
1. Coolant reservoir ..............................7-17
2. Brake fluid reservoir..........................7-18
3. Fuse box ...........................................7-41
4. Battery (12 volt) ...............................7-25
5. Coolant cap.......................................7-17
6. Windshield washer fluid reservoir .....7-19
The actual motor compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OAEE076001N
1-10
Safety system of your vehicle
This chapter provides you with important information about how to protect yourself and your passengers.
It explains how to properly use your seats and seat belts, and how your air bags work.
Additionally, this chapter explains how to properly restrain infants and children in your vehicle.
2
Important safety precautions .............................2-2
Child restraint system (CRS) .............................2-37
Always wear your seat belt ..........................................2-2
Restrain all children .........................................................2-2
Air bag hazards ................................................................2-2
Driver distraction .............................................................2-2
Control your speed ..........................................................2-3
Keep your vehicle in safe condition ............................2-3
Our recommendation:Children always in the rear ...2-37
Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS) ................2-38
Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS)..................2-40
Seats ........................................................................2-4
Safety precautions ..........................................................2-6
Front seats..........................................................................2-7
Rear seats .........................................................................2-13
Headrest ...........................................................................2-16
Seat warmers and air ventilation seats.....................2-21
Seat belts ..............................................................2-25
Seat belt safety precautions ......................................2-25
Seat belt warning light .................................................2-26
Seat belt restraint system ...........................................2-29
Additional seat belt safety precautions ...................2-34
Care of seat belts ..........................................................2-36
Air bag - supplemental restraint system .........2-50
Where are the air bags? ..............................................2-53
How does the air bags system operate? .................2-58
What to expect after an air bag inflates ................2-62
Why didn't my air bag go off in a collision? ...........2-64
SRS care ...........................................................................2-69
Additional safety precautions .....................................2-70
Air bag warning labels ................................................2-71
Safety system of your vehicle
IMPORTANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
You will find many safety precautions
and recommendations throughout
this section, and throughout this manual. The safety precautions in this section are among the most important.
Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in
all types of accidents. Air bags are
designed to supplement seat belts,
not replace them. So even though
your vehicle is equipped with air bags,
ALWAYS make sure you and your
passengers wear your seat belts, and
wear them properly.
2-2
Restrain all children
Driver distraction
All children under age 13 should ride
in your vehicle properly restrained in
a rear seat, not the front seat. Infants
and small children should be
restrained in an appropriate Child
Restraint System. Larger children
should use a booster seat with the
lap/shoulder belt until they can use
the seat belt properly without a
booster seat.
Driver distraction presents a serious
and potentially deadly danger, especially for inexperienced drivers. Safety
should be the first concern when
behind the wheel and drivers need to
be aware of the wide array of potential
distractions, such as drowsiness,
reaching for objects, eating, personal
grooming, other passengers, and
using cellular phones.
Drivers can become distracted when
they take their eyes and attention off
the road or their hands off the wheel
to focus on activities other than driving. To reduce your risk of distraction
and an accident:
• ALWAYS set up your mobile devices
(i.e., MP3 players, phones, navigation units, etc.) when your vehicle is
parked or safely stopped.
• ONLY use your mobile device when
allowed by laws and conditions permit safe use. NEVER text or email
while driving. Most countries have
laws prohibiting drivers from texting.
Some countries and cities also prohibit drivers from using handheld
phones.
Air bag hazards
While air bags can save lives, they
can also cause serious or fatal
injuries to occupants who sit too
close to them, or who are not properly restrained. Infants, young children, and short adults are at the
greatest risk of being injured by an
inflating air bag. Follow all instructions and warnings in this manual.
Keep your vehicle in safe condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical
failure can be extremely hazardous. To
reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pressures and
condition frequently, and perform all
regularly scheduled maintenance.
2
Safety system of your vehicle
• NEVER let the use of a mobile device
distract you from driving. You have a
responsibility to your passengers and
others on the road to always drive
safely, with your hands on the wheel
as well as your eyes and attention on
the road.
Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in
crash injuries and deaths. Generally,
the higher the speed, the greater the
risk, but serious injuries can also
occur at lower speeds. Never drive
faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum
speed posted.
2-3
Safety system of your vehicle
SEATS
■ Left-hand drive
Front seat
(1) Forward and backward
(2) Seatback angle
(3) Seat cushion height*
(4) Lumbar support (Driver’s seat)*
(5) Seat warmer */ Air ventilation seat *
(6) Headrest
2nd row seat
(7) Seat warmer*
(8) Armrest
(9) Headrest
(10) Seatback angle and folding
* : if equipped
OAEE039001
2-4
■ Right-hand drive
2nd row seat
(7) Seat warmer*
(8) Armrest
(9) Headrest
(10) Seatback angle and folding
* : if equipped
OAEE039001R
2-5
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Front seat
(1) Forward and backward
(2) Seatback angle
(3) Seat cushion height*
(4) Lumbar support (Driver’s seat)*
(5) Seat warmer */ Air ventilation seat *
(6) Headrest
Safety system of your vehicle
Safety precautions
Air bags
Adjusting the seats so that you are sitting in a safe, comfortable position
plays an important role in driver and
passenger safety together with the
seat belts and air bags in an accident.
You can take steps to reduce the risk
of being injured by an inflating air
bag. Sitting too close to an air bag
greatly increases the risk of injury in
the event the air bag inflates. Move
your seat as far back as possible
from front air bags, while still maintaining control of the vehicle.
WARNING
Do not use a cushion that reduces
friction between the seat and the
passenger.The passenger's hips
may slide under the lap portion
of the seat belt during an accident or a sudden stop.
Serious or fatal internal injuries
could result because the seat
belt cannot operate properly.
2-6
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from an inflating
air bag, take the following precautions:
• Adjust the driver’s seat as far
to the rear as possible maintaining the ability to control of
the vehicle.
• Adjust the front passenger seat
as far to the rear as possible.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Hold the steering wheel by the
rim with hands at the 9 o’clock
and 3 o’clock positions to minimize the risk of injuries to
your hands and arms.
• NEVER place anything or anyone between the air bag.
• Do not allow the front passenger to place feet or legs on the
dashboard to minimize the risk
of leg injuries.
Seat belts
(Continued)
• Do not route the seat belt
across your neck, across sharp
edges, or reroute the shoulder
strap away from your body.
• Do not allow the seat belt to
become caught or jammed.
Front seats
The front seat can be adjusted by
using the control lever or switches
located on the outside of the seat
cushion. Before driving, adjust the
seat to the proper position so that you
can easily control the steering wheel,
foot pedals and controls on the instrument panel.
WARNING
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when adjusting your seat belt:
• NEVER use one seat belt for
more than one occupant.
• Always position the seatback
upright with the lap portion of
the seat belt snug and low
across the hips.
• NEVER allow children or small
infants to ride in a passenger’s
lap.
(Continued)
Take the following precautions
when adjusting your seat:
• NEVER attempt to adjust the
seat while the vehicle is moving. The seat could respond
with unexpected movement
and may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
• Do not place anything under
the front seats. Loose objects
in the driver’s foot area could
interfere with the operation of
the foot pedals, causing an
accident.
(Continued)
2-7
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Always fasten your seat belt before
starting any trip.
At all times, passengers should sit
upright and be properly restrained.
Infants and small children must be
restrained in appropriate Child Restraint
Systems. Children who have outgrown a
booster seat and adults must be
restrained using the seat belts.
Safety system of your vehicle
(Continued)
• Do not allow anything to interfere with the normal position
and proper locking of the seatback.
• Do not place a cigarette lighter
on the floor or seat. When you
operate the seat, gas may exit
out of the lighter causing a fire.
• Use extreme caution when
picking small objects trapped
under the seats or between
the seat and the center console. Your hands might be cut
or injured by the sharp edges
of the seat mechanism.
• If there are occupants in the
rear seats, be careful while
adjusting the front seat position.
2-8
CAUTION
Manual adjustment
To prevent injury:
• Do not adjust your seat while
wearing your seat belt.
Moving the seat cushion forward may cause strong pressure on your abdomen.
• Do not allow your hands or
fingers to get caught in the
seat mechanisms while the
seat is moving.
OAE036002
Forward and rearward adjustment
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Pull up the seat slide adjustment
lever and hold it.
2. Slide the seat to the position you
desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure
the seat is locked in place. Move
forward and rearward without using
the lever. If the seat moves, it is not
locked properly.
WARNING
OAE036003
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Lean forward slightly and lift up the
seatback lever.
2. Carefully lean back on the seat
and adjust the seatback to the
position you desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure
the seatback is locked in place.
(The lever MUST return to its original position for the seatback to
lock.)
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious or fatal injuries in the event
of a collision or sudden stop.
Drivers and passengers should
ALWAYS sit well back in their
seats, properly belted, and with
the seatbacks upright.
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly.
When the seatback is reclined, the
shoulder belt cannot do its job
because it will not be snug against
your chest. Instead, it will be in front
of you. During an accident, you could
be thrown into the seat belt, causing
neck or other injuries.
The more the seatback is reclined,
the greater chance the passenger’s
hips will slide under the lap belt or
the passenger’s neck will strike the
shoulder belt.
2-9
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Reclining seatback
Sitting in a reclined position when
the vehicle is in motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up, the
protections of your restraint system
(seat belts and/or air bags) is greatly
reduced by reclining your seatback.
Safety system of your vehicle
Power adjustment (if equipped)
WARNING
NEVER allow children in the
vehicle unattended. The power
seats are operable when the
vehicle is turned off.
OAE036004
Seat cushion height (if equipped)
To change the height of the seat
cushion:
• Push down the lever several times,
to lower the seat cushion.
• Pull up the lever several times, to
raise the seat cushion.
2-10
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the seats:
• Always stop adjusting the
seats when the seat has been
adjusted as far forward or
rearward as possible.
• Do not adjust the seats longer
than necessary when the
vehicle is turned off. This may
result in unnecessary battery
drain.
• Do not operate two or more
seats at the same time. This
may result in an electrical
malfunction.
OAE036006
OAE036007
Forward and rearward adjustment
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Push the control switch forward or
rearward.
2. Release the switch once the seat
reaches the desired position.
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Push the control switch forward or
rearward.
2. Release the switch once the seatback reaches the desired position.
2-11
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Reclining seatback
Sitting in a reclined position when
the vehicle is in motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up, the
protections of your restraint system
(seat belts and air bags) is greatly
reduced by reclining your seatback.
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious
or fatal injuries in the event of a
collision or sudden stop.
Driver and passengers should
ALWAYS sit well back in their
seats, properly belted, and with
the seatbacks upright.
2-12
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly.
When the seatback is reclined, the
shoulder belt cannot do its job
because it will not be snug against
your chest. Instead, it will be in front
of you. During an accident, you could
be thrown into the seat belt, causing
neck or other injuries.
The more the seatback is reclined,
the greater chance the passenger’s
hips will slide under the lap belt or
the passenger’s neck will strike the
shoulder belt.
OAE036008
Seat cushion height (if equipped)
To change the height of the seat cushion:
1. • Push the front portion of the control switch up to raise or down to
lower the front part of the seat
cushion.
• Push the rear portion of the control switch up to raise or down to
lower the height of the seat cushion.
2. Release the switch once the seat
reaches the desired position.
Seatback pocket (if equipped)
Rear seats
Folding the rear seat
WARNING
• Never allow passengers to sit
OAE036005
Lumbar support (for driver’s seat,
if equipped)
• The lumbar support can be adjusted by pressing the lumbar support
switch.
• Press the front portion of the switch
(1) to increase support or the rear
portion of the switch (2) to decrease
support.
OAE036064
The seatback pocket is provided on
the back of the front seatbacks.
CAUTION
Do not put heavy or sharp
objects in the seatback pockets.
In an accident they could come
loose from the pocket and
injure occupants.
on top of the folded down
seatback while the vehicle is
moving. This is not a proper
seating position and no seat
belts are available for use.
This could result in serious
injury or death in case of an
accident or sudden stop.
• Objects carried on the folded
down seatback should not
extend higher than the top of
the front seatbacks. This could
allow cargo to slide forward
and cause injury or damage
during sudden stops.
2-13
2
Safety system of your vehicle
The rear seatbacks can be folded to
facilitate carrying long items or to
increase the luggage capacity of the
vehicle.
Safety system of your vehicle
OAE036065L
OAE036020
OAE036019
OAE036021
3.Locate the seatbelt toward the outboard position before folding down
the seatback. If not, the seatbelt
system may be interfered by the
seatback.
4.Pull on the seatback folding lever
(1), then fold the seat toward the
front of the vehicle.
OAE036018
To fold down the rear seatback:
1. Set the front seatback to the upright
position.
2. Lower the rear headrests down(2)
pushing the adjusting button(1).
2-14
WARNING
5.To use the rear seat, lift and push
the seatback rearward.
Push the seatback firmly until it
clicks into place. Make sure the
seatback is locked in place.
Do not place objects in the rear
seats, since they cannot be
properly secured and may hit
vehicle occupants in a collision
causing serious injury or death.
2-15
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OAE036066L
When returning the rear seatback from a folded to an upright
position, hold the seatback and
return it slowly. Ensure that the
seatback is completely locked
into its upright position by
pushing on the top of the seatback. In an accident or sudden
stop, the unlocked seatback
could allow cargo to move forward with great force and enter
the passenger compartment,
which could result in serious
injury or death.
WARNING
Safety system of your vehicle
Armrest
Headrest
(Continued)
The vehicle’s front and rear seats have
adjustable headrests. The headrests
provide comfort for passengers, but
more importantly they are designed to
help protect passengers from whiplash
and other neck and spinal injuries during an accident, especially in a rear
impact collision.
WARNING
OAE036022
The armrest is located in the center
of the rear seat. Pull the armrest
down from the seatback to use it.
2-16
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death in an accident,
take the following precautions
when adjusting your headrests:
• Always properly adjust the
headrests for all passengers
BEFORE starting the vehicle.
• NEVER let anyone ride in a seat
with the headrest removed.
(Continued)
•
OLF034072N
Adjust the headrests so the
middle of the headrests is at
the same height as the height
of the top of the eyes.
• NEVER adjust the headrest
position of the driver’s seat
when the vehicle is in motion.
• Adjust the headrest as close
to the passenger’s head as
possible. Do not use a seat
cushion that holds the body
away from the seatback.
• Make sure the headrest locks
into position after adjusting it.
Front seat headrests
NOTICE
To prevent damage, NEVER hit or
pull on the headrests.
2
When there is no occupant in
the rear seats, adjust the height
of the headrest to the lowest
position. The rear seat headrest
can reduce the visibility of the
rear area.
OAE036010
OPDE036068
The driver’s and front passenger’s
seats are equipped with adjustable
headrests for the passengers safety
and comfort.
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the headrest:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
To lower the headrest:
1. Push and hold the release button
(2) on the headrest support.
2. Lower the headrest to the desired
position (3).
2-17
Safety system of your vehicle
CAUTION
Safety system of your vehicle
■ Type A
OAE036012
OLF034015
OAE036009
Forward and rearward adjustment
(if equipped)
The headrest may be adjusted forward to 3 different positions by
pulling the headrest forward to the
desired detent. To adjust the headrest to it’s furthest rearwards position, pull it fully forward to the farthest
position and release it.
■ Type B
NOTICE
If you recline the seatback towards
the front with the headrest and
seat cushion raised, the headrest
may come in contact with the sunvisor or other parts of the vehicle.
OAE036011
Removal/Reinstall
To remove the headrest:
1. Recline the seatback (2) with using
the seatback angle lever or switch
(1).
2. Raise headrest as far as it can go.
2-18
3. Press the headrest release button
(3) while pulling the headrest up (4).
■ Type A
4. Recline the seatback (4) with the
seatback angle lever or switch (3).
WARNING
WARNING
2
OAE036014
■ Type B
OAE036013
To reinstall the headrest :
1. Recline the seatback.
2. Put the headrest poles (2) into the
holes while pressing the release
button (1).
3. Adjust the headrest to the appropriate height.
2-19
Safety system of your vehicle
Always make sure the headrest
locks into position after reinstalling and adjusting it properly.
NEVER allow anyone to travel in a
seat with the headrest removed.
Safety system of your vehicle
Rear seat headrests
OPDE036069
The rear seats are equipped with
headrests in all the seating positions
for the passenger’s safety and comfort.
OAE036017
OAE036072L
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the headrest:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
To remove the headrest, raise it as
far as it can go then press the
release button (1) while pulling the
headrest up (2).
To reinstall the headrest, put the
headrest poles (3) into the holes
while pressing the release button (1).
Then adjust it to the appropriate
height.
To lower the headrest:
1. Push and hold the release button
(2) on the headrest support.
2. Lower the headrest to the desired
position (3).
WARNING
Make sure the headrest locks in
position after adjusting it to
properly protect the occupants.
2-20
Seat warmers and air ventilation seats
Front seat warmers (if equipped)
Seat warmers are provided to warm
the seats during cold weather.
The seat warmers can cause a
SERIOUS BURN, even at low
temperatures and especially if
used for long periods of time.
Passengers must be able to feel
if the seat is becoming too warm
so they can turn it off, if needed.
People who cannot detect temperature change or pain to the
skin should use extreme caution, especially the following
types of passengers:
• Infants, children, elderly or
disabled persons, or hospital
outpatients.
• People with sensitive skin or
who burn easily.
(Continued)
WARNING
NEVER place anything on the
seat that insulates against heat
when the seat warmer is in operation, such as a blanket or seat
cushion. This may cause the
seat warmer to overheat, causing a burn or damage to the seat.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the seat
warmers and seats:
• Never use a solvent such as
paint thinner, benzene, alcohol
or gasoline to clean the seats.
• Do not place heavy or sharp
objects on seats equipped with
seat warmers.
• Do not change the seat cover. It
may damage the seat warmer.
2-21
2
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
(Continued)
• Fatigued individuals.
• Intoxicated individuals.
• People taking medication that
can cause drowsiness or
sleepiness.
Safety system of your vehicle
• Each time you push the switch, the
temperature setting of the seat is
changed as follows :
→
HIGH (
OAEE039002
While the vehicle is ON, push either of
the switches to warm the driver's seat
or front passenger's seat.
During mild weather or under conditions where the operation of the seat
warmer is not needed, keep the
switches in the OFF position.
2-22
)
→
LOW (
)
→
→
OFF
Front air ventilation seat
(if equipped)
MIDDLE (
)
• When pressing the switch for more
than 1.5 seconds with the seat
warmer operating, the seat warmer
will turn OFF.
• The seat warmer defaults to the
OFF position whenever the POWER
button is placed to the ON position.
i Information
With the seat warmer switch in the
ON position, the heating system in the
seat turns off or on automatically
depending on the seat temperature.
OAEE039003
The air ventilation seats are provided
to cool the front seats by blowing air
through small vent holes on the surface of the seat cushions and seatbacks.
When the operation of the air ventilation seat is not needed, keep the
switches in the OFF position.
While the vehicle is ON, push the
switch to cool the driver's seat or the
front passenger's seat (if equipped).
• Each time you push the switch, the
airflow changes as follows:
→
HIGH (
)
→
LOW (
)
→
→
OFF
MIDDLE (
)
To prevent damage to the air ventilation seat:
• Use the air ventilation seat ONLY
when the climate control system
is on. Using the air ventilation
seat for prolonged periods of
time with the climate control system off could cause the air ventilation seat to malfunction.
• Never use a solvent such as paint
thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline to clean the seats.
• Avoid spilling liquids on the surface of the front seats and seatbacks; this may cause the air vent
holes to become blocked and not
work properly.
• Do not place materials such as
plastic bags or newspapers under
the seats. They may block the air
intake causing the air vents to not
work properly.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not change the seat covers. It
may damage the air ventilation
seat.
• If the air vents do not operate,
restart the vehicle. If there is no
change, we recommend that you
have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
2-23
2
Safety system of your vehicle
• When pressing the switch for more
than 1.5 seconds with the air ventilation seat operating, the operation
will turn OFF.
• The air ventilation seats defaults to
the OFF position whenever the
POWER button is placed to the ON
position.
NOTICE
Safety system of your vehicle
Rear seat warmers (if equipped)
Each time you push the switch, the
temperature setting of the seat is
changed as follows :
→
OFF → HIGH (
) → LOW (
)
The seat warmer defaults to the OFF
position whenever the POWER button
is placed to the ON position.
i Information
OAE036023
While the vehicle is ON, push either of
the switches to warm the rear seat.
During mild weather or under conditions where the operation of the seat
warmer is not needed, keep the
switches in the OFF position.
2-24
With the seat warmer switch in the
ON position, the heating system in the
seat turns off or on automatically
depending on the seat temperature.
SEAT BELTS
This section describes how to use the
seat belts properly. It also describes
some of the things not to do when
using seat belts.
Always fasten your seat belt and
make sure all passengers have fastened their seat belts before starting
any trip. Air bags (if equipped) are
designed to supplement the seat belt
as an additional safety device, but
they are not a substitute. Most countries require all occupants of a vehicle
to wear seat belts.
Seat belts must be used by ALL
passengers whenever the vehicle is moving. Take the following
precautions when adjusting and
wearing seat belts:
• Children under the age of 13
should be properly restrained
in the rear seats.
• Never allow children to ride in
the front passenger seat, unless
the air bag is deactivated. If a
child is seated in the front passenger seat, move the seat as
far back as possible and properly restrain them in the seat.
• NEVER allow an infant or child
to be carried on an occupant’s
lap.
• NEVER ride with the seatback
reclined when the vehicle is
moving.
• Do not allow children to share
a seat or seat belt.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not wear the shoulder belt
under your arm or behind your
back.
• Never wear a seat belt over
fragile objects. If there is a sudden stop or impact, the seat
belt can damage it.
• Do not use the seat belt if it is
twisted. A twisted seat belt
will not protect you properly
in an accident.
• Do not use a seat belt if the
webbing or hardware is damaged.
• Do not latch the seat belt into
the buckles of other seats.
• NEVER unfasten the seat belt
while driving. This may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
• Make sure there is nothing in
the buckle interfering with the
seat belt latch mechanism.
This may prevent the seat belt
from fastening securely.
(Continued)
2-25
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Seat belt safety precautions
WARNING
Safety system of your vehicle
(Continued)
• No modifications or additions
should be made by the user
which will either prevent the
seat belt adjusting devices
from operating to remove
slack, or prevent the seat belt
assembly from being adjusted
to remove slack.
WARNING
Damaged seat belts and seat
belt assemblies will not operate
properly. Always replace:
• Frayed, contaminated, or damaged webbing.
• Damaged hardware.
• The entire seat belt assembly
after it has been worn in an
accident, even if damage to
webbing or assembly is not
apparent.
Seat belt warning light
Seat belt warning
OAM032161L
Driver’s seat belt warning
As a reminder to the driver, the seat
belt warning light will illuminate and
chime for approximately 6 seconds
each time the POWER button is
turned ON regardless of belt fastening.
If the driver’s seat belt is unfastened
after the POWER button is ON, the
seat belt warning light illuminates
until the belt is fastened.
2-26
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 9km/h, the
illuminated warning light will start to
blink until you drive under 6km/h.
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 20km/h the
seat belt warning chime will sound
for approximately 100 seconds and
the corresponding warning light will
blink.
OTLE035082
Front passenger’s seat belt warning
(if equipped)
As a reminder to the front passenger,
the front passenger’s seat belt warning lights will illuminate for approximately 6 seconds each time the
POWER button is turned on regardless of belt fastening.
If the front passenger’s seat belt is
not fastened when the POWER button is turned ON or if it is disconnected after the POWER button is
turned ON, the corresponding seat
belt warning light will illuminate until
the belt is fastened.
WARNING
Riding in an improper position
adversely affects the front passenger's seat belt warning system. It is important for the driver
to instruct the passenger to
properly be seated as instructed
in this manual.
2-27
2
Safety system of your vehicle
If you start to drive without fastening
the seatbelt, warning light will continue to illumiante until you fasten the
seatbelt.
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 20km/h the
seat belt warning chime will sound
for approximately 100 seconds and
the corresponding warning light will
blink. (if equipped)
Safety system of your vehicle
i Information
• You can find the front passenger’s
seat belt warning light on the center
fascia panel.
• Although the front passenger seat is
not occupied, the seat belt warning
light will blink or illuminate for 6
seconds.
• The front passenger's seat belt
warning may operate when luggage
is placed on the front passenger seat.
OTLE035083
Rear passenger’s seat belt warning
(if equipped)
If the POWER button is turned ON
when the rear passenger's lap/shoulder belt is not fastened, the corresponding seat belt warning light will
illuminate until the belt is fastened.
And then, the rear corresponding
seat belt warning light will illuminate
for approximately 35 seconds, if any
of following occurs:
- You start the vehicle when the rear
belt is not fastened.
- You drive over 9km/h when the rear
belt is not fastened.
- The rear belt is disconnected when
driving under 20km/h.
2-28
If the rear seat belt is fastened, the
warning light will turn off immediately.
If the rear seat belt is disconnected
when you drive over the 20km/h, the
corresponding seat belt warning light
will blink and warning chime will
sound for 35 seconds.
But, if the rear passenger's lap/shoulder belt is/are connected and disconnected twice within 9 seconds after
the belt is fastened, the corresponding
seat belt warning light will not operate.
Seat belt restraint system
Lap/shoulder belt
NOTICE
WARNING
OHS0380100
OHSS038101
To fasten your seat belt:
Pull it out of the retractor and insert
the metal tab (1) into the buckle (2).
There will be an audible "click" when
the tab locks into the buckle.
You should place the lap belt (1) portion across your hips and the shoulder
belt (2) portion across your chest.
The seat belt automatically adjusts to
the proper length after the lap belt portion is adjusted manually so that it fits
snugly around your hips. If you lean
forward in a slow, easy motion, the belt
will extend and move with you.
If there is a sudden stop or impact,
the belt will lock into position. It will
also lock if you try to lean forward too
quickly.
OHSS038102
Improperly positioned seat belts
may increase the risk of serious
injury in an accident. Take the following precautions when adjusting the seat belt:
(Continued)
2-29
2
Safety system of your vehicle
If you are not able to smoothly pull
enough of the seat belt out from
the retractor, firmly pull the seat
belt out and release it. After
release, you will be able to pull the
belt out smoothly.
Safety system of your vehicle
(Continued)
• Position the lap portion of the
seat belt as low as possible
across your hips, not on your
waist, so that it fits snugly. This
allows your strong pelvic bones
to absorb the force of the crash,
reducing the chance of internal
injuries.
• Position one arm under the
shoulder belt and the other over
the belt, as shown in the illustration.
• Always position the shoulder
belt anchor into locked position at the appropriate height.
• Never position the shoulder
belt across your neck or face.
Height adjustment
You can adjust the height of the
shoulder belt anchor to one of the
four different positions for maximum
comfort and safety.
The shoulder portion should be
adjusted so it lies across your chest
and midway over your shoulder nearest the door, not over your neck.
2-30
■ Front seat
OAD035027
OHSS038103
To adjust the height of the seat belt
anchor, lower or raise the height
adjuster into an appropriate position.
To raise the height adjuster, pull it up
(1). To lower it, push it down (3) while
pressing the height adjuster button (2).
Release the button to lock the anchor
into position. Try sliding the height
adjuster to make sure that it has
locked into position.
To release your seat belt:
Press the release button (1) in the
locking buckle.
When it is released, the belt should
automatically draw back into the
retractor. If this does not happen,
check the belt to be sure it is not twisted, then try again.
Rear center seatbelt
(3-point rear center seat belt)
Pre-tensioner seat belt
2
OAE036068L
1.Insert the tongue plate (A) into the
buckle (A’) until an audible “click" is
heard, indicating the latch is
locked. Make sure the belt is not
twisted.
2. Pull the tongue plate (B) and
insert it into the buckle (B’) until an
audible “click” is heard, indicating
the latch is locked. Make sure the
belt is not twisted.
When using the rear center seat belt,
the buckle with the “CENTER” mark
must be used.
i Information
If you are not able to pull out the safety belt from the retractor, firmly pull
the belt out and release it. After
release, you will be able to pull the belt
out smoothly.
OLMB033039
Your vehicle is equipped with driver's
and front passenger's and rear side
passenger’s (if equipped) Pre-tensioner Seat Belts (Retractor Pretensioner).
The purpose of the pre-tensioner is to
make sure the seat belts fit tightly
against the occupant's body in certain
frontal collisions. The pre-tensioner
seat belts may be activated in crashes where the frontal collision is
severe enough, together with the air
bags.
2-31
Safety system of your vehicle
OAE036027
Safety system of your vehicle
When the vehicle stops suddenly, or
if the occupant tries to lean forward
too quickly, the seat belt retractor will
lock into position. In certain frontal
collisions, the pre-tensioner will activate and pull the seat belt into tighter
contact against the occupant's body.
If the system senses excessive tension
on the driver or passenger's seat belt
when the pre-tensioner system activates, the load limiter (if equipped)
inside the retractor pre-tensioner will
release some of the pressure on the
affected seat belt.
WARNING
• Always wear your seat belt and
•
•
•
•
•
2-32
sit properly in your seat.
Do not use the seat belt if it is
loose or twisted. A loose or
twisted seat belt will not protect you properly in an accident.
Do not place anything near the
buckle. This may adversely
affect the buckle and cause it
to function improperly.
Always replace your pre-tensioners after activation or an
accident.
NEVER inspect, service, repair
or replace the pre-tensioners
yourself. This must be done by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not hit the seat belt assemblies.
WARNING
Do not touch the pre-tensioner
seat belt assemblies for several
minutes after they have been
activated. When the pre-tensioner seat belt mechanism
deploys during a collision, the
pre-tensioner can become hot
and can burn you.
CAUTION
Body work on the front area of
the vehicle may damage the
pre-tensioner seat belt system.
Therefore, we recommend the
system to be serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
(3) SRS control module
(4) Rear retractor pre-tensioner
(if equipped)
NOTICE
OPDE037069
The Pre-Tensioner Seat Belt System
consists mainly of the following components. Their locations are shown in
the illustration above:
(1) SRS air bag warning light
(2) Front retractor pre-tensioner
2-33
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OLMB033040/Q
The sensor that activates the SRS
control module is connected with
the pre–tensioner seat belts. The
SRS air bag warning light on the
instrument panel will illuminate
for approximately 6 seconds after
the power button is placed to the
ON position, and then it should
turn off.
If the pre-tensioner is not working
properly, the warning light will illuminate even if the SRS control
module is not malfunctioning. If
the warning light does not illuminate when the vehicle is turned
ON, stays illuminated or illuminates when the vehicle is being
driven, we recommend the pretensioner seat belts and/or SRS
air bags be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
i Information
• Both the driver's and front passenger's pre-tensioner seat belts may be
activated in certain frontal or side
collisions.
• The pre-tensioners will be activated
even if the seat belts are not worn at
the time of the collision.
• When the pre-tensioner seat belts
are activated, a loud noise may be
heard and fine dust, which may
appear to be smoke, may be visible
in the passenger compartment.
These are normal operating conditions and are not hazardous.
• Although it is non-toxic, the fine dust
may cause skin irritation and should
not be breathed for prolonged periods. Wash all exposed skin areas
thoroughly after an accident in which
the pre-tensioner seat belts were activated.
Safety system of your vehicle
Additional seat belt safety precautions
Seat belt use during pregnancy
The seat belt should always be used
during pregnancy. The best way to
protect your unborn child is to protect
yourself by always wearing the seat
belt.
Pregnant women should always wear
a lap-shoulder seat belt. Place the
shoulder belt across your chest, routed between your breasts and away
from your neck. Place the lap belt
below your belly so that it fits SNUGLY
across your hips and pelvic bone,
under the rounded part of the belly.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death to an unborn
child during an accident, pregnant women should NEVER
place the lap portion of the seat
belt above or over the area of
the abdomen where the unborn
child is located.
2-34
Seat belt use and children
Infant and small children
Most countries have Child Restraint
System laws which require children to
travel in approved Child Restraint
System devices, including booster
seats. The age at which seat belts can
be used instead of Child Restraint
System differs among countries, so
you should be aware of the specific
requirements in your country, and
where you are travelling. Infant and
Child Restraint System must be properly placed and installed in a rear seat.
For more information refer to the “Child
Restraint Systems” in this chapter.
WARNING
ALWAYS properly restrain infants
and small children in a Child
Restraint System appropriate for
the child’s height and weight.
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death to a child and
other passengers, NEVER hold a
child in your lap or arms when
the vehicle is moving.The violent
forces created during an accident will tear the child from your
arms and throw the child against
the interior of the vehicle.
Larger children
Children under age 13 and who are
too large for a booster seat should
always occupy the rear seat and use
the available lap/shoulder belts. A
seat belt should lie across the upper
thighs and be snug across the shoulder and chest to restrain the child
safely. Check belt fit periodically. A
child's squirming could put the belt
out of position. In the event of an accident, children are afforded the best
safety restrained by a proper Child
Restraint System in the rear seats.
If a larger child over age 13 must be
seated in the front seat, the child
must be securely restrained by the
available lap/shoulder belt and the
seat should be placed in the rearmost position.
If the shoulder belt portion slightly
touches the child’s neck or face, try
placing the child closer to the center
of the vehicle. If the shoulder belt still
touches their face or neck, they need
to be returned to an appropriate
booster seat in the rear seat.
WARNING
• Always make sure larger children’s seat belts are worn and
properly adjusted.
• NEVER allow the shoulder
belt to contact the child’s
neck or face.
• Do not allow more than one
child to use a single seat belt.
2-35
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Small children are best protected
from injury in an accident when properly restrained in the rear seat by a
Child Restraint System that meets the
requirements of the Safety Standards
of your country. Before buying any
Child Restraint System, make sure
that it has a label certifying that it
meets Safety Standard of your country. The Child Restraint System must
be appropriate for your child's height
and weight. Check the label on the
Child Restraint System for this information. Refer to “Child Restraint Systems”
in this chapter.
Safety system of your vehicle
Seat belt use and injured people
A seat belt should be used when an
injured person is being transported.
Consult a physician for specific recommendations.
One person per belt
Two people (including children) should
never attempt to use a single seat belt.
This could increase the severity of
injuries in case of an accident.
Do not lie down
Sitting in a reclined position when
the vehicle is in motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up, the
protections of your restraint system
(seat belts and/or air bags) is greatly
reduced by reclining your seatback.
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly.
During an accident, you could be
thrown into the seat belt, causing
neck or other injuries.
2-36
The more the seat back is reclined,
the greater the chance for the passenger's hips to slide under the lap
belt or the passenger's neck to strike
the shoulder belt.
WARNING
Care of seat belts
Seat belt systems should never be
disassembled or modified. In addition, care should be taken to assure
that seat belts and belt hardware are
not damaged by seat hinges, doors
or other abuse.
• NEVER ride with a reclined
Periodic inspection
seatback when the vehicle is
moving.
• Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious or fatal injuries in the event
of a collision or sudden stop.
• Driver and passengers should
always sit well back in their
seats, properly belted, and with
the seatbacks upright.
All seat belts should be inspected
periodically for wear or damage of
any kind. Any damaged parts should
be replaced as soon as possible.
Keep belts clean and dry
Seat belts should be kept clean and
dry. If belts become dirty, they can be
cleaned by using a mild soap solution
and warm water. Bleach, dye, strong
detergents or abrasives should not be
used because they may damage and
weaken the fabric.
When to replace seat belts
The entire seat belt assembly or
assemblies should be replaced if the
vehicle has been involved in an accident. This should be done even if no
damage is visible. We recommend that
you consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM (CRS)
Our recommendation:
Children always in the rear
WARNING
Children under age 13 should always
ride in the rear seats and must
always be properly restrained to minimize the risk of injury in an accident,
sudden stop or sudden maneuver.
According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained
in the rear seats than in the front
seat. Children too large for a Child
Restraint System must use the seat
belts provided.
Child Restraint System (CRS)
Infants and younger children must be
restrained in an appropriate rearwardfacing or forward-facing CRS that has
first been properly secured to the seat
of the vehicle. Read and comply with
the instructions for installation and use
provided by the manufacturer of the
Child Restraint System.
WARNING
• Always follow the Child Restraint
System manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use.
• Always properly restrain your
child in the Child Restraint
System.
• Do not use an infant carrier or
a child safety seat that “hooks”
over a seatback, it may not provide adequate protection in an
accident.
• After an accident, we recommend a HYUNDAI dealer to
check the Child Restraint
System, seat belts, ISOFIX
anchorages and top-tether
anchorages.
2-37
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Always properly restrain children
in the vehicle. Children of all ages
are safer when riding in the rear
seats. Never place a rearwardfacing Child Restraint System on
the front passenger seat, unless
the air bag is deactivated.
Most countries have regulations which
require children to travel in approved
Child Restraint Systems.
The laws governing the age or
height/weight restrictions at which seat
belts can be used instead of Child
Restraint System differs among countries, so you should be aware of the
specific requirements in your country,
and where you are travelling.
Child Restraint Systems must be
properly installed in the vehicle seat.
Always use a commercially available
Child Restraint System that meets the
requirements of your country.
Safety system of your vehicle
Selecting a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
When selecting a Child Restraint
System for your child, always:
• Make sure the Child Restraint
System has a label certifying that it
meets applicable Safety Standards
of your country.
A Child Restraint System may only
be installed if it was approved in
accordance with the requirements of
ECE-R44 or ECE-R129.
• Select a Child Restraint System
based on your child’s height and
weight. The required label or the
instructions for use typically provide this information.
• Select a Child Restraint System
that fits the vehicle seating position
where it will be used.
• Read and comply with the warnings and instructions for installation
and use provided with the Child
Restraint System.
2-38
Child Restraint System types
There are three main types of Child
Restraint Systems: rearward-facing,
forward-facing and booster Child
Restraint Systems.
They are classified according to the
child’s age, height and weight.
OAE036062
Rearward-facing Child Restraint
System
A rearward-facing Child Restraint
System provides restraint with the
seating surface against the back of
the child. The harness system holds
the child in place, and in an accident,
acts to keep the child positioned in the
Child Restraint Systems and reduce
the stress to the fragile neck and spinal
cord.
OAE036028
Forward-facing Child Restraint
System
A forward-facing Child Restraint System
provides restraint for the child’s body
with a harness. Keep children in a forward-facing Child Restraint System
with a harness until they reach the
top height or weight limit allowed by
your Child Restraint System’s manufacturer.
Once your child outgrows the forwardfacing Child Restraint System, your
child is ready for a booster seat.
Booster seats
A booster seat is a Child Restraint
System designed to improve the fit of
the vehicle’s seat belt system. A booster seat positions the seat belt so that it
fits properly over the stronger parts of
your child’s body. Keep your children in
booster seats until they are big
enough to fit in a seat belt properly.
For a seat belt to fit properly, the lap
belt must lie comfortable across the
upper thighs, not the stomach. The
shoulder belt should lie comfortable
across the shoulder and chest and
not across the neck or face. Children
under age 13 must always be properly restrained to minimize the risk of
injury in an accident, sudden stop or
sudden maneuver.
2-39
2
Safety system of your vehicle
All children under the age of one year
must always ride in a rearward-facing
Child Restraint System. There are different types of rearward-facing Child
Restraint Systems: infant-only Child
Restraint Systems can only be used
rearward-facing. Convertible and 3-in1 Child Restraint Systems typically
have higher height and weight limits
for the rearward-facing position, allowing you to keep your child rearwardfacing for a longer period of time.
Keep using Child Restraint Systems
in the rearward-facing position as long
as children fit within the height and
weight limits allowed by the Child
Restraint System's manufacturer.
Safety system of your vehicle
Installing a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
WARNING
Before installing your Child
Restraint System always:
Read and follow the instructions
provided by the manufacturer of
the Child Restraint System.
Failure to follow all warnings
and instructions could increase
the risk of the SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH if an accident occurs.
WARNING
If the vehicle headrest prevents
proper installation of a Child
Restraint System, the headrest
of the respective seating position shall be readjusted or
entirely removed.
2-40
After selecting a proper Child Restraint
System for your child and checking
that the Child Restraint System fits
properly on the seating position, there
are three general steps for a proper
installation:
• Properly secure the Child Restraint
System to the vehicle. All Child
Restraint Systems must be secured
to the vehicle with the lap belt or lap
part of a lap/shoulder belt or with
the ISOFIX top-tether and/or ISOFIX
anchorage and/or with the support
leg.
• Make sure the Child Restraint
System is firmly secured. After
installing a Child Restraint System
to the vehicle, push and pull the
seat forward and from side-to-side
to verify that it is securely attached
to the seat. A Child Restraint
System secured with a seat belt
should be installed as firmly as
possible. However, some side-toside movement can be expected.
When installing a Child Restraint
System, adjust the vehicle seat and
seatback (up and down, forward and
rearward) so that your child fits in
the Child Restraint System in a confortable manner.
• Secure the child in the Child
Restraint System. Make sure the
child is properly strapped in the
Child Restraint System according
to the Child Restraint System manufacturer’s instructions.
CAUTION
A Child Restraint System in a
closed vehicle can become very
hot. To prevent burns, check the
seating surface and buckles
before placing your child in the
Child Restraint System.
ISOFIX anchorage and top-tether anchorage (ISOFIX anchorage
system) for children
OAE036063
Do not attempt to install a Child
Restraint System using ISOFIX
anchorages in the rear center
seating position. There are no
ISOFIX anchorages provided for
this seat. Using the outboard seat
anchorages, for the CRS installation on the rear center seating
position, can damage the anchorages.
ISOFIX anchorages have been provided in the left and right outboard
rear seating positions. Their locations
are shown in the illustration.
2-41
2
Safety system of your vehicle
The ISOFIX system holds a Child
Restraint System during driving and in
an accident.This system is designed to
make installation of the Child Restraint
System easier and reduce the possibility of improperly installing your
Child Restraint System. The ISOFIX
system uses anchors in the vehicle
and attachments on the Child
Restraint System. The ISOFIX system eliminates the need to use seat
belts to secure the Child Restraint
System to the rear seats.
ISOFIX anchorages are metal bars
built into the vehicle. There are two
lower anchors for each ISOFIX seating position that will accommodate a
Child Restraint System with lower
attachments.
To use the ISOFIX system in your vehicle, you must have a Child Restraint
System with ISOFIX attachments.
The Child Restraint System manufacturer will provide you with instructions on how to use the Child
Restraint System with its attachments for the ISOFIX anchorages.
WARNING
Safety system of your vehicle
Securing a Child Restraint
System with the “ISOFIX
Anchorage System”
ISOFIX Anchorage
Position Indicator
ISOFIX Anchorage
OAE036031
ISOFIX anchorages are located
between the seatback and the seat
cushion of the rear seat left and right
outboard seating positions, indicated
by the symbols
.
2-42
To install an ISOFIX-compatible Child
Restraint System in either of the rear
outboard seating positions:
1. Move the seat belt buckle away
from the ISOFIX anchorages.
2. Move any other objects away from
the anchorages that could prevent
a secure connection between the
Child Restraint System and the
ISOFIX anchorages.
3. Place the Child Restraint System
on the vehicle seat, then attach the
seat to the ISOFIX anchorages
according to the instructions provided by the Child Restraint System
manufacturer.
4. Follow the instructions of the Child
Restraint System's manufacturer
for proper installation and connection of the ISOFIX attachments on
the Child Restraint System to the
ISOFIX anchorages.
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when using the ISOFIX system:
• Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with
your Child Restraint System.
• To prevent the child from reaching and taking hold of unretracted seat belts, buckle all
unused rear seat belts and
retract the seat belt webbing
behind the child. Children can
be strangled if a shoulder belt
becomes wrapped around their
neck and the seat belt tightens.
• NEVER attach more than one
Child Restraint System to a
single anchorage. This could
cause the anchor or attachment to come loose or break.
• Always have the ISOFIX system inspected by your dealer
after an accident. An accident
can damage the ISOFIX system
and may not properly secure
the Child Restraint System.
Securing a Child Restraint
System seat with “Top-tether
Anchorage” system
WARNING
OAEE036029
Top-tether anchorages for Child
Restraint Systems are located on the
rear of the seatbacks.
1. Route the Child Restraint System
top-tether strap over the seatback.
Placing the top tether strap, please
follow the instructions of the Child
Restraint System manufacturer.
2. Connect the top-tether strap to the
top-tether anchorage, then tighten
the top-tether strap according to the
instructions of your Child Restraint
System's manufacturer to firmly
attach the Child Restraint System to
the seat.
2-43
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OAE036030
Take the following precautions
when installing the top-tether:
• Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with
your Child Restraint System.
• NEVER attach more than one
Child Restraint System to a
single
ISOFIX
top-tether
anchorage. This could cause
the anchorage or attachment
to come loose or break.
• Do not attach the top-tether to
anything other than the correct top-tether anchorage. It
may not work properly if
attached to something else.
• Child Restraint System anchorages are designed to withstand
only those loads imposed by
correctly fitted Child Restraint
System.
Under no circumstances are
they to be used for adult seat
belts or harnesses or for attaching other items or equipment to
the vehicle.
Safety system of your vehicle
Suitability of each seating position for ISOFIX Child Restraint Systems according to ECE regulations
Mass Groupx
Carrycot
0- : UP TO 10KG
0+ : UP TO 13KG
1 : 9 TO 18KG
Size
Class
Fixture
F
G
E
E
D
C
D
C
B
B1
A
ISO/L1
ISO/L2
ISO/R1
ISO/R1
ISO/R2
ISO/R3
ISO/R2
ISO/R3
ISO/F2
ISO/F2X
ISO/F3
1st row
Passenger
-
IUF = Suitable for ISOFIX forward child restraints systems of universal
category approved for use in the mass group.
IL = Suitable for particular ISOFIX child restraints systems (CRS)
given in the attached list.
These ISOFIX CRS are those of the "specific vehicle", "restricted" or "semi-universal" categories.
X = ISOFIX position not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint system in
this mass group and/or this size class.
2-44
Vehicle ISOFIX positions
2nd row
Left
Center
X
X
IL
IL
IL
IL
IL
IL
IUF,IL
IUF,IL
IUF,IL
-
Right
X
X
IL
IL
IL
IL
IL
IL
IUF,IL
IUF,IL
IUF,IL
A - ISO/F3: Full-Height Forward-Facing toddler Child Restraint System
(height 720mm)
B - ISO/F2: Reduced-Height Forward-Facing toddler Child Restraint
System (height 650mm)
B1 - ISO/F2X: Reduced-Height Second Version Back Surface Shape
Forward-Facing toddler Child Restraint System (height 650mm)
C - ISO/R3: Full-Size Rearward-Facing toddler Child Restraint System
D - ISO/R2: Reduced-Size Rearward-Facing toddler Child Restraint System
E - ISO/R1: Infant-Size Rearward-Facing Child Restraint System
F - ISO/L1: Left Lateral Facing position Child Restraint System (carry-cot)
G - ISO/L2: Right Lateral Facing position Child Restraint System (carry-cot)
Securing a Child Restraint
System with a lap/shoulder belt
i Information
When using the rear center seat belt,
you should also refer to the “Rear
Center Seat Belt” in this chapter.
2
Safety system of your vehicle
When not using the ISOFIX system,
all Child Restraint Systems must be
secured to a rear seat with the lap
part of a lap/shoulder belt.
OLMB033044
Installing a Child Restraint System
with a lap/shoulder belt
To install a Child Restraint System
on the rear seats, do the following:
1. Place the Child Restraint System
on a rear seat and route the lap/
shoulder belt around or through the
Child Restraint System, following
the Child Restraint System manufacturer’s instructions.
Make sure the seat belt webbing is
not twisted.
2-45
Safety system of your vehicle
To remove the Child Restraint System,
press the release button on the buckle
and then pull the lap/shoulder belt out
of the Child Restraint System and
allow the seat belt to retract fully.
OLMB033045
OLMB033046
2. Fasten the lap/shoulder belt latch
into the buckle. Listen for the distinct “click” sound.
3. Remove as much slack from the
belt as possible by pushing down
on the Child Restraint System while
feeding the shoulder belt back into
the retractor.
4. Push and pull on the Child Restraint
System to confirm that the seat belt
is holding it firmly in place.
i Information
Position the release button so that it is
easy to access in case of an emergency.
If your Child Restraint System manufacturer recommends the use of a
top-tether with the lap/shoulder belt,
see page 2-43.
2-46
Suitability of each seating position for "universal" category belted Child Restraint Systems according to
ECE regulations (for Europe)
Seating Position
Front Passenger
Mass Group
2
Outboard
Right
Airbag
activated
Airbag
deactivated
up to 10kg
X
U*
U
U
U
up to 13kg
X
U*
U
U
U
9 to 18kg
X
U*
U
U
U
15 to 25kg
UF
U*
U
U
U
22 to 36kg
UF
U*
U
U
U
U = Suitable for "universal" category Child Restraint Systems approved for use in this mass group.
U* = Suitable for "universal" category Child Restraint Systems approved for use in this mass group (If front passenger seat is not
adjustable for the height, you should adjust the seat to upward properly. (This step is necessary to restrain child seat to your
vehicle.)
❈ Height adjutable device of Front passenger seat is an optional feature.
UF = Suitable for forward facing "universal" category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
L = Suitable for particular child restraints given on attached list. These restraints may be of the "specific vehicle", "restricted" or
"semi-universal" categories.
B = Built-in restraint approved for this mass group.
X = Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.
2-47
Safety system of your vehicle
Group 0
(0-9months)
Group 0 +
(0-2years)
Group I
(9months-4years)
Group II
(15 to 25kg)
Group III
(22 to 36kg)
Second Row
Center
Outboard Left
(3-point seat belt)
Safety system of your vehicle
Suitability of each seating position for "universal" category belted Child Restraint Systems (except Europe)
Seating Position
Front Passenger
Mass Group
Group 0
(0-9months)
Group 0 +
(0-2years)
Group I
(9months-4years)
Group II
(15 to 25kg)
Group III
(22 to 36kg)
Second Row
Airbag
Equipped
Airbag
NOT
Equipped
Outboard
Left
Center
(3-point
seat belt)
Center
(2-point
seat belt)
Outboard
Right
up to 10kg
X
U*
U
U
UF
U
up to 13kg
X
U*
U
U
UF
U
9 to 18kg
X
U*
U
U
UF
U
15 to 25kg
UF
U*
U
U
UF
U
22 to 36kg
UF
U*
U
U
UF
U
U = Suitable for "universal" category Child Restraint Systems approved for use in this mass group.
U* = Suitable for "universal" category Child Restraint Systems approved for use in this mass group (If front passenger seat is
adjustable for the height, you should adjust the seatback to upward properly. (This step is necessary to restrain child seat to
your vehicle.)
❈ Height adjutable device of Front passenger seat is an optional feature.
UF = Suitable for forward facing "universal" category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
L = Suitable for particular child restraints given on attached list. These restraints may be of the "specific vehicle", "restricted" or
"semi-universal" categories.
B = Built-in restraint approved for this mass group.
X = Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.
2-48
i-Size Child Restraint Systems according to ECE regulations (for Europe)
Seating Position
Mass Group
Second Row
Outboard Left
Center
Outboard
Right
X
i-U
X
i-U
i-size Child Restraint Systems
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Front passenger
Outboard
i-U : Suitable for i-Size "universal" Child Restraint Systems forward and rearward-facing
i-UF : Suitable for forward-facing i-Size "universal" Child Restraint Systems only
X : Seat position not suitable for i-size CRS.
Recommended child restraint systems (for Europe)
Mass Group
Name
Manufacturer
Type of Fixation
ECE-R44
Approval No.
Group 0+
Cabriofix & Familyfix
Maxi Cosi
Rearward-facing with ISOFIX
E4 04443907
Group I
Duo Plus
Britax Römer
Forward-facing with ISOFIX and top-tether
E1 04301133
Group II
KidFix II XP
Britax Römer
Forward-facing with ISOFIX and vehicle Belt
E1 04301323
Group III
KidFix II XP
Britax Römer
Forward-facing with ISOFIX and vehicle Belt
E1 04301323
CRS Manufacturer information
Maxi Cosi Cabriofix & Familyfix http://www.maxi-cosi.com
Britax Römmer http://www.britax.com
2-49
Safety system of your vehicle
AIR BAG - SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
■ Left-hand drive
1. Driver’s front air bag
2. Passenger’s front air bag
3. Side air bag
4. Curtain air bag
5. Knee air bag
6. Front passenger air bag ON/OFF
switch (if equipped)
The actual air bags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OAEE036035/OAE036073L
2-50
■ Right-hand drive
2
2. Passenger’s front air bag
3. Side air bag
4. Curtain air bag
5. Knee air bag
6. Front passenger air bag ON/OFF
switch (if equipped)
The actual air bags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OAEE036062R/OAE036073R
2-51
Safety system of your vehicle
1. Driver’s front air bag
Safety system of your vehicle
The vehicles are equipped with a
Supplemental Air Bag System for the
driver’s seat and front passenger’s
seats.
The front air bags are designed to
supplement the three-point seat
belts. For these air bags to provide
protection, the seat belts must be
worn at all times when driving.
You can be severely injured or killed
in an accident if you are not wearing
a seat belt. Air bags are designed to
supplement seat belts, but do not
replace them. Also, air bags are not
designed to deploy in every collision.
In some accidents, the seat belts are
the only restraint protecting you.
2-52
WARNING
AIR BAG SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
ALWAYS use seat belts Child Restraint Systems - every trip, every
time, everyone! Even with air bags, you can be seriously injured or
killed in a collision if you are improperly belted or not wearing your
seat belt when the air bag inflates.
NEVER place a child in any Child Restraint System or booster seat in
the front passenger seat, unless the air bag is deactivated.
An inflating air bag could forcefully strike the infant or child causing
serious or fatal injuries.
ABC - Always Buckle Children under age 13 in the back seat. It is the
safest place for children of any age to ride. If a child age 13 or older
must be seated in the front seat, he or she must be properly belted
and the seat should be moved as far back as possible.
All occupants should sit upright with the seatback in an upright position, centered on the seat cushion with their seat belt on, legs comfortably extended and their feet on the floor until the vehicle is parked
and the vehicle is turned off. If an occupant is out of position during
an accident, the rapidly deploying air bag may forcefully contact the
occupant causing serious or fatal injuries.
You and your passengers should never sit or lean unnecessarily
close to the air bags or lean against the door or center console.
Move your seat as far back as possible from front air bags, while still
maintaining control of the vehicle.
Where are the air bags?
Driver’s and passenger’s front
air bags
The purpose of the SRS is to provide
the vehicle's driver and front passengers with additional protection than
that offered by the seat belt system
alone in case of a frontal impact of
sufficient severity.
■ Passenger’s front air bag
■ Driver’s front air bag
OAEPH038036
OAEE039032
■ Driver’s knee airbag
Your vehicle is equipped with a
Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) and lap/shoulder belts at both
the driver and passenger seating
positions.
The SRS consists of air bags which
are located in the center of the steering wheel, in the driver’s side lower
crash pad below the steering wheel,
and the passenger's side front panel
pad above the glove box.
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from inflating front
air bags, take the following precautions:
• Seat belts must be worn at all
times to help keep occupants
positioned properly.
• Move your seat as far back as
possible from front air bags,
while still maintaining control
of the vehicle.
(Continued)
OAE036033
2-53
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
2
Safety system of your vehicle
(Continued)
• Never lean against the door or
center console.
• Do not allow the front passenger to place their feet or legs on
the dashboard.
• No objects (such as crash pad
cover, cellular phone holder,
cup holder, perfume or stickers)
should be placed over or near
the air bag modules on the
steering wheel, instrument
panel, windshield glass, and
the front passenger's panel
above the glove box. Such
objects could cause harm if the
vehicle is in a crash severe
enough to cause the air bags to
deploy.
• Do not attach any objects on
front windshield and inside mirror.
2-54
OAE036073L
OAEE039070L
Passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF
switch (if equipped)
The purpose of the switch is to disable the passenger’s front air bag in
order to transport occupants who are
at increased risk for air bag-related
injury due to age, size, or medical
condition.
To deactivate the passenger’s front
air bag:
Insert the key or a similar rigid device
into the passenger’s front air bag
ON/OFF switch and turn it to the
OFF position. The passenger air bag
OFF indicator ( ) will illuminate and
stay on until the passenger’s front air
bag is reactivated.
WARNING
To reactivate the passenger’s front
air bag:
Insert the key or a similar rigid device
into the passenger’s front air bag
ON/OFF switch and turn it to the ON
position. The passenger air bag ON
indicator ( ) will illuminate and stay
on for 60 seconds.
i Information
The passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF
indicator illuminates for about 4 seconds after the POWER button is placed
in the ON position.
If the passenger’s front air bag
ON/OFF switch malfunctions,
the following conditions may
occur:
• The air bag warning light ( )
on the instrument panel will
illuminate.
• The passenger air bag OFF
indicator ( ) will not illuminate and the ON indicator ( )
will come on and go off after
approximately 60 seconds.
The passenger’s front air bag
will inflate in a frontal impact
even though the passenger’s
front air bag ON/OFF switch is
set to the OFF position.
• We recommend that an authorized HYUNDAI dealer inspect
the passenger’s front air bag
ON/OFF switch and the SRS air
bag system as soon as possible.
2-55
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OAEE039069L
Never allow an adult passenger
to ride in the front passenger
seat when the passenger air
bag OFF indicator is illuminated. During a collision, the air
bag will not inflate if the indicator is illuminated. Turn on the
passenger’s front air bag or
have your passenger move to
the rear seat.
WARNING
Safety system of your vehicle
Side air bags
The side air bags are designed to
deploy during certain side impact collisions, depending on the crash
severity, angle, speed and point of
impact.
The side air bags are not designed to
deploy in all side impact situations.
WARNING
OAE036037
OAE036038
Your vehicle is equipped with a side air
bag in each front seat. The purpose of
the air bag is to provide the vehicle’s
driver and the front passenger with
additional protection than that offered
by the seat belt alone.
2-56
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from an inflating
side air bag, take the following
precautions:
• Seat belts must be worn at all
times to help keep occupants
positioned properly.
• Do not allow passengers to
lean their heads or bodies onto
doors, put their arms on the
doors, stretch their arms out of
the window, or place objects
between the doors and seats.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Hold the steering wheel at the 9
o’clock and 3 o’clock positions,
to minimize the risk of injuries
to your hands and arms.
• Do not use any accessory
seat covers. This could reduce
or prevent the effectiveness
of the system.
• Do not hang other objects
except clothes on the clothes
hanger. In an accident it may
cause vehicle damage or personal injury especially when
airbag is inflated.
• Do not place any objects over
the air bag or between the air
bag and yourself. Also, do not
attach any objects around the
area the air bag inflates such
as the door, side door glass,
front and rear pillar.
• Do not place any objects
between the door and the
seat. They may become dangerous projectiles if the side
air bag inflates.
(Continued)
Curtain air bags
They are designed to help protect the
heads of the front seat occupants
and the rear outboard seat occupants
in certain side impact collisions.
The curtain air bags are designed to
deploy during certain side impact
collisions, depending on the crash
severity, angle, speed and impact.
The curtain air bags are not designed
to deploy in all side impact situations.
OAE036041
OAE036042
Curtain air bags are located along
both sides of the roof rails above the
front and rear doors.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from an inflating
curtain air bags, take the following precautions:
• All seat occupants must wear
seat belts at all times to help
keep occupants positioned
properly.
• Properly secure Child Restraint
System as far away from the
door as possible.
(Continued)
2-57
2
Safety system of your vehicle
(Continued)
• Do not install any accessories
on the side or near the side air
bags.
• Do not put any objects
between the side airbag label
and seat cushion. It could
cause harm if the vehicle is in
a crash severe enough to
cause the air bags to deploy.
• Do not cause impact to the
doors when the POWER button
is in the ON position or this
may cause the side air bags to
inflate.
• If the seat or seat cover is
damaged, we recommend that
the system be serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Safety system of your vehicle
(Continued)
• Do not place any objects over
the air bag. Also, do not attach
any objects around the area the
air bag inflates such as the
door, side door glass, front and
rear pillar, roof side rail.
• Do not hang other objects
except clothes, especially hard
or breakable objects on the
clothes hanger. In an accident,
it may cause vehicle damage or
personal injury.
• Do not allow passengers to
lean their heads or bodies
onto doors, put their arms on
the doors, stretch their arms
out of the window, or place
objects between the doors
and seats.
• Do not open or repair the side
curtain air bags.
2-58
How does the air bags system
operate?
OAEE036061L
The SRS consists of the following
components:
(1) Driver's front air bag module/
Driver’s knee airbag module
(2) Passenger's front air bag module
(3) Side air bag modules/
Side impact sensors
(4) Curtain air bag modules
(5) Front retractor pre-tensioner/
Rear retractor pre-tensioner
assemblies (if equipped)
(6) Air bag warning light
(7) SRS control module (SRSCM)
(8) Front impact sensors
(9) Side pressure sensors
(10) Passenger’s front air bag
ON/OFF indicator (front passenger's seat only)
(11) Passenger’s front air bag
ON/OFF switch
The SRSCM continually monitors all
SRS components while the POWER
button is ON to determine if a crash
impact is severe enough to require
air bag deployment or pre-tensioner
seat belt deployment.
SRS warning light
If your SRS malfunctions, the
air bag may not inflate properly
during an accident increasing
the risk of serious injury or
death.
If any of the following conditions occur, your SRS is malfunctioning:
• The light does not turn on for
approximately six seconds
when the POWER button is in
the ON position.
• The light stays on after illuminating for approximately six
seconds.
• The light comes on while the
vehicle is in motion.
• The light blinks when the
vehicle is running.
We recommend that an authorized HYUNDAI dealer inspect the
SRS as soon as possible if any
of these conditions occur.
During a moderate to severe frontal
collision, sensors will detect the vehicle’s rapid deceleration. If the rate of
deceleration is high enough, the control unit will inflate the front air bags,
at the time and with the force needed.
The front air bags help protect the driver and front passenger by responding
to frontal impacts in which seat belts
alone cannot provide adequate
restraint. When needed, the side air
bags help provide protection in the
event of a side impact by supporting
the side upper body area.
• Air bags are activated (able to inflate
if necessary) only when the POWER
button is in the ON position.
• Air bags inflate in the event of certain
frontal or side collisions to help protect the occupants from serious
physical injury.
• There is no single speed at which the
air bags will inflate. Generally, air bags
are designed to inflate based upon
the severity of a collision and its direction. These two factors determine
whether the sensors produce an electronic deployment/inflation signal.
2-59
2
Safety system of your vehicle
The SRS (Supplement Restraint
System) air bag warning light on the
instrument panel displays the air bag
symbol depicted in the illustration. The
system checks the air bag electrical
system for malfunctions. The light indicates that there is a potential problem
with your air bag system.
WARNING
Safety system of your vehicle
• Air bag deployment depends on a
number of factors including vehicle
speed, angles of impact and the
density and stiffness of the vehicles
or objects which your vehicle
impacts during a collision. The
determining factors are not limited
to those mentioned above.
• The front air bags will completely
inflate and deflate in an instant. It is
virtually impossible for you to see
the air bags inflate during an accident. It is much more likely that you
will simply see the deflated air bags
hanging out of their storage compartments after the collision.
2-60
• To help provide protection, the air
bags must inflate rapidly. The speed
of air bag inflation is a consequence
of extremely short time in which to
inflate the air bag between the
occupant and the vehicle structures
before the occupant impacts those
structures. This speed of inflation
reduces the risk of serious or lifethreatening injuries and is thus a
necessary part of air bag design.
However, the rapid air bag inflation
can also cause injuries which can
include facial abrasions, bruises
and broken bones because the
inflation speed also causes the air
bags to expand with a great deal of
force.
• There are even circumstances
under which contact with the air
bag can cause fatal injuries, especially if the occupant is positioned
excessively close to the air bag.
You can take steps to reduce the risk
of being injured by an inflating air
bag. The greatest risk is sitting too
close to the air bag. An air bag needs
space to inflate. It is recommended
that drivers sit as far as possible
between the center of the steering
wheel and the chest while still maintaining control of the vehicle.
■ Driver’s front air bag (1)
■ Driver’s front air bag (2)
■ Driver’s front air bag (3)
2
OLMB033055
When the SRSCM detects a sufficiently severe impact to the front of
the vehicle, it will automatically
deploy the front air bags.
Upon deployment, tear seams molded directly into the pad covers will
separate under pressure from the
expansion of the air bags. Further
opening of the covers allows full
inflation of the air bags.
A fully inflated air bag, in combination with a properly worn seat belt,
slows the driver's or the front passenger's forward motion, reducing
the risk of head and chest injury.
■ Passenger’s front air bag
OLMB033057
After complete inflation, the air bag
immediately starts deflating, enabling
the driver to maintain forward visibility and the ability to steer or operate
other controls.
2-61
Safety system of your vehicle
OLMB033056
OLMB033054
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
To prevent objects from becoming dangerous projectiles when
the passenger's air bag inflates:
• Do not install or place any
objects (drink holder, CD holder, stickers, etc.) on the front
passenger's panel above the
glove box where the passenger's air bag is located.
• Do not install a container of
liquid air freshener near the
instrument cluster or on the
instrument panel surface.
2-62
What to expect after an air bag
inflates
After a frontal or side air bag inflates,
it will deflate very quickly. Air bag
inflation will not prevent the driver
from seeing out of the windshield or
being able to steer. Curtain air bags
may remain partially inflated for
some time after they deploy.
WARNING
After an air bag inflates, take
the following precautions:
• Open your windows and doors
as soon as possible after
impact to reduce prolonged
exposure to the smoke and
powder released by the inflating air bag.
• Do not touch the air bag storage area’s internal components immediately after an air
bag has inflated. The parts
that come into contact with an
inflating air bag may be very
hot.
• Always wash exposed skin
areas thoroughly with cold
water and mild soap.
• We recommend that an authorized HYUNDAI dealer replace
the air bag immediately after
deployment. Air bags are
designed to be used only once.
Noise and smoke from inflating
air bag
WARNING
NEVER use a rearward facing
Child Restraint on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in
front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS
INJURY to the CHILD can occur.
OYDESA2042
Never install a Child Restraint System
in the front passenger seat, unless the
air bag is deactivated
2-63
2
Safety system of your vehicle
When the air bags inflate, they make
a loud noise and may produce smoke
and powder in the air inside of the
vehicle. This is normal and is a result
of the ignition of the air bag inflator.
After the air bag inflates, you may feel
substantial discomfort in breathing
because of the contact of your chest
with both the seat belt and the air
bag, as well as from breathing the
smoke and powder. The powder may
aggravate asthma for some people. If
you experience breathing problems
after an air bag deployment, seek
medical attention immediately.
Though the smoke and powder are
nontoxic, they may cause irritation to
the skin, eyes, nose, throat, etc. If this
is the case, wash and rinse with cold
water immediately and seek medical
attention if the symptoms persist.
Do not install a Child Restraint
System on the front passenger
seat
Safety system of your vehicle
Why didn’t my air bag go off in
a collision?
There are certain types of accidents
in which the air bag would not be
expected to provide additional protection. These include rear impacts, second or third collisions in multiple
impact accidents, as well as low
speed impacts. Damage to the vehicle
indicates a collision energy absorption, and is not an indicator of whether
or not an air bag should have inflated.
2-64
Air bag collision sensors
WARNING
To reduce the risk of an air bag
deploying unexpectedly and
causing serious injury or death:
• Do not hit or allow any objects to
impact the locations where air
bags or sensors are installed.
• Do not perform maintenance
on or around the air bag sensors. If the location or angle of
the sensors is altered, the air
bags may deploy when they
should not or may not deploy
when they should.
• Do not install bumper guards or
replace the bumper with a nongenuine part.This may adversely affect the collision and air
bag deployment performance.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Place the POWER button to
the OFF position, when the
vehicle is being towed to prevent inadvertent air bag
deployment.
• We recommend that all air bag
repairs are conducted by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
2
Safety system of your vehicle
1. SRS control module
2. Front impact sensor
3. Side pressure sensor (front)
4. Side impact sensor (B-pillar)
OAEE039005L/OAE036044/OAEE039006L/OAE036046/OAE036047
2-65
Safety system of your vehicle
Air bag inflation conditions
OAEE039007
OAEE039048
Front air bags
Front air bags are designed to inflate
in a frontal collision depending on
the severity, speed or angles of
impact of the front collision.
OAE036050
Side and curtain air bags
Side and curtain air bags are
designed to inflate when an impact is
detected by side collision sensors
depending on the severity, speed or
angles of impact resulting from a
side impact collision.
2-66
Although the driver’s and front passenger’s air bags are designed to
inflate in frontal collisions, they also
may inflate in other types of collisions if the front impact sensors
detect a sufficient impact. Side and
curtain air bags are designed to
inflate in side impact collisions, but
they may inflate in other collisions if
the side impact sensors detect a sufficient impact.
If the vehicle chassis is impacted by
bumps or objects on unimproved
roads, the air bags may deploy. Drive
carefully on unimproved roads or on
surfaces not designed for vehicle
traffic to prevent unintended air bag
deployment.
Air bag non-inflation conditions
2
In certain low-speed collisions the air
bags may not deploy. The air bags
are designed not to deploy in such
cases because they may not provide
benefits beyond the protection of the
seat belts.
OAEE039008
Front air bags are not designed to
inflate in rear collisions, because
occupants are moved backward by
the force of the impact. In this case,
inflated air bags would not provide
any additional benefit.
Front air bags may not inflate in side
impact collisions, because occupants
move in the direction of the collision,
and thus in side impacts, front air bag
deployment would not provide additional occupant protection.
However, side and curtain air bags
may inflate depending on the severity,
vehicle speed and angles of impact.
2-67
Safety system of your vehicle
OAEE039051
OAEE039052
Safety system of your vehicle
OAE036061
OAEE039054
OAE036055
In an angled collision, the force of
impact may direct the occupants in a
direction where the air bags would
not be able to provide any additional
benefit, and thus the sensors may
not deploy any air bags.
Just before impact, drivers often
brake heavily. Such heavy braking
lowers the front portion of the vehicle
causing it to “ride” under a vehicle
with a higher ground clearance. Air
bags may not inflate in this "underride" situation because deceleration
forces that are detected by sensors
may be significantly reduced by such
“underride” collisions.
Front air bags may not inflate in
rollover accidents because front air
bag deployment would not provide
additional occupant protection.
2-68
i Information
The side and/or curtain air bags may
inflate when the vehicle is rolled over
by a side impact collision, if the vehicle is equipped with side and/or curtain air bags.
SRS care
Air bags may not inflate if the vehicle
collides with objects such as utility
poles or trees, where the point of
impact is concentrated and the collision energy is absorbed by the vehicle structure.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death take the following precautions:
• Do not attempt to modify or
disconnect the SRS components or wiring, including the
addition of any kind of badges
to the pad covers or modifications to the body structure.
• Do not place objects over or
near the air bag modules on the
steering wheel, instrument
panel, and the front passenger's
panel above the glove box.
• Clean the air bag pad covers
with a soft cloth moistened
with plain water. Solvents or
cleaners could adversely affect
the air bag covers and proper
deployment of the system.
• We recommend that inflated
air bags be replaced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
(Continued)
2-69
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OAEE039009
The SRS is virtually maintenancefree and there are no parts you can
safely service by yourself. If the SRS
air bag warning light does not illuminate when the POWER button is in
the ON position, or continuously
remains on, we recommend that the
system be immediately inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
We recommend any work on the SRS
system, such as removing, installing,
repairing, or any work on the steering
wheel, the front passenger's panel,
front seats and roof rails be performed
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Improper handling of the SRS system
may result in serious personal injury.
Safety system of your vehicle
(Continued)
• If components of the air bag
system must be discarded, or if
the vehicle must be scrapped,
certain safety precautions must
be observed. Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for the
necessary information. Failure
to follow these precautions
could increase the risk of personal injury.
2-70
Additional safety precautions
Passengers should not move out of
or change seats while the vehicle is
moving. A passenger who is not
wearing a seat belt during a crash or
emergency stop can be thrown
against the inside of the vehicle,
against other occupants, or be ejected
from the vehicle.
Do not use any accessories on seat
belts. Devices claiming to improve
occupant comfort or reposition the
seat belt can reduce the protection
provided by the seat belt and increase
the chance of serious injury in a crash
Do not modify the front seats.
Modification of the front seats could
interfere with the operation of the supplemental restraint system sensing
components or side air bags.
Do not place items under the front
seats. Placing items under the front
seats could interfere with the operation of the supplemental restraint system sensing components and wiring
harnesses.
Do not cause impact to the doors.
Impact to the doors when the POWER
button is in the ON position may cause
the air bags to inflate.
Adding equipment to or modifying your air bag equipped vehicle
Air bag warning labels
■ Left-hand drive
If you modify your vehicle by changing
your vehicle's frame, bumper system,
front end or side sheet metal or ride
height, this may affect the operation of
your vehicle's air bag system.
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OAD035053
■ Right-hand drive
OAE036060
Air bag warning labels are attached
to alert the passengers of potential
risks of the air bag system.
Be sure to read all of the information
about the air bags that are installed on
your vehicle in this Owner’s Manual.
2-71
Convenient features of your vehicle
Accessing your vehicle .........................................3-3
Sunroof..................................................................3-27
Smart key ............................................................................3-3
Immobilizer system ..........................................................3-7
Sunroof opening and closing.......................................3-28
Sliding the sunroof .........................................................3-28
Tilting the sunroof..........................................................3-29
Sunshade...........................................................................3-30
Resetting the sunroof....................................................3-30
Door locks ...............................................................3-8
Operating door locks from outside the vehicle.........3-8
Operating door locks from inside the vehicle ...........3-9
Auto door lock/unlock features..................................3-11
Child-protector rear door locks ..................................3-11
Theft-alarm system.............................................3-12
Driver position memory system.........................3-13
Storing memory positions .............................................3-13
Easy access function .....................................................3-14
Steering wheel......................................................3-15
Electric power steering (EPS)......................................3-15
Tilt steering / Telescope steering...............................3-16
Heated steering wheel .................................................3-16
Horn....................................................................................3-17
Exterior features .................................................3-31
Hood ...................................................................................3-31
Tailgate...............................................................................3-33
Instrument cluster................................................3-35
Instrument cluster control ............................................3-36
Gauges and meters.........................................................3-37
Warning and indicator lights ........................................3-41
LCD display messages....................................................3-53
LCD Display ...........................................................3-64
LCD display control.........................................................3-64
LCD display modes..........................................................3-65
Mirrors...................................................................3-17
Trip computer .......................................................3-77
Inside rearview mirror....................................................3-17
Outside rearview mirror ................................................3-19
Light .......................................................................3-81
Windows ................................................................3-22
Power windows................................................................3-22
Trip modes ........................................................................3-77
Exterior lights ..................................................................3-81
Welcome system ............................................................3-91
Interior lights....................................................................3-92
3
Wipers and washers ...........................................3-95
Storage compartment........................................3-127
Windshield wipers ..........................................................3-95
Windshield washers .......................................................3-97
Center console storage ...............................................3-127
Glove box ........................................................................3-128
Sunglass holder ............................................................3-128
Multi box ........................................................................3-129
Rear View Monitor ..............................................3-98
3
Driving Rear View Monitor (DRVM) ...........................3-98
Reverse Parking Distance Warning system............3-100
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system..............................................................................3-104
Self-Diagnosis ...............................................................3-108
Defroster.............................................................3-109
Rear window defroster ...............................................3-109
Automatic climate control system...................3-110
Automatic heating and air conditioning..................3-111
Manual heating and air conditioning .......................3-112
System operation..........................................................3-119
System maintenance ....................................................3-121
Windshield defrosting and defogging ............3-123
Automatic climate control system ............................3-123
Defogging logic ............................................................3-124
Auto defogging system ..............................................3-125
Climate control additional features.................3-126
Sunroof inside air recirculation.................................3-126
Interior features ...............................................3-130
Ashtray ...........................................................................3-130
Cup holder.......................................................................3-130
Sunvisor...........................................................................3-131
Power outlet .................................................................3-132
Wireless cellular phone charging system ...............3-133
Cigarette lighter ............................................................3-135
Clock.................................................................................3-135
Clothes hanger .............................................................3-136
Floor mat anchor(s) ....................................................3-136
Luggage net (holder) ...................................................3-137
Cargo security screen..................................................3-138
ACCESSING YOUR VEHICLE
Locking
Smart key
i Information
The door handle button will only
operate when the smart key is within
0.7~1 m (28~40 in.) from the outside
door handle.
OAE046001
Your HYUNDAI uses a Smart Key,
which you can use to lock or unlock
a door (and tailgate) and even start
the vehicle.
1. Door Lock
2. Door Unlock
3. Tailgate Unlock
To lock :
1. Close all doors, hood and tailgate.
2. Either press the door handle button or press the Door Lock button
(1) on the smart key.
3. The hazard warning lights will
blink. Also, the outside rearview
mirror will fold, if the outside
rearview mirror folding switch is in
the AUTO position (if equipped).
4. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door
lock button inside the vehicle.
WARNING
Do not leave the Smart Key in
your vehicle with unsupervised
children. Unattended children
could press the POWER button
and may operate power windows or other controls, or even
make the vehicle move, which
could result in serious injury or
death.
3-3
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OBA043222IN
Even though you press the outside
door handle button, the doors will not
lock and the chime will sound for
three seconds if any of the following
occur:
• The Smart Key is in the vehicle.
• The POWER button is in ON position.
• Any door except the tailgate is
open.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Unlocking
i Information
• The door handle button will only
operate when the smart key is within 0.7~1 m (28~40 in.) from the outside door handle. Other people can
also open the doors without the
smart key in possession.
• After unlocking the doors, the doors
will lock automatically after 30 seconds unless a door is opened.
OAE046001
To unlock:
1. Carry the Smart Key.
2. Either press the door handle button or press the Door Unlock button (2) on the smart key.
3. The doors will unlock. The hazard
warning lights will blink two times.
Also, the outside rearview mirror
will unfold, if the outside rearview
mirror folding switch is in the AUTO
position. (if equipped)
3-4
Tailgate unlocking
To unlock:
1. Carry the smart key.
2. Either press the tailgate handle
button or press the Tailgate Unlock
button (3) on the smart key for
more than one second.
3. The hazard warning lights will
blink two times.
Once the tailgate is opened and then
closed, the tailgate will lock automatically.
i Information
After unlocking the tailgate, the tailgate will lock automatically after 30
seconds unless the tailgate is opened.
Start-up
Mechanical key
Loss of a smart key
You can start the vehicle without
inserting the key. For detailed information, refer to the POWER button
in chapter 5.
If the Smart Key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
door by using the mechanical key.
A maximum of two smart keys can
be registered to a single vehicle. If
you happen to lose your smart key, it
is recommended that you should
immediately take the vehicle and
remaining key to your authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or tow the vehicle,
if necessary.
NOTICE
NOTICE
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
To prevent damaging the smart
key:
• Keep the smart key away from
water or any liquid and fire. If the
inside of the smart key gets
damp (due to drinks or moisture),
or is heated, internal circuit may
malfunction, excluding the car
from the warranty.
• Avoid dropping or throwing the
smart key.
• Protect the smart key from
extreme temperatures.
OAE046034L
Press and hold the release button (1)
and remove the mechanical key (2).
Insert the mechanical key into the
key hole on the door.
To reinstall the mechanical key, put
the key into the hole and push it until
a click sound is heard.
Always have the smart key with
you when leaving the vehicle. If
the smart key is left near the vehicle, the vehicle battery may be discharged.
3-5
Convenient features of your vehicle
Smart key precautions
The smart key will not work if any of
the following occur:
• The smart key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station
or an airport which can interfere
with normal operation of the transmitter.
• The smart key is near a mobile two
way radio system or a cellular
phone.
• Another vehicle’s smart key is
being operated close to your vehicle.
When the smart key does not work
correctly, open and close the door
with the mechanical key. If you have
a problem with the smart key, it is
recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the smart key is in close proximity
to your mobile phone, the signal
could be blocked by your mobile
phones normal operational signals.
This is especially important when the
phone is active such as making and
receiving calls, text messaging,
and/or sending/receiving emails.
3-6
Avoid placing the smart key and your
mobile phone in the same pants or
jacket pocket and always try to maintain an adequate distance between
the two devices.
Battery replacement
i Information
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment. If
the keyless entry system is inoperative
due to changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance, it will not
be covered by your manufacturer’s
vehicle warranty.
NOTICE
Keep the smart key away from
electromagnetic materials that
blocks electromagnetic waves to
the key surface.
OLF044008
If the Smart Key is not working properly, try replacing the battery with a
new one.
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Pry open the rear cover of the
smart key.
2. Remove the old battery and insert
the new battery. Make sure the
battery position is correct.
3. Reinstall the rear cover of the
smart key.
If you suspect your smart key might
have sustained some damage, or
you feel your smart key is not working correctly, it is recommended that
you contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
i Information
The immobilizer system protects your
vehicle from theft. If an improperly
coded key (or other device) is used,
the power system is disabled.
When the POWER button is placed
in the ON position, the immobilizer
system indicator should come on
briefly, then go off. If the indicator
starts to blink, the system does not
recognize the coding of the key.
Place the POWER button to the OFF
position, then place the POWER button to the ON position again.
The system may not recognize your
key’s coding if another immobilizer
key or other metal object (i.e., key
chain) is near the key. The vehicle
may not start because the metal may
interrupt the transponder signal from
transmitting normally.
If the system repeatedly does not
recognize the coding of the key, it is
recommended that you contact your
HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it. Electrical
problems could result that may make
your vehicle inoperable.
WARNING
In order to prevent theft of your
vehicle, do not leave spare keys
anywhere in your vehicle. Your
immobilizer password is a customer unique password and
should be kept confidential.
NOTICE
The transponder in your key is an
important part of the immobilizer
system. It is designed to give
years of trouble-free service, however you should avoid exposure to
moisture, static electricity and
rough handling. Immobilizer system malfunction could occur.
3-7
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human health.
Dispose of the battery according
to your local law(s) and regulation.
Immobilizer system
Convenient features of your vehicle
DOOR LOCKS
Operating door locks from
outside the vehicle
Mechanical key
L o ck
U n l o ck
After removing the cover, turn the
key toward the front of the vehicle to
unlock and toward the rear of the
vehicle to lock.
If you lock/unlock the driver's door
with a key, all vehicle doors will
lock/unlock automatically.
Once the doors are unlocked, they
may be opened by pulling the door
handle.
When closing the door, push the
door by hand. Make sure that doors
are closed securely.
Smart key
L o ck / U n l o ck
OAE046001
OAEE046188N
To remove the cover:
1. Pull out the door handle (1).
2. Press the lock (2) located inside
the bottom part of the cover with a
key or flat-head screwdriver.
3. Push out the cover while pressing
the lock.
To install the cover:
1. Pull out the door handle.
2. Install the cover.
3-8
OBA043224IN
To lock the doors, press the button on
the outside door handle while carrying the smart key with you or press
the door lock button on the smart key.
Operating door locks from
inside the vehicle
With the door lock button
U n l o ck / L o ck
i Information
i Information
• In cold and wet climates, door lock
and door mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
• If the door is locked/unlocked multiple times in rapid succession with
either the vehicle key or door lock
switch, the system may stop operating temporarily in order to protect
the circuit and prevent damage to
system components.
• If the inner door handle of the driver’s (or front passenger’s) door is
pulled when the door lock button is
in the lock position, the button is
unlocked and door opens.
• Doors cannot be locked if the
smart key is in the vehicle and any
door is open.
OAE046004
• To unlock a door, pull the door lock
button (1) to the “Unlock” position.
The red mark (2) on the door lock
button will be visible.
• To lock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Lock” position. If
the door is locked properly, the red
mark (2) on the door lock button
will not be visible.
• To open a door, pull the door handle (3) outward.
If a power door lock ever fails to function while you are in the vehicle try
one or more of the following techniques to exit:
Operate the door unlock feature
repeatedly (both electronic and manual) while simultaneously pulling on the
door handle.
Operate the other door locks and handles, front and rear.
Lower a front window and use the
mechanical key to unlock the door
from outside.
3-9
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
To unlock the doors, press the button
on the outside door handle while carrying the smart key with you or press
the door unlock button on the smart
key.
Once the doors are unlocked, they
may be opened by pulling the door
handle.
When closing the door, push the
door by hand. Make sure that doors
are closed securely.
Convenient features of your vehicle
With the central door lock
switch
WARNING
• The doors should always be
Always secure your vehicle
fully closed and locked while
the vehicle is in motion. If the
doors are unlocked, the risk of
being thrown from the vehicle
in a crash is increased.
• Do not pull the inner door
handle of driver’s or passenger’s door while the vehicle is
moving.
Leaving your vehicle unlocked
increases the potential risk to
you or others from someone
hiding in your vehicle.
To secure your vehicle, while
depressing the brake, shift to
the P (Park) position, engage
the parking brake, and place the
POWER button in the OFF position, close all windows, lock all
doors, and always take the key
with you.
OAE046005
When pressing the ( ) portion (1) of
the switch, all vehicle doors will lock.
• If the smart key is in the vehicle
and any door is opened, the doors
will not lock even though the lock
button (1) of the central door lock
switch is pressed.
When pressing the ( ) portion (2) of
the switch, all vehicle doors will
unlock.
3-10
WARNING
WARNING
Do not leave children or animals
unattended in your vehicle. An
enclosed vehicle can become
extremely hot, causing death or
serious injury to unattended
children or animals who cannot
escape the vehicle. Children
might operate features of the
vehicle that could injure them,
or they could encounter other
harm, possibly from someone
gaining entry to the vehicle.
WARNING
If you stay in the vehicle for a
long time while the weather is
very hot or cold, there are risks
of injuries or danger to life. Do
not lock the vehicle from the outside when someone is in the
vehicle.
WARNING
Child-protector rear door locks
Auto door lock/unlock features
Impact sensing door unlock
system (if equipped)
All doors will be automatically
unlocked when an impact causes the
air bags to deploy.
Speed sensing door lock system
(if equipped)
All doors will be automatically locked
when vehicle speed exceeds 15
km/h (9 mph).
3
WARNING
OAEE046002
The child safety lock is provided to
help prevent children seated in the
rear from accidentally opening the
rear doors. The rear door safety locks
should be used whenever children
are in the vehicle.
The child safety lock is located on
the edge of each rear door. When the
child safety lock is in the lock position, the rear door will not open if the
inner door handle (2) is pulled.
If children accidently open the
rear doors while the vehicle is
in motion, they could fall out of
the vehicle. The rear door safety
locks should always be used
whenever children are in the
vehicle.
You can activate or deactivate the
Auto Door Lock/Unlock features from
the User Settings Mode on the LCD
display. For more details, refer to
"LCD Display" in this chapter.
3-11
Convenient features of your vehicle
Opening a door when something
is approaching may cause damage or injury. Be careful when
opening doors and watch for
vehicles, motorcycles, bicycles
or pedestrians approaching the
vehicle in the path of the door.
To lock the child safety lock, insert a
key (or screwdriver) (1) into the hole
and turn it to the lock position.
To allow a rear door to be opened
from inside the vehicle, unlock the
child safety lock.
Convenient features of your vehicle
THEFT-ALARM SYSTEM
This system helps to protect your
vehicle and valuables. The horn will
sound and the hazard warning lights
will blink continuously if any of the
following occurs:
- A door is opened without using the
smart key.
- The tailgate is opened without
using the smart key.
- The hood is opened.
The alarm continues for 30 seconds,
then the system resets. To turn off
the alarm, unlock the doors with the
smart key.
The Theft Alarm System automatically sets 30 seconds after you lock
the doors and the tailgate. For the
system to activate, you must lock the
doors and the tailgate from outside
the vehicle with the smart key or by
pressing the button on the outside of
the door handles with the smart key
in your possession.
The hazard warning lights will blink
and the chime will sound once to
indicate the system is armed.
3-12
Once the security system is set, opening any door, the tailgate, or the hood
without using the smart key will cause
the alarm to activate.
The Theft Alarm System will not set if
the hood, the tailgate, or any door is
not fully closed. If the system will not
set, check the hood, the tailgate, or
the doors are fully closed.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it.
OJC040170
i Information
• Do not lock the doors until all passengers have left the vehicle. If the
remaining passenger leaves the
vehicle when the system is armed,
the alarm will be activated.
• If the vehicle is not disarmed with
the smart key, open the doors by
using the mechanical key, start the
vehicle and wait for 30 seconds.
• When the system is disarmed but a
door or tailgate is not opened within
30 seconds, the system will be
rearmed.
i Information
Vehicles equipped with a theft alarm
system will have a label attached to
the vehicle with the following words:
1. WARNING
2. SECURITY SYSTEM
DRIVER POSITION MEMORY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
OAE046036L
The Driver Position Memory System
is provided to store and recall the following memory settings with a simple button operation.
- Driver's seat position
- Outside rearview mirror position
- Instrument panel illumination intensity
i Information
• If the battery is disconnected, the
memory settings will be erased.
• If the Driver Position Memory
System does not operate normally,
we recommend that you have the
system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
1. Shift to P (Park) while the POWER
button is in the ON position.
2. Adjust the driver's seat position,
outside rearview mirror position
and instrument panel illumination
intensity to the desired position.
3. Press the SET button. The system
will beep once and notify you
"Press button to save settings"on
the LCD display.
4. Press one of the memory buttons
(1 or 2) within 4 seconds. The system will beep twice when the memory has been successfully stored.
5. "Driver 1 (or 2) settings saved" will
appear on the LCD display.
3-13
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
Never attempt to operate the driver position memory system while
the vehicle is moving.
This could result in loss of control, and an accident causing
death, serious injury, or property
damage.
Storing memory positions
Convenient features of your vehicle
Recalling memory positions
1. Shift to P (Park) while the POWER
button is in the ON position.
2. Press the desired memory button
(1 or 2). The system will beep
once, then the driver’s seat position, outside rearview mirror and
instrument panel illumination will
automatically adjust to the stored
position (if equipped).
3. "Driver 1(or 2) settings is applied"
will appear on the LCD display.
3-14
i Information
• While recalling the "1" memory
position, pressing the SET or 1 button temporarily stops the adjustment of the recalled memory position. Pressing the 2 button recalls
the "2" memory position.
• While recalling the "2" memory
position, pressing the SET or 2 button temporarily stops the adjustment of the recalled memory position. Pressing the 1 button recalls
the "1" memory position.
• While recalling the stored positions,
pressing one of the control buttons
for the driver's seat, outside
rearview mirror, or instrument
panel illumination will cause the
movement of that component to stop
and move in the direction that the
control button is pressed.
Easy access function
(if equipped)
The system will move the driver's
seat automatically as follows:
The gear is in P (Park)
- It will move the driver’s seat rearward when the POWER button is in
the OFF position and the driver’s
door is opened.
- It will move the driver’s seat forward
when the vehicle is turned ON or
the driver’s door is closed with the
smart key with you.
You can activate or deactivate the
Easy Access Function from the User
Settings Mode on the LCD display.
For more details, refer to "LCD
Display" in this chapter.
STEERING WHEEL
Electric power steering (EPS)
NOTICE
• If the Electric Power Steering
System does not operate normally, the warning light ( ) will
illuminate or blink on the instrument cluster. The steering wheel
may become difficult to control
or operate. Take your vehicle to
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
and have the system checked as
soon as possible.
(Continued)
i Information
The following symptoms may occur
during normal vehicle operation:
• The steering effort may be high
immediately after placing the
POWER button in the ON position.
This happens as the system performs the EPS system diagnostics.
When the diagnostics is completed,
the steering wheel will return to its
normal condition.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• A click noise may be heard from the
EPS relay after the POWER button
is in the ON or OFF position.
• Motor noise may be heard when the
vehicle is at a stop or at a low driving speed.
• When you operate the steering
wheel in low temperature, abnormal
noise may occur. If temperature
rises, the noise will disappear. This
is a normal condition.
• When the vehicle is stationary, if
you turn the steering wheel all the
way to the left or right continuously,
the steering wheel effort increases.
This is not a system malfunction. As
time passes, the steering wheel
effort will return to its normal condition.
3-15
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
The system assists you with steering
the vehicle. If the vehicle is off or if
the power steering system becomes
inoperative, the vehicle may still be
steered, but it will require increased
steering effort.
Also, the steering effort becomes
heavier as the vehicle’s speed
increases and becomes lighter as
the vehicle’s speed decreases for
better control of the steering wheel.
Should you notice any change in the
effort required to steer during normal
vehicle operation, we recommend
that the system be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
(Continued)
• When abnormality is detected in
the electric power steering system, to prevent a deadly accident, the steering assist function
will stop. At this time, the warning light turns on or blinks on
the cluster. The steering wheel
may become difficult to control
or operate. Have your vehicle
checked immediately, after moving the vehicle to a safe zone.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Tilt steering / Telescope steering
Heated steering wheel
(if equipped)
WARNING
Never adjust the steering wheel
while driving. You may lose
steering control and cause
severe personal injury, death or
accidents.
i Information
After adjustment, sometimes the lockrelease lever may not lock the steering
wheel.
It is not a malfunction. This occurs
when two gears are not engaged correctly. In this case, adjust the steering
wheel again and then lock the steering
wheel.
CAUTION
While adjusting the steering
wheel height, please do not
push or pull it hard since the fixture can be damaged.
3-16
OAEE049655
Pull down the lock-release lever (1) on
the steering wheel column and adjust
the steering wheel angle (2) and position (3). Move the steering wheel, so it
points toward your chest, not toward
your face.
Make sure you can see the instrument
panel warning lights and gauges.
After adjusting, pull up the lockrelease lever (1) to lock the steering
wheel in place. Push the steering
wheel both up and down to be certain it is locked in position. Always
adjust the position of the steering
wheel before driving.
OAEE049003
When the vehicle is ON, press the
heated steering wheel button to warm
the steering wheel. The indicator on
the button will illuminate.
To turn the heated steering wheel off,
press the button again. The indicator
on the button will turn off.
MIRRORS
i Information
Horn
Inside rearview mirror
Before you start driving, adjust the
rearview mirror to the center on the
view through the rear window.
The heated steering wheel will turn off
automatically approximately 30 minutes after the heated steering wheel is
turned on.
When the vehicle is turned off during
the heated steering wheel is on, the
timer function of heated steering
wheel will be reset.
To reuse heated steering wheel, press
button again.
WARNING
Do not install any cover or accessory on the steering wheel. This
cover or accessory could cause
damage to the heated steering
wheel system.
To sound the horn, press the area
indicated by the horn symbol on your
steering wheel. The horn will operate
only when this area is pressed.
NOTICE
Do not strike the horn severely to
operate it, or hit it with your fist.
Do not press on the horn with a
sharp-pointed object.
WARNING
To prevent serious injury during
an accident or deployment of
the air bag, do not modify the
rearview mirror and do not
install a wide mirror.
3-17
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAE046009
NOTICE
Make sure your line of sight is
not obstructed. Do not place
objects in the rear seat, cargo
area, or behind the rear headrests which could interfere with
your vision through the rear
window.
Convenient features of your vehicle
WARNING
Day/night rearview mirror
(if equipped)
NEVER adjust the mirror while
driving. This may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Night
NOTICE
When cleaning the mirror, use a
paper towel or similar material
dampened with glass cleaner. Do
not spray glass cleaner directly on
the mirror as that may cause the
liquid cleaner to enter the mirror
housing.
3-18
Day
OAE046010
Make this adjustment before you
start driving and while the day/night
lever is in the day position.
Pull the day/night lever toward you to
reduce glare from the headlights of
the vehicles behind you during night
driving.
Remember that you lose some
rearview clarity in the night position.
Electric Chromic Mirror (ECM)
(if equipped)
The electric rearview mirror automatically controls the glare from the headlamp of the car behind you in nighttime or low light driving conditions.
When the vehicle is ON, the glare is
automatically controlled by the sensor mounted in the rearview mirror.
The sensor detects the light level
around the vehicle, and automatically adjusts to control the headlamp
glare from vehicles behind you.
Whenever the gear is shifted to R
(Reverse), the mirror will automatically go to the brightest setting in
order to improve the drivers view
behind the vehicle.
Outside rearview mirror
WARNING
• The right outside rearview mir-
Indicator
To operate the electric rearview
mirror:
• Press the ON/OFF button (1) to
turn the automatic dimming function off. The mirror indicator light
will turn off.
Press the ON/OFF button (1) to
turn the automatic dimming function on. The mirror indicator light
will illuminate.
• The mirror defaults to the ON position whenever the POWER button is
in the ON position.
OAE046013
Be sure to adjust mirror angles
before driving.
Your vehicle is equipped with both
left-hand and right-hand outside
rearview mirrors.
The mirror can be adjusted remotely
with the remote switch.
The mirror heads can be folded to
prevent damage during an automatic
car wash or when passing through a
narrow street.
WARNING
Do not adjust or fold the outside
rearview mirrors while driving.
This may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
3-19
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAD045010
ror is convex. In some countries, the left outside rearview
mirror is also convex. Objects
seen in the mirror are closer
than they appear.
• Use your interior rearview
mirror or turn your head and
look to determine the actual
distance of following vehicles
when changing lanes.
Convenient features of your vehicle
NOTICE
• Do not scrape ice off the mirror
face; this may damage the surface of the glass.
• If the mirror is jammed with ice,
do not adjust the mirror by
force. Use an approved spray
de-icer (not radiator antifreeze)
spray, or a sponge or soft cloth
with very warm water, or move
the vehicle to a warm place and
allow the ice to melt.
3-20
NOTICE
OAE046014
Adjusting the rearview mirrors:
1. Press either the L (left side) or R
(right side) button (1) to select the
rearview mirror you would like to
adjust.
2. Use the mirror adjustment control
to position the selected mirror up,
down, left or right.
3. After adjustment, put the button
into neutral (center) position to
prevent inadvertent adjustment.
• The mirrors stop moving when
they reach the maximum adjusting angles, but the motor continues to operate while the switch
is pressed. Do not press the
switch longer than necessary,
the motor may be damaged.
• Do not attempt to adjust the outside rearview mirror by hand or
the motor may be damaged.
Folding the outside rearview
mirror
NOTICE
OAE046016
OAE046015
Manual type
To fold the outside rearview mirror,
grasp the housing of the mirror and
then fold it toward the rear of the
vehicle.
Electric type (if equipped)
Left : The mirror will unfold.
Right : The mirror will fold.
Center (AUTO) : The mirror will fold
or unfold automatically as follows:
- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the smart key.
- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the button on the outside door handle.
- The mirror will unfold when you
approach the vehicle (all doors
closed and locked) with a smart
key in possession. (if equipped)
NOTICE
Do not fold the electric type outside rearview mirror by hand. It
could cause motor failure.
3-21
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
The electric type outside rearview
mirror operates even though the
POWER button is in the OFF position. However, to prevent unnecessary battery discharge, do not
adjust the mirrors longer than
necessary while the vehicle is not
in the ready (
) mode.
Convenient features of your vehicle
WINDOWS
Power windows
(1) Driver’s door power window
switch
(2) Front passenger’s door power
window switch
(3) Rear door (left) power window
switch
(4) Rear door (right) power window
switch
(5) Window opening and closing
(6) Automatic power window*
(7) Power window lock switch
■ Left-hand drive
* : if equipped
OAE046019
3-22
■ Right-hand drive
* : if equipped
OAE046019R
3-23
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
(1) Driver’s door power window
switch
(2) Front passenger’s door power
window switch
(3) Rear door (right) power window
switch
(4) Rear door (left) power window
switch
(5) Window opening and closing
(6) Automatic power window*
(7) Power window lock switch
Convenient features of your vehicle
The POWER button must be in the
ON position to be able to raise or
lower the windows. Each door has a
Power Window switch to control that
door's window. The driver has a
Power Window Lock switch which
can block the operation of passenger
windows. The power windows will
operate for approximately 30 seconds after the POWER button is
placed in the ACC or OFF position.
However, if the front doors are
opened, the Power Windows cannot
be operated even within the 30 second period.
WARNING
To avoid serious injury or death,
do not extend your head, arms
or body outside the windows
while driving.
3-24
i Information
• In cold and wet climates, power windows may not work properly due to
freezing conditions.
• While driving with the rear windows
down or with the sunroof (if
equipped) opened (or partially
opened), your vehicle may demonstrate a wind buffeting or pulsation
noise. This noise is normal and can
be reduced or eliminated by taking
the following actions. If the noise
occurs with one or both of the rear
windows down, partially lower both
front windows approximately 2.5 cm.
If you experience the noise with the
sunroof open, slightly close the sunroof.
Window opening and closing
OAE046020
To open:
Press the window switch down to the
first detent position (5). Release the
switch when you want the window to
stop.
To close:
Pull the window switch up to the first
detent position (5). Release the window switch when you want the window to stop.
To reset the power windows
Pressing the power window switch
momentarily to the second detent
position (6) completely lowers the
window even when the switch is
released. To stop the window at the
desired position while the window is
in operation, pull up or press down
and release the switch.
If the power windows do not operate
normally, the automatic power window system must be reset as follows:
1. Place the POWER button to the
ON position.
2. Close the window and continue
pulling up on the power window
switch for at least one second.
If the power windows do not operate
properly after resetting, it is recommended that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Auto up/down window
(if equipped)
Pressing or pulling up the power window switch momentarily to the second detent position (6) completely
lowers or lifts the window even when
the switch is released. To stop the
window at the desired position while
the window is in operation, pull up or
press down and release the switch.
WARNING
The automatic reverse feature
doesn’t activate while resetting
the power window system. Make
sure body parts or other objects
are safely out of the way before
closing the windows to avoid
injuries or vehicle damage.
Automatic reverse (if equipped)
3
OLF044032
If a window senses any obstacle
while it is closing automatically, it will
stop and lower approximately 30 cm
(12 inches) to allow the object to be
cleared.
If the window detects the resistance
while the power window switch is
pulled up continuously, the window
will stop upward movement then
lower approximately 2.5 cm (1 inch).
If the power window switch is pulled
up continuously again within 5 seconds after the window is lowered by
the automatic window reverse feature, the automatic window reverse
will not operate.
3-25
Convenient features of your vehicle
Auto down window (if equipped)
Convenient features of your vehicle
i Information
Power window lock switch
The automatic reverse feature is only
active when the “Auto Up” feature is
used by fully pulling up the switch to
the second detent.
Do not allow children to play
with the power windows. Keep
the driver’s door power window
lock switch in the LOCK position. Serious injury or death can
result from unintentional window operation by a child.
WARNING
Make sure body parts or other
objects are safely out of the way
before closing the windows to
avoid injuries or vehicle damage.
Objects less than 4 mm (0.16
inch) in diameter caught between
the window glass and the upper
window channel may not be
detected by the automatic reverse
window and the window will not
stop and reverse direction.
NOTICE
Do not install any accessories on
the windows.The automatic reverse
feature may not operate.
3-26
WARNING
NOTICE
OAE046021
The driver can disable the power
window switches on the rear passengers' doors by pressing the power
window lock switch.
When the power window lock switch
is pressed:
• The driver's master control can
operate all the power windows.
• The front passenger's control can
operate the front passenger's power
window.
• The rear passenger's control cannot operate the rear passengers'
power window.
• To prevent possible damage to
the power window system, do
not open or close two windows
or more at the same time. This
will also ensure the longevity of
the fuse.
• Never try to operate the main
switch on the driver's door and
the individual door window
switch in opposite directions at
the same time. If this is done, the
window will stop and cannot be
opened or closed.
SUNROOF (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
• NEVER leave the keys in your
•
•
•
i Information
• In cold and wet climates, the sunroof may not work properly due to
freezing conditions.
• After the vehicle is washed or in a
rainstorm, be sure to wipe off any
water that is on the sunroof before
operating it.
WARNING
• Never adjust the sunroof or
OAD045022
The sunroof can be opened, closed,
or tilted when the POWER button is
in the ON position.
The sunroof can be operated for
approximately 30 seconds after the
POWER button is in the ACC or OFF
position.
However, if the front door is opened,
the sunroof cannot be operated even
within 30 seconds.
sunshade while driving. This
could result in loss of control
and an accident that may
cause death, serious injury, or
property damage.
• Make sure heads, other body
parts or objects are out of the
way before using the sunroof.
• Do not extend your head, arms
or body outside the sunroof
while driving, to avoid serious
injury.
• Do not leave the vehicle on and
the key in your vehicle with
unsupervised children.
(Continued)
3-27
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
•
vehicle with unsupervised
children, when the vehicle is
ON.
NEVER leave any child unattended in the vehicle. Even
very young children may inadvertently cause the vehicle to
move, entangle themselves in
the windows, or otherwise
injure themselves or others.
Always double check to make
sure all arms, hands, head
and other obstructions are
safely out of the way before
closing a window.
Do not allow children to play
with the power windows. Keep
the driver’s door power window
lock switch in the LOCK position (pressed). Serious injury
can result from unintentional
window operation by the child.
Do not extend your head,
arms or body outside the windows while driving.
If your vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, you can slide or tilt your
sunroof with the sunroof control
switch located on the overhead console.
Convenient features of your vehicle
(Continued)
Unattended children could
operate the sunroof, which
could result in serious injury.
• Do not sit on the top of the
vehicle. It may cause injuries or
vehicle damage.
Sunroof opening and closing
Pressing the sunroof control lever
backward or forward momentarily to
the second detent position completely
opens or closes the sunroof even
when the switch is released. To stop
the sunroof at the desired position
while the sunroof is in operation, press
the sunroof control lever backward or
forward and release the switch.
NOTICE
• Do not continue to move the
sunroof control lever after the
sunroof is fully opened, closed,
or tilted. Damage to the motor or
system components could
occur.
• Make sure the sunroof is closed
fully when leaving your vehicle.
If the sunroof is open, rain or
snow may leak through the sunroof and wet the interior as well
as allow theft.
3-28
Sliding the sunroof
i Information
OAD045023
To open:
Press the sunroof control lever backward to the first detent position.
Release the switch when you want
the sunroof to stop.
To close:
Press the sunroof control lever forward
to the first detent position. Release the
switch when you want the sunroof to
stop.
To reduce wind noise while driving, it
is recommended that you drive with
the sunroof slightly closed (stop the
sunroof about 7 cm before the maximum slide open position).
Automatic reverse (if equipped)
WARNING
Tilting the sunroof
Small objects that can get caught
between the sunroof glass and
the front glass channel may not
be detected by the automatic
reverse system. In this case, the
sunroof glass will not detect the
object and reverse direction.
3
OAD045024
Tilt the sunroof open:
Push the sunroof control lever
upward until the sunroof moves to
the desired position.
To close the sunroof:
Press the sunroof lever forward until
the sunroof moves to the desired
position.
3-29
Convenient features of your vehicle
OLFC044035CN
If the sunroof senses any obstacle
while it is closing automatically, it will
reverse direction then stop to allow
the object to be cleared.
The auto reverse function does not
work if a small obstacle is between
the sliding glass and the sunroof
sash.
You should always check that all passengers and objects are away from
the sunroof before closing it.
Convenient features of your vehicle
NOTICE
Sunshade
• Periodically remove any dirt that
may accumulate on the sunroof
guide rail or between the sunroof and roof panel, which can
make a noise.
• Do not try to open the sunroof
when the temperature is below
freezing or when the sunroof is
covered with snow or ice, otherwise the motor could be damaged. In cold and wet climates, the
sunroof may not work properly.
Resetting the sunroof
OAD045037
The sunshade will open automatically with the sunroof when the glass
panel moves. If you want it closed,
move the sunshade manually.
NOTICE
The sunroof is made to slide
together with the sunshade. Do
not leave the sunshade closed
while the sunroof is open.
3-30
The sunroof may need to be reset if
the following conditions occur:
- Battery is discharged or disconnected or the related fuse has been
replaced or disconnected
- The one-touch sliding function of the
sunroof does not normally operate
To reset the sunroof, perform the following steps:
1. Place the POWER button to the
ON position or when the vehicle is
in the ready (
) mode. It is recommended to reset the sunroof
while the vehicle is in the ready
(
) mode.
2. Push the control lever forward. The
sunroof will close completely or tilt
depending on the condition of the
sunroof.
3. Release the control lever until the
sunroof does not move.
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Do not release the lever until the
operation is completed.
If you release the lever during operation, try again from step 2.
5. Within 3 seconds, push the control
lever forward until the sunroof
operates as follows:
6. Release the sunroof control lever
after all operation has completed.
The sunroof system has been
reset.
Hood
Opening the hood
i Information
• If the sunroof does not reset when
the vehicle battery is disconnected
or discharged, or related fuse is
blown, the sunroof may not operate
normally.
• For more detailed information, we
recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3
OAEE049011L
1. Park the vehicle and set the parking brake.
2. Pull the release lever to unlatch
the hood. The hood should pop
open slightly.
Tilt down → Slide Open → Slide
Close.
Do not release the lever until the
operation is completed.
If you release the lever during operation, try again from step 2.
3-31
Convenient features of your vehicle
4. Push the control lever forward
about 10 seconds.
- When the sunroof is in the close
position :
The glass will tilt and slightly move
up and down.
- When the sunroof is in the tilt position:
The glass will slightly move up
and down.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Closing the hood
OAEE049005L
OAD045039
3. Go to the front of the vehicle, raise
the hood slightly, push the secondary latch up (1) inside of the hood
center and lift the hood (2).
4. Pull out the support rod.
5. Hold the hood opened with the
support rod (1).
WARNING
• Grasp the support rod in the
area wrapped in rubber. The
rubber will help prevent you
from being burned by hot
metal.
• The support rod must be
inserted completely into the
hole provided whenever you
inspect the motor compartment. This will prevent the
hood from falling and possibly injuring you.
3-32
1. Before closing the hood, check the
following:
• All filler caps in motor room must
be correctly installed.
• Gloves, rags or any other combustible material must be removed
from the motor compartment.
2. Return the support rod to its clip to
prevent it from rattling.
3. Lower the hood halfway (lifted
approximately 30cm from the
closed position) and push down to
securely lock in place. Then double
check to be sure the hood is secure.
If the hood can slightly be raised, it
is not securely locked. Open it
again and close it with more force.
WARNING
• Before closing the hood,
1. Make sure the gear is shifted to P
(Park) and set the parking brake.
3
OAEE049007
OAEE049006
2. Then do one of the following :
- Press the Smart Key Tailgate
Unlock button for more than one
second.
- Press the button on the tailgate
itself with the Smart Key in your
possession.
3. Lift the tailgate lid up.
Lower the tailgate lid and press down
until it locks. To be sure the tailgate
lid is securely fastened, always
check by trying to pull it up again.
3-33
Convenient features of your vehicle
ensure all obstructions are
removed from around the
hood opening.
• Always double check to be
sure that the hood is firmly
latched before driving away.
Check there is no hood open
warning light or message displayed on the instrument cluster. If the hood is not latched
while the vehicle is moving, the
chime will sound to warn the
driver the hood is not fully
latched. Driving with the hood
opened may cause a total loss
of visibility, which might result
in an accident.
• Do not move the vehicle with
the hood in the raised position, as vision is obstructed,
which might result in an accident, and the hood could fall
or be damaged.
Closing the tailgate
Tailgate
Opening the tailgate
Convenient features of your vehicle
i Information
WARNING
To prevent damage to the tailgate lift
cylinders and the attached hardware,
always close the tailgate before driving.
• NEVER allow anyone to occu-
NOTICE
In cold and wet climates, tailgate
lock and tailgate mechanisms may
not work properly due to freezing
conditions.
OHYK047009
Do not hold the part (gas lifter)
that supports the tailgate. Be
aware that the deformation of
the part may cause vehicle damage and a risk of safety accident.
3-34
WARNING
py the tailgate of the vehicle at
any time. If the luggage compartment is partially or totally
latched and the person is
unable to get out, serious
injury or death could occur due
to lack of ventilation, exhaust
fumes and rapid heat build-up,
or because of exposure to cold
weather conditions. The luggage compartment is also a
highly dangerous location in
the event of a crash because it
is not a protected occupant
space but is a part of the vehicle’s crush zone.
• Your vehicle should be kept
locked and keys should be kept
out of the reach of children.
Parents should teach their children about the dangers of playing in luggage compartment.
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
3
1. Power/Charge gauge
3. Warning and indicator lights
4. LCD display (including Trip computer)
5. Battery SOC (State of Charge) gauge
The actual cluster in the vehicle
may differ from the illustration.
For more details, refer to the
"Gauges and meters" in this
chapter.
OAEE049100L
3-35
Convenient features of your vehicle
2. Speedometer/Eco guide
Convenient features of your vehicle
Instrument cluster control
Instrument panel illumination
WARNING
Never adjust the instrument
cluster while driving. This could
result in loss of control and lead
to an accident that may cause
death, serious injury, or property
damage.
■ Type A
■ Type B
OIK047144L
OAEE049412
When the vehicle's position lights or
headlights are on, press the illumination control button to adjust the
brightness of the instrument panel
illumination.
When pressing the illumination control button, the interior switch illumination intensity is also adjusted.
3-36
• The brightness of the instrument
panel illumination is displayed.
• If the brightness reaches to the
maximum or minimum level, a
chime will sound.
Gauges and meters
Speedometer
The speedometer is displayed differently according to the selected drive
mode in the Drive Mode Integrated
Control System.
For more details, refer to “Drive
Mode Integrated Control System”
in chapter 5.
■ NORMAL/ECO mode selected
• CHARGE :
It shows the charging status of the
battery when it is being charged by
the regenerative brakes (decelerating or driving on a downhill road).
The more electric energy is charged,
the lower the gauge level.
OAEE049657
■ SPORT mode selected
OAEEQ019087
OAEE049658
The Power/Charge gauge shows the
energy consumption rate of the vehicle and the charge/discharge status
of the regenerative brakes.
The speedometer indicates the
speed of the vehicle and is calibrated
in kilometers per hour (km/h) and/or
miles per hour (MPH).
3-37
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
Power/Charge gauge
• POWER :
It shows the energy consumption rate
of the vehicle when driving uphill or
accelerating. The more electric energy is used, the higher the gauge level.
Convenient features of your vehicle
State of Charge (SOC) gauge for
high voltage battery
■ Except Europe
NOTICE
When the high voltage battery level
is low, the power down warning
illuminates and the power output
from the vehicle is limited. Charge
the battery immediately since your
vehicle may not drive uphill or skid
on a slope with the warning light
ON.
■ For Europe
OAEEQ019089
OAEEQ019088/OAEE049678L
The SOC gauge shows the charging
status of the high voltage battery.
“L (Low) or 0" position on the indicator indicates that there is not enough
energy in the high voltage battery. “H
(High) or 1“ position indicates that
the driving battery is fully charged.
When driving on highways or motorways, make sure to check in advance
if the driving battery is charged
enough.
3-38
When there are 4~5 gauge bars
(near the “L (Low) or 0" area) on the
SOC gauge, the warning lamp turns
ON to alert you of the battery level.
When the warning lamp turns ON,
the vehicle can drive an additional
30~40 km (18~25 miles) depending
on the driving speed, heater/air conditioner, weather, driving style, and
other factors. Charging is required.
Outside temperature gauge
Odometer
3
OAEE049214
The odometer indicates the total distance that the vehicle has been driven and should be used to determine
when periodic maintenance should
be performed.
3-39
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE049211
This gauge indicates the current outside air temperatures either in
Celsius (°C) or Fahrenheit.
- Temperature range :
-40°C ~ 60°C (-40°F ~ 140°F)
The outside temperature on the display may not immediately change
like a general thermometer not to
distract the driver.
The temperature unit (from °C to °F
or from °F to °C) can be changed by:
- User Settings mode in the Cluster :
You can change the temperature
unit in the “Other Features Temperature unit” .
- Automatic climate control system :
While pressing the OFF button,
press the AUTO button for 3 seconds or more.
The temperature unit of the instrument
cluster and climate control system will
change at once.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Distance to empty
Reduction gear shift indicator
OAEE049215
OAEE049212
• The distance to empty is the estimated distance the vehicle can be
driven with remaining level of the
high voltage battery.
For more details, refer to
“Distance to Empty” in the
Electric Vehicle Guide.
• The distance to empty is displayed
differently according to the selected
drive mode in the Drive Mode
Integrated Control System. For
more details, refer to “Drive Mode
Integrated Control System” in
chapter 5.
This indicator displays which gear is
selected.
3-40
Regenerative braking rate
indicator
OAEE049216
While using the regenerative brakes,
you may select the regenerative
braking rate from 0 to 3 by pulling the
paddle shifter.
For more details, refer to “Paddle
Shifter (Regenerative Braking
Control)” in chapter 5.
Warning and indicator lights
Ready Indicator
Service Warning Light
This indicator illuminates :
When the vehicle is ready to be driven.
- ON : Normal driving is possible.
- OFF : Normal driving is not possible,
or a problem has occurred.
- Blinking : Emergency driving.
This warning light illuminates :
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a problem with related parts of the electric vehicle control system, such as sensors, etc.
i Information
Make sure that all warning lights are
OFF after starting the vehicle. If any
light is still ON, this indicates a situation that needs attention.
When the warning light illuminates
while driving, or does not go OFF
after starting the vehicle, we recommend that you have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
3-41
Convenient features of your vehicle
When the ready indicator goes OFF
or blinks, there is a problem with the
system. In this case, we recommend
that you have your vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
Power Down Warning
Light
This warning light illuminates :
• When the power is limited for the
safety of the electric vehicle.
The power is limited for the following reasons.
- The high voltage battery level is
below a certain level or voltage is
decreasing
- The temperature of the motor or
high voltage battery is too high or
too low
- There is a problem with the cooling system, or a failure that may
interrupt normal driving
3-42
NOTICE
• Do not accelerate or start the
vehicle suddenly when the
power down warning light is ON.
• When the high voltage battery
level is low, the power down
warning illuminates and the
power output from the vehicle is
limited. Charge the battery
immediately since your vehicle
may not drive uphill or skid on a
slope with the warning light ON.
Charging Indicator
Light
This warning light illuminates :
• [Red] When charging outlet cables
plug into the inlet cable of vehicle.
High Voltage Battery
Low Level Warning
Light
This warning light illuminates :
• When the high voltage battery level
is low.
When the warning light turns ON,
charge the battery immediately.
Air Bag Warning Light
Seat Belt Warning Light
Parking Brake & Brake
Fluid Warning Light
(red)
This warning light informs the driver
that the seat belt is not fastened.
For more details, refer to the “Seat
Belts” in chapter 2.
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds
- It remains on if the parking brake
is applied.
• When the parking brake is applied.
• When the brake fluid level in the
reservoir is low.
- If the warning light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates the brake fluid level in
reservoir is low.
• When the regenerative brake does
not operate.
3-43
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 6
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the SRS.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Convenient features of your vehicle
If the brake fluid level in the reservoir is low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. With the vehicle turned off, check
the brake fluid level immediately
and add fluid as required (For
more details, refer to “Brake
Fluid” in chapter 7). After adding
brake fluid, check all brake components for fluid leaks. If a brake fluid
leak is found, or if the warning light
remains on, or if the brakes do not
operate properly, do not drive the
vehicle. We recommend you to
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Dual-diagonal braking system
Your vehicle is equipped with dualdiagonal braking systems. This
means you still have braking on two
wheels even if one of the dual systems should fail.
With only one of the dual systems
working, more than normal pedal
travel and greater pedal pressure is
required to stop the vehicle.
3-44
Also, the vehicle will not stop in as
short a distance with only a portion
of the brake system working.
WARNING
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid
Warning Light
Driving the vehicle with a warning light ON is dangerous. If the
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid
Warning Light illuminates with
the parking brake released, it
indicates that the brake fluid
level is low.
In this case, we recommend
that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Regenerative Brake
Warning Light
(yellow)
This warning light illuminates :
When the regenerative brake does
not operate and the brake does not
perform well. This causes the Brake
Warning light (red) and Regenerative
Brake Warning Light (yellow) to illuminate simultaneously.
In this case, drive safely and we recommend that you have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
The operation of the brake pedal may
be more difficult than normal and the
braking distance can increase.
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Warning Light
These two warning lights illuminate
at the same time while driving:
• When the ABS and regular brake
system may not work normally.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD) System
Warning Light
When both ABS and Parking
Brake & Brake Fluid Warning
Lights are on, the brake system
will not work normally and you
may experience an unexpected
and dangerous situation during
sudden braking.
(Continued)
(Continued)
In this case, avoid high speed
driving and abrupt braking.
We recommend you have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
i Information - Electronic
Brake Force Distribution
(EBD) System Warning Light
When the ABS Warning Light is on or
both ABS and Parking Brake & Brake
Fluid Warning Lights are on, the
speedometer, odometer, or tripmeter
may not work. Also, the EPS Warning
Light may illuminate and the steering
effort may increase or decrease.
In this case, we recommend you have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
3-45
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the ABS (The normal braking system will still be operational without
the assistance of the anti-lock
brake system).
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD)
System Warning Light
Convenient features of your vehicle
Electric Power Steering
(EPS) Warning Light
Charging System
Warning Light
(for 12-volt battery)
Master Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the EPS.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This warning light illuminates:
• When the 12-volt battery level is
low or a failure occurs on the
charging system such as LDC.
• If the warning light turns on while
driving, move the vehicle to a safe
location, turn off and turn on the
vehicle again, and check if the
warning light turns off. If the warning
light remains on, we recommend
that you have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Even if the warning light turns off,
we recommend that you have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
If you drive the vehicle while the
warning light is on, vehicle speed
may be limited and the 12-volt battery may be discharged.
This indicator light illuminates:
• When there is a malfunction in operation in any of the following systems:
- Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist system malfunction
(if equipped)
- Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist radar blocked (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning
system malfunction (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar
blocked (if equipped)
- LED Headlamp malfunction
(if equipped)
- High Beam Assist malfunction
(if equipped)
- Smart Cruise Control malfunction
(if equipped)
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) malfunction (if equipped)
To identify the details of the warning,
look at the LCD display.
❈ LDC : Low voltage DC-DC Converter.
3-46
Low Tire Pressure
Warning Light
(if equipped)
For more details, refer to
“Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)” in chapter 6.
Electronic Parking
Brake (EPB) Warning
Light
EPB
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the EPB.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Safe Stopping
• The TPMS cannot alert you to
severe and sudden tire damage
caused by external factors.
• If you notice any vehicle instability, immediately take your
foot off the accelerator pedal,
apply the brake pedal gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the
road.
i Information
The Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
Warning Light may illuminate when
the Electronic Stability control (ESC)
Indicator Light comes on to indicate
that the ESC is not working properly
(This does not indicate malfunction of
the EPB).
3-47
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When one or more of your tires are
significantly underinflated.
For more details, refer to
“Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)” in chapter 6.
This warning light remains ON
after blinking for approximately 60
seconds, or repeatedly blinks ON
and OFF in 3 second intervals:
• When there is a malfunction with
the TPMS.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
Convenient features of your vehicle
AUTO HOLD Indicator
Light
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) Indicator
Light
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) OFF
Indicator Light
This indicator light illuminates:
• [White] When you activate the auto
hold system by pressing the AUTO
HOLD switch.
• [Green] When you stop the vehicle
completely by depressing the
brake pedal with the auto hold system activated.
• [Yellow] When there is a malfunction with the auto hold system.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Auto
Hold” in chapter 5.
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the ESC system.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately
3 seconds and then goes off.
• When you deactivate the ESC system by pressing the ESC OFF button.
For more details, refer to
“Electronic Stability Control (ESC)”
in chapter 5.
3-48
This indicator light blinks:
• While the ESC is operating.
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)” in chapter
5.
Immobilizer Indicator
Light
This indicator light blinks for a few
seconds:
• When the smart key is not in the
vehicle.
- At this time, you cannot start the
vehicle.
This indicator light blinks:
• When the battery voltage of the
smart key is low.
- At this time, you can not start the
vehicle. However, you can start
the vehicle if you press the
POWER button with the smart
key. (For more details, refer to
"Starting the vehicle" in chapter 5).
• When there is a malfunction with
the immobilizer system.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Turn Signal Indicator
Light
This indicator light blinks:
• When you operate the turn signal
indicator light.
If any of the following occurs, there
may be a malfunction with the turn
signal system.
- The turn signal indicator light illuminates but does not blink
- The turn signal indicator light blinks
rapidly
- The turn signal indicator light does
not illuminate at all
If either of these conditions occur, we
recommend you to have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
3-49
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
This indicator light illuminates for
up to 30 seconds:
• When the vehicle detects the
smart key in the vehicle with the
POWER button in the ACC or ON
position.
- At this time, you can start the
vehicle.
- The indicator light goes off after
starting the vehicle.
This indicator light illuminates for
2 seconds and goes off:
• If the smart key is in the vehicle
and the POWER button is ON, but
the vehicle cannot detect the smart
key.
In this case, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Low Beam Indicator
Light (if equipped)
Light ON Indicator
Light
LED Headlamp Warning
Light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the headlights are on.
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the tail lights or headlights
are on.
This warning light illuminates:
• When there is a malfunction with
the LED headlamp.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
High Beam Indicator
Light
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the headlights are on and in
the high beam position
• When the turn signal lever is pulled
into the Flash-to-Pass position.
Rear Fog Indicator
Light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the rear fog lights are on.
This warning light blinks:
When there is a malfunction with a
LED headlamp related part.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
Continuous driving with the LED
Headlamp Warning Light on or
blinking can reduce LED headlamp life.
3-50
Cruise
Indicator Light
(if equipped)
■ Type A
■ Type B
Cruise SET Indicator
Light
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the cruise control speed is
set.
For more details, refer to “Cruise
Control System” in chapter 5.
ECO Mode Indicator
Light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates
when:
• When the speed limiter is enabled.
For more details, refer to “Speed
Limit Control System” in chapter
5.
This indicator light illuminates
• When you select "ECO" mode as
drive mode.
For more details, refer to "Drive
Mode Integrated Control System"
in chapter 5.
SPORT Mode Indicator
Light
ECO+ Mode Indicator
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates
• When you select "SPORT" mode
as drive mode.
For more details, refer to "Drive
Mode Integrated Control System"
in chapter 5.
This indicator light illuminates:
• When you select "ECO" mode as
drive mode.
For more details, refer to "Drive
Mode Integrated Control System"
in chapter 5.
3-51
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the cruise control system is
enabled.
For more details, refer to “Cruise
Control System” in chapter 5.
Speed Limiter Indicator
Light (if equipped)
Convenient features of your vehicle
UTIL (Utility) Mode
Indicator (if equipped)
Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist (FCA)
system warning light
(if equipped)
Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA) system indicator
light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
• When Utility mode is activated
from the User Settings mode.
This indicator light illuminates:
• When you set the POWER button
to the ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the FCA.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This indicator light illuminates:
• [Green] When the system operating conditions are satisfied.
• [White] The system operating conditions are not satisfied.
• [Yellow] When there is a malfunction with the lane keeping assist
system.
In this case, we recommend that
you have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to the
Electric Vehicle Guide provided in
the front of the owner’s manual.
For more information, refer to
"Forward
Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA) system" in chapter 5.
3-52
For more details, refer to "Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA) system" in
chapter 5.
Icy Road Warning Light
(if equipped)
i Information
If the icy road warning light appears
while driving, you should drive more
attentively and safely, refraining from
over-speeding, rapid acceleration, sudden braking or sharp turning, etc.
Check Steering Wheel Lock
System
This warning message is displayed if
you try to turn off the vehicle with the
gear in the N (Neutral) position.
At this time, the POWER button
changes to the ACC position (If you
press the POWER button once more,
it will turn to the ON position).
This warning message is displayed if
the steering wheel does not lock normally while the POWER button
changes to the OFF position.
Low Key Battery
This warning message is displayed if
the battery of the smart key is discharged while changing the POWER
button to the OFF position.
Press POWER button while
turning wheel
This warning message is displayed if
the steering wheel does not unlock
normally when the POWER button is
pressed.
You should press the POWER button
while turning the steering wheel right
and left.
Press brake pedal to start vehicle
This warning message is displayed if
the POWER button changes to the
ACC position twice by pressing the
button repeatedly without depressing
the brake pedal.
You can start the vehicle by depressing the brake pedal.
Key not in vehicle
This warning message is displayed if
the smart key is not in the vehicle
when you press the POWER button.
When attempting to start the vehicle,
always have the smart key with you.
3-53
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
This warning light is to warn the driver
the road may be icy.
When the temperature on the outside temperature gauge is approximately below 4°C (40°F), the Icy
Road Warning Light and Outside
Temperature Gauge blinks and then
illuminates. Also, the warning chime
sounds 1 time.
The Icy Road Warning function can
be activated or deactivated from the
User Settings mode in the cluster
LCD display.
LCD display messages
Shift to P
Convenient features of your vehicle
Key not detected
Press POWER button with key
Unplug vehicle to start
This warning message is displayed if
the smart key is not detected when
you press the POWER button.
This warning message is displayed if
you press the POWER button while
the warning message “Key not
detected” is displayed.
At this time, the immobilizer indicator
light blinks.
This message is displayed when you
start the vehicle without unplugging
the charging cable. Unplug the charging cable, and then start the vehicle.
Press POWER button again
This message is displayed if you
were unable to start the vehicle when
the POWER button was pressed.
If this occurs, attempt to start the
vehicle by pressing the POWER button again.
If the warning message appears
each time you press the POWER
button, we recommend you to have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check BRAKE SWITCH fuse
This warning message is displayed if
the brake switch fuse is disconnected.
You need to replace the fuse with a
new one before starting the vehicle.
If that is not possible, you can start the
vehicle by pressing the POWER button for 10 seconds in the ACC position.
Shift to P to start vehicle
This warning message is displayed if
you try to start the vehicle without
shifting to the P (Park) position.
3-54
Low Washer Fluid (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
the washer fluid level in the reservoir
is nearly empty.
Have the washer fluid reservoir
refilled.
Door, Hood, Tailgate open
Sunroof open (if equipped)
Icy Road Warning (if equipped)
3
OAEPH048644
OAEPH049648L
This warning is displayed if you turn
off the vehicle when the sunroof is
open.
This warning message is to warn the
driver the road may be icy.
When the temperature on the outside temperature gauge is approximately below 4°C (40°F), the Icy
Road Warning message.
CAUTION
Before driving the vehicle, you
should confirm that the door/
hood/tailgate is fully closed.
Also, check there is no door
/hood/tailgate open warning light
or message displayed on the
instrument cluster.
i Information
If the icy road warning message
appears while driving, you should
drive more attentively and safely
refraining from over-speeding, rapid
acceleration, sudden braking or sharp
turning, etc.
3-55
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEPH048613
This warning is displayed indicating
which door, or hood, or tailgate is
open.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Low Pressure (if equipped)
Turn on "FUSE SWITCH"
Lights Mode
■ Except Europe
■ For Europe
OAEPH059643L
OIK057165L
OIK047145L/OIK047163L
This warning message is displayed if
the tire pressure is low. The corresponding tire on the vehicle will be
illuminated.
For more details, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)" in chapter 6.
This warning message is displayed if
the fuse switch located on the fuse
box under the steering wheel is OFF.
You should turn the fuse switch on.
For more details, refer to “Fuses”
in chapter 7.
This indicator displays which exterior
light is selected using the lighting
control.
3-56
Wiper
■ Except Europe
■ For Europe
Check headlight (High/Low)
(if equipped)
Check headlamp LED
(if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
the headlamps are not operating
properly. A headlamp bulb may need
to be replaced.
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the LED headlamps. We recommend that you have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Check turn signal (if equipped)
Check brake light (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
the brake lights are not operating
properly. A lamp may need to be
replaced.
i Information
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same wattage
rating.
3-57
Convenient features of your vehicle
OIK047146L/OIK047164L
This indicator displays which wiper
speed is selected using the wiper
control.
This warning message is displayed if
the turn signal lamps are not operating properly. A lamp may need to be
replaced.
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
Shift to P to charge
Remaining time
■ AC charge
Charging Door Open
■ DC charge
OAEPHQ049833L
OOSEV048133L/OOSEV048198L
OOSEV048130L
This message is displayed if you
connect the charging cable without
the gear in the P (Park) position.
Shift to P (Park) before connecting
the charging cable.
This message is displayed to notify
the remaining time to fully charge the
battery to the selected target battery
charge level.
This message is displayed when the
vehicle is driven with the charging
door opened. Close the charging
door and then start driving.
3-58
Charging stopped.
Check the AC/DC charger
■ AC charge
■ DC charge
If the same problem occurs when
charging the vehicle with a normally
operating AC charger or genuine
HYUNDAI portable charger, we recommend that you have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Charging stopped.
Check the cable connection
3
OOSEV048196L
This warning message is displayed
when charging is stopped because
the charging connector is not correctly connected to the charging inlet
In this case, separate the charging
connector and re-connect it and
check whether there is any problem
(external damage, foreign substances, etc.) with the charging connector and charging inlet.
If the same problem occurs when
charging the vehicle with a replaced
charging cable or genuine HYUNDAI
portable charger, we recommend that
you have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3-59
Convenient features of your vehicle
OOSEV048131L/OOSEV048132L
• This warning message is displayed
when charging is stopped for the
reasons below:
- There is a problem with the external AC charger or DC charger
charger
- The external AC charger stopped
charging
- The charging cable is damaged
In this case, check whether there is
any problem with the external AC or
DC charger and charging cable.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Check regenerative brakes /
Stop vehicle and check brakes
Low Battery
Charge immediately.
Power limited
OOSEV048121L
OOSEV048118L/OOSEV048117L
This warning message is displayed
when the regenerative brake system
does not work properly.
In this case, we recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3-60
OOSEV048122L
When the high voltage battery level
reaches below 10%, this warning
message is displayed.
The warning light on the instrument
cluster ( ) will turn ON simultaneously.
Charge the high voltage battery
immediately.
When the high voltage battery level
reaches below 6%, this warning
message is displayed.
The warning light on the instrument
cluster ( ) and the power down
warning light ( ) will turn on simultaneously.
The vehicle’s power will be reduced
to minimize the energy consumption
of the high voltage battery. Charge
the battery immediately.
Low outside temp. may limit
power output. Charge EV battery/
Low battery temperature.
Power limited
A
B
NOTICE
If this warning message is still displayed even after the ambient temperature has increased, we recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Battery Overheated!
Stop vehicle
3
OOSEV048199L/OOSEV048126L
[A] : Displays when turning off vehicle.
[B] : Displays when turning on vehicle.
Both warning messages are displayed to protect electric vehicle system when outside temperature is
low. If the high voltage battery charging level is low and parked outside in
low temperature for a long time, vehicle power could be limited.
Charging the battery before driving
helps increase power.
This warning message is displayed
to protect battery and electric vehicle
system when the high voltage battery temperature is too high.
Turn off the POWER button and stop
the vehicle so that the battery temperature decreases.
3-61
Convenient features of your vehicle
OOSEV048213L
Convenient features of your vehicle
Power limited
NOTICE
• When this warning message is
displayed, do not accelerate or
start the vehicle suddenly.
• When the high voltage battery
level is low, the power down
warning illuminates and the
power output from the vehicle is
limited. Charge the battery
immediately since your vehicle
may not drive uphill or skid on a
slope with the warning light ON.
Stop vehicle and check power
supply
OOSEV048125L
In the following cases, this warning
message is displayed when the vehicle’s power is limited for safety.
• When the high voltage battery is
below a certain level, or voltage is
decreasing.
• When the temperature of the motor
or high voltage battery is too high
or too low.
• When there is a problem with the
cooling system or a failure that
may interrupt normal driving.
3-62
OOSEV048200L
This warning message is displayed
when a failure occurs in the power
supply system.
In this case, park the vehicle in a
safe location and we recommend
that you tow your vehicle to the nearest authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the vehicle inspected.
Check Active Air Flap System
Check Virtual Engine Sound
System
Check electric vehicle system
3
OOSEV048124L
OOSEV048116L
This message is displayed when
there is a problem with the Virtual
Engine Sound System (VESS).
In this case, we recommend that you
have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This warning message is displayed
when there is a problem with the
electric vehicle control system.
Refrain from driving when the warning message is displayed.
In this case, we recommend that you
have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
When all of the above conditions are
fixed, the warning will disappear.
3-63
Convenient features of your vehicle
OOSEV048201L
This warning message is displayed
in the following situations:
- There is a malfunction with the
actuator flap
- There is a malfunction with the
actuator air flap controller
- The air flap does not open
Convenient features of your vehicle
LCD DISPLAY
LCD display control
The LCD display modes can be
changed by using the control buttons.
■ Ty p e A
(1)
: MODE button for changing
modes
(2)
,
: MOVE
switch
for
changing items
(3) OK : SELECT/RESET button for
setting or resetting the selected item
■ Ty p e B
■ Ty p e C
OAE046402
3-64
LCD display modes
Menu
Trip Computer
Assist
User Settings
Consumption Info
Route Guidance
Smart Cruise Control
(SCC)
Driver Assistance
Accumulated Info
Destination Info
Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA)
Door
Lane Following Assist
(LFA)
Lights
Drive Info
Driving style
Up/Down
Energy flow
Driver Attention
Warning (DAW)
Sound
Convenience
Speed Limit Warning
(ISLW)
Service Interval
Tire Pressure
Other Features
Master warning
The Master Warning
mode displays warning messages related
to the vehicle when
one or more systems
is not operating normally.
Language
Reset
The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-65
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
TBT
Convenient features of your vehicle
Trip computer mode
Turn By Turn (TBT) mode
Driving Assist mode
OAEE049679L
OIK047147
OAEPH058615
The trip computer mode displays
information related to vehicle driving
parameters including energy consumption, tripmeter information and
vehicle speed.
For more information, refer to
"Trip Computer" in this chapter.
This mode displays the state of the
navigation.
SCC/LKA/LFA/DAW
This mode displays the state of the
Smart Cruise Control (SCC), Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA), Lane
Following Assist (LFA) system and
Driver Attention Warning (DAW).
3-66
For more information, refer to
each system information in chapter 5.
Master warning mode
Tire Pressure
This mode displays information related to Tire Pressure.
For more information, refer to
"Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)" in chapter 6.
OAEE049654L
This warning light informs the driver
the following situations.
3-67
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEPH049114L
- Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist system malfunction
(if equipped)
- Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist radar blocked (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning
system malfunction (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar
blocked (if equipped)
- LED Headlamp malfunction
(if equipped)
- High Beam Assist malfunction
(if equipped)
- Smart Cruise Control malfunction
(if equipped)
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) malfunction (if equipped)
The Master Warning Light illuminates if one or more of the above
warning situations occur. At this time,
a Master Warning icon (
) will
appear beside the User Settings icon
(
), on the LCD display.
If the warning situation is solved, the
master warning light will be turned
off and the Master Warning icon will
disappear.
Convenient features of your vehicle
User settings mode
Quick guide (Help)
This mode provides quick guides for
the systems in the User Settings
mode.
Select an item, press and hold the
OK button.
For more details about each system, refer to this Owner’s Manual
OOSEV048172L
OAD048572L
In this mode, you can change the
settings of the instrument cluster,
doors, lamps, etc.
1. Driver Assistance
2. Door
3. Lights
4. Sound
5. Convenience
6. Service interval
7. Other (features)
8. Languages
9. Reset
The information provided may differ depending on which functions
are applicable to your vehicle.
3-68
Shift to P to edit settings
This warning message appears if
you try to adjust the User Settings
while driving.
For your safety, change the User
Settings after parking the vehicle,
applying the parking brake and shifting to P (Park).
1. Driver Assistance
Items
SCC response
Explanation
• Fast/Normal/Slow
To adjust the sensitivity of the Smart Cruise Control system.
For more details, refer to ''Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go'' in chapter 5.
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
• Lane Following Assist
To activate or deactivate the Lane Following Assist (LFA) system.
For more details, refer to the “Lane Following Assist (LFA) System” in chapter 5.
Driving assist
• Speed Limit Warning (ISLW)
To activate or deactivate the Intelligent Speed Limit Warning (ISLW)
For more details, refer to "Intelligent Speed Limit Warning (ISLW)" in chapter 5.
Warning timing
To adjust the warning timing of the driver assistance system.
- Normal / Later
Warning volume
To adjust the warning volume of the driver assistance system.
- High / Medium / Low
• Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
To activate or deactivate the Leading Vehicle Departure Alert.
DAW (Driver Attention Warning)
For more details, refer to the "Leading Vehicle Departure Alert (LVDA)" in chapter 5.
To adjust the sensitivity of the DAW (Driver Attention Warning).
For more details, refer to the "Driver Attention Warning (DAW)" in chapter 5.
❈ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-69
Convenient features of your vehicle
1. Driver Assistance
Items
Forward Safety
Explanation
• Active Assist: If selected, the system controls the vehicle and provides a warning when a collision is
detected.
• Warning Only: If selected, the system provides a warning when a collision is detected.
• Off: Deactivates the system.
For more details, refer to the "Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) system" in chapter 5.
Lane Safety
• Lane Keeping Assist : If selected, the system controls the vehicle and provides a warning when the
vehicle leaves the lane.
• Lane Departure Warning: If selected, the system provides a warning when the vehicle leaves the
lane.
• Off: Deactivates the LKA system.
For more details, refer to the "Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) System" in chapter 5.
• Warning Only: If selected, the system provides a warning when a collision is detected.
Blind-Spot Safety
• Off: Deactivates the system.
For more details, refer to the "Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW) System" in chapter 5.
Parking Safety
• Rear Cross-Traffic Safety
To activate or deactivate the Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning function.
For more details, refer to "Rear Cross-traffic Collision Warning (RCCW) System" in chapter 5.
❈ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-70
2. Door
Items
Auto Lock
Explanation
• Disable : The auto door lock operation will be deactivated.
• Enable on Speed: All doors will be automatically locked when the vehicle speed exceeds 15km/h
(9.3mph).
• Enable on Shift: All doors will be automatically locked if the gear is shifted from the P (Park) position
to the R (Reverse), N (Neutral), or D (Drive) position.
Lock/Unlock sound
To activate or deactivate the lock/unlock sound.
If you lock the door with a remote control key again after locking the door, the alarm beeps.
Horn feedback
To activate or deactivate the horn feedback.
If the horn feedback is activated, after locking the door by pressing the lock button on the remote key,
and pressing it again within 4 seconds, the horn feedback sound will operate once to indicate that all
doors are locked (if equipped with remote key).
❈ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-71
Convenient features of your vehicle
Auto Unlock
• Disable: The auto door unlock operation will be canceled. (if equipped with smart key)
• Vehicle Off: All doors will be automatically unlocked when the POWER button is set to the
OFF position.
• On Shift to P: All doors will be automatically unlocked if the gear is shifted to the P (Park) position.
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
3. Lights
Items
One touch turn signal
Explanation
• Off: The one touch turn signal function will be deactivated.
• 3, 5, 7 Flashes: The turn signal indicator will blink 3, 5, or 7 times when the turn signal lever is moved
slightly.
For more details, refer to "Lighting" in this chapter.
To activate or deactivate the headlight delay function.
Headlight Delay
For more details, refer to "Lighting" in this chapter.
To activate or deactivate the high beam assist system.
High beam Assist
For more details, refer to “High Beam Assist” in this chapter.
4. Sound
Items
Cluster sound
Explanation
To adjust the cluster volume.
- OFF/Level 1/Level 2/Level 3
❈ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-72
5. Convenience
Items
Seat Easy Access
Explanation
• Off: The seat easy access function is deactivated.
• Normal/Extended: When you turn off the vehicle, the driver's seat will automatically move rearward
short (Normal) or long (Extended) for you to enter or exit the vehicle more comfortably.
For more details, refer to "Driver Position Memory System" in this chapter.
To activate the utility mode.
Switch to utility mode?
When activated, electric devices in the vehicle is operated using the high voltage battery.
For more details, refer to “Utility Mode” in the Electric Vehicle Guide in front of the owner’s manual.
To activate or deactivate the welcome mirror and/or light function.
Welcome Mirror/Light
For more details, refer to ''Welcome System'' in this chapter.
Wireless Charging System
Wiper/Lights Display
Smart recuperation
To activate or deactivate the wireless charging system in the front seat.
For more details, refer to "Wireless Charging System" in this chapter.
To activate or deactivate the Wiper/Light mode.
When activated, the LCD display shows the selected Wiper/Light mode whenever you changed the
mode.
To activate or deactivate the Smart Recuperation function. When activated, the recuperation level is
adjusted automatically according to the current driving situation.
For more details, refer to “Smart Recuperation System” in chapter 5.
Icy Road Warning
To activate or deactivate the icy road warning.
❈ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-73
Convenient features of your vehicle
Charge Connector Lock Mode
3
To activate the charge connector lock.
• Always/While charging/Do not lock
Convenient features of your vehicle
6. Service interval
Items
Explanation
Service Interval
To activate or deactivate the service interval function.
Adjust Interval
If the service interval menu is activated, you may adjust the time and distance.
Reset
To reset the service interval.
i Information
To use the service interval menu, consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the service interval is activated and the time and distance is adjusted, messages are displayed in the following situations
each time the vehicle is turned on.
- Service in
: Displayed to inform the driver the remaining mileage and days to service.
- Service required
: Displayed when the mileage and days to service has been reached or passed.
i Information
If any of the following conditions occur, the mileage and number of days to service may be incorrect.
- The battery cable is disconnected.
- The fuse switch is turned off.
- The battery is discharged.
3-74
7. Other (features)
Items
AUX. BATTERY SAVER+
To activate or deactivate the Aux. Battery Saver+ function.
When activated, the high voltage battery is used to keep the 12V battery charged.
For more details, reter to the ''Electric Vehicle System Overview'' provided in the front of
the owner’s manual.
• Off: The average energy consumption will not reset automatically.
• After ignition: The average energy consumption will reset automatically whenever it has
passed 4 hours after turning OFF the vehicle.
• After recharging : The energy consumption will reset automatically after recharging.
For more details, refer to "Trip Computer" in this chapter.
Consumption unit
To select the consumption unit.
(km/kWh, kWh/100km, mi/kWh)
Temperature Unit
To select the temperature unit.
(°C,°F)
Tire Pressure Unit
To select the tire pressure unit.
(psi, kPa, bar)
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
Energy consumption auto reset
Explanation
❈ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-75
Convenient features of your vehicle
8. Language (if equipped)
Items
Language
Explanation
Choose the language.
9. Reset
Items
Reset
Explanation
You can reset the menus in the User Settings Mode. All menus in the User Settings Mode are
reset to factory settings, except language and service interval.
❈ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-76
TRIP COMPUTER
The trip computer is a microcomputer-controlled driver information system that displays information related
to driving.
i Information
■ Ty p e A
Consumption Info
• Average energy consumption
• Instant energy consumption
Accumulated Info
• Tripmeter
■ Ty p e B
3
■ Ty p e C
• Average energy consumption
• Elapsed time
Drive Info
OAE046402
To change the trip mode, toggle the
“ , ” switch on the steering wheel.
• Tripmeter
• Average energy consumption
• Elapsed time
Digital Speedometer
Driving Style
Energy flow
3-77
Convenient features of your vehicle
Some driving information stored in the
trip computer (for example Average
Vehicle Speed) resets if the battery is
disconnected.
Trip modes
Convenient features of your vehicle
Consumption info display
Manual reset
Accumulated info display
To clear the average energy consumption manually, press the OK button on the steering wheel for more
than 1 second when the average
energy consumption is displayed.
Automatic reset
OAEE049679L
Average energy consumption (1)
• The average energy consumption
is calculated by the total driving distance and the high voltage battery
consumption since the last average
energy consumption reset.
• The average energy consumption
can be reset both manually and
automatically.
To automatically reset the average
energy consumption select either
menu from the ‘Energy consumption
auto reset’ in the User Settings mode
on the LCD display.
- After ignition: The average energy
consumption will reset automatically whenever it has passed 4 hours
after turning OFF the vehicle.
- After recharging: The average energy consumption will reset automatically when driving speed exceeds 1
km/h, after recharging more than
10%.
Instant energy consumption (2)
• This mode displays the instantaneous energy consumption while
driving.
3-78
OAEE049463L
This display shows the accumulated
trip distance (1), the average energy
consumption (2), and the total driving time (3).
The information is accumulated
starting from the last reset.
To manually reset the information,
press and hold the OK button when
viewing the Accumulated driving info.
The trip distance, the average energy consumption, and total driving
time will reset simultaneously.
The accumulated driving information
will continue to be counted while the
vehicle is in the ready (
) mode
(for example, when the vehicle is in
traffic or stopped at a stop light).
Drive Info display
The driving information will continue
to be counted while the vehicle is in
the ready (
) mode (for example,
when the vehicle is in traffic or
stopped at a stop light.)
i Information
i Information
The vehicle must be driven for a minimum of 300 meters (0.19 miles) since
the last ignition key cycle before the
driving information is recalculated.
OAEE049121L
This display shows the trip distance
(1), the average energy consumption
(2), and the total driving time (3).
The information is combined for each
ignition cycle. However, when the
vehicle has been OFF for 4 hours or
longer the Drive Info screen will reset.
To manually reset the information,
press and hold the OK button when
viewing the Drive Info. The trip distance, the average energy consumption, and total driving time will reset
simultaneously.
3-79
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
The vehicle must be driven for a minimum of 300 meters (0.19 miles) since
the last ignition key cycle before the
accumulated driving information is
recalculated.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Digital speedometer
Driving style
Energy flow
OIK047151
OAEPH049537L
OAEPHQ049851L
This digital speedometer display
shows the speed of the vehicle
(km/h, MPH).
This display shows whether the driver's driving style is Economical(1),
Normal (2) or Aggressive (3).
The electric vehicle system informs
the drivers its energy flow in various
operating modes. While driving, the
current energy flow is specified in 3
modes.
For more details, refer to “Energy
Flow” in the Electric Vehicle Guide
provided in front of the owner’s
manual.
3-80
LIGHT
■ Type A
Exterior lights
Lighting control
Even with the AUTO light feature in
operation, it is recommended to
manually turn ON the lamps when
driving at night or in a fog, or when
you enter dark areas, such as tunnels and parking facilities.
■ Type A
3
NOTICE
■ Type B
OAE046448L
■ Type B
OAE046451L
OAE046449L
To operate the lights, turn the knob at
the end of the control lever to one of
the following positions:
(1) OFF (O) position
(2) AUTO light position
(3) Position lamp position
(4) Headlamp position
AUTO light position
When the light switch is in the AUTO
position, the position lamp and headlamp will be turned ON or OFF automatically depending on the amount
of light outside the vehicle.
• Do not cover or spill anything on
the sensor (1) located on the
instrument panel.
• Do not clean the sensor using a
window cleaner, the cleanser
may leave a light film which
could interfere with sensor operation.
• If your vehicle has window tint
or other types of metallic coating on the front windshield, the
AUTO light system may not work
properly.
3-81
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAE046450L
Convenient features of your vehicle
■ Type A
High beam operation
■ Type A
■ Type A
OAE046468L
■ Type B
OAE046466L
■ Type B
OAE046452L
■ Type B
OAE046469L
OAE046467L
Position lamp position (
)
The position lamp, license plate lamp
and instrument panel lamp are turned
ON.
Headlamp position ( )
The headlamp, position lamp, license
plate lamp and instrument panel
lamp are turned ON.
i Information
The POWER button must be in the
ON position to turn on the headlamp.
3-82
OAE046453L
To turn on the high beam headlamp,
push the lever away from you. The
lever will return to its original position.
The high beam indicator will light
when the headlamp high beams are
switched on.
To turn off the high beam headlamp,
pull the lever towards you. The low
beams will turn on.
High Beam Assist (HBA) system
(if equipped)
■ Type A
■ Type A
WARNING
Do not use high beam when there
are other vehicles approaching
you. Using high beam could
obstruct the other driver's vision.
3
OAEPH049468L
■ Type B
OAE046455L
To flash the high beam headlamp,
pull the lever towards you, then
release the lever. The high beams
will remain ON as long as you hold
the lever towards you.
OAEPH049469L
The High Beam Assist (HBA) is a
system that automatically adjusts the
headlamp range (switches between
high beam and low beam) according
to the brightness of other vehicles
and road conditions.
3-83
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAE046454L
■ Type B
Convenient features of your vehicle
Operating condition
1.Place the light switch in the AUTO
position.
2.Turn on the high beam by pushing
the lever away from you.
The High Beam Assist ( ) indicator will illuminate.
3.The High Beam Assist (HBA) will
turn on when vehicle speed is
above 45km/h (25mph).
• If the light switch is pushed away
when the High Beam Assist (HBA)
is operating, the High Beam Assist
(HBA) will turn off and the high
beam will be on continuously.
• If the light switch is pulled towards
you when the high beam is off, the
high beam will turn on without the
High Beam Assist (HBA) canceled. When you let go of the light
switch, the lever will move to the
middle and the high beam will turn
off.
• If the light switch is pulled towards
you when the high beam is on by
the High Beam Assist (HBA), the
low beam will be on and the High
Beam Assist will turn off.
3-84
• If the light switch is placed to the
headlamp position, the High
Beam Assist (HBA) will turn off
and the low beam will be on continuously.
When the High Beam Assist (HBA) is
operating, the high beam switches to
low beam in the following conditions.
- When the headlamp of an on-coming vehicle is detected.
- When the tail lamp of a vehicle in
front is detected.
- When the headlamp or tail lamp of a
motorcycle or a bicycle is detected.
- When the surrounding ambient light
is bright enough that high beams
are not required.
- When streetlights or other lights
are detected.
- When the light switch is not in the
AUTO position.
- When the High Beam Assist (HBA)
is off.
- When vehicle speed is below 30km/h
(20 mph).
Warning light and message
OOS047127L
When the High Beam Assist (HBA)
Assist System is not working properly, the warning message will come on
for a few second. After the message
disappears, the master warning light
( ) will illuminate.
We recommend that you take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked.
CAUTION
(Continued)
• When the light from the
oncoming or front vehicle is
not detected because of
exhaust fume, smoke, fog,
snow, etc.
• When the front window is covered with foreign matters
such as ice, dust, fog, or is
damaged
3) When the forward visibility is
poor. Such examples may
include:
• When the headlamps of an
oncoming vehicle or a vehicle
in front is not detected due to
poor outside visibility (smog,
smoke, dust, fog, heavy rain,
snow, etc.)
• When the windshield visibility
is poor
3-85
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
The system may not operate
normally if any of the following
conditions should occur:
1) When the illumination from
an on-coming vehicle or a
vehicle in front is dim. Such
examples may include:
• When the headlamps of an
oncoming vehicle or the tail
lamps of a vehicle in front is
covered with dust, snow, or
water
• When the headlamps on an
on-coming vehicle are OFF,
but the fog lamps are ON)
2) When the High Beam Assist
camera is adversely affected
by an external condition. Such
examples may include:
• When the vehicle's headlamps have been damaged or
not repaired properly
• When the vehicle headlamps
are not aimed properly
(Continued)
(Continued)
• When the vehicle is driven on
a narrow curved road or rough
road
• When the vehicle is driven on
an uphill road or downhill
road
• When only part of the vehicle
in front is visible on a crossroad or curved road
• When there is a traffic light,
reflecting sign, flashing sign
or mirror
• When the road conditions are
bad such as being wet or covered with snow
• When a vehicle suddenly
appears from a curve
• When the vehicle is tilted from
a flat tire or being towed
• When the Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA) system warning
light illuminates
(Continued)
Convenient features of your vehicle
i Information
When you replace or reinstall the
windshield glass or LDW/LKA camera (if equipped), We recommend that
you take your vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the system checked.
3-86
WARNING
• Do not attempt to disassemble
the front view camera without
the assistance of an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer technician.
If camera is removed for any
reason, the system may need
to be re-calibrated. We recommend that the system be
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the windshield of your vehicle is replaced, most likely the
front view camera will need to
be re-calibrated. If this occurs,
have your vehicle inspected
and have the system re-calibrated by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Be careful that water doesn’t
get into the High Beam Assist
(HBA) unit and do not remove
or damage related parts of the
High Beam Assist (HBA) system.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not place objects on the
crash pad that reflect light
such as mirrors, white paper,
etc. The system may malfunction if sunlight is reflected.
• At times, the High Beam Assist
(HBA) may not work properly.
The system is for your convenience only. It is the responsibility of the driver for safe driving
practices and always check the
road conditions for your safety.
• When the system does not
operate normally, change the
lamp
position
manually
between the high beam and
low beam.
Turn signals and lane change
signals
■ Type A
The lever will return to the OFF position when released or when the turn
is completed.
If an indicator stays on and does not
flash or if it flashes abnormally, one
of the turn signal bulbs may be
burned out and will require replacement.
OAE046456L
■ Type B
OAE046457L
To signal a turn, push down on the
lever for a left turn or up for a right
turn in position (A). To signal a lane
change, move the turn signal lever
slightly and hold it in position (B).
3-87
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
One-touch turn signal function
To activate an one-touch turn signal
function, move the turn signal lever
slightly and then release it. The lane
change signals will blink 3, 5 or 7
times.
You can activate/deactivate the One
Touch Turn Signal function or choose
the number of blinking (3, 5, or 7)
from the User Settings Mode on the
LCD display. For more details, refer
to "LCD Display" in this chapter.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Rear fog lamp (if equipped)
■ Type A
OAE046458L
■ Type B
OAE046459L
To turn on the rear fog lamp:
Position the light switch in the headlamp position, and then turn the light
switch (1) to the rear fog lamp position.
3-88
To turn the rear fog lamps off, do one
of the following:
• Turn off the headlamp switch.
• Turn the light switch to the rear fog
lamp position again.
Battery saver function
The purpose of this feature is to prevent the battery from being discharged. The system automatically
turns off the position lamp when the
driver turns the vehicle off and opens
the driver-side door.
With this feature, the position lamps
will turn off automatically if the driver
parks on the side of road at night.
If necessary, to keep the lamps on
when the vehicle is turned off, perform
the following:
1) Open the driver-side door.
2) Turn the position lamps OFF and
ON again using the light switch on
the steering column.
Headlamp delay function
(if equipped)
If the driver gets out of the vehicle
through other doors (except driver's door), the battery saver function does not operate and the
headlamp delay function does not
turn off automatically. Therefore, It
causes the battery to be discharged. In this case, make sure to
turn off the lamp before getting out
of the vehicle.
Daytime running light (DRL)
The Daytime Running Lights (DRL)
can make it easier for others to see
the front of your vehicle during the
day, especially after dawn and before
sunset.
The DRL system will turn the dedicated lamp OFF when:
1. The headlights are in the ON position.
2. The vehicle is turned off.
3-89
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
If you place the POWER button to
the ACC or OFF position with the
headlamps ON, the headlamps
(and/or position lamps) remain on for
about 5 minutes. However, with the
vehicle off if the driver’s door is
opened and closed, the headlamps
(and/or position lamps) are turned off
after 15 seconds.
The headlamps (and/or position
lamps) can be turned off by pressing
the lock button on the smart key
twice or turning the light switch to the
OFF or AUTO position. However, if
you turn the light switch to the AUTO
position when it is dark outside, the
headlamps will not be turned off.
You can activate or deactivate the
Headlamp Delay function from the
User Settings Mode on the LCD display. For more details, refer to
"LCD Display" in this chapter.
NOTICE
Convenient features of your vehicle
Headlight leveling device
Listed below are the examples of
proper switch settings. For loading
conditions other than those listed
below, adjust the switch position so
that the beam level may be the nearest as the condition obtained according to the list.
Loading condition
Switch
position
Driver only
0
Driver + Front passenger
0
OAEE049013L
Full passengers (including driver)
1
Manual type
To adjust the headlight beam level
according to the number of the passengers and loading weight in the
luggage area, turn the beam leveling
switch.
The higher the number of the switch
position, the lower the headlight
beam level. Always keep the headlight beam at the proper leveling
position, or headlights may dazzle
other road users.
Full passengers (including driver)
+ Maximum permissible loading
2
Driver + Maximum permissible
loading
3
3-90
Automatic type
It automatically adjusts the headlight
beam level according to the number
of passengers and loading weight in
the luggage area.
And it offers proper headlight beam
under various conditions.
WARNING
If it does not work properly even
though your car is inclined
backward according to passenger's posture, or the headlight
beam is irradiated to the high or
low position, we recommend
that the system be inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not attempt to inspect or
replace the wiring yourself.
Welcome system (if equipped)
Welcome light (if equipped)
Puddle lamp (if equipped)
When all the doors (and tailgate) are
closed and locked, the puddle lamp
will come on for about 15 seconds if
any of the below is performed.
• When the door unlock button is
pressed on the smart key.
• When the button of the outside
door handle is pressed with the
smart key in possession.
• When the vehicle is approached
with the smart key in possession.
(if equipped)
Door handle lamp (if equipped)
When all the doors (and tailgate) are
closed and locked, the door handle
lamp will come on for about 15 seconds if any of the below is performed.
• When the door unlock button is
pressed on the smart key.
• When the button of the outside door
handle is pressed with the smart
key in possession.
• When the vehicle is approached
with the smart key in possession.
Headlamp and position lamp
When the headlamp (lamp switch in the
headlamp or AUTO position) is on and
all doors (and tailgate) are locked and
closed, the position lamp and headlamp will come on for 15 seconds if/or
any of the below is performed.
• When the door unlock button is
pressed on the smart key.
At this time, if you press the door lock
or unlock button, the position lamp and
headlamp will turn off immediately.
You can activate or deactivate the
Welcome Light from the User
Settings Mode on the LCD display.
For more details, refer to "LCD
Display" in this chapter.
Interior lamp
When the interior lamp switch is in
the DOOR position and all doors (and
tailgate) are closed and locked, the
room lamp will come on for 30 seconds if any of the below is performed.
• When the door unlock button is
pressed on the smart key.
• When the button of the outside
door handle is pressed.
At this time, if you press the door lock
or unlock button, the room lamp will
turn off immediately.
3-91
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE049400L
Also, if the outside rearview mirror
folding switch is in the AUTO position, the outside rearview mirror will
unfold automatically.
You can activate or deactivate
Welcome Light function from the
User Settings mode on the LCD display. For more details, refer to
"LCD Display" in this chapter.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Interior lights
Front lamps
NOTICE
Do not use the interior lights for
extended periods when the vehicle is turned off or the battery will
discharge.
Interior lamp AUTO cut
The interior lamps will automatically
go off approximately 20 minutes after
the vehicle is turned off and the
doors closed. If a door is opened, the
lamp will go off 40 minutes after the
vehicle is turned off. If the doors are
locked by the smart key and the vehicle enters the armed stage of the
theft alarm system, the lamps will go
off five seconds later.
3-92
OAEPH047539L
(1) Front Map Lamp
(2) Front Door Lamp
(3) Front Room Lamp
Front Map Lamp :
Press either of these lens to turn the
map lamp on or off. This light produces a spot beam for convenient
use as a map lamp at night or as a
personal lamp for the driver and the
front passenger.
Front Door Lamp (
):
The front or rear room lamps come
on when the front or rear doors are
opened. When doors are unlocked by
the smart key, the front and rear
lamps come on for approximately 30
seconds as long as any door is not
opened. The front and rear room
lamps go out gradually after approximately 30 seconds if the door is
closed. However, if the POWER button is in the ON position or all doors
are locked, the front and rear lamps
will turn off. If a door is opened with
the POWER button in the ACC position or the OFF position, the front
and rear lamps stay on for about 20
minutes.
Front room lamp
•
:
Press the button to turn ON the
room lamp for the front/rear seats.
•
:
Press the button to turn OFF the
room lamp for the front/rear seats.
Rear lamps
NOTICE
■ Type A
Tailgate room lamp
Do not leave the lamp switches on
for an extended period of time
when the vehicle is turned off.
3
OAE049418
The tailgate room lamp comes on
when the tailgate is opened.
NOTICE
OAEE046421
The tailgate lamp comes on as
long as the tailgate lid is open. To
prevent unnecessary charging
system drain, close the tailgate lid
securely after using the tailgate.
Rear Room Lamp Switch (
):
Press this button to turn the room
lamp on and off.
3-93
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAE046445
■ Type B
Convenient features of your vehicle
Vanity mirror lamp
Puddle lamp (if equipped)
OAD045410
OAE046419
Push the switch to turn the light on or
off.
•
: The lamp will turn on if this
button is pressed.
•
: The lamp will turn off if this
button is pressed.
Welcome light
When all doors (and tailgate) are
closed and locked, the puddle lamp
will come on for 15 seconds if the
door is unlocked by the smart key or
outside door handle button.
For more details, refer to "Welcome
System" in this chapter.
NOTICE
Always have the switch in the off
position when the vanity mirror
lamp is not in use. If the sunvisor
is closed without the lamp off, it
may discharge the battery or damage the sunvisor.
3-94
Escort light
When the POWER button is in the
OFF position and the driver's door is
opened, the puddle lamp will come
on for 30 seconds. If the driver's door
is closed within the 30 seconds, the
puddle lamp will turn off after 15 seconds. If the driver's door is closed
and locked, the puddle lamp will turn
off immediately.
The Puddle Lamp Escort Light will
turn on only the first time the driver's
door is opened after the vehicle is
turned off.
WIPERS AND WASHERS
■ Left-hand drive
• Type A
Windshield wipers
■ Right-hand drive
OAD045437R
A : Wiper speed control
· MIST / V – Single wipe
· OFF / O – Off
· AUTO
– Auto control wipe
INT / --- – Intermittent wipe
· LO / 1
– Low wiper speed
· HI / 2
– High wiper speed
* : if equipped
OAD045438L
B : Auto control wipe time adjustment
C : Wash with brief wipes
3-95
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAD045437L
• Type B
Operates as follows when the
POWER button is in the ON position.
MIST (V) : For a single wiping cycle,
push the lever upward (or
downward) and release.
The wipers will operate
continuously if the lever is
held in this position.
OFF (O) : Wiper is not in operation.
INT (---) : Wiper operates intermittently at the same wiping
intervals.To vary the speed
setting, turn the speed
control knob (B).
AUTO : The rain sensor located on
the upper end of the windshield glass senses the
amount of rainfall and controls the wiping cycle for the
proper interval. The more it
rains, the faster the wiper
operates. When the rain
stops, the wiper stops.To
vary the speed setting, turn
the speed control knob (B).
Convenient features of your vehicle
LO (1) : The wiper runs at a lower
speed.
HI (2) : The wiper runs at a higher
speed.
AUTO (Automatic) control
i Information
If there is heavy accumulation of snow
or ice on the windshield, defrost the
windshield for about 10 minutes, or
until the snow and/or ice is removed
before using the windshield wipers to
ensure proper operation.
If you do not remove the snow and/or
ice before using the wiper and washer,
it may damage the wiper and washer
system.
3-96
Sensor
OAD045441L
The rain sensor located on the upper
end of the windshield glass senses
the amount of rainfall and controls
the wiping cycle for the proper interval. The more it rains, the faster the
wiper operates.
When the rain stops, the wiper stops.
To vary the speed setting, turn the
speed control knob (1).
If the wiper switch is set in AUTO
mode when the POWER button is in
the ON position, the wiper will operate once to perform a self-check of
the system. Set the wiper to OFF
position when the wiper is not in use.
WARNING
To avoid personal injury from the
windshield wipers, when the
vehicle is in the ready (
) mode
and the windshield wiper switch
is placed in the AUTO mode:
• Do not touch the upper end of
the windshield glass facing
the rain sensor.
• Do not wipe the upper end of
the windshield glass with a
damp or wet cloth.
• Do not put pressure on the
windshield glass.
NOTICE
• When washing the vehicle, set
the wiper switch in the OFF (O)
position to stop the auto wiper
operation. The wiper may operate and be damaged if the switch
is set in the AUTO mode while
washing the vehicle.
• Do not remove the sensor cover
located on the upper end of the
passenger side windshield
glass. Damage to system parts
could occur and may not be covered by your vehicle warranty.
Windshield washers
WARNING
OAD045404
In the OFF (O) position, pull the lever
gently toward you to spray washer fluid
on the windshield and to run the wipers
1-3 cycles. The spray and wiper operation will continue until you release the
lever. If the washer does not work, you
may need to add washer fluid to the
washer fluid reservoir.
• To prevent possible damage
to the washer pump, do not
operate the washer when the
fluid reservoir is empty.
• To prevent possible damage
to the wipers or windshield,
do not operate the wipers
when the windshield is dry.
• To prevent damage to the
wiper arms and other components, do not attempt to move
the wipers manually.
• To prevent possible damage
to the wipers and washer system, use anti-freezing washer
fluids in the winter season or
cold weather.
3-97
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
When the outside temperature is
below freezing, ALWAYS warm
the windshield using the
defroster to prevent the washer
fluid from freezing on the windshield and obscuring your vision
which could result in an accident
and serious injury or death.
CAUTION
Convenient features of your vehicle
REAR VIEW MONITOR (IF EQUIPPED)
OAEE049416
• The Rear View Monitor with parking guidance will activate when the
vehicle is in the ready mode and
the shift into R (Reverse) position.
• To assist in parking, the rear view
is shown (the parking guide line
disappears) on the screen when
the shift button is shifted from R
(Reverse) to D (Drive) with vehicle
speed below 15 km/h (9 mph).
Driving Rear View Monitor
(DRVM)
OAEE049645
OAEE046417L
The Rear View Monitor system is a
supplemental system that shows the
area behind the vehicle on the infotainment system screen to assist you
when parking or driving.
3-98
OAEE049680L
The Driving Rear View Monitor is a
driving assist function that shows the
image behind the vehicle on the
screen regardless of vehicle speed
while driving.
Operating Conditions
- The ignition status is [ON].
- The rear view monitor button (1) is
pressed when gearshift status is
[D](Drive) or [N](Neutral).
Deactivations
• When the vehicle is reversing the
screen switches to the parking
guidance screen.
• If rear image was ON while driving,
an icon (
) is displayed in the
upper right of the infotainment system screen to indicate Driving
Rear View Monitor function is supported.
The Driving Rear View Monitor
is a driving assist function. As
the appearance on the screen
may differ from the actual location, check the front/rear/side
view directly for safety.
Rear View Monitor – Top view
When you touch the icon of infotainment system, the top view is displayed on the screen and shows the
distance from the vehicle in the back
of your vehicle. Touch the icon
again, to switch back to the previous
screen.
CAUTION
• The Rear View Monitor is not a
safety device. It only serves to
assist the driver in identifying
objects directly behind the
middle of the vehicle. The
camera does not cover the
complete area behind the
vehicle.
• Never rely solely on the rear
view monitor. As there are
blind spots that do not appear
on the camera while backing
up and parking, You must
always use methods of viewing the area behind you
including looking over both
shoulders as well as continuously checking all three rear
view mirrors.
• Always look around your vehicle to make sure there are no
objects or obstacles before
moving the vehicle in any
direction to prevent a collision.
3-99
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
- The rear view monitor button (1) is
pressed again
- One of the infotainment system
button (2) is pressed
WARNING
Convenient features of your vehicle
• Always pay close attention
when the vehicle is driven
close to objects, particularly
pedestrians, and especially
children.
• Always keep the camera lens
clean. If lens is covered with
foreign matter, the camera
may not operate normally.
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system (if equipped)
• Always look around your vehi-
A
OAE048403
[A] : Rear Sensor
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system assists the driver during
reverse movement of the vehicle by
chiming if any object is sensed within the distance of 120 cm (48 in)
behind the vehicle.
This system is a supplemental system that senses objects within the
range and location of the sensors, it
cannot detect objects in other areas
where sensors are not installed.
3-100
WARNING
cle to make sure there are not
any objects or obstacles before
moving the vehicle in any direction to prevent a collision.
• Always pay close attention
when the vehicle is driven close
to objects, particularly pedestrians, and especially children.
• Be aware that some objects
may not be visible on the
screen or be detected by the
sensors, due to the objects distance, size or material, all of
which can limit the effectiveness of the sensor.
Operation of Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system
Operating condition
Types of warning sound
When an object is 120 cm to 60
cm (48 in to 24 in) from the rear
bumper :
Buzzer beeps intermittently.
When an object is approximately
30 to 60 cm (12 to 24 in) from
the rear bumper, the warning
sound beeps more frequently.
When an object is within 30 cm
(12 in) of the rear bumper :
Buzzer beeps continuously.
Indicator
NOTICE
• The indicator may differ from the
illustration
depending
on
objects or sensors status. If the
indicator blinks, we recommend
that you have your vehicle
checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the audible warning does not
sound or if the buzzer sounds
intermittently when the gear is R
(Reverse) position, this may indicate a malfunction with Reverse
Parking Distance Warning system. If this occurs, we recommend that you have your vehicle
checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
3-101
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
• This system will activate when
backing up with the ignition switch
in the ON position. However, if
vehicle speed exceeds 5 km/h (3
mph), the system may not detect
objects.
• If vehicle speed exceeds 10 km/h
(6 mph), the system will not warn
you even though objects are
detected.
• When more than two objects are
sensed at the same time, the closest one will be recognized first.
Types of warning sound and
indicator
Convenient features of your vehicle
To turn off Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system
(if equipped)
Non-operational conditions of
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system may not operate normally
when:
• Moisture is frozen to the sensor.
• Sensor is covered with foreign matter, such as snow or water, or the
sensor cover is blocked.
OAEE049415
Push the button to turn off Reverse
Parking Distance Warning system.
The indicator light on the button will
turn on.
3-102
There is a possibility of Reverse
Parking Distance Warning system
malfunction when:
• Driving on uneven road surfaces
such as unpaved roads, gravel,
bumps, or gradient.
• Objects generating excessive noise
such as vehicle horns, loud motorcycle engines, or truck air brakes
can interfere with the sensor.
• Heavy rain or water spray is present.
• Wireless transmitters or mobile
phones are present near the sensor.
• The sensor is covered with snow.
• Any non-factory equipment or
accessories have been installed, or
if the vehicle bumper height or sensor installation has been modified.
Detecting range may decrease
when:
• Outside air temperature is extremely hot or cold.
• Undetectable objects smaller than
100 cm (40 in) and narrower than
14 cm (6 in) in diameter.
The following objects may not be
recognized by the sensor:
• Sharp or slim objects such as
ropes, chains or small poles.
• Objects, which tend to absorb sensor frequency such as clothes,
spongy material or snow.
NOTICE
• Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system may not sound consistently
depending on the speed and
shapes of the objects detected.
• Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system may malfunction if the vehicle bumper height or sensor installation has been modified or damaged. Any non-factory installed
equipment or accessories may
also interfere with the sensor performance.
• The sensor may not recognize
objects less than 30 cm (12 in)
from the sensor, or it may sense an
incorrect distance. Use caution.
• When the sensor is frozen or
stained with snow, dirt, or water,
the sensor may be inoperative until
the stains are removed using a soft
cloth.
• Do not push, scratch or strike the
sensor with any hard objects that
could damage the surface of the
sensor. Sensor damage could
occur.
• Do not spray the sensors or its surrounding area directly with a high
pressure washer. Shock applied
from high pressure water may
cause the device to not operate
normally.
3
WARNING
Your new vehicle warranty does
not cover any accidents or damage to the vehicle or injuries to
its occupants related to a
Reverse
Parking
Distance
Warning system. Always drive
safely and cautiously.
3-103
Convenient features of your vehicle
• This system can only sense
objects within the range and
location of the sensors; It cannot detect objects in other areas
where sensors are not installed.
Also, small or slim objects, such
as poles or objects located
between sensors may not be
detected by the sensors.
Always visually check behind
the vehicle when backing up.
• Be sure to inform any drivers of
the vehicle that may be unfamiliar with the system regarding
the systems capabilities and
limitations.
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system precautions
Convenient features of your vehicle
Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system
(if equipped)
■ Front sensor
the distance of 100 cm (40 in) in front
and 120 cm (48 in) behind the vehicle.
This system is a supplemental system that senses objects within the
range and location of the sensors, it
cannot detect objects in other areas
where sensors are not installed.
Operation of Forward/Reverse
Parking Distance Warning
WARNING
• Always look around your vehiA
OAEE049414L
■ Rear sensor
B
OAEE049413
[A] : Front Sensor, [B] : Rear Sensor
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system assists the driver
during movement of the vehicle by
chiming if any object is sensed within
3-104
cle to make sure there are no
objects or obstacles before
moving the vehicle in any direction to prevent a collision.
• Always pay close attention
when the vehicle is driven close
to objects, particularly pedestrians, and especially children.
• Be aware that some objects
may not be visible on the
screen or be detected by the
sensors, due to the objects distance, size or material, all of
which can limit the effectiveness of the sensor.
OAEE049415L
Operating condition
• This system will activates when
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system button is pressed
with the engine running
Types of warning sound and indicator
Distance
from object
cm (in)
100 ~ 60
(40 ~ 24)
120 ~ 60
(48 ~ 24)
60 ~ 30
(24 ~ 12)
Front
Rear
-
Warning sound
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
Buzzer beeps
frequently
-
Buzzer beeps
frequently
Buzzer sounds
continuously
Front
Rear
When driving
rearward
-
Front
Rear
30
(12)
Warning indicator
When driving
forward
-
Buzzer sounds
continuously
NOTICE
• The indicator may differ from the illustration depending on objects or
sensors status. If the indicator blinks, we recommend that the system
be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
• If the audible warning does not sound or if the buzzer sounds intermittently when shifting into R (Reverse) position, this may indicate a
malfunction with Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning system.
If this occurs, we recommend that vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
3-105
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
• Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system button turns on
automatically
and
activates
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system when the gear is R
(Reverse) position. However, if
vehicle speed exceeds 10 km/h (6
mph), the system will not warn you
even though objects are detected,
and if vehicle speed exceeds 20
km/h (12 mph), the system will turn
off automatically. To turn on the system, press Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system button
• When more than two objects are
sensed at the same time, the closest one will be recognized first.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Non-operational conditions of
Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning may not operate when:
• Moisture is frozen to the sensor. (It
will operate normally when the ice
melts.)
• Sensor is covered with foreign matter, such as snow or water, or the
sensor cover is blocked. (It will
operate normally when the material is removed or the sensor is no
longer blocked.)
• Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning button is off.
3-106
There is a possibility of
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system malfunction when:
• Driving on uneven road surfaces
such as unpaved roads, gravel,
bumps, or gradient.
• Objects generating excessive
noise such as vehicle horns, loud
motorcycle engines, or truck air
brakes can interfere with the sensor.
• Heavy rain or water spray is present.
• Wireless transmitters or mobile
phones present near the sensor.
• The sensor is covered with snow
• Any non-factory equipment or
accessories have been installed,
or if the vehicle bumper height or
sensor installation has been modified.
Detecting range may decrease
when:
• Outside air temperature is
extremely hot or cold.
• The sensor is covered with foreign
matter such as snow or water. (The
sensing range will return to normal
when removed.)
The following objects may not be
recognized by the sensor:
• Sharp or slim objects such as
ropes, chains or small poles.
• Objects, which tend to absorb sensor frequency such as clothes,
spongy material or snow.
• Undetectable objects smaller than
100 cm (40 in) and narrower than
14 cm (5.5 in) in diameter.
Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system precautions
NOTICE
• This system can only sense
objects within the range and
location of the sensors; It cannot detect objects in other areas
where sensors are not installed.
Also, small or slim objects, such
as poles or objects located
between sensors may not be
detected by the sensors.
Always visually check behind
the vehicle when backing up.
• Be sure to inform any drivers of
the vehicle that may be unfamiliar with the system regarding
the systems capabilities and
limitations.
WARNING
Pay close attention when the
vehicle is driven close to
objects on the road, particularly
pedestrians, and especially
children. Be aware that some
objects may not be detected by
the sensors, due to the objects
distance, size or material, all of
which can limit the effectiveness of the sensor. Always perform a visual inspection to
make sure the vehicle is clear of
all obstructions before moving
the vehicle in any direction.
3-107
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
• Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system may not sound
consistently depending on the
speed and shapes of the objects
detected.
• Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system may malfunction if
the vehicle bumper height or sensor installation has been modified.
Any non-factory installed equipment or accessories may also
interfere with the sensor performance.
• Sensor may not recognize objects
less than 30 cm (12 in) from the
sensor, or it may sense an incorrect distance. Use with caution.
• When the sensor is frozen or
stained with snow, dirt, or water,
the sensor may be inoperative until
the stains are removed using a soft
cloth.
• Do not push, scratch or strike the
sensor. Sensor damage could
occur.
• Do not spray the sensors or its surrounding area directly with a high
pressure washer. Shock applied
from high pressure water may
cause the device to not operate
normally.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Self-Diagnosis
When the gear is R (Reverse) position and if one or more of the below
occurs you may have a malfunction
in the Parking Distance Warning system.
• You don't hear an audible warning
sound or if the buzzer sounds intermittently.
• Parking Distance Warning system
warning indicator is blinked. (if
equipped)
If this occurs, have the system
checked by a professional workshop.
We recommend that vehicle be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
3-108
WARNING
Your new vehicle warranty does
not cover any accidents or damage to the vehicle or injuries to
its occupants. Always drive
safely and cautiously.
DEFROSTER
NOTICE
i Information
Rear window defroster
To prevent damage to the conductors bonded to the inside surface
of the rear window, never use sharp
instruments or window cleaners
containing abrasives to clean the
window.
• If there is heavy accumulation of
snow on the rear window, brush it off
before operating the rear defroster.
• The rear window defroster automatically turns off after approximately 20
minutes or when the POWER button
is in the OFF position.
If you want to defrost and defog the
front windshield, refer to “Windshield
Defrosting and Defogging” in this
chapter.
Convenient features of your vehicle
i Information
3
OAEE049301
The defroster heats the window to
remove frost, fog and thin ice from
the interior and exterior of the rear
window, while the vehicle is in the
ready (
) mode.
• To activate the rear window
defroster, press the rear window
defroster button located in the center facia switch panel. The indicator
on the rear window defroster button illuminates when the defroster
is ON.
• To turn off the defroster, press the
rear window defroster button again.
3-109
Convenient features of your vehicle
AUTOMATIC CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM
1. Temperature control button
2. Fan speed control button
3. Mode selection button
4. HEAT button
5. AUTO(automatic control) button
6. OFF button
7. Front windshield defrost button
8. Rear window defrost button
9. Air conditioning button
10. Air intake control button
11. Driver only button
12. EV button
13. Climate information screen
OAEE049500L
3-110
i Information
Automatic heating and air conditioning
OAEE049302L
1. Press the AUTO button.
The modes, fan speeds, air intake
and air-conditioning will be controlled
automatically according to the temperature setting.
2. Press the temperature control button to set the desired temperature.
3-111
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE049303
• To turn the automatic operation off,
select any button of the following:
- Mode selection button
- Front windshield defrost button
(Press the button one more time to
deselect the front windshield
defroster function. The 'AUTO'
sign will illuminate on the information display once again.)
- Fan speed control button
The selected function will be controlled manually while other functions operate automatically.
• For your convenience, use the
AUTO button and set the temperature to 23°C (73°F).
Convenient features of your vehicle
Manual heating and air conditioning
OAEE049686L
i Information
Never place anything near the sensor
to ensure better control of the heating
and cooling system.
3-112
The heating and cooling system can be
controlled manually by pushing buttons
other than the AUTO button. In this
case, the system works sequentially
according to the order of buttons selected. When pressing any button except
the AUTO button while using automatic
operation, the functions not selected
will be controlled automatically.
1.Start the vehicle.
2.Set the mode to the desired position.
For improving the effectiveness of
heating and cooling;
- Heating:
- Cooling:
3.Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4.Set the air intake control to the outside (fresh) air position.
5.Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
6.If air conditioning is desired, turn
the air conditioning system on.
Press the AUTO button in order to
convert to full automatic control of
the system.
Mode selection
■ Left-hand drive
■ Right-hand drive
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
(if equipped)
(if equipped)
(if equipped)
OAEE049320
(if equipped)
OAEE049320R
3-113
Convenient features of your vehicle
Face-Level (B, C, D, E, F)
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each
outlet can be controlled to direct the
air discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D, E, F)
OAEE049306
The mode selection button controls
the direction of the air flow through
the ventilation system.
The air flow outlet port is converted
as follows:
Air flow is directed towards the face
and the floor.
Floor & Defrost
(A, C, D, E, F)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters.
Floor-Level (A, C, D, E, F)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield and
side window defrosters.
3-114
OAEE049307
Defrost-Level
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side window defrosters.
■ Front
Also, you can adjust the direction of
air delivery from these vents using
the vent control lever as shown.
Temperature control button
3
OAEE049303
Press the temperature control button
to set the desired temperature.
OAEPH049309L
Instrument panel vents
The outlet vents can be opened or
closed (
) using the vent control
lever.
3-115
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE049321
■ Rear (if equipped)
Convenient features of your vehicle
Air intake control
Recirculated air position
With the recirculated air
position selected, air
from the passenger
compartment will be
drawn through the heating system and heated
or cooled according to
the function selected.
Outside (fresh) air position
OAEE049312L
This is used to select the outside
(fresh) air position or recirculated air
position.
To change the air intake control position, push the control button.
With the outside (fresh) air
position selected, air
enters the vehicle from
outside and is heated or
cooled according to the
function selected.
i Information
Prolonged operation of the heater in
the recirculated air position (without
air conditioning selected) may cause
fogging of the windshield and side windows and the air within the passenger
compartment may become stale.
In addition, prolonged use of the air
conditioning with the recirculated air
position selected will result in excessively dry air in the passenger compartment.
3-116
WARNING
• Continued climate control
system operation in the recirculated air position may allow
humidity to increase inside
the vehicle which may fog the
glass and obscure visibility.
• Do not sleep in a vehicle with
the air conditioning or heating
system on. It may cause serious harm or death due to a
drop in the oxygen level
and/or body temperature.
• Continued climate control system operation in the recirculated air position can cause
drowsiness or sleepiness, and
loss of vehicle control. Set the
air intake control to the outside
(fresh) air position as much as
possible while driving.
Fan speed control
NOTICE
Driver only
Operating the fan speed when the
POWER button is in the ON position could cause the battery to
discharge. Operate the fan speed
when the vehicle is in the ready
(
) mode.
OAEE049314
If you press the DRIVER ONLY button( DRIVER
ONLY ) and the indicator light
illuminates, cold air mostly blows in
the direction of the driver’s seat.
However, some of the cold air may
come out of other seats’ ducts to
keep indoor air pleasant.
If you use the button with no passenger in the front passenger seat, energy consumption will be reduced.
DRIVER ONLY button will be turned
off under the following conditions:
1) Defrost on
2) DRIVER ONLY button re-push
3-117
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE049313
The fan speed can be set to the
desired speed by pushing the fan
speed control button.
The higher the fan speed is, the
more air is delivered.
Pressing the OFF button turns off the
fan.
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
Air conditioning
HEAT button
EV mode
OAEE049315
OAEE049310
OAEE049311
Push the A/C button to turn the air
conditioning system on (indicator
light will illuminate).
Push the button again to turn the air
conditioning system off.
Push the HEAT button to turn the
heater on (indicator light will illuminate).
Push the button again to turn the
heater off.
Push the EV button to enter the EV
mode on the infotainment system
screen.
The EV mode has a total of 7 menus
including Range, Nearby Stations,
Energy Information, Drive Mode,
ECO Driving, Charging/Climate
Settings and EV Settings.
Air conditioner/Heater uses energy
from the battery. If you use the heater
or air conditioner for too long, distance to empty can be reduced due
to too much power consumption.
Turn off the heater and air conditioner if you do not need them.
3-118
For details on EV mode, refer to
the infotainment system System
manual that is provided separately.
OFF mode
System operation
Ventilation
Heating
OAEE049316
Push the OFF button to turn the climate control system off. However,
you can still operate the mode and air
intake buttons as long as the
POWER button is in the ON position.
1. Set the mode to the
position.
2. Set the air intake control to the
outside (fresh) air position.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If dehumidified heating is desired,
turn the air conditioning system on.
• If the windshield fogs up, set the
mode to the
or
position.
3-119
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
1. Set the mode to the
position.
2. Set the air intake control to the
outside (fresh) air position.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Operation Tips
• To keep dust or unpleasant fumes
from entering the vehicle through
the ventilation system, temporarily
set the air intake control to the
recirculated air position. Be sure to
return the control to the fresh air
position when the irritation has
passed to keep fresh air in the
vehicle. This will help keep the driver alert and comfortable.
• Air for the heating/cooling system
is drawn in through the grilles just
ahead of the windshield. Care
should be taken that these are not
blocked by leaves, snow, ice or
other obstructions.
• To prevent interior fog on the windshield, set the air intake control to
the fresh air position and fan speed
to the desired position, turn on the
air conditioning system, and adjust
the temperature control to desired
temperature.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Air conditioning
HYUNDAI Air Conditioning Systems
are filled with R-134a or R1234yf
refrigerant.
1. Start the vehicle. Push the air conditioning button.
2. Set the mode to the
position.
3. Set the air intake control to the outside air or recirculated air position.
4. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
i Information
Your vehicle is filled with R-134a or
R-1234yf according to the regulation
in your country at the time of production. You can find out which air conditioning refrigerant is applied to your
vehicle on the label located inside of
the hood.
3-120
NOTICE
• The refrigerant system should
only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians to insure
proper and safe operation.
• The refrigerant system should
be serviced in a well-ventilated
place.
• The air conditioning evaporator
(cooling coil) shall never be
repaired or replaced with one
removed from a used or salvaged vehicle and new replacement MAC evaporators shall be
certified (and labeled) as meeting SAE Standard J2842.
i Information
When opening the windows in humid
weather air conditioning may create
water droplets inside the vehicle.
Since excessive water droplets may
cause damage to electrical equipment,
air conditioning should only be used
with the windows closed.
Air conditioning system operation
tips
• If the vehicle has been parked in
direct sunlight during hot weather,
open the windows for a short time
to let the hot air inside the vehicle
escape.
• Use air conditioning to reduce
humidity and moisture inside the
vehicle on rainy or humid days.
• During air conditioning system
operation, you may occasionally
notice a slight change in the vehicle
speed as the air conditioning compressor cycles. This is a normal
system operation characteristic.
• Use the air conditioning system
every month only for a few minutes
to ensure maximum system performance.
• When using the air conditioning
system, you may notice clear water
dripping (or even puddling) on the
ground under the passenger side of
the vehicle. This is a normal system
operation characteristic.
System maintenance
Climate control air filter
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases, we recommend the system be
checked at an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Outside air
i Information
Recirculated
air
Blower
Climate control
air filter
Evaporator
core
Heater core
1LDA5047
This filter is installed behind the
glove box. It filters the dust or other
pollutants that enter the vehicle
through the heating and air conditioning system.
We recommend that the climate control air filter be replaced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer according to the maintenance schedule. If
the vehicle is being driven in severe
conditions such as dusty or rough
roads, more frequent climate control
filter inspections and changes are
required.
• Replace the filter according to the
Maintenance Schedule.
If the car is being driven in severe
conditions such as dusty, rough
roads, more frequent climate control air filter inspections and
changes are required.
• When the air flow rate suddenly
decreases, we recommend that the
system be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
3-121
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
• Operating the air conditioning system in the recirculated air position
provides maximum cooling, however, continual operation in this mode
may cause the air inside the vehicle
to become stale.
• During cooling operation, you may
occasionally notice a misty air flow
because of rapid cooling and
humid air intake. This is a normal
system operation characteristic.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Checking the amount of air conditioner refrigerant and compressor lubricant
When the amount of refrigerant is
low, the performance of the air conditioning is reduced. Overfilling also
has a bad influence on the air conditioning system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is
found, we recommend that the system be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-134a
Because the refrigerant is at very high
pressure, the air conditioning
system
should only be serviced by trained and certified
technicians. It is important that
the correct type and amount of
oil and refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, it may cause damage
to the vehicle and personal injury.
3-122
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with
R-1234yf
Because the refrigerant is mildly inflammable at very high
pressure, the air conditioning
system
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
It is important that the
correct type and amount of oil
and refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, it may cause damage to the vehicle and personal
injury.
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTING AND DEFOGGING
WARNING
Windshield heating
Automatic climate control
system
To defog inside windshield
3
OAEE049317L
1. Select desired fan speed.
2. Select desired temperature.
3. Press the defroster button (
).
4. The air-conditioning will turn on
according to the detected ambient
temperature, outside (fresh) air
position and higher fan speed will
be selected automatically.
3-123
Convenient features of your vehicle
Do not use the
or
position during cooling operation in
extremely humid weather. The
difference between the temperature of the outside air and that
of the windshield could cause
the outer surface of the windshield to fog up, causing loss of
visibility. In this case, set the
mode selection button to the
position and fan speed control knob or button to lower
speed.
• For maximum defrosting, set the
temperature control to the extreme
right/hot position and the fan speed
control to the highest speed.
• If warm air to the floor is desired
while defrosting or defogging, set the
mode to the floor-defrost position.
• Before driving, clear all snow and
ice from the windshield, rear window, outside rear view mirrors, and
all side windows.
• Clear all snow and ice from the
hood and air inlet in the cowl grill to
improve heater and defroster efficiency and to reduce the probability of fogging up inside of the windshield.
Convenient features of your vehicle
If the air-conditioning, outside (fresh)
air position and higher fan speed are
not selected automatically, adjust the
corresponding button manually.
If the
position is selected, lower
fan speed is controlled to higher fan
speed.
3-124
To defrost outside windshield
Defogging logic
OAEE049318L
OAEE049319L
1. Set fan speed to the highest position.
2. Set temperature to the extreme
hot (HI) position.
3. Press the defroster button (
).
4. The air-conditioning will turn on
according to the detected ambient
temperature and outside (fresh)
air position will be selected automatically.
If the
position is selected, lower
fan speed is controlled to higher fan
speed.
To reduce the probability of fogging
up the inside of the windshield, the
air intake or air conditioning are controlled automatically according to
certain conditions such as
or
position. To cancel or return the
defogging logic, do the following.
1. Turn the POWER button to the ON
position.
2. Press the defroster button (
).
3. While pressing the air conditioning
button (A/C), press the air intake
control button at least 5 times within 3 seconds.
The climate control information
screen will blink 3 times. It indicates
that the defogging logic is canceled
or returned to the programmed status.
Auto defogging system
When the Auto Defogging
System operates, the indicator will illuminate.
OAEE049687L
Auto defogging reduces the possibility of fogging up the inside of the
windshield by automatically sensing
the moisture of inside the windshield.
The auto defogging system operates
when the heater or air conditioning is
on.
i Information
The auto defogging system may not
operate normally, when the outside
temperature is below -10 °C.
Step 1 : Outside air position
Step 2 : Operating the air conditioning
Step 3 : Blowing air toward the windshield
Step 4 : Increasing air flow toward
the windshield
If the air conditioning is off or recirculated air position is manually selected
while Auto Defogging System is ON,
the Auto Defogging System Indicator
will blink 3 times to signal that the
manual operation has been canceled.
To cancel or reset the Auto Defogging
System
Press the front windshield defroster
button for 3 seconds when the
POWER button is in the ON position.
3-125
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
If higher level of moisture are sensed
in the vehicle, the Auto Defogging
System will operate in the following
order:
If the battery has been discharged or
disconnected, it resets to the defog
logic status.
Convenient features of your vehicle
When the Auto Defogging System is
canceled, ADS OFF symbol will blink
3 times and the ADS OFF will be displayed on the climate control information screen.
When the Auto Defogging System is
reset, ADS OFF symbol will blink 6
times without a signal.
i Information
• When the air conditioning is turned
on by Auto defogging system, if you
try to turn off the air conditioning, the
indicator will blink 3 times and the air
conditioning will not be turned off.
• For efficiency, do not select recirculated air position while Auto defogging system is operating.
NOTICE
Do not remove the sensor cover
located on the upper end of the
windshield glass.
Damage to system parts could
occur and may not be covered by
your vehicle warranty.
3-126
CLIMATE CONTROL
ADDITIONAL FEATURES
Sunroof inside air recirculation
(if equipped)
When the sunroof is opened, outside (fresh) air will be automatically
selected. At this time, if you press the
air intake control button, recirculated
air position will be selected but will
change back to outside (fresh) air
after 3 minutes. When the sunroof is
closed, the air intake position will
return to the original position that
was selected.
STORAGE COMPARTMENT
WARNING
Center console storage
ALWAYS keep the storage compartment covers closed securely while driving. Items inside
your vehicle are moving as fast
as the vehicle. If you have to
stop or turn quickly, or if there
is a crash, the items may fly out
of the compartment and may
cause an injury if they strike the
driver or a passenger.
3
OAEE046418
NOTICE
To avoid possible theft, do not
leave valuables in the storage
compartments.
To open :
Press the button (1).
3-127
Convenient features of your vehicle
Never store cigarette lighters,
propane cylinders, or other
flammable/explosive materials
in the vehicle. These items may
catch fire and/or explode if the
vehicle is exposed to hot temperatures for extended periods.
WARNING
Convenient features of your vehicle
Glove box
Sunglass holder (if equipped)
WARNING
• Do not keep objects except
OAEE046427
To open:
Pull the lever (1).
WARNING
ALWAYS close the glove box
door after use.
An open glove box door can
cause serious injury to the passenger in an accident, even if the
passenger is wearing a seat belt.
3-128
OAD045413
To open:
Press the cover and the holder will
slowly open. Place your sunglasses
in the compartment door with the
lenses facing out.
To close:
Push back into position.
Make sure the sunglass holder is
closed while driving.
sunglasses inside the sunglass holder. Such objects can
be thrown from the holder in
the event of a sudden stop or
an accident, possibly injuring
the passengers in the vehicle.
• Do not open the sunglass
holder while the vehicle is
moving. The rear view mirror
of the vehicle can be blocked
by an open sunglass holder.
• Do not put the glasses forcibly
into a sunglass holder. It may
cause personal injury if you
try to open it forcibly when the
glasses are jammed in holder.
Multi box (if equipped)
WARNING
Do not keep objects that can be
thrown from the multi box and
severely injure passengers in
the vehicle in the event of a sudden stop or an accident.
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE046402L
OAEE046403
Use the multi box to keep small
objects.
3-129
Convenient features of your vehicle
INTERIOR FEATURES
Ashtray (if equipped)
Cup holder
Rear
■ Front
Pull the armrest down to use the cup
holders.
WARNING
• Avoid abrupt starting and
OAEE049404
OAEE049471L
■ Rear
To use the ashtray, open the cover.
To clean the ashtray:
The plastic receptacle should be
removed by lifting the plastic ashtray
receptacle upward after turning the
cover counterclockwise and pulling it
out.
OAE046424
WARNING
Ashtray use
Putting lit cigarettes or matches
in an ashtray with other combustible materials may cause a
fire.
3-130
Cups or small beverages cups may
be placed in the cup holders.
braking when the cup holder
is in use to prevent spilling
your drink. If hot liquid spills,
you could be burned. Such a
burn to the driver could cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
• Do not place uncovered or
unsecured cups, bottles,
cans, etc., in the cup holder
containing hot liquid while the
vehicle is in motion. Injuries
may result in the event of sudden stop or collision.
• Only use soft cups in the cup
holders. Hard objects can
injure you in an accident.
WARNING
i Information
Sunvisor
Close the vanity mirror cover securely
and return the sunvisor to its original
position after use.
Keep cans or bottles out of
direct sun light and do not put
them in a hot vehicle. It may
explode.
WARNING
NOTICE
OAE046425
To use a sunvisor, pull it downward.
To use a sunvisor for a side window,
pull it downward, unsnap it from the
bracket (1) and swing it to the side (2).
To use the vanity mirror, pull down the
sunvisor and slide the mirror cover (3).
Use the ticket holder (4) to hold tickets.
NOTICE
Do not put several tickets in the
ticket holder at one time. This
could cause damage to the ticket
holder.
3-131
Convenient features of your vehicle
• Keep your drinks sealed while
driving to prevent spilling your
drink. If liquid spills, it may get
into the vehicle's electrical/electronic system and damage electrical/electronic parts.
• When cleaning spilled liquids, do
not dry the cup holder at high
temperature. This may damage
the cup holder.
3
For your safety, do not block your
view when using the sunvisor.
Convenient features of your vehicle
Power outlet (if equipped)
OAEE049405L
The power outlet is designed to provide power for mobile telephones or
other devices designed to operate
with vehicle electrical systems. The
devices should draw less than 180
W(Watt) with the vehicle in the ready
(
) mode.
WARNING
Avoid electrical shocks. Do not
place your fingers or foreign
objects (pin, etc.) into a power
outlet or touch the power outlet
with a wet hand.
3-132
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the Power
Outlets :
• Use the power outlet only when
the vehicle is in the ready (
)
mode and remove the accessory
plug after use. Using the accessory plug for prolonged periods
of time with the vehicle off could
cause the battery to discharge.
• Only use 12V electric accessories
which are less than 180 W(Watt) in
electric capacity.
• Adjust the air-conditioner or
heater to the lowest operating
level when using the power outlet.
• Close the cover when not in use.
• Some electronic devices can
cause electronic interference
when plugged into a vehicle’s
power outlet. These devices may
cause excessive audio static
and malfunctions in other electronic systems or devices used
in your vehicle.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Push the plug in as far as it will
go. If good contact is not made,
the plug may overheat and the
fuse may open.
• Plug in battery equipped electrical/electronic devices with
reverse current protection. The
current from the battery may
flow into the vehicle's electrical/electronic system and cause
system malfunction.
Wireless cellular phone charging system (if equipped)
There is a wireless cellular phone
charger inside the front console.
The system is available when all
doors are closed, and when the
POWER button is in the ACC, ON or
START position.
The wireless cellular phone charging
system charges only the Qi-enabled
cellular phones (
). Read the label
on the cellular phone accessory
cover or visit your cellular phone
manufacturer’s website to check
whether your cellular phone supports
the Qi technology.
The wireless charging process starts
when you put a Qi-enabled cellular
phone on the wireless charging unit.
1. Remove other items, including the
smart key, from the wireless charging unit. If not, the wireless charging process may be interrupted.
Place the cellular phone on the
center of charging pad.
2. The indicator light is orange when
the cellular phone is chargeing. The
indicator light turns green when
phone charging is completed.
3. You can turn ON or OFF the wireless charging function in the user
settings mode on the instrument
cluster. (For further information,
refer to the “LCD display” in this
chapter.)
If your cellular phone is not charging:
- Slightly change the position of the
cellular phone on the charging pad.
- Make sure the indicator light is
orange.
The indicator light will blink orange
for 10 seconds if there is a malfunction in the wireless charging system.
In this case, temporarily stop the
charging process, and re-attempt to
wirelessly charge your cellular phone
again.
The system warns you with a message on the LCD display if the cellular phone is still on the wireless
charging unit after the POWER button is in the OFF position and the
front door is opened.
i Information
For some manufacturers' cellular
phones, the system may not warn you
even though the cellular phone is left
on the wireless charging unit. This is
due to the particular characteristic of
the cellular phone and not a malfunction of the wireless charging.
3-133
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE049407
To charge a cellular phone
Convenient features of your vehicle
NOTICE
• The wireless cellular phone
charging system may not support certain cellular phones,
which are not verified for the Qi
specification (
).
• When placing your cellular
phone on the charging mat, position the phone in the middle of
the mat for optimal charging performance. If your cell phone is off
to the side, the charging rate may
be less and in some cases the
cell phone may experience higher heat conduction.
• In some cases, the wireless
charging may stop temporarily
when the Smart Key is used,
either when starting the vehicle
or locking/unlocking the doors,
etc.
• When charging certain cellular
phones, the charging indicator
may not change to green when
the cell phone is fully charged.
(Continued)
3-134
(Continued)
• The wireless charging process may
temporarily stop, when temperature abnormally increases inside
the wireless cellular phone charging system. The wireless charging
process restarts, when temperature falls to a proper level.
• The wireless charging process
may temporarily stop when there
is any metallic item, such as a
coin, between the wireless cellular phone charging system and a
cellular phone.
• For certain cellular phones with
their own protection, the wireless
charging speed may decrease
and the wireless charging may
stop.
• If the cellular phone has a thick
cover, the wireless charging may
not be possible.
• If the cell phone is not completely contacting the charging pad,
wireless charging may not operate properly.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Some magnetic items like credit
cards, phone cards or rail tickets
may be damaged if left with the
cellular phone during the charging process.
• If the cellular phone without the
wireless charging function or the
metallic items are placed on the
charging pad, it may cause slight
noise. This noise does not affect
the cellular phone and the vehicle, because this noise is an
operating sound during determining the item on the charging
pad.
• If the POWER button is in the
OFF position, the charging also
stops.
Cigarette lighter (if equipped)
WARNING
• Do not hold the lighter in after
To use the cigarette lighter, the
POWER button must be in the ACC
or ON position.
Push the cigarette lighter all the way
into its socket. When the element is
heated, the lighter will pop out to the
“ready” position.
We recommend that you use parts
for replacement from an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
Only a genuine HYUNDAI lighter
should be used in the cigarette
lighter socket. The use of plug-in
accessories (shavers, hand-held
vacuums, and coffee pots, etc.)
may damage the socket or cause
electrical failure.
WARNING
Do not adjust the clock while
driving.You may lose your steering control and cause severe
personal injury or accidents.
Vehicles with Audio system
Select the [SETUP] button on the
audio system ➟ Select [Date/Time].
• Set time: Set the time displayed on
the audio screen.
• Time format: Choose between 12hour and 24-hour time formats.
Vehicles with Navigation system
Select the Settings menu on the
Navigation
system
➟
Select
[Date/Time].
• GPS time: Displays time according
to the received GNSS time.
• 24-hour: Switches to 12 hour or 24
hour.
❈ Detailed information for the
Infotainment system is described
in a separately supplied manual.
3-135
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE049472L
it is already heated because it
will overheat.
• If the lighter does not pop out
within 30 seconds, remove it
to prevent overheating.
• Do not insert foreign objects
into the socket of the cigarette
lighter. It may damage the cigarette lighter.
Clock
Convenient features of your vehicle
Clothes hanger (if equipped)
OAEE046434
These hangers are not designed to
hold large or heavy items.
3-136
WARNING
Floor mat anchor(s)
(if equipped)
OGSB047265L
Do not hang other objects such
as hangers or hard objects
except clothes. Also, do not put
heavy, sharp or breakable
objects in the clothes pockets.
In an accident or when the curtain air bag is inflated, it may
cause vehicle damage or personal injury.
OAE046430
ALWAYS use the Floor Mat Anchors
to attach the front floor mats to the
vehicle. The anchors on the front
floor carpet keep the floor mats from
sliding forward.
WARNING
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the goods
or the vehicle, care should be
taken when carrying fragile or
bulky objects in the luggage
compartment.
WARNING
OAEE046408
To keep items from shifting in the
cargo area, you can use the four
holders located in the cargo area to
attach the luggage net.
If necessary, we recommend that you
contact your authorized HYUNDAI
dealer to obtain a luggage net.
To avoid eye injury, DO NOT
overstretch the luggage net.
ALWAYS keep your face and
body out of the luggage net’s
recoil path. DO NOT use the luggage net when the strap has visible signs of wear or damage.
3-137
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
The following must be observed
when installing ANY floor mat
to the vehicle.
• Ensure that the floor mats are
securely attached to the vehicle's floor mat anchor(s)
before driving the vehicle.
• Do not use ANY floor mat that
cannot be firmly attached to
the vehicle's floor mat anchors.
• Do not stack floor mats on top
of one another (e.g. all-weather rubber mat on top of a carpeted floor mat). Only a single
floor mat should be installed
in each position.
IMPORTANT - Your vehicle was
manufactured with driver's side
floor mat anchors that are
designed to securely hold the
floor mat in place. To avoid any
interference with pedal operation,
HYUNDAI recommends that the
HYUNDAI floor mat designed for
use in your vehicle be installed.
Luggage net (holder)
(if equipped)
Convenient features of your vehicle
To use the cargo security screen
Cargo security screen
(if equipped)
When the cargo security screen
is not in use:
1. Pull the cargo security screen
backward and up to release it from
the guides.
2. The cargo security screen will
automatically slide back in.
NOTICE
OAEE046423
OAEE046422
Use the cargo security screen to
hide items stored in the cargo area.
1. Pull the cargo security screen
towards the rear of the vehicle by
the handle (1).
2. Insert the guide pin into the guide
(2).
NOTICE
Pull out the cargo security screen
with the handle in the center to
prevent the guide pin from falling
out of the guide.
3-138
The cargo security screen may
not automatically slide back in if
the cargo security screen is not
fully pulled out. Fully pull it out
and then let go.
To remove the cargo security
screen
3
Convenient features of your vehicle
OAEE046424L
OAEE046409
1. Push out the lower part of guide
pins in both sides.
2. While pushing the guide pins, pull
out the cargo security screen.
3. Open the luggage tray and keep
the cargo security screen in the
tray.
3-139
Infotainment system
Infotainment system ..............................................4-2
USB and iPod® port ..........................................................4-2
Antenna ...............................................................................4-2
Steering wheel audio control .........................................4-3
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology hands-free ..........4-4
Audio / Video / Navigation system ..............................4-4
4
Infotainment system
INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM
i Information
Antenna
Roof antenna (Type A)
USB and iPod® port
• If you install an aftermarket HID
headlamp, your vehicle’s audio and
electronic device may malfunction.
• Prevent chemicals such as perfume,
cosmetic oil, sun cream, hand cleaner, and air freshener from contacting
the interior parts because they may
cause damage or discoloration.
OAEE049411L
You can use an USB port to plug in
and USB and an iPod® port.
i Information
When using a portable audio device
connected to the power outlet, noise
may occur during playback. If this
happens, use the power source of the
portable audio device.
❈
4-2
iPod®
is a trademark of Apple Inc.
OAEPH049481L
The roof antenna receives both AM
and FM broadcast signals.
Rotate the roof antenna in a counterclockwise direction to remove it.
Rotate it in a clockwise direction to
reinstall it.
NOTICE
• Before entering a place with a low
height clearance or a car wash,
remove the antenna by rotating it
counterclockwise. If not, the
antenna may be damaged.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• When reinstalling your antenna,
it is important that it is fully
tightened and adjusted to the
upright position to ensure proper reception.
Steering wheel audio control
(if equipped)
■ Type A
Do not operate audio remote control buttons simultaneously.
VOLUME (VOL + / - ) (1)
• Move the VOLUME toggle switch
up to increase volume.
• Move the VOLUME toggle switch
down to decrease volume.
Shark fin antenna (Type B)
■ Type B
SEEK/PRESET (
/
) (2)
If the SEEK/PRESET toggle switch
is moved up or down and held for 0.8
second or more, it will function in the
following modes.
■ Type C
OAEE049410
OAE046474L
RADIO mode
It will function as the AUTO SEEK
select switch. It will SEEK until you
release the switch.
MEDIA mode
It will function as the FF/REW switch.
The steering wheel audio control
switches are installed for your convenience.
4-3
4
Infotainment system
OAE046437
The shark fin antenna receives
transmitted data. (for example:
AM/FM, DAB, GPS/ GNSS)
NOTICE
Infotainment system
If the SEEK/PRESET toggle switch
is moved up or down, it will function
in the following modes.
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
hands-free
RADIO mode
It will function as the PRESET STATION UP/DOWN switch.
MEDIA mode
It will function as the TRACK UP/
DOWN switch.
MODE (
) (3)
Press the MODE button to select
Radio, Disc, or AUX.
MUTE (
• Audio : Detailed information of the
AUDIO system is described in the
manual supplied separately.
• AVN : Detailed information for the
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
hands-free is described in the
manual supplied separately.
OAE046440
Audio / Video / Navigation system (if equipped)
Detailed information for the navigation system is described in a separately supplied manual.
) (4)
• Press the button to mute the
sound.
• Press the button again to activate
the sound.
i Information
Detailed information for audio control
buttons are described in the following
pages in this chapter.
4-4
(1) Call / Answer button
(2) Call end button
(3) Microphone
OAE046447
You can use the phone wirelessly by
using the Bluetooth® Wireless
Technology.
Driving your vehicle
Before driving.........................................................5-3
Braking system.....................................................5-27
Before entering the vehicle ...........................................5-3
Before starting...................................................................5-3
Power brakes ..................................................................5-27
Disc brakes wear indicator ..........................................5-28
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)...................................5-28
Auto hold .........................................................................5-33
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ....................................5-37
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)................................5-39
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM).........................5-43
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) ....................................5-44
Good braking practices ................................................5-45
Power button ..........................................................5-4
POWER button positions .................................................5-6
Starting the vehicle...........................................................5-8
Turning off the vehicle..................................................5-10
Reduction gear .....................................................5-11
Reduction gear operation .............................................5-11
Parking...............................................................................5-13
LCD display messages....................................................5-14
Good driving practices ..................................................5-16
Paddle shifter (Regenerative braking control) ..5-18
One pedal driving ............................................................5-19
Smart recuperation system
(with smart cruise control system)...................5-20
System setting .................................................................5-20
To activate Smart Recuperation System ...................5-20
Smart Recuperation System will be temporarily
cancelled when: ...............................................................5-21
To resume Smart Recuperation System ....................5-22
To turn Smart Recuperation System off...................5-22
Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance recognition sensor
(Front radar).....................................................................5-22
System malfunction........................................................5-23
Limitations of the system .............................................5-23
Drive mode integrated control system .............5-46
Drive mode........................................................................5-46
Initial setting for each Drive Mode ............................5-46
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) system
- sensor fusion type
(Front view camera + Front radar) ....................5-47
System setting and activation......................................5-47
FCA warning message and brake control.................5-49
FCA sensor (Front camera+ Front radar).................5-52
System malfunction........................................................5-54
Limitations of the system .............................................5-56
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system ..................5-63
LKA operation ..................................................................5-65
Warning light and message ..........................................5-68
Limitations of the System.............................................5-69
LKA system function change .......................................5-71
5
Blind-spot Collision Warning (BCW) system ...5-72
System description .........................................................5-72
System setting and operation......................................5-73
Warning message and system control.......................5-75
Declaration of conformity ...........................................5-81
Driver Attention Warning (DAW) ......................5-83
System setting and operation......................................5-83
Resetting the system ....................................................5-86
System standby ...............................................................5-86
System malfunction........................................................5-86
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert .................................5-89
5
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning (RCCW)
system ................................................................5-123
System description .......................................................5-123
System setting and operation....................................5-123
Warning message and system control ....................5-125
Detecting Sensor...........................................................5-127
Speed limit control system ..............................5-133
Speed Limit Control operation...................................5-133
Intelligent Speed Limit Warning (ISLW)..........5-135
Cruise control ......................................................5-91
System setting and operation....................................5-136
Display .............................................................................5-137
Limitations of the system ...........................................5-140
Cruise control operation................................................5-91
Special driving conditions.................................5-142
Smart cruise control system
(with stop & go system) ....................................5-97
Hazardous driving conditions ....................................5-142
Rocking the vehicle ......................................................5-142
Smooth cornering .........................................................5-143
Driving at night..............................................................5-143
Driving in the rain .........................................................5-143
Driving in flooded areas..............................................5-144
Highway driving.............................................................5-144
To adjust the sensitivity of Smart Cruise Control ..5-99
To convert to Cruise Control mode ..........................5-100
Smart Cruise Control speed........................................5-101
Smart Cruise Control Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance..5-106
Sensor to detect distance to the vehicle ahead...5-109
Limitations of the system ...........................................5-111
Lane Following Assist (LFA) system ..............5-116
LFA operation ................................................................5-118
Warning message..........................................................5-119
Limitations of the system ...........................................5-121
Winter driving.....................................................5-145
Snow or icy conditions ................................................5-145
Winter precautions .......................................................5-147
Vehicle weight ....................................................5-149
Overloading ....................................................................5-149
Trailer towing .....................................................5-150
BEFORE DRIVING
Before starting
• Be sure all windows, outside mirror(s), and outside lights are clean
and unobstructed.
• Remove frost, snow, or ice.
• Visually check the tires for uneven
wear and damage.
• Check under the vehicle for any
sign of leaks.
• Be sure there are no obstacles
behind you if you intend to back up.
• Make sure the hood, the tailgate,
and the doors are securely closed
and locked.
• Adjust the position of the seat and
steering wheel.
• Adjust the inside and outside
rearview mirrors.
• Verify all the lights work.
• Fasten your seat belt. Check that
all passengers have fastened their
seat belts.
• Check the gauges and indicators in
the instrument panel and the messages on the instrument display
when the POWER button is in the
ON position.
• Check that any items you are carrying are stored properly or fastened down securely.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, take the following precautions:
• ALWAYS wear your seat belt.
All passengers must be properly belted whenever the vehicle is moving. For more information, refer to "Seat Belts" in
chapter 2.
• Always drive defensively.
Assume other drivers or pedestrians may be careless and
make mistakes.
• Stay focused on the task of
driving. Driver distraction can
cause accidents.
• Leave plenty of space between
you and the vehicle in front of
you.
5-3
5
Driving your vehicle
Before entering the vehicle
Driving your vehicle
POWER BUTTON
WARNING
NEVER drink or take drugs and
drive.
Drinking or taking drugs and
driving is dangerous and may
result in an accident and SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH.
Drunk driving is the number
one contributor to the highway
death toll each year. Even a
small amount of alcohol will
affect your reflexes, perceptions and judgment. Just one
drink can reduce your ability to
respond to changing conditions
and emergencies and your reaction time gets worse with each
additional drink.
Driving while under the influence of drugs is as dangerous
or more dangerous than driving
under the influence of alcohol.
(Continued)
5-4
(Continued)
You are much more likely to have
a serious accident if you drink or
take drugs and drive. If you are
drinking or taking drugs, don't
drive. Do not ride with a driver
who has been drinking or taking
drugs. Choose a designated driver or call a taxi.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, take the following precautions:
• NEVER allow children or any
person who is unfamiliar with
the vehicle to touch the
POWER button or related
parts. Unexpected and sudden vehicle movement can
occur.
• NEVER reach through the
steering wheel for the POWER
button or any other control,
while the vehicle is in motion.
The presence of your hand or
arm in this area may cause a
loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
WARNING
OAEE056019
• NEVER press the POWER button while the vehicle is in
motion except in an emergency. This will result in the
vehicle turning off and loss of
power assist for the steering
and brake systems. This may
lead to loss of directional control and braking function,
which could cause an accident.
• Before leaving the driver's
seat, always make sure the
gear is in the P (Park) position,
set the parking brake, press
the POWER button to the OFF
position, and take the Smart
Key with you. Unexpected
vehicle movement may occur
if these precautions are not
followed.
5-5
5
Driving your vehicle
Whenever the front door is opened,
the POWER button will illuminate
and will go off 30 seconds after the
door is closed.
To turn the vehicle off in an
emergency:
Press and hold the POWER button for more than two seconds
OR Rapidly press and release
the POWER button three times
(within three seconds).
If the vehicle is still moving, you
can restart the vehicle without
depressing the brake pedal by
pressing the POWER button
with the gear in the N (Neutral)
position.
WARNING
Driving your vehicle
POWER button positions
Button Position
5-6
Action
Notice
OFF
To turn off the vehicle, press the POWER
If the steering wheel is not locked properly
button with the gear in P (Park).
when you open the driver's door, the warning
chime will sound.
Also, the vehicle will turn off when the
POWER button is pressed with the gear in D
(Drive) or R (Reverse) because the gear
automatically shifts to the P (Park) position.
But, when it is pressed in N (Neutral), the
POWER button will go to the ACC position.
The steering wheel locks to protect the vehicle
from theft (if equipped).
ACC
Press the POWER button when the button
is in the OFF position without depressing
the brake pedal.
Some of the electrical accessories are
usable.
The steering wheel unlocks.
If the steering wheel doesn't unlock properly,
the POWER button will not work. Press the
POWER button while turning the steering
wheel right and left to release tension.
Button Position
ON
START
Action
Press the POWER button while it is in the
ACC position without depressing the brake
pedal.
The warning lights can be checked before
the vehicle is started.
Notice
Do not leave the POWER button in the ON
position when the vehicle is not in the ready
(
) mode to prevent the battery from discharging.
5-7
5
Driving your vehicle
To start the vehicle, depress the brake pedal If you press the POWER button without
and press the POWER button with the gear depressing the brake pedal, the vehicle does
in the P (Park) position.
not start and the POWER button changes as
follows:
OFF → ACC → ON → OFF or ACC
Driving your vehicle
Starting the vehicle
WARNING
• Always wear appropriate shoes
when operating your vehicle.
Unsuitable shoes, such as high
heels, ski boots, sandals, flipflops, etc., may interfere with
your ability to use the brake
and accelerator pedals.
• Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle can move and
lead to an accident.
5-8
i Information
• The vehicle will start by pressing the
POWER button, only when the
smart key is in the vehicle.
• Even if the smart key is in the vehicle, and when it is far away from the
driver, the vehicle may not start.
• When the POWER button is in the
ACC or ON position, any door is
open, the system checks for the
smart key. When the smart key is
not in the vehicle, the "
" indicator will blink and the warning "Key
not in vehicle" will come on. When
all doors are closed, the chime will
also sound for about 5 seconds.
Keep the smart key in the vehicle
when in the ACC position or if the
vehicle is in the ready (
) mode.
1. Always carry the smart key with
you.
2. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
3. Make sure the gear is in P (Park).
4. Depress the brake pedal.
5. Press the POWER button. If the
vehicle starts, the "
" indicator
will come on.
i Information
• Always start the vehicle with your
foot on the brake pedal. Do not
depress the accelerator while starting the vehicle.
• If ambient temperature is low, the
"
" indicator may remain illuminated longer than the normal amount
of time.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
• If the "
" indicator turns off
while you are in motion, do not
attempt to shift to the P (Park)
position.
If traffic and road conditions
permit, you may shift to the N
(Neutral) position while the vehicle is still moving and press the
POWER button in an attempt to
restart the vehicle.
• Do not push or tow your vehicle
to start the vehicle.
NOTICE
OAEE056024
i Information
If the smart key battery is weak or the
smart key does not work correctly,
you can start the vehicle by pressing
the POWER button with the smart
key in the direction of the picture
above.
5-9
5
Driving your vehicle
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
Do not press the POWER button
for more than 10 seconds except
when the stop lamp fuse is blown.
When the stop lamp fuse is blown,
you cannot normally start the
vehicle. Replace the fuse with a
new one. If you are not able to
replace the fuse, you can start the
vehicle by pressing and holding
the POWER button for 10 seconds
with the POWER button in the ACC
position.
For your safety always depress
the brake pedal before starting the
vehicle.
Driving your vehicle
Turning off the vehicle
1.
2.
3.
4.
Depress the brake pedal fully.
Shift to P (Park).
Apply the parking brake.
Press the POWER button to turn
the vehicle off.
5. Make sure the "
" indicator
light on the instrument cluster is
turned off.
CAUTION
If the "
" indicator light on
the instrument cluster is still
on, the vehicle is not turned off
and can move when the gear is
in any position except P (Park).
5-10
REDUCTION GEAR
Gear position
Reduction gear operation
WARNING
OAEE056001L
Select gear positions by pressing the
shift button.
For your safety, always depress the
brake pedal while shifting to another
gear.
OAEE049212
The indicator in the instrument cluster displays the gear position when
the POWER button is in the ON position.
5-11
5
Driving your vehicle
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death:
• ALWAYS check the surrounding areas near your vehicle for
people, especially children,
before shifting a vehicle into
D (Drive) or R (Reverse).
• Before leaving the driver's
seat, always make sure the
gear is in the P (Park) position, then set the parking
brake, and place the POWER
button in the OFF position.
Unexpected and sudden vehicle movement can occur if
these precautions are not followed.
Driving your vehicle
P (Park)
Always come to a complete stop
before shifting into P (Park).
To shift the gear from R (Reverse), N
(Neutral) or D (Drive) to P (Park),
press the [P] button.
If you turn off the vehicle in D (Drive)
or R (Reverse), the gear automatically shifts to P (Park).
WARNING
• Shifting into P (Park) while the
vehicle is in motion may
cause you to lose control of
the vehicle.
• After the vehicle has stopped,
always make sure the gear is
in P (Park), apply the parking
brake, and turn the vehicle off.
• Do not use the P (Park) position in place of the parking
brake.
5-12
R (Reverse)
Use this position to drive the vehicle
backward.
To shift to R (Reverse), press the [R]
button while depressing the brake
pedal.
N (Neutral)
The wheels and gear are not
engaged.
To shift to N (Neutral), press the [N]
button while depressing the brake
pedal.
Always depress the brake pedal
when you are shifting from N
(Neutral) to another gear.
In N (Neutral), if the driver attempts
to turn off the vehicle, the gear
remains in N (Neutral) and the
POWER button will be in the ACC
position.
To turn off the vehicle from the ACC
position, press the POWER button
to the ON position, press the [P] button, and press the POWER button to
the OFF position.
When the driver’s door is opened
within 3 minutes with the POWER
button in the ACC position and the
gear in N (Neutral), the vehicle is
automatically turned OFF and shifted
to the P (Park) position.
D (Drive)
This is the normal driving position.
To shift to D (Drive), press the [D]
button while depressing the brake
pedal.
Shift-lock system
For your safety, your vehicle has a
shift-lock system which prevents
shifting the gear from P (Park) or N
(Neutral) into R (Reverse) or D
(Drive) unless the brake pedal is
depressed.
To shift from P (Park) or N (Neutral)
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive) :
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Start the vehicle or place the
POWER button in the ON position.
3. Press the R (Reverse) or D (Drive)
button.
When the battery (12 V) is discharged
You cannot shift the gear when the
battery is discharged.
Jump start your vehicle (refer to
“Jump Starting” in chapter 6) or we
recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Parking
Always come to a complete stop and
continue to depress the brake pedal.
Shift to the P (Park) position, apply
the parking brake, and place the
POWER button in the OFF position.
Take the Key with you when exiting
the vehicle.
5
Driving your vehicle
5-13
Driving your vehicle
LCD display messages
Shifting conditions not met
Press brake pedal to change
gear
Shift to P after stopping
OAEE059105L
OAEE059103L
The message appears on the LCD
display when driving speed is too
fast to shift the gear.
Decrease the vehicle speed or slow
down before shifting the gear.
5-14
OAEE059104L
The message appears on the LCD
display, when the brake pedal is not
depressed while shifting the gear.
Depress the brake pedal and then
shift the gear.
The message appears on the LCD
display when the gear is shifted to P
(Park) while the vehicle is moving.
Stop the vehicle before shifting to P
(Park).
PARK engaged
Gear already selected
Shift button held down
OAEE059110L
OAEE059109L
The message appears on the LCD
display when the selected gear button is pressed again.
The message appears on the LCD
display when the shift button is continuously pressed or there is problem
with the button.
Make sure that there is no object over
the shift button. If the problem persists, we recommend you to immediately have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
5-15
5
Driving your vehicle
OAEE059111L
The message appears on the LCD
display when the P (Park) position is
engaged.
Driving your vehicle
Check shift controls
Good driving practices
OAEE059106L
The message appears on the LCD
display when there is problem with
the shift buttons.
We recommend you to immediately
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer
5-16
• Never shift to P (Park) or N
(Neutral) to any other position with
the accelerator pedal depressed.
• Never shift to P (Park) when the
vehicle is in motion.
Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you attempt to shift
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).
• Do not shift to N (Neutral) when
driving. Doing so may result in an
accident.
• Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
consistent pedal pressure can
result in the brakes overheating,
brake wear and possibly even
brake failure.
• Always apply the parking brake
when leaving the vehicle. Do not
depend on placing the gear in P
(Park) to keep the vehicle from
moving.
• Exercise extreme caution when
driving on a slippery surface. Be
especially careful when braking,
accelerating or shifting gears. Also,
avoid increasing the regenrative
braking level suddenly. On a slippery surface, an abrupt change in
vehicle speed can cause the drive
wheels to lose traction and may
cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident
• Optimum vehicle performance and
economy is obtained by smoothly
depressing and releasing the
accelerator.
WARNING
5
Driving your vehicle
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH:
• ALWAYS wear your seat belt.
In a collision, an unbelted
occupant is significantly more
likely to be seriously injured
or killed than a properly belted occupant.
• Avoid high speeds when cornering or turning.
• Do not make quick steering
wheel movements, such as
sharp lane changes or fast,
sharp turns.
• The risk of rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control
of your vehicle at highway
speeds.
• Loss of control often occurs if
two or more wheels drop off
the roadway and the driver
over steers to reenter the
roadway.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• In the event your vehicle
leaves the roadway, do not
steer sharply. Instead, slow
down before pulling back into
the travel lanes.
• HYUNDAI recommends you
follow all posted speed limits.
5-17
Driving your vehicle
PADDLE SHIFTER (REGENERATIVE BRAKING CONTROL)
What Does Regenerative
Braking Do?
It uses an electric motor when decelerating and braking and transforms
kinetic energy to electrical energy in
order to charge the high voltage battery.
OAEE056003
OAEE049216
The paddle shifter is used to adjust
the regenerative braking rate from 0
to 3 during decelerating or braking.
• Left side (
): Increases regenerative braking and deceleration.
• Right side (
): Decreases
regenerative braking and deceleration.
The selected regenerative braking
rate is displayed on the instrument
cluster.
i Information
The paddle shifter does not operate
when:
• The [
] and [
] paddle
shifters are pulled at the same time.
• The Cruise Control system or
Advanced Cruise Control system is
activated.
5-18
nitial setting of the regenerative braking level and adjustable range vary
according to the selected Drive
mode.
Drive mode Initial setting
Adjustable
Range
ECO+
2
0-3
ECO
2
0-3
NORMAL
1
0-3
SPORT
1
0-3
Automatic engagement of EPB
The driver can stop the vehicle by
pulling and holding the left side paddle shifter.
After the vehicle is stopped by the
One Pedal Driving function, EPB is
automatically engaged when any of
these conditions occur:
• The driver's door is open
• The driver's seatbelt is unfastened.
• The hood is open
• The tailgate is open.
• 5 minutes have passed after the
vehicle has stopped.
• The system operation is limited
due to other reasons.
Operating Conditions
The system enters the operating
condition when the conditions below
are met:
• The driver's door is closed.
• The driver's seat belt is fastened.
To operate:
• Pull and hold the left side paddle
shifter while coasting.
• When the vehicle speed is above 3
km/h, release the paddle shifter to
return to the previously set level.
• When the vehicle speed is below 3
km/h, the function maintains control to stop the vehicle even though
the paddle shifter is released.
• While the One pedal driving is in
activation, the driver can control
the vehicle stopping position using
the accelerator pedal.
WARNING
Stopping the vehicle may not be
possible according to the vehicle and road conditions. Pay
attention to the road condition
ahead and apply the brake if
necessary.
5-19
5
Driving your vehicle
For more details, refer to "Drive
Mode Integrated Control System"
in this chapter.
One pedal driving
Driving your vehicle
SMART RECUPERATION SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED WITH SMART CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM)
The Smart Recuperation System
controls the regenerative braking
automatically according to the road
gradient and driving condition of the
vehicle in front. The system minimizes the unnecessary operation of
the brake and acceleration pedal,
improving the fuel efficiency and
assisting the driver.
System setting
The Smart Recuperation System
enters the ready status when:
The gear is in P (Park) and select
'User settings → Convenience →
Smart recuperation' on the User
Settings mode.
The setting is maintained when the
vehicle is restarted.
5-20
To activate Smart
Recuperation System
With 'AUTO' for the regenerative
braking level displayed on the cluster, the regenerative braking level is
controlled automatically when vehicle speed is above 10 km/h (6 mph)
and one of the condition below is
met.
- The road gradient changes
- Distance from the vehicle ahead
reduces or increases
- Speed of the vehicle ahead
reduces or increases
WARNING
When vehicle speed is under 10
km/h (6 mph), the Smart
Recuperation System is cancelled. The driver must adjust
the vehicle speed by depressing the accelerator or brake
pedal according to the road
condition ahead and driving
condition.
OAEE049671
When the system is turned on from
the User Settings mode, but the front
radar doesn't recognize the vehicle
in front, 'AUTO' is displayed in white.
WARNING
OAEE049671L
• Cancelled manually
Pulling and holding the right side
paddle shifter for more than 1 second.
The Smart Recuperation System
turns off temporarily and AUTO for
the regenerative braking level disappears from the cluster.
• Cancelled automatically
- The vehicle is shifted to N
(Neutral), R (Reverse) or P
(Park).
- The Cruise Control System
(including the Smart Cruise
Control system) is in activation.
- The ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) or ABS is operating.
5-21
5
Driving your vehicle
If the front radar recognizes the vehicle in front, 'AUTO' is displayed in
blue. The regenerative braking level
is automatically controlled depending on the driving condition of the
vehicle in front and the level is indicated with arrows.
However, current regenerative braking level is maintained if the driver
depresses the brake pedal while the
system is in activation. Also, the system is cancelled temporarily if the
accelerator pedal is depressed.
The
Smart
Recuperation
System which automatically
controls the regenerative braking level when coasting is only
a supplemental system for the
driver's convenience. The system cannot completely stop the
vehicle nor avoid all collisions.
The brake control may be insufficient depending on the speed
of the vehicle in front and when
the vehicle in front suddenly
stops, a vehicle cuts in suddenly and there is a steep slope.
Always look ahead cautiously
to prevent unexpected and sudden situations from occurring.
Smart Recuperation System
will be temporarily cancelled
when:
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
When the Smart Recuperation
System is cancelled automatically, adjust the vehicle speed
directly by depressing the
accelerator or brake pedal
according to the road condition
ahead and driving condition.
To resume Smart
Recuperation System
To re-activate the Smart Recuperation
System while driving, pull and hold the
right side paddle shifter for more than
1 second again. Then, AUTO for the
regenerative braking level will appear
on the cluster.
To turn Smart Recuperation
System off
To turn off the system, shift to P
(Park) and deselect 'User settings →
Convenience → Smart recuperation'
on the User Settings mode.
Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance
recognition sensor
(Front radar)
In order for the Smart Recuperation
System to operate properly, always
make sure the radar sensor cover is
clean and free of dirt, snow, and
debris. Dirt, snow, or foreign substances on the lens may adversely
affect the sensing performance of
the sensor. In this case, the system
operation may stop temporarily and
not operate normally.
CAUTION
• Do not apply license plate
frame or foreign objects such
as a bumper sticker or a
bumper guard near the radar
sensor. Doing so may adversely affect the sensing performance of the radar.
• Always keep the radar sensor
and lens cover clean and free
of dirt and debris.
(Continued)
5-22
System malfunction
Limitations of the system
The Smart Recuperation System
may not operate properly in certain
situations when the driving condition
is beyond the performance of the
front radar sensor.
Driver's attention is required in such
cases when the system does not
react properly or operate unintentionally.
OOSEV048204L
5
Check Smart Recuperation system
The message will appear when the
system is not functioning normally.
The system will be cancelled and the
word 'AUTO' on the cluster will disappear and instead display regenerative braking level. Check for foreign
substances on the front radar.
Remove any dirt, snow, or foreign
material that could interfere with the
radar sensors. If the system still does
not operate normally, we recommend
that you take your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the system checked.
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• Use only a soft cloth to wash
the vehicle. Do not spray pressurized water directly on the
sensor or sensor cover.
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary force on the radar sensor or sensor cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved out of
proper alignment, the Smart
Recuperation System may not
operate correctly. In this case,
a warning message may not be
displayed. We recommend that
the vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the front bumper becomes
damaged in the area around
the radar sensor, the Smart
Recuperation System may not
operate properly. We recommend that the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Use only genuine HYUNDAI
parts to repair or replace a
damaged sensor or sensor
cover. Do not apply paint to
the sensor cover.
5-23
Driving your vehicle
On curves
On inclines
OAD058166L
OAD058165L
When coasting on the curve, the system may not detect the vehicle in
your lane and the regenerative braking level will reduce automatically,
making you feel that the vehicle is
accelerating.
Also, if the system suddenly recognizes the vehicle in front, the regenerative braking level will increase
automatically, making you feel that
the vehicle is decelerating.
The driver must maintain a safe braking distance, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to maintain a safe distance.
5-24
Your vehicle speed can be reduced
due to a vehicle in the adjacent lane.
Apply the accelerator pedal and
select the appropriate speed. Check
to be sure that the road conditions
permit safe operation of the Smart
Recuperation System.
OAEE059617
When coasting on an uphill or downhill, the system may not detect the
vehicle in your lane and the regenerative braking level will reduce automatically, making you feel that the
vehicle is accelerating.
Also, if the system suddenly recognizes the vehicle in front, the regenerative braking level will increase
automatically, making you feel that
the vehicle is decelerating.
The driver must maintain a safe braking distance, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to maintain a safe distance.
Lane changing
Vehicle recognition
OAD058173N
Some vehicles in your lane cannot
be recognized by the sensor:
- Narrow vehicles such as motorcycles or bicycles
- Vehicles offset to one side
- Slow-moving vehicles or suddendecelerating vehicles
- Stopped vehicles (When the vehicle ahead drives away, the system
may not detect a stopped vehicle.)
- Vehicles with small rear profile
such as trailers with no loads
5
Driving your vehicle
OAD058167L
• A vehicle which moves into your
lane from an adjacent lane cannot
be recognized by the sensor until it
is in the sensor's detection range.
• The radar may not detect immediately when a vehicle cuts in suddenly. Always pay attention to the
traffic, road and driving conditions.
A vehicle ahead cannot be recognized correctly by the sensor if any of
following occurs:
- When the vehicle is pointing
upwards due to overloading in the
luggage compartment
- While the steering wheel is operating
- When driving to one side of the
lane
- When driving on narrow lanes or
on curves
Apply the brake or accelerator pedal
if necessary.
5-25
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
When
using
the
Smart
Recuperation System take the
following precautions:
• If an emergency stop is necessary, you must apply the
brakes.
• Keep a safe distance according to road conditions and
vehicle speed. If the vehicle to
vehicle distance is too close
during a high-speed driving, a
serious collision may result.
• Always maintain sufficient
braking distance and decelerate your vehicle by applying
the brakes if necessary.
• The Smart Recuperation
System cannot recognize a
stopped vehicle, pedestrians
or an oncoming vehicle.
Always look ahead cautiously
to prevent unexpected and
sudden situations from occurring.
(Continued)
5-26
(Continued)
• Vehicles moving in front of
you with a frequent lane
change may cause a delay in
the system's reaction or may
cause the system to react to a
vehicle actually in an adjacent
lane. Always drive cautiously
to prevent unexpected and
sudden situations from occurring.
• The Smart Recuperation
System may not recognize
complex driving situations so
always pay attention to driving conditions and control
your vehicle speed.
NOTICE
The Smart Recuperation System
may not operate temporarily due
to:
• Electrical interference
• Modifying the suspension
• Differences of tire abrasion or
tire pressure
• Installing different type of tires
BRAKING SYSTEM
Power brakes
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
• Do not drive with your foot
resting on the brake pedal.
This will create abnormal high
brake temperatures, excessive brake lining and pad
wear, and increased stopping
distances.
• When descending down a
long or steep hill, use the paddle shifter (left side lever) to
increase regenerative braking
control in order to control
your speed without using the
brake pedal excessively.
Applying the brakes continuously will cause the brakes to
overheat and could result in a
temporary loss of braking performance.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Wet brakes may impair the
vehicle's ability to safely slow
down; the vehicle may also
pull to one side when the
brakes are applied. Applying
the brakes lightly will indicate
whether they have been
affected in this way. Always
test your brakes in this fashion after driving through deep
water. To dry the brakes, lightly tap the brake pedal to heat
up the brakes while maintaining a safe forward speed until
brake performance returns to
normal. Avoid driving at high
speeds until the brakes function correctly.
5-27
5
Driving your vehicle
Your vehicle has power-assisted
brakes that adjust automatically
through normal usage.
If the vehicle is not in the ready
(
) mode or the vehicle is turned
off while driving, the power assist for
the brakes will not work. You can still
stop your vehicle by applying greater
force to the brake pedal than typical.
The stopping distance, however, will
be longer than with power brakes.
When the vehicle is not in the ready
(
) mode, the reserve brake
power is partially depleted each time
the brake pedal is applied. Do not
pump the brake pedal when the
power assist has been interrupted.
Pump the brake pedal only when
necessary to maintain steering control on slippery surfaces.
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
• Do not continue depressing the
brake pedal if the "
" indicator is OFF. The battery may be
discharged.
• Noise and vibration generated
during braking is normal.
• Under normal operation, electric
brake pump noise and motor
vibration may occur temporarily
in below cases.
- When the pedal is depressed
suddenly.
- When the pedal is repeatedly
depressed in short intervals.
- When the ABS function is activated while braking.
Disc brakes wear indicator
When your brake pads are worn and
new pads are required, you will hear
a high pitched warning sound from
your front or rear brakes. You may
hear this sound come and go or it
may occur whenever you depress
the brake pedal.
Note that some driving conditions or
climates may cause a brake squeal
when you first apply (or lightly apply)
the brakes. This is normal and does
not indicate a problem with your
brakes.
NOTICE
To avoid costly brake repairs, do
not continue to drive with worn
brake pads.
i Information
Always replace brake pads as complete front or rear axle sets.
5-28
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
Applying the parking brake
OAEE059004
To apply the Electronic Parking
Brake (EPB) manually:
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Pull the EPB switch upwards.
Make sure the Parking Brake
Warning Light comes on.
With the AUTO HOLD feature
enabled, the EPB is automatically
applied when the vehicle is shut off.
However, if the EPB switch is
pressed within 1 second after the
vehicle is turned off, the EPB will not
be applied.
WARNING
Releasing the parking brake
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, do not operate the parking brake while the
vehicle is moving except in an
emergency situation. It could
damage the brake system and
lead to an accident.
OAEE059005
5-29
5
Driving your vehicle
To release the Electronic Parking
Brake (EPB) manually:
• Have the POWER button in the ON
position.
• Depress the brake pedal.
• Press the EPB switch.
Make sure the Parking Brake
Warning Light goes off.
To release the Electronic Parking
Brake (EPB) automatically:
• Shifted to P (Park)
With the vehicle in the ready (
)
mode depress the brake pedal and
shift out of P (Park) to R (Reverse)
or D (Drive).
• Shifted to N (Neutral)
With the vehicle in the ready (
)
mode depress the brake pedal and
shift out of N (Neutral) to R
(Reverse) or D (Drive).
• Under the following conditions
1. Start the vehicle.
2. Fasten the driver's seat belt.
3. Close the driver's door, hood
and tailgate.
4. Depress the accelerator pedal
while the gear is in D (Drive) or
R (Reverse).
The Parking Brake Warning Light
should be turned off when the EPB is
released.
Driving your vehicle
i Information
• For your safety, you can engage the
EPB even though the POWER button is in the OFF position, but you
cannot release it.
• For your safety, depress the brake
pedal and release the parking brake
manually with the EPB switch when
you drive downhill or when backing
up the vehicle.
NOTICE
• If the parking brake warning light
is still on even though the EPB
has been released, we recommend that the system be
checked an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
• Do not drive your vehicle with
the EPB applied. It may cause
excessive brake pad and brake
rotor wear.
5-30
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
may be automatically applied
when:
• Requested by other systems
• The vehicle is turned off with the
EPB applied
Warning messages
i Information
If the driver turns the vehicle off while
Auto Hold is operating, EPB will be
automatically applied. However, if
you press the EPB switch within one
second after the vehicle is turned off,
the EPB will not be applied.
OTM058132L
To release EPB, fasten seatbelt,
close door, hood, and tailgate
• If you try to drive with the EPB
applied, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
• If the driver's seat belt is not fastened and the hood or tailgate is
opened, a warning will sound and
a message will appear.
• If there is a problem with the vehicle, a warning may sound and a
message may appear.
If the situation occurs, depress the
brake pedal and release EPB by
pressing the EPB switch.
WARNING
• To prevent unintentional move-
• A click sound may be heard
while operating or releasing the
EPB, but these conditions are
normal and indicate that the
EPB is functioning properly.
• When leaving your keys with a
parking lot attendant or valet,
make sure to inform him/her
how to operate the EPB.
• The EPB may malfunction if you
drive with the EPB applied.
• When you automatically release
EPB by depressing the accelerator pedal, depress it slowly.
OOSEV058098L/OAEPH059648L
Deactivating AUTO HOLD...
Press brake pedal/
Turning off AUTO HOLD.
Press brake pedal
When the conversion from Auto Hold
to EPB is not working properly a
warning will sound and a message
will appear.
5-31
5
Driving your vehicle
ment when stopped and leaving the vehicle, do not use the
P (Park) position in place of the
parking brake. Set the parking
brake and make sure the vehicle is securely positioned in P
(Park).
• Never allow anyone who is
unfamiliar with the vehicle to
touch the parking brake. If the
parking brake is released
unintentionally, serious injury
may occur.
• All vehicles should always
have the parking brake fully
engaged when parking to
avoid inadvertent movement
of the car which can injure
occupants or pedestrians.
NOTICE
Driving your vehicle
EPB malfunction indicator
The EPB malfunction indicator may
illuminate when the ESC (Electronic
Stability Control) indicator comes on
to indicate that the ESC is not working properly, but it does not indicate a
malfunction of the EPB.
NOTICE
OOSEV058099L
Parking brake automatically applied
If the EPB is applied while Auto Hold
is activated, a warning will sound and
a message will appear.
5-32
OAEE059006
This warning light illuminates if the
POWER button is changed to the ON
position and goes off in approximately 3 seconds if the system is operating normally.
If the EPB malfunction indicator
remains on, comes on while driving,
or does not come on when the
POWER button is changed to the ON
position, this indicates that the EPB
may have malfunctioned.
If this occurs, we recommend that
the system be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the EPB warning light is still
on, we recommend that the system be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the parking brake warning
light does not illuminate or
blinks even though the EPB
switch was pulled up, the EPB
may not be applied.
• If the parking brake warning light
blinks when the EPB warning
light is on, press the switch, then
pull it up. Once more press it
back to its original position and
pull it back up. If the EPB warning
does not go off, we recommend
that the system be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Emergency braking
If there is a problem with the brake
pedal while driving, emergency braking is possible by pulling up and
holding the EPB switch. Braking is
possible only while you are holding
the EPB switch.
WARNING
Do not operate the parking
brake while the vehicle is moving except in an emergency situation.
NOTICE
If you continuously notice a noise
or burning smell when the EPB is
used for emergency braking, we
recommend that the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Auto hold (if equipped)
The Auto Hold maintains the vehicle
in a standstill even though the brake
pedal is not depressed after the driver brings the vehicle to a complete
stop by depressing the brake pedal.
Set up
White
5
i Information
During emergency braking by the
EPB, the parking brake warning light
will illuminate to indicate that the system is operating.
OAEE059007
1. With the driver's door and hood
closed, fasten the driver's seat
belt or depress the brake pedal
and then press the [AUTO HOLD]
switch. The white AUTO HOLD
indicator will come on and the system will be in the standby position.
5-33
Driving your vehicle
When the EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake) does not release
If the EPB does not release normally, we recommend that you contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer by
loading the vehicle on a flatbed tow
truck and have the system checked.
Driving your vehicle
White
Green
OAEE059008
2. When you stop the vehicle completely by depressing the brake
pedal, the AUTO HOLD indicator
changes from white to green.
3. The vehicle will remain stationary
even if you release the brake
pedal.
4. If EPB is applied, Auto Hold will be
released.
5-34
Leaving
• If you press the accelerator pedal
with the gear in D (Drive) or R
(Reverse), the Auto Hold will be
released automatically and the
vehicle will start to move. The
AUTO HOLD indicator changes
from green to white.
• If the vehicle is restarted using the
cruise control toggle switch (RES+
or SET-) while Auto Hold and cruise
control is operating, the Auto Hold
will be released regardless of
accelerator pedal operation. The
AUTO HOLD indicator changes
from green to white. (if equipped
with cruise control system)
WARNING
When driving off from Auto
Hold by depressing the accelerator pedal, always check the
surrounding area near your
vehicle.
Slowly depress the accelerator
pedal for a smooth start.
Cancel
Light off
OAEE059009
To cancel the Auto Hold operation,
press the [AUTO HOLD] switch. The
AUTO HOLD indicator will turn off.
To cancel the Auto Hold operation
when the vehicle is at a standstill,
press the [AUTO HOLD] switch while
depressing the brake pedal.
i Information
WARNING
• Depress the accelerator pedal
slowly when you start the
vehicle.
• For your safety, cancel the
Auto Hold when you drive
downhill, back up the vehicle
or park the vehicle.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the
driver's door or hood open detection system, the Auto Hold may
not work properly.
We recommend that you contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-35
5
Driving your vehicle
• The Auto Hold does not operate
when:
- The driver's seat belt is unfastened
and driver's door is opened
- The hood is opened
- The gear is in P (Park)
- The EPB is applied
- The tailgate is opened
• For your safety, the Auto Hold automatically switches to EPB in such
cases:
- The driver's door is opened
- The hood is opened while the gear
is in D (Drive)
- The vehicle is in a standstill for
more than 10 minutes
- The vehicle is standing on a steep
slope
- The vehicle moved several times
- The tailgate is opened while the
gear is in R (Reverse)
(Continued)
(Continued)
In these cases, the parking brake
warning light comes on, the AUTO
HOLD indicator changes from green
to white, and a warning sounds and
a message will appear to inform you
that EPB has been automatically
engaged. Before driving again,
depress the brake pedal, check the
surrounding area near your vehicle
and release the parking brake manually with the EPB switch.
• If the AUTO HOLD indicator lights
up yellow, the Auto Hold is not
working properly. We recommend
that you contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• While operating Auto Hold, you may
hear mechanical noise. However, it is
normal operating noise.
Driving your vehicle
Warning messages
OOSEV058099L
Parking brake automatically applied
When the EPB is applied from Auto
Hold, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
5-36
OOSEV058098L/OAEPH059648L
OIK057080L
Deactivating AUTO HOLD...
Press brake pedal/
Turning off AUTO HOLD.
Press brake pedal
When the conversion from Auto Hold
to EPB is not working properly a
warning will sound and a message
will appear.
Depress the brake pedal when the
above message appears for the Auto
Hold and EPB may not activate.
Press brake pedal to deactivate
AUTO HOLD
If you did not apply the brake pedal
when you release the Auto Hold by
pressing the [AUTO HOLD] switch, a
warning will sound and a message
will appear.
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
WARNING
OAEE059680L
5
ABS is an electronic braking system
that helps prevent a braking skid.
ABS allows the driver to steer and
brake at the same time.
5-37
Driving your vehicle
AUTO HOLD conditions not met.
Close door, hood and tailgate
When you press the [AUTO HOLD]
switch, if the driver's door, hood and
tailgate are not closed, a warning will
sound and a message will appear on
the cluster LCD display.
Press the [AUTO HOLD] switch after
closing the driver's door, hood and
tailgate.
An Anti-Lock Braking System
(ABS) or an Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) system will not
prevent accidents due to
improper or dangerous driving
maneuvers. Even though vehicle control is improved during
emergency braking, always
maintain a safe distance
between you and objects ahead
of you. Vehicle speeds should
always be reduced during
extreme road conditions. The
braking distance for cars
equipped with ABS or ESC may
be longer than for those without
these systems in the following
road conditions.
Drive your vehicle at reduced
speeds during the following
conditions:
• Rough, gravel or snow-covered roads.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• On roads where the road surface is pitted or has different
surface height.
• Tire chains are installed on
your vehicle.
The safety features of an ABS
or ESC equipped vehicle should
not be tested by high speed
driving or cornering. This could
endanger the safety of yourself
or others.
Driving your vehicle
Using ABS
To obtain the maximum benefit from
your ABS in an emergency situation,
do not attempt to modulate your
brake pressure and do not try to
pump your brakes. Depress your
brake pedal as hard as possible.
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the
wheels, you may hear sounds from
the brakes, or feel a corresponding
sensation in the brake pedal. This is
normal and it means your ABS is
active.
ABS does not reduce the time or distance it takes to stop the vehicle.
Always maintain a safe distance from
the vehicle in front of you.
ABS will not prevent a skid that
results from sudden changes in
direction, such as trying to take a
corner too fast or making a sudden
lane change. Always drive at a safe
speed for the road and weather conditions.
5-38
ABS cannot prevent a loss of stability. Always steer moderately when
braking hard. Severe or sharp steering wheel movement can still cause
your vehicle to veer into oncoming
traffic or off the road.
On loose or uneven road surfaces,
operation of the anti-lock brake system may result in a longer stopping
distance than for vehicles equipped
with a conventional brake system.
The ABS warning light (
) will stay
on for several seconds after the
POWER button is in the ON position.
During that time, the ABS will go
through self-diagnosis and the light
will go off if everything is normal. If
the light stays on, you may have a
problem with your ABS. We recommend that you contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
WARNING
If the ABS warning light (
) is
on and stays on, you may have
a problem with the ABS. Your
power brakes will work normally. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death, we recommend
that you contact your HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
NOTICE
When you jump start your vehicle
because of a drained battery, the ABS
warning light (
) may turn on at the
same time. This happens because of
the low battery voltage. It does not
mean your ABS is malfunctioning.
Have the battery recharged before
driving the vehicle.
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC)
■ Type A
OAEE059016L
■ Type B
5
OAEE059025L
The Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system helps to stabilize the
vehicle during cornering maneuvers.
5-39
Driving your vehicle
When you drive on a road having
poor traction, such as an icy road,
and apply your brakes continuously, the ABS will be active continuously and the ABS warning
light (
) may illuminate. Pull
your car over to a safe place and
turn the vehicle off.
Restart the vehicle. If the ABS
warning light is off, then your ABS
system is normal.
Otherwise, you may have a problem with your ABS system. We
recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
i Information
Driving your vehicle
ESC checks where you are steering
and where the vehicle is actually
going. ESC applies braking pressure
to any one of the vehicle's brakes
and intervenes in the electric vehicle
control system to assist the driver
with keeping the vehicle on the
intended path. It is not a substitute
for safe driving practices. Always
adjust your speed and driving to the
road conditions.
WARNING
Never drive too fast for the road
conditions or too quickly when
cornering. The ESC system will
not prevent accidents.
Excessive speed in turns,
abrupt
maneuvers,
and
hydroplaning on wet surfaces
can result in severe accidents.
5-40
ESC operation
ESC ON condition
When the POWER button is in the
ON position, the ESC and the ESC
OFF indicator lights illuminate for
approximately three seconds. After
both lights go off, the ESC is
enabled.
When operating
When the ESC is in operation, the ESC indicator light
blinks:
• When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the
wheels, you may hear sounds from
the brakes, or feel a corresponding
sensation in the brake pedal. This is
normal and it means your ESC is
active.
• When the ESC activates, the vehicle may not respond to the accelerator as it does under routine conditions.
• If the Cruise Control was in use
when the ESC activates, the Cruise
Control automatically disengages.
The Cruise Control can be reengaged when the road conditions
allow. See "Cruise Control System"
later in this chapter. (if equipped)
ESC OFF condition
To cancel ESC operation :
Indicator lights
• State 2
■ ESC indicator light (blinks)
• State 1
■ ESC OFF indicator light (comes on)
OAEPH059019L
Press the ESC OFF button briefly.
The ESC OFF indicator light and/or
message "Traction Control disabled"
will illuminate. In this state, the traction control function of ESC is disabled, but the brake control function
of ESC still operates.
When the POWER button is pressed
to the ON position, the ESC indicator
light illuminates, then goes off if the
ESC system is operating normally.
The ESC indicator light blinks whenever the ESC is operating.
If the ESC indicator light stays on,
your vehicle may have a malfunction
with the ESC system. When this
warning light illuminates we recommend that the vehicle be checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
The ESC OFF indicator light comes
on when the ESC is turned off with
the button.
5-41
5
Driving your vehicle
OAEPH059017L
Press and hold the ESC OFF button
continuously for more than 3 seconds. The ESC OFF indicator light
and/or message "Traction & Stability
Control disabled" illuminates and a
warning chime sounds. In this state,
both the traction control function of
ESC and the brake control function
of ESC are disabled.
If the POWER button is placed to the
OFF position when ESC is off, ESC
remains off. Upon restarting the vehicle, the ESC will automatically turn
on again.
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
When the ESC is blinking, this
indicates the ESC is active:
Drive slowly and NEVER attempt
to accelerate. NEVER turn the
ESC off while the ESC indicator
light is blinking or you may lose
control of the vehicle resulting in
an accident.
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC
system to malfunction. Before
replacing tires, make sure all four
tires and wheels are the same
size. Never drive the vehicle with
different sized wheels and tires
installed.
5-42
ESC OFF usage
When Driving
The ESC OFF mode should only be
used briefly to help free the vehicle if
stuck in snow or mud, by temporarily
stopping operation of the ESC, to
maintain wheel torque.
To turn ESC off while driving, press
the ESC OFF button while driving on
a flat road surface.
NOTICE
• Do not allow wheel(s) of one
axle to spin excessively while
the ESC, ABS, and parking brake
warning lights are displayed.
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Reduce vehicle power and do
not spin the wheel(s) excessively while these lights are displayed.
• When operating the vehicle on a
dynamometer, make sure the
ESC is turned off (ESC OFF light
illuminated).
i Information
Turning the ESC off does not affect
ABS or standard brake system operation.
Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM)
VSM operation
VSM ON condition
The Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM) is a function of the Electronic
Stability Control (ESC) system. It
helps ensure the vehicle stays stable
when accelerating or braking suddenly on wet, slippery and rough
roads where traction over the four
tires can suddenly become uneven.
The VSM operates when:
• The Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) is on.
• Vehicle speed is approximately
above 15 km/h (9 mph) on curve
roads.
• Vehicle speed is approximately
above 20 km/h (12 mph) when the
vehicle is braking on rough roads.
WARNING
5
When operating
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may activate the
ESC, you may hear sounds from the
brakes, or feel a corresponding sensation in the brake pedal. This is normal and it means your VSM is active.
Driving your vehicle
Take the following precautions
when using the Vehicle Stability
Management (VSM):
• ALWAYS check the speed and
the distance to the vehicle
ahead.The VSM is not a substitute for safe driving practices.
• Never drive too fast for the
road conditions. The VSM system will not prevent accidents. Excessive speed in bad
weather, slippery and uneven
roads can result in severe
accidents.
i Information
The VSM does not operate when:
• Driving on a banked road such as a
gradient or incline.
• Driving in reverse.
• The ESC OFF indicator light is on.
• The EPS (Electric power steering)
warning light ( ) is on or blinks.
5-43
Driving your vehicle
VSM OFF condition
To cancel VSM operation, press the
ESC OFF button. ESC OFF indicator
light ( ) will illuminate.
To turn on VSM, press the ESC OFF
button again. The ESC OFF indicator
light will go out.
WARNING
If the ESC indicator light ( ) or
EPS warning light (
) stays
on or blinks, your vehicle may
have a malfunction with the
VSM system. When the warning
light illuminates we recommend
that the vehicle be checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC
system to malfunction. Before
replacing tires, make sure all four
tires and wheels are the same
size. Never drive the vehicle with
different sized tires and wheels
installed.
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
The Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
helps prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards when starting a vehicle
from a stop on a hill. The system
operates the brakes automatically for
approximately 2 seconds and releases the brake after 2 seconds or when
the accelerator pedal is depressed.
WARNING
Always be ready to depress the
accelerator pedal when starting
off an incline. The HAC activates
only for approximately 2 seconds.
i Information
• The HAC does not operate when the
gear is in P (Park) or N (Neutral).
• The HAC activates even when the
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
off. However, it does not activate,
when the ESC does not operate normally.
5-44
Good braking practices
WARNING
Wet brakes can be dangerous! The
brakes may get wet if the vehicle is
driven through standing water or if it
is washed. Your vehicle will not stop
as quickly if the brakes are wet. Wet
brakes may cause the vehicle to pull
to one side.
5
Driving your vehicle
Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete stop and continue to
depress the brake pedal. Shift
to the P (Park) position, then
apply the parking brake, and
place the POWER button in the
OFF position.
Vehicles parked with the parking brake not applied or not
fully engaged may roll inadvertently and may cause injury to
the driver and others. ALWAYS
apply the parking brake before
exiting the vehicle.
To dry the brakes, apply the brakes
lightly until the braking action returns
to normal. If the braking action does
not return to normal, stop as soon as
it is safe to do so and we recommend
that you call an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer for assistance.
DO NOT drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
constant pedal pressure can result in
the brakes overheating, brake wear,
and possibly even brake failure.
If a tire goes flat while you are driving, apply the brakes gently and
keep the vehicle pointed straight
ahead while you slow down. When
you are moving slowly enough for it
to be safe to do so, pull off the road
and stop in a safe location.
Keep your foot firmly on the brake
pedal when the vehicle is stopped to
prevent the vehicle from rolling forward.
5-45
Driving your vehicle
DRIVE MODE INTEGRATED CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
Drive mode
Initial setting for each Drive Mode
OAEE059010
The drive mode may be selected
according to the driver's preference
or road condition.
• The mode changes, as below,
whenever the DRIVE MODE button is pressed.
NORMAL
SPORT
ECO
• Press and hold the DRIVE MODE
button to select ECO+ mode.
5-46
Drive mode
NORMAL
SPORT
ECO
ECO+ *1
Feature
Normal driving
mode
Sporty driving
mode
Optimal for
eco- driving
Ultra power
saving driving
mode
Button activation
Press
Press
Press
Press and hold
Indicator on the
cluster
-
Air conditioner/
heater system
control
NORMAL
(ECO/
NORMAL) *2
NORMAL
(ECO/
NORMAL) *2
ECO
Off
Speed limit
-
-
(90~130 km/h) *2
Below 90 km/h
Regenerative
braking level
1 (1~3) *2
1 (1~3) *2
2 (1~3) *2
2
*1 : Change to ECO+ mode
- Distance to empty may not change when the air conditioner/heater system is off. However,
actual distance may be extended.
- Air conditioner/heater system turns off (except the defroster) but you may turn it on if necessary.
- When the drive mode is switched from the ECO+ mode to a different mode, it is changed to
air conditioner/heater operation status of the ECO mode.
- The speed limit is automatically deactivated when the Smart Cruise Control system is in activation or the accelerator pedal is depressed to the end. If speed limit function is deactivated
by depressing the accelerator pedal, the speed limit function will reactivate when vehicle
speed is lower than the set speed limit. Also, the speed is changed to the speed set at ECO
mode when the drive mode switches from the ECO+ mode to ECO mode.
*2 : It is possible to set the driving condition for each drive mode (except the ECO+ mode) at the
drive mode setting in the Audio and AVN system. For more information, refer to the separately supplied manual.
FORWARD COLLISION-AVOIDANCE ASSIST (FCA) SYSTEM - SENSOR FUSION TYPE
DAR) (IF EQUIPPED)
(FRONT VIEW CAMERA + FRONT RAD
The Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA) system is designed to
help detect and monitor the vehicle
ahead or detect a pedestrian or
cyclists in the roadway through front
radar signals and front view camera
recognition to warn the driver that a
collision is imminent, and if necessary, apply emergency braking.
WARNING
5
OAEPH059649L
• Setting Forward Safety function
- The driver can activate the FCA
by placing the ignition switch to
the ON position and by selecting:
'User settings → Driver assistance → Forward safety'
- If you select 'Active assist', the
FCA system activates. The FCA
produces warning messages and
warning alarms in accordance
with the collision risk levels.
Braking assist will be applied in
accordance with the collision risk.
5-47
Driving your vehicle
Take the following precautions
when using the Forward
Collision-Avoidance
Assist
(FCA) system:
• This system is only a supplemental system and it is not
intended to, nor does it
replace the need for extreme
care and attention of the driver. The sensing range and
objects detectable by the sensors are limited. Pay attention
to the road conditions at all
times.
• Drive at posted speed limits
and accordance to road conditions.
• Always drive cautiously to
prevent unexpected and sudden situations from occurring. The FCA system may not
always stop the vehicle completely and is only intended to
help mitigate a collision that
is imminent.
System setting and activation
System setting
Driving your vehicle
- If you select 'Warning only', the
FCA system activates and produces only warning alarms in
accordance with the collision risk
levels. Braking assist will not be
applied in this setting.
- If you select 'Off', the FCA system
deactivates,
The warning light illuminates on the instrument
cluster, when you cancel
the FCA system. The
driver can monitor the FCA ON/OFF
status on the LCD display. Also, the
warning light illuminates when the
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
turned off.
- If the warning light remains ON
when the FCA is activated, we recommend that you have the system
checked
by
an
authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
5-48
OAEPH059650L
• Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time from the
User Settings in the cluster LCD
display by selecting 'User settings
→ Driver assistance → Warning
timing → Normal/Later'.
The options for the initial Forward
Collision Warning includes the following:
- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Forward Collision Warning is
activated sensitively. If you feel the
warning activates too early, set the
Forward Collision Warning to
'Later'.
Even though, 'Normal' is selected if
the front vehicle suddenly stops
the initial warning activation time
may not seem fast.
- Later:
When this option is selected, the
initial Forward Collision Warning is
activated later than normal. This
setting reduces the amount of distance between the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist ahead before the initial warning occurs.
Select 'Later' when traffic is light
and when driving speed is slow.
When you accelerate suddenly to
the vehicle ahead, the warning
may seem to activate earlier even if
‘Later’ is selected.
i Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning timing of other systems may
change. Always be aware before
changing the warning timing.
Prerequisite for activation
WARNING
• To avoid driver distractions,
do not attempt to set or cancel the FCA while driving the
vehicle. Always completely
stop the vehicle at a safe
place before setting or canceling the system.
• The FCA automatically activates upon placing the POWER
button to the ON position. The
driver can deactivate the FCA
by canceling the system setting on the cluster LCD display.
• The FCA automatically deactivates upon canceling the ESC
(Electronic Stability Control).
When the ESC is canceled, the
FCA cannot be activated on
the LCD display. In this situation, the FCA warning light will
illuminate which is normal.
FCA warning message and
brake control
FCA produces warning messages,
warning alarms, and emergency
braking based on the level of risk of
a frontal collision, such as when a
vehicle ahead suddenly brakes, or
the system detects that a collision
with a pedestrian or cyclist (if
equipped) is imminent.
5
Driving your vehicle
The FCA gets ready to be activated,
when 'Active Assist' or 'Warning
Only' under Forward Safety is selected in the cluster LCD display, and
when the following prerequisites are
satisfied.
- ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
is on.
- Vehicle speed is over 8 km/h (5
mph). (The FCA is only activated
within a certain speed range.)
- The system detects a pedestrian,
cyclist (if equipped) or a vehicle in
front, which may collide with your
vehicle. However, FCA may not be
activated or may only sound a
warning alarm depending on the
driving or vehicle conditions.
The FCA may not operate properly
according to the frontal situation,
the direction of pedestrian or
cyclist (if equipped) and speed.
5-49
Driving your vehicle
Collision Warning
(First warning)
OAEPH059587L
This warning message appears on
the LCD display with a warning
chime. Additionally, some vehicle
system intervention occurs to help
decelerate the vehicle.
5-50
• If FCA detects a vehicle in front,
the system operates when your
vehicle speed is between 8 km/h (5
mph) and 180 km/h (110 mph).
Maximum vehicle speed may
decrease depending on the condition of the vehicle ahead and surroundings.
• If FCA detects a pedestrian or
cyclist in front, the system operates
when your vehicle speed is
between 8 km/h (5 mph) and 70
km/h (45 mph). Maximum vehicle
speed may decrease depending
on the condition of the pedestrian
or cyclist ahead and surroundings.
• If you select 'Warning only' for the
system setting, the FCA system
activates and produces only warning alarms in accordance with the
collision risk levels. You should
control the brake directly because
the FCA system will not control the
brake.
Emergency braking
(Second warning)
OAEPH059588L
This warning message appears on
the LCD display with a warning
chime. Additionally, some vehicle
system intervention occurs to help
decelerate the vehicle.
Brake operation
• In an urgent situation, the braking
system enters into the ready status
for prompt reaction against the driver's depressing the brake pedal.
• The FCA provides additional braking power for optimum braking performance, when the driver
depresses the brake pedal.
• The braking control is automatically deactivated, when the driver
sharply depresses the accelerator
pedal, or when the driver abruptly
operates the steering wheel.
• The FCA brake control is automatically canceled, when risk factors
disappear.
CAUTION
• The driver should always use
extreme caution while operating the vehicle, whether or not
there is a warning message or
alarm from the FCA system.
• After the brake control is activated, the driver must immediately depress the brake pedal
and check the surroundings.
The brake activation by the
system lasts for about 2 seconds.
• If any other warning sound
such as seat belt warning
chime is already generated,
the
Forward
CollisionAvoidance Assist (FCA) system warning may not sound.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may prevent occupants from hearing
the system warning sounds.
5-51
5
Driving your vehicle
• If FCA detects a vehicle in front,
the system operates when your
vehicle speed is above 8 km/h (5
mph) and less than or equal to 180
km/h (110 mph). Maximum vehicle
speed may decrease depending
on the condition of the vehicle
ahead and surroundings.
• If FCA detects a pedestrian or
cyclist in front, the system operates
when your vehicle speed is
between 8 km/h (5 mph) or above
and under 70 km/h (45 mph).
Maximum vehicle speed may
decrease depending on the condition of the pedestrian or cyclist
ahead and surroundings.
• If you select 'Warning only' for the
system setting, the FCA system
activates and produces only warning alarms in accordance with the
collision risk levels. You should
control the brake directly because
the FCA system will not control the
brake.
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
The braking control cannot
completely stop the vehicle nor
avoid all collisions. The driver
should hold the responsibility
to safely drive and control the
vehicle.
FCA sensor (Front view
camera+ Front radar)
■ Front view camera
NOTICE
WARNING
The FCA system logic operates
within certain parameters, such
as the distance from the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist (if
equipped) ahead, the speed of
the vehicle ahead, and the driver's vehicle speed. Certain
conditions such as inclement
weather and road conditions
may affect the operation of the
FCA system.
OAEE059013L
■ Front radar
OAEE059654L
WARNING
Never deliberately drive dangerously to activate the system.
5-52
Dirt, snow, or foreign substances on
the sensor cover or sensor may
adversely affect the sensing performance of the sensor.
In order for the FCA system to operate properly, always make sure the
sensor cover or sensor is clean and
free of dirt, snow, and debris.
• Do not apply license plate frame
or foreign objects such as a
bumper sticker or a bumper
guard near the front radar sensor. Doing so may adversely
affect the sensing performance
of the front radar.
• Always keep the front radar sensor and cover clean and free of
dirt and debris.
• Use only a soft cloth to wash the
vehicle. Do not spray pressurized water directly on the sensor
or sensor cover.
(Continued)
NOTICE
• NEVER install any accessories
or stickers on the front windshield, or tint the front windshield.
• NEVER place any reflective
objects (i.e. white paper, mirror)
over the crash pad. Any light
reflection may prevent the system from functioning properly.
• Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera dry.
• NEVER disassemble the camera
assembly, or apply any impact
on the camera assembly.
i Information
We recommend that you have the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer when:
• The windshield glass is replaced.
• The front radar sensor or cover gets
damaged or replaced.
Warning message and warning
light
OOSEV058030L
FCA disabled (Forward Collision
Avoidance Assist). Radar blocked
When the sensor cover is blocked
with dirt, snow, or debris, the FCA
system may not detect other vehicles. If this occurs, a warning message will appear on the LCD display.
Remove any dirt, snow, or debris and
clean the radar sensor cover before
operating the FCA system.
The system will operate normally
when such dirt, snow or debris is
removed.
5-53
5
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary force on the radar sensor or
sensor cover. If the sensor is
forcibly moved out of proper
alignment, the FCA system may
not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may
not be displayed. We recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the front bumper becomes
damaged in the area around the
front radar sensor, the FCA system may not operate properly.
We recommend that you have
the vehicle inspected by authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Use only genuine parts to repair
or replace a damaged sensor or
sensor cover. Do not apply paint
to the sensor cover.
Driving your vehicle
FCA may not properly operate in an
area (e.g. open terrain), where any
substances are not detected after
turning ON the vehicle.
Also, even though a warning message does not appear on the LCD
display, the FCA may not properly
operate.
System malfunction
• The FCA warning message may
appear along with the illumination
of the ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) warning light. Both FCA
warning light and warning message will disappear once the ESC
warning light issue is resolved.
WARNING
The FCA system may not activate according to the road conditions, inclement weather, driving conditions or traffic conditions.
5-54
OAEPH059657L
Check FCA (Forward CollisionAvoidance Asst.) system
• When FCA is not working properly,
the FCA warning light (
) will illuminate and the warning message
will appear for a few seconds. After
the message disappears, the master warning light (
) will illuminate. In this case, we recommend
that you have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
(Continued)
• The brake control not work,
possibly causing a collision, if
a vehicle in front abruptly
stops. Always pay extreme
caution.
• Occupants may get injured, if
the vehicle abruptly stops by
the activated FCA system. Pay
extreme caution.
• The FCA system operates
only when the system detect
vehicles, pedestrian or cyclist
in front of the vehicle.
WARNING
• The FCA system does not
operate when the vehicle is in
reverse.
• The FCA system is not
designed to detect other
objects on the road such as
animals.
(Continued)
5-55
5
Driving your vehicle
• FCA is only a supplemental
system for the driver's convenience. The driver should
hold the responsibility to control the vehicle operation. Do
not solely depend on the FCA
system. Rather, maintain a
safe braking distance, and, if
necessary, depress the brake
pedal to reduce the driving
speed or to stop the vehicle.
• In certain instances and
under certain driving conditions, the FCA system may
activate unintentionally. This
initial
warning
message
appears on the LCD display
with a warning chime.
Also due to sensing limitations, in certain situations, the
front radar sensor or front view
camera recognition system
may not detect the vehicle,
pedestrian or cyclist ahead.
The FCA system may not activate and the warning message
may not be displayed.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Even if there is any problem
with the brake control function of the FCA system, the
vehicle's basic braking performance will operate normally. However, brake control
function for avoiding collision
will not activate.
• If the vehicle in front stops
suddenly, you may have less
control of the brake system.
Therefore, always keep a safe
distance between your vehicle
and the vehicle in front of you.
• The FCA system may activate
during braking and the vehicle may stop suddenly shifting loose objects toward the
passengers. Always keep
loose objects secured.
• The FCA system may not activate if the driver applies the
brake pedal to avoid collision.
(Continued)
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• The FCA system does not
detect vehicles in the opposite lane.
• The FCA system does not
detect cross traffic vehicles
that are approaching.
• The FCA system cannot
detect vehicles that are
stopped vertically to your
vehicle at a intersection or
dead end street.
• The FCA system cannot
detect the cross traffic cyclist
that are approaching.
In these cases, you must maintain a safe braking distance,
and if necessary, depress the
brake pedal to reduce the driving speed in order to maintain a
safe distance or to stop the
vehicle.
5-56
Limitations of the system
Detecting vehicles
The Forward Collision avoidance
assist (FCA) system is designed to
monitor the vehicle ahead or a
pedestrian or cyclist in the roadway
through front view camera and radar
signals recognition to warn the driver
that a collision is imminent, and if
necessary, apply emergency braking.
In certain situations, the front view
camera or the front radar sensor may
not be able to detect the vehicle,
pedestrian or cyclist ahead. In these
cases, the FCA system may not operate normally. The driver must pay
careful attention in the following situations where the FCA operation may
be limited.
The sensor may be limited when:
• The system may not operate for 15
seconds after the vehicle is started
or the front view camera is initialized
• The front view camera or front
radar sensor is covered with a foreign object or debris
• The front view camera lens is contaminated due to tinted, filmed or
coated windshield, damaged
glass, or stuck of foreign matter
(sticker, bug, etc.) on the glass
• Inclement weather such as heavy
rain or snow obscures the field of
view of the front view camera or
front radar sensor
• There is interference by electromagnetic waves
• There is severe irregular reflection
from the front radar sensor
• The front view camera/front radar
sensor recognition is limited
• The vehicle in front is too small to
be detected (for example a motorcycle etc.)
• The vehicle in front is driving erratically
• The vehicle is on unpaved or
uneven rough surfaces, or road
with sudden gradient changes
• The vehicle is driven near areas
containing metal substances as a
construction zone, railroad, etc.
• The vehicle drives inside a building,
such as a basement parking lot
• The front view camera does not
recognize the entire vehicle in front
• The front view camera is damaged
• The brightness outside is too low
such as when the headlamps are
not on at night or the vehicle is
going through a tunnel
• The shadow is on the road by a
median strip, trees, etc.
• The vehicle drives through a tollgate
• The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
• The rear part of the vehicle in front
is not normally visible. (the vehicle
turns in other direction or the vehicle is overturned.)
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
• The sensor recognition changes
suddenly when passing over a
speed bump
• The vehicle in front is moving vertically to the driving direction
• The vehicle in front is stopped vertically
• The vehicle in front is driving
towards your vehicle or reversing
• You are on a roundabout and the
vehicle in front circles
5-57
5
Driving your vehicle
• The vehicle in front is an oversize
vehicle or trailer that is too big to
be detected by the front view camera recognition system (for example a tractor trailer, etc.)
• The front view camera's field of
view is not well illuminated (either
too dark or too much reflection or
too much backlight that obscures
the field of view)
• The vehicle in front does not have
their rear lights or their rear lights
does not turned ON or their rear
lights are located unusually
• The outside brightness changes
suddenly, for example when entering or exiting a tunnel
• Light coming from a street light or
an oncoming vehicle is reflected on
a wet road surface such as a puddle in the road
• The field of view in front is obstructed by sun glare or head light of
oncoming vehicle
• The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
Driving your vehicle
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
OAD058165L
OAD058166L
• Driving on a curve
The performance of Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist system
may be limited when driving on a
curved road.
The front view camera or front
radar sensor recognition system
may not detect the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist traveling in front on
a curved road.
This may result in no alarm and
braking when necessary.
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system may recognize a vehicle or
pedestrian or cyclist in the next lane
or outside the lane when driving on a
curved road.
If this occurs, the system may unnecessarily alarm the driver and apply
the brake.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
5-58
Always keep your eyes forward
while driving upward or downward
on a slope, and, if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain distance.
OAD058167L
• Driving on a slope
The performance of Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist system
may be decreased while driving
upward or downward on a slope.
The front view camera or front
radar sensor recognition may not
detect the vehicle, pedestrian or
cyclist in front.
This may result in unnecessary
alarm and braking or no alarm and
braking when necessary.
When the system suddenly recognizes the vehicle, pedestrian or
cyclist in front while passing over a
slope, you may experience sharp
deceleration.
• Changing lanes
When a vehicle changes lanes in
front of you, the Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist system may not
immediately detect the vehicle,
especially if the vehicle changes
lanes abruptly. In this case, you
must maintain a safe braking distance, and if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce your
driving speed in order to maintain a
safe distance.
5-59
5
Driving your vehicle
OAEE059617
Driving your vehicle
Detecting pedestrians or
cyclists
OAD058168L
OAEE059620
When driving in stop-and-go traffic,
and a vehicle in front of you merges
out of the lane, the Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist system may not
immediately detect the new vehicle
that is now in front of you. In this case,
you must maintain a safe braking distance, and if necessary, depress the
brake pedal to reduce your driving
speed in order to maintain a safe distance.
• Detecting the vehicle in front of you
If the vehicle in front of you has
cargo that extends rearward from
the cab, or when the vehicle in
front of you has higher ground
clearance, additional special attention is required. The Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist system
may not be able to detect the cargo
extending from the vehicle. In
these instances, you must maintain a safe braking distance from
the rearmost object, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain distance.
5-60
The sensor may be limited when:
• The pedestrian or cyclist is not fully
detected by the front view camera
recognition system, for example, if
the pedestrian is leaning over or is
not fully walking upright
• The pedestrian or cyclist is moving
very quickly or appears abruptly in
the front view camera detection
area
• The pedestrian or cyclist is wearing clothing that easily blends into
the background, making it difficult
to be detected by the front view
camera recognition system
• The outside lighting is too bright
(e.g. when driving in bright sunlight
or in sun glare) or too dark (e.g.
when driving on a dark rural road
at night)
• It is difficult to detect and distinguish the pedestrian or cyclist from
other objects in the surroundings,
for example, when there is a group
of pedestrians, cyclists or a large
crowd
• The sensor recognition changes
suddenly when passing over a
speed bump
• You are on a roundabout
• The pedestrian or cyclist suddenly
interrupts in front of the vehicle
• The cyclist in front is riding intersected with the driving direction
• There is any other electromagnetic
interference
• The construction area, rail or other
metal object is near the cyclist
• The bicycle material is not reflected
well on the front radar
WARNING
• Do not use the Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA) system when towing a
vehicle. Application of the
FCA system while towing may
adversely affect the safety of
your vehicle or the towing
vehicle.
• Use extreme caution when the
vehicle in front of you has
cargo that extends rearward
from the cab, or when the
vehicle in front of you has
higher ground clearance.
• Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist system may operate
when an object, which has
similar shape or characteristic to a vehicle, pedestrian or
cyclist, is detected.
(Continued)
5-61
5
Driving your vehicle
• There is an item similar to a person's body structure
• The pedestrian or cyclist is small
• The pedestrian has impaired
mobility
• The sensor recognition is limited
• The front radar sensor or front view
camera is blocked with a foreign
object or debris
• Inclement weather such as heavy
rain or snow obscures the field of
view of the front radar sensor or
front view camera
• When light coming from a street
light or an oncoming vehicle is
reflected on a wet road surface
such as a puddle in the road
• The field of view in front is
obstructed by sun glare
• The windshield glass is fogged up;
a clear view of the road is obstructed
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• The FCA system is designed
to help detect and monitor the
vehicle ahead or detect a
pedestrian or cyclist in the
roadway through front radar
signals and camera recognition. It is not designed to
detect bicycles, motorcycles,
or smaller wheeled objects
such as luggage bags, shopping carts, or strollers.
• Never try to test the operation
of the FCA system. Doing so
may cause severe injury or
death.
• If the front bumper, front
glass, front radar or front view
camera have been replaced or
repaired, we recommend that
you have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
5-62
i Information
In some instances, the FCA system
may be cancelled when subjected to
electromagnetic interference.
LANE KEEPING ASSIST (LKA) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system is not a substitute for
safe driving practices, but a
convenience function only. It is
the responsibility of the driver
to always be aware of the surroundings and steer the vehicle.
OAEE059013L
Take the following precautions
when using the Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA) system :
• Do not turn the steering wheel
suddenly when the steering
wheel is being assisted by the
system.
• LKA system helps to prevent
the driver from moving out of
the lane unintentionally by
assisting the driver's steering.
However, the driver should
not solely rely on the system
but always pay attention on
the steering wheel to stay in
the lane.
• The operation of the LKA system can be cancelled or not
work properly according to
road condition and surroundings. Always be cautious
when driving.
(Continued)
5-63
5
Driving your vehicle
The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system helps detect lane markers on the
road with a front view camera at the
front windshield, and assists the driver's steering to help keep the vehicle between lanes.
When the system detects the vehicle
straying from its lane, it alerts the
driver with a visual and audible warning, while applying a slight countersteering torque, trying to help prevent the vehicle from moving out of
its lane.
WARNING
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• Do not disassemble the LKA
system camera temporarily to
tint the window or attach any
types of coatings and accessories. If you disassemble the
camera and assemble it again,
we recommend that you take
your vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the
system checked for calibration.
• When you replace the windshield glass, LKA system
camera or related parts of the
steering wheel, we recommend that you take your vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system
checked for calibration.
(Continued)
5-64
(Continued)
• The system detects lane
markers and controls the
steering wheel by a front view
camera, therefore, if the lane
markers are hard to detect,
the system may not work
properly.
Please refer to "Limitations of
the System".
• Do not remove or damage the
related parts of LKA system.
• You may not hear a warning
sound of LKA system if the
audio volume is high.
• Do not place objects on the
dashboard that reflects light
such as mirrors, white paper,
etc. This may prevent the LKA
system from functioning
properly.
• When the lane markers are
hard to detect, please refer to
"Driver's Attention".
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Always have your hands on
the steering wheel while the
LKA system is activated. If
you continue to drive with
your hands off the steering
wheel after the "Keep hands
on steering wheel" warning
message appears, the system
will stop controlling the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel is not continuously controlled so if the
vehicle speed is at a higher
rate when leaving a lane the
vehicle may not be controlled
by the system. The driver
must always follow the speed
limit when using the system.
• If you attach objects to the
steering wheel, the system
may not assist steering or the
hands off alarm may not work
properly.
• When you tow a trailer, make
sure that you turn off the LKA
system.
LKA operation
The indicator (
) in the cluster
display will initially illuminate white.
This indicates the LKA system is in
the READY but NOT ENABLED state.
If you press the LKA button located
on the instrument panel on the lower
left hand side of the driver, LKA will
be turned off and the indicator on the
cluster display will go off.
■ Type A
OAEE059049L
■ Type B
OAEE059122L
• To see the LKA screen on the LCD
display in the cluster, select Driving
Assist mode ( ). For more information, refer to "LCD Display
Modes" in chapter 3.
i Information
If the indicator (white) is activated from
the previous ignition cycle, the system
will turn ON without any additional control. If you press the LKA button again,
the indicator on the cluster goes off.
5-65
5
Driving your vehicle
OAEE049681L
To activate/deactivate the LKA system:
With the ignition switch in the ON
position, press the LKA system button located on the instrument panel
on the left hand side of the steering
wheel. (Right hand side of the steering wheel for RHD vehicles.)
Note that the vehicle
speed must be at least
approximately 60 km/h
(40 mph) to ENABLE the
LKA system. The indicator in the cluster display
will illuminate green.
- White : Sensor does not detect lane
markers or vehicle speed is
under 60 km/h (37 mph).
- Green : Sensor detects lane markers and the system is able
to control vehicle steering.
LKA system operation
Driving your vehicle
■ Line undetected
■ Line detected
• If your vehicle speed exceeds 60
km/h (37 mph) and the LKA system
button is ON, the system is enabled.
If your vehicle departs from the projected lane in front of you, the LKA
system operates as follows:
■ Left lane marker
■ Right lane marker
OAEPH059628L/OAEPH059629L
• If vehicle speed is over 60 km/h (37
mph) and the system detects lane
markers, the color changes from
gray to white.
OAEPH059631L/OAEPH059630L
1. A visual warning appears on the
cluster LCD display. Either the left
lane marker or the right lane marker in the cluster LCD display will
blink depending on which direction
the vehicle is veering.
5-66
2. The LKA system will help control
the vehicle's steering to prevent
the vehicle from crossing the lane
marker in below conditions.
- Vehicle speed is over 60 km/h (37
mph)
- The system detects both lane
markers
- When driving, the vehicle is located between both lanes normally.
- The steering wheel is not turned
suddenly.
When lanes are detected and all the
conditions to activate the LKA system are satisfied, a LKA system indicator light (
) will change from
white to green. This indicates that the
LKA system is in the ENABLED state
and the steering wheel will be controlled.
WARNING
The warning message may
appear late according to road
conditions. Therefore, always
have your hands on the steering
wheel while driving.
OIK057120L
Keep hands on steering wheel
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds
while the LKA system is activated,
the system will warn the driver.
Driver's hands not detected. LKA
system is disabled temporarily
If the driver still does not have their
hands on the steering wheel after the
message "Keep hands on steering
wheel", the system will not control
the steering wheel and warn the driver only when the driver crosses the
lane markers.
However, if the driver has their hands
on the steering wheel again, the system will start controlling the steering
wheel.
i Information
If the steering wheel is held very lightly the message may still appear
because the LKA system may not recognize that the driver has their hands
on the wheel.
5-67
5
Driving your vehicle
OAEPH059625L
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
Warning light and message
The LKA system indicator (yellow) will illuminate
if the LKA system is not
working properly. We recommend that the system
be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• The driver is responsible for
accurate steering.
• The LKA system is a supplemental system only. It is the
responsibility of the driver to
safely steer the vehicle and to
maintain it in its lane.
• Turn off the LKA system and
drive without using the system
in the following situations:
- In bad weather
- In bad road conditions
- When the steering wheel
needs to be controlled by the
driver frequently.
- When towing a vehicle or
trailer.
i Information
• Even though the steering is assisted
by the system, the driver can still
steer to control the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel may feel heavier
or lighter when the steering wheel is
assisted by the system than when it
is not.
5-68
LKA system indicator
OOSEV058078L
Check LKA (Lane Keep Assist)
system
If there is a problem with the system
a message will appear for a few seconds. If the problem continues the
LKA system failure indicator will illuminate.
When there is a problem with the
system do one of the following:
• Turn the system on after turning
the vehicle off and on again.
• Check if the ignition switch is in the
ON position.
• Check if the system is affected by
the weather. (ex: fog, heavy rain,
etc.)
• Check if there is foreign matter on
the camera lens.
If the problem is not solved, we recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• There are more than two lane
markers on the road. (e.g. construction area)
• The vehicle is driven on a steep
incline.
• The steering wheel is turned suddenly.
• There are more than two lane
markers on the road in front of you.
• The system may not operate for 15
seconds after the vehicle is started
or the camera is initialized or
rebooting of the front view camera.
• Radius of a curve is too small.
Limitations of the System
The LKA system may operate prematurely even if the vehicle does not
depart from the intended lane, OR,
the LKA system may not assist your
steering or warn you if the vehicle
leaves the intended lane under the
following circumstances:
When the lane and road conditions are poor
• It is difficult to distinguish the lane
marking from the road surface or
the lane marking is faded or not
clearly marked.
• It is difficult to distinguish the color
of the lane marker from the road.
• There are markings on the road
surface that look like a lane marker
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• The lane marker is merged or
divided (e.g. tollgate).
• The lane number increases or
decreases or the lane marker are
crossing complicatedly.
• There are more than two lane
markers on the road in front of you.
5-69
5
Driving your vehicle
The LKA system will not be in the
ENABLED state and the steering
wheel will not be assisted when:
• The turn signal is turned on before
changing a lane. If you change
lanes without the turn signal on,
the steering wheel might be controlled.
• The vehicle is not driven in the middle of the lane when the system is
turned on or right after changing a
lane.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) or
VSM (Vehicle Stability Management)
is activated.
• The vehicle is driven on a sharp
curve.
• Vehicle speed is below 60 km/h (37
mph) and over 180 km/h (112
mph).
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle brakes suddenly.
• One lane marker is detected.
• The lane is very wide or narrow.
Driving your vehicle
• The lane marker is very thick or
thin.
• The lanes ahead are not visible
due to rain, snow, water on the
road, damaged or stained road
surface, or other factors.
• The shadow is on the lane marker
by a median strip, trees, etc.
• The lanes are incomplete or the
area is in a construction zone.
• There are crosswalk signs or other
symbols on the road.
• The lane marker in a tunnel is
stained with oil, etc.
• The lane suddenly disappears
such as at the intersection.
5-70
When external condition is intervened
• The brightness outside changes
suddenly such as when entering or
exiting a tunnel, or when passing
under a bridge.
• The brightness outside is too low
such as when the headlamps are
not on at night or the vehicle is
going through a tunnel.
• There is a boundary structure in
the roadway such as a concrete
barrier, guardrail and reflector post
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• When light coming from a street
light or an oncoming vehicle is
reflected on a wet road surface
such as a puddle in the road.
• The field of view in front is
obstructed by sun glare.
• There is not enough distance
between you and the vehicle in
front to be able to detect the lane
marker or the vehicle ahead is driving on the lane marker.
• Road surface is not evenness.
• Driving on a steep grade, over a
hill, or when driving on a curved
road.
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving.
• The surrounding of the inside rear
view mirror temperature is high
due to direct sunlight, etc.
When front visibility is poor
• The windshield or the front view
camera lens is blocked with dirt or
debris.
• The windshield glass is fogged up;
a clear view of the road is obstructed.
• Placing objects on the dashboard,
etc.
• The sensor cannot detect the lane
because of fog, heavy rain or snow.
LKA system function change
Lane Keeping Assist
The driver can change LKA to the
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) or
change the LKA mode between
Standard LKA and Active LKA from
the LCD display. Go to the 'User settings → Driver assistance → Lane
safety'.
The system is automatically set to
Standard LKA if a function is not
selected.
This mode guides the driver to help
keep the vehicle within the lanes. It
rarely controls the steering wheel,
when the vehicle drives well inside
the lanes. However, it starts to control the steering wheel, when the
vehicle is about to deviate out of the
lane.
Lane Departure Warning
Lane Departure Warning alerts the
driver with a visual warning and a
warning alarm when the system
detects the vehicle departing the
lane. The steering wheel will not be
controlled.
5
Driving your vehicle
5-71
Driving your vehicle
BLIND-SPOT COLLISION WARNING (BCW) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
System description
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
(BCW)
2) Closing at high speed
WARNING
The Blind-Spot Collision Warning
System (BCW) uses radar sensors in
the rear bumper to monitor and warn
the driver when it detects an
approaching vehicle in the driver's
blind spot area.
1) Blind-Spot Area
OAD058154L
The Lane Change Assist feature will
alert you when it detects a vehicle is
approaching in an adjacent lane at a
high rate of speed. If the driver activates the turn signal when the system detects an oncoming vehicle,
the system sounds an audible alert.
OAD058153L
The blind spot detection range varies
relative to vehicle speed.
Note that if your vehicle is traveling
much faster than the vehicles around
you, the warning will not occur.
5-72
• Always be aware of road conditions while driving and be
alert for unexpected situations even though the BlindSpot
Collision
Warning
System is operating.
• The Blind-Spot Collision
Warning System (BCW) is
supplemental systems to
assist you. Do not entirely rely
on the systems. Always pay
attention, while driving, for
your safety.
• The Blind-Spot Collision
Warning System (BCW) is not
substitutes for proper and
safe driving. Always drive
safely and use caution when
changing lanes or backing up
the vehicle.
The Blind-Spot Collision
Warning System (BCW) may
not detect every object alongside the vehicle.
System setting and operation
System setting
■ Type A
When the system is initially turned
on and when the vehicle is turned
off then on again while the system
is in activation, the warning light
will illuminate for 3 seconds on the
outside rearview mirror.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the
last setting.
OAEE059017L
■ Type B
5
OAEPH059651L
OAEE059026L
• If you press the BCW button while
'Warning only' is selected, the indicator on the button turns off and
the system deactivates.
• If you press the BCW button while
the system is cancelled, the indicator on the button illuminates and
the system activates.
OAEPH059650L
• Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time from the
User Settings in the cluster LCD
display by selecting 'User settings
→ Driver assistance → Warning
timing → Normal/Later'.
5-73
Driving your vehicle
• Setting Blind-Spot Safety function
- The driver can activate the system by placing the ignition switch
to the ON position and by selecting 'User settings → Driver assistance → Blind-spot safety' in the
cluster LCD display.
- BCW turns on and gets ready to
be operated when 'Warning only'
is selected. Then, if a vehicle
approaches the driver's blind spot
area a warning sounds.
- The system is deactivated and
the indicator on the BCW button
turns off when 'Off' is selected.
Driving your vehicle
The options for the initial Blind-Spot
Collision Warning includes the following:
- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial
Blind-Spot
Collision
Warning is activated normally. If
this setting feels too sensitive
change the option to 'later'.
The warning activation time may
feel late if the side/rear vehicle
abruptly accelerates.
- Later:
Select this warning activation
time when the traffic is light and
you are driving in at low speeds.
i Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change.
Operating Conditions
The system enters the ready status,
when 'Warning Only' is selected in
the cluster LCD display and vehicle
speed is above approximately 30
km/h (20 mph).
OAEPH059652L
• Setting Warning Volume
The driver can select the warning
volume from the User Settings in
the LCD display by selecting 'User
settings → Driver assistance →
Warning volume → High/Medium/
Low'.
i Information
If you change the warning volume, the
warning volume of other systems may
change.
For more information refer to
"LCD Display Modes" in chapter 3.
5-74
Warning message and system
control
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
(BCW) system
■ Left side
■ Right side
■ Left side
A
■ Right side
OAE056036
A
OAE056037
[A] : Warning sound
First stage alert
If a vehicle is detected within the
boundary of the system, a warning
light will illuminate on the outside
rearview mirror.
If the detected vehicle is no longer
within the blind spot area, the warning will turn off according to the driving conditions of the vehicle.
5-75
5
Driving your vehicle
OAE056035
Second stage alert
A warning chime to alert the driver will activate when:
1. A vehicle has been detected in the blind spot area by the radar system
AND.
2. The turn signal is applied (same side as where the vehicle is being
detected).
When this alert is activated, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will also blink. And a warning chime will sound.
If you turn off the turn signal indicator, the second stage alert will be deactivated.
If the detected vehicle is no longer within the blind spot area, the warning
will turn off according to the driving conditions of the vehicle.
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
• The warning light on the outside rearview mirror will illuminate whenever a vehicle is
detected at the rear side by
the system.
To avoid accidents, do not
focus only on the warning
light and neglect to see the
surroundings of the vehicle.
• Drive safely even though the
vehicle is equipped with a
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
System (BCW). Do not solely
rely on the system but check
your surroundings before
changing lanes or backing the
vehicle up.
• The system may not alert the
driver in some situations due
to system limitations so
always check your surroundings while driving.
5-76
CAUTION
• Always pay attention to road
and traffic conditions while
driving, whether or not the
warning light on the outside
rearview mirror illuminates or
there is a warning alarm.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may offset
the
Blind-Spot
Collision
Warning System warning
sounds.
• The warning of the Blind-Spot
Collision Warning System
may not sound while other
system's warning sounds.
Detecting Sensor
■ Rear radar
OAEE059012
The rear radars are located inside
the rear bumper for detecting the
side and rear areas. Always keep the
rear bumper clean for proper operation of the system.
NOTICE
• The system may not work properly when the bumper has been
damaged, or if the rear bumper
has been replaced or repaired.
(Continued)
Warning message
- When a trailer or carrier is
installed.
If any of these conditions occur, the
light on the BCW button and the system will turn off automatically.
i Information
OOSEV058035L
BCW (Blind-Spot Collision
Warning) system disabled.
Radar blocked
• This warning message may appear
when:
- One or both of the sensors on the
rear bumper is blocked by dirt or
snow or a foreign object.
- Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle for an extended period of
time.
- When there is inclement weather
such as heavy snow or rain.
Turn off the BCW and RCCW system
(if equipped) when a trailer or carrier
is installed.
- Press the BCW button (the indicator on the button will turn off)
- Deactivate the RCCW system by
deselecting
'User settings → Driver assistance
→ Parking safety → Rear crosstraffic safety'
When the BCW canceled warning
message is displayed in the cluster,
check to make sure that the rear
bumper is free from any dirt or snow
in the areas where the sensor is
located. Remove any dirt, snow, or
foreign material that could interfere
with the radar sensors.
5-77
5
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• The sensing range differs somewhat according to the width of the
road.When the road is narrow, the
system may detect other vehicles
in the next lane.
• The system may turn off if interfered by strong electromagnetic
waves.
• Always keep the sensors clean.
• NEVER disassemble the sensor
component or apply any impact
on the sensor component.
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary force on the radar sensor or
sensor cover. If the sensor is
forcibly moved out of proper
alignment, the system may not
operate correctly. In this case, a
warning message may not be displayed. We recommend that the
vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Do not apply foreign objects such
as a bumper sticker or a bumper
guard near the radar sensor or
apply paint to the sensor area.
Doing so may adversely affect the
performance of the sensor.
Driving your vehicle
After any dirt or debris is removed,
the system should operate normally
after about 10 minutes of driving the
vehicle.
If the system still does not operate
normally, we recommend that the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OOSEV048203L
Check BCW (Blind-spot Collision
Warning) system
If there is a problem with the BCW
system, a warning message will
appear and the light on the button
will turn off. The system will turn off
automatically. We recommend that
you have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-78
Limitations of the system
The driver must be cautious in the
below situations because the system
may not detect other vehicles or
objects in certain circumstances:
• When a trailer or carrier is
installed.
• The vehicle drives in inclement
weather such as heavy rain or
snow.
• The sensor is covered with rain,
snow, mud, etc.
• The rear bumper where the sensor
is located is covered with a foreign
object such as a bumper sticker, a
bumper guard, a bike rack, etc.
• The rear bumper is damaged, or
the sensor is out of the original
default position.
• The vehicle height gets lower or
higher due to heavy loading in a
tailgate, abnormal tire pressure,
etc.
• When the temperature of the rear
bumper is high.
• When the sensors are blocked by
other vehicles, walls or parking-lot
pillars.
• The vehicle is driven on a curved
road.
• The vehicle is driven through a tollgate.
• The road pavement (or the peripheral ground) abnormally contains
metallic components (i.e. possibly
due to subway construction).
• There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as a guardrail.
• While going down or up a steep
road where the height of the lane is
different.
• Driving on a narrow road where
trees or grass or overgrown.
• Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle or structure for an extended
period of time.
• Driving on a wet road.
• Driving on a road where the
guardrail or wall is in double structure.
• A big vehicle is near such as a bus
or truck.
• Temperature is extremely low
around the vehicle.
• The vehicle severely vibrates while
driving over a bumpy road,
uneven/bumpy road, or concrete
patch.
• The vehicle drives on a slippery
surface due to snow, water puddle,
or ice.
OAD058155N
• Driving on a curve
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving on a curved
road. In certain instances the system may not detect the vehicle in
the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
5-79
5
Driving your vehicle
• When the other vehicle approaches very close.
• When the other vehicle passes at a
very fast speed.
• While changing lanes.
• If the vehicle has started at the
same time as the vehicle next to
you and has accelerated.
• When the vehicle in the next lane
moves two lanes away from you
OR when the vehicle two lanes
away moves to the next lane from
you.
• A motorcycle or bicycle is near.
• A flat trailer is near.
• If there are small objects in the
detecting area such as a shopping
cart or a baby stroller.
• If there is a low height vehicle such
as a sports car.
• The vehicle abruptly changes driving direction.
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle sharply stops.
Driving your vehicle
OAD058156N
OAD058157N
OAEE059592
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving on a curved
road. In certain instances the system may recognize a vehicle in the
same lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
• Driving where the road is merging/dividing
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving where the
road is merging/dividing. In certain
instances the system may not
detect the vehicle in the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
• Driving on a slope
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving on a slope.
In certain instances the system
may not detect the vehicle in the
next lane.
Also, in certain instances the system may wrongly recognize the
ground or structures.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
5-80
Declaration of conformity
(if equipped)
The radio frequency components
(Rear Corner Radar) comply with
requirements and other relevant provisions.
• For Taiwan
OAD058150N
• Driving where there is a structure
beside the road
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving where there
is structure beside the road.
In certain instances, the system
may wrongly recognize the structures (noise barriers, guardrail,
double guardrail, median strip, bollard, street light, road sign, tunnel
wall, etc.) beside the road.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OAEPH069049L
5
• For Singapore
OAEPH069048L
• For Mexico
OAEPH069050L
5-81
Driving your vehicle
• Driving where the heights of the
lanes are different
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving where the
heights of the lanes are different.
In certain instances, the system
may not detect the vehicle on a
road with different lane heights
(underpass joining section, grade
separated intersections, etc.).
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OAD058151N
[A] : noise barrier, [B] : guardrail
Driving your vehicle
• For Serbia
• For Russia
• For Brazil
OAEPH069061L
• For South Africa (TA-2012/779)
OAEPH069057L
OAEPH069054L
• For Ukraine
• For UAE
OAEPH069051L
OAEPH069058L
OAEPH069055L
• For Oman
• For Argentina
• For Vietnam
OAEPH069059L
OAEPH069052L
OAEPH069056L
• For Moldova
• For Paraguay (2017-08-I-0000279 )
OAEPH069060L
OAEPH069053L
5-82
DRIVER ATTENTION WARNING (DAW) (IF EQUIPPED)
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system displays the level of the driver’s fatigue and inattention, considering the driving pattern, etc.
System setting and operation
System setting
OAEPH059650L
• Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time from the
User Settings in the cluster LCD
display by selecting 'User settings
→ Driver assistance → Warning
timing → Normal/Later'.
i Information
Other driver assistance systems like
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA) System, etc. can be changed
when warning time setting is changed.
5-83
5
Driving your vehicle
• Selecting Driver Attention Warning
function
The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) can be activated from the
Users Settings mode in the cluster
LCD display by following the procedure below.
1. Set the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Select 'User settings → Driver
assistance → DAW (Driver
Attention Warning)' in the cluster
LCD display. Deselect the setting
to turn off the system.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the
last setting.
The options for the initial Driver
Attention Warning includes the following:
- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Driver Attention Warning is
activated normally. If this setting
feels sensitive, change the option
to 'Later'.
The warning activation time may
feel late if a vehicle at the side or
rear abruptly accelerates.
- Later:
Select this warning activation time
when the traffic is light and you are
driving at low speeds.
Driving your vehicle
Display of the driver's attention
level
■ Inattentive driving
■ System off
OPDE056062
OAEPH059652L
• Setting Warning Volume
The driver can select the warning
volume from the User Settings in
the LCD display by selecting 'User
settings → Driver assistance →
Warning
volume
→
High/Medium/Low'.
OAE048569L
■ Attentive driving
i Information
If you change the warning volume, the
warning volume of other systems may
change.
For more details, refer to "LCD
Display Modes" in chapter 3.
5-84
OPDE056061
• The driver can monitor his/her driving conditions on the cluster LCD
display.
The DAW screen will appear when
you select the Driving Assist mode
(
) on the LCD display if the system is activated. (For more
details, refer to "LCD Display
Modes" in chapter 3.)
• The driver's attention level is displayed on the scale of 1 to 5. The
lower the level is, the more inattentive the driver is.
• The level decreases when the driver does not take a break for a certain period of time.
• The level increases when the driver attentively drives for a certain
period of time.
• When the driver turns on the system while driving, it displays 'Last
Break time' and level.
Take a break
CAUTION
If any other warning sound
such as seat belt warning chime
is already generated, the Driver
Attention Warning (DAW) system warning may not sound.
OIK057132L
5
Driving your vehicle
• The "Consider taking a break“
message appears on the cluster
LCD display and a warning sounds
to suggest that the driver take a
break, when the driver’s attention
level is below 1.
• The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system will not suggest a
break, when the total driving time
is shorter than 10 minutes and also
doesn't recommend an additional
break within 10 minutes after a
break.
5-85
Driving your vehicle
Resetting the system
• The last break time is set to 00:00
and the driver's attention level is
set to 5 (very attentive) when the
driver resets the Driver Attention
Warning (DAW) system.
• The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system resets the last
break time to 00:00 and the driver's
attention level to 5 in the following
situations.
- The vehicle is turned OFF.
- The driver unfastens the seat belt
and then opens the driver's door.
- The vehicle is stopped for more
than 10 minutes.
• The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system operates again,
when the driver restarts driving.
5-86
System standby
System malfunction
OAE058266L
OOSEV058080L
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system enters the ready status and
displays the 'Standby' screen in the
following situations.
- The front view camera does not
detect the lane.
- Driving speed over 180 km/h (110
mph).
Check DAW (Driver Attention
Warning) system
When the "Check Driver Attention
Warning (DAW) system" warning
message appears, the system is not
working properly. In this case, we
recommend that you have the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
i Information
The system may suggest a break
according to the driver's driving pattern or habits even if the driver doesn't feel fatigue.
The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system utilizes the front
view camera sensor on the front
windshield for its operation. To
keep the front view camera sensor
in the best condition, you should
observe the followings:
• Never install any accessories or
stickers on the front windshield,
or tint the front windshield.
• NEVER place any reflective
objects (i.e. white paper, mirror)
over the dashboard. Any light
reflection may cause a malfunction of the Driver Attention
Warning (DAW) system.
• Pay extreme caution to keep the
front view camera sensor dry.
• NEVER disassemble the front
view camera assembly, nor
apply any impact on the front
view camera assembly.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Never disassemble the front
view camera assembly, or apply
any impact on the front view
camera assembly.
If the sensor is forcibly moved
out of proper alignment, the system may not operate correctly.
We recommend that you take
your vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the
system checked for calibration.
5
Driving your vehicle
• The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system is not a substitute for safe driving practices,
but a convenience function
only. It is the responsibility of
the driver to always drive cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
• The driver who feels fatigued
should take a break, even
though there is no break suggestion
by
the
Driver
Attention Warning (DAW) system.
• The driver must have a
responsibility of safe driving
himself/herself.
NOTICE
5-87
Driving your vehicle
CAUTION
The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system may not provide
alerts in the following situations:
• The system may not work
around 15 seconds after starting the vehicle or the initialization or rebooting of the
front view camera.
• The lane detection performance is limited. (For more
information, refer to "Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA) system"
in this chapter.)
• The vehicle is erratically driven or is abruptly turned for
obstacle avoidance (e.g. construction area, other vehicles,
fallen objects, bumpy road).
(Continued)
5-88
(Continued)
• Forward drivability of the
vehicle is severely undermined (possibly due to wide
variation in tire pressures,
uneven tire wear-out, toein/toe-out alignment).
• The vehicle is driven on a
curvy road.
• The vehicle is driven through
a windy area.
• The vehicle is driven on a
bumpy road.
• The vehicle is controlled by
the following driving assist
systems:
- Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA) system
- Smart Cruise Control (SCC)
system
- Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system
- Lane Following Assist (LFA)
system
CAUTION
Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may prevent
occupants from hearing the
Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system warning sounds.
Leading Vehicle Departure
Alert (if applied)
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert system provides the alert whether the
leading vehicle drives away or not,
while a stop.
System setting and operating
conditions
System setting
OAEPH059659L
Alert announcement
The system notifies the driver with
the alert message and a warning
sound when the leading vehicle
drives away while a stop.
5-89
5
Driving your vehicle
• Selecting Driver Attention Warning
function
The Leading Vehicle Departure
Alert can be activated from Users
Settings mode in the cluster LCD
display by following the procedure
below.
1. Set the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Select 'User Settings → Driving
Assistance → Driver Attention
Warning → Leading Vehicle
Departure Alert' in cluster LCD
display. Deselect the setting to
turn off the system.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the
last setting.
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
• The
Leading
Vehicle
Departure Alert system is
only a convenient auxiliary for
the driver. The system can’t
announce the alarm when a
leading vehicle departs in real
time.
• The driver must check and
determine real conditions and
then start to drive even if the
system notified the leading
vehicle departure.
5-90
CAUTION
• The
Leading
Vehicle
Departure Alert (LVDA) system is quite related with the
front camera in the vehicle for
the better performance. For
more information of front
camera, refer to "Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA)".
• It may not provide Vehicle
Departure Alert or not properly operate in the following situations:
- Leading pedestrian(s) or
bicycle(s) in front of vehicle
- Leading cut-in vehicle(s)
- Leading vehicle’s quick
departure
- Stop on speed bump or
steep hill
- Stop on a right-turn junction
or a curved road
- Stop on shoulder road, rest
area, parking lot
CRUISE CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)
Cruise Control operation
OOSEV058038
The Cruise Control system allows you
to drive at speeds above 30 km/h
(20 mph) without depressing the
accelerator pedal.
Take the following precautions:
• Always set the vehicle speed
under the speed limit in your
country.
• If the Cruise Control is left on,
(cruise indicator light in the
instrument cluster is illuminated) the Cruise Control can
be activated unintentionally.
Keep the Cruise Control system off (cruise indicator light
OFF) when the Cruise Control
is not in use, to avoid inadvertently setting a speed.
• Use the Cruise Control system
only when traveling on open
highways in good weather.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not use the Cruise Control
when it may be unsafe to keep
the vehicle at a constant
speed:
- When driving in heavy traffic
or when traffic conditions
make it difficult to drive at a
constant speed
- When driving on rainy, icy, or
snow-covered roads
- When driving on hilly or
windy roads
- When driving in windy areas
- When driving with limited
view (possibly due to bad
weather such as fog, snow,
rain and sandstorm)
5-91
5
Driving your vehicle
(1) Cruise indicator
(2) SET indicator
WARNING
Driving your vehicle
i Information
• During normal cruise control operation, when the SET switch is activated or reactivated after applying the
brakes, the cruise control will energize after approximately 3 seconds.
This delay is normal.
• Before activating the cruise control
function, the system will check to
verify that the brake switch is operating normally. Depress the brake
pedal at least once after turning ON
the POWER button or starting the
vehicle.
■ Type A
i Information
■ Type B
OAE056153L
Cruise control switch
CANCEL/O : Cancels cruise control
operation.
CRUISE /
: Turns cruise control
system on or off.
RES+: Resumes or increases cruise
control speed.
SET-: Sets or decreases cruise control speed.
OAE056068L
First, switch the mode to Cruise
Control by pressing the
button if
equipped with the Speed Limit
Control System.
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
5-92
To set Cruise Control speed
■ Type A
To increase Cruise Control
speed
■ Type A
■ Type A
■ Type B
■ Type B
■ Type B
OAE056155L
OAE056154L
i Information
On a steep slope, the vehicle may
slightly slow down or speed up, while
driving uphill or downhill.
OAE056156L
• Push the toggle switch (1) up
(RES+) and release it immediately.
The cruising speed will increase
2.0 km/h (1.2 mph) each time the
toggle switch is operated in this
manner.
• Push the toggle switch (1) up
(RES+) and hold it, while monitoring the SET speed on the instrument cluster.
Release the toggle switch when
the desired speed is shown and
the vehicle will accelerate to that
speed.
5-93
5
Driving your vehicle
1. Press the CRUISE /
button on
the steering wheel to turn the system on. The cruise indicator will
illuminate.
2. Accelerate to the desired speed,
which must be more than 30 km/h
(20 mph).
3. Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-), and release it. The SET
indicator light will illuminate.
4. Release the accelerator pedal.
Driving your vehicle
• Depress the accelerator pedal.
When the vehicle attains the
desired speed, push the toggle
switch (1) down (SET-).
To decrease Cruise Control
speed
■ Type A
■ Type B
OAE056155L
• Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-) and release it immediately.
The cruising speed will decrease
2.0 km/h (1.2 mph) each time the
toggle switch is operated in this
manner.
• Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-) and hold it. Your vehicle will
gradually slow down. Release the
toggle switch at the speed you
want to maintain.
• Lightly tap the brake pedal. When
the vehicle attains the desired
speed, push the toggle switch (1)
down (SET-).
5-94
To temporarily accelerate with
the Cruise Control ON
Depress the accelerator pedal. When
you take your foot off the accelerator,
the vehicle will return to the previously set speed.
If you push the toggle switch down
(SET-) at the increased speed, the
Cruise Control will maintain the
increased speed.
Cruise Control will be canceled
when:
■ Type A
■ Type B
i Information
Each of the above actions will cancel
Cruise Control operation (the SET
indicator light in the instrument cluster will go off), but only pressing the
CRUISE /
button will turn the system off. If you wish to resume Cruise
Control operation, push the toggle
switch up (RES+) located on your
steering wheel. You will return to your
previously preset speed, unless the
system was turned off using the
CRUISE /
button.
To resume preset Cruising
speed
■ Type A
■ Type B
OAE056156L
Push the toggle switch (1) up
(RES+). If the vehicle speed is over
30 km/h (20 mph), the vehicle will
resume the preset speed.
5-95
5
Driving your vehicle
OAE056157L
• Depressing the brake pedal.
• Pressing the CANCEL / O button
located on the steering wheel.
• The vehicle is shifted into N
(Neutral).
• Decreasing the vehicle speed to
less than the memory speed by
approximately 20 km/h (12 mph).
• Decreasing the vehicle speed to
less than approximately 30 km/h
(20 mph).
• The ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) is operating.
Driving your vehicle
To turn Cruise Control off
■ Type A
i Information
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
■ Type B
OAE056154L
• Press the CRUISE /
button (the
cruise indicator light will go off).
• Press the
button (The indicator
light will go off.).
- With the Cruise Control on,
pressing the button once will turn
Off the Cruise Control and turn
on the Speed Limit Control.
- With the Cruise Control off and
Speed Limit Control on, pressing
the button will turn off both system.
5-96
SMART CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM (WITH STOP & GO SYSTEM) (IF EQUIPPED)
To see the SCC screen on the LCD
display in the cluster, select Driving
Assist mode ( ). For more information, refer to "LCD Display Modes" in
chapter 3.
OAEPH058615
For your safety, please read the
owner's manual before using the
Smart Cruise Control system.
WARNING
• The Smart Cruise Control
System is not a substitute for
safe driving practices, but a
convenience function only. It
is the responsibility of the
driver to always check the
speed and distance to the
vehicle ahead.
• Always be aware of road conditions while driving and be
alert for unexpected situations even though the Smart
Cruise Control System is
operating.
• The Smart Cruise Control
(SCC) is supplemental systems to assist you Do not
entirely rely on the systems.
Always pay attention, while
driving, for you safety.
5-97
5
Driving your vehicle
(1) Cruise indicator
(2) Set speed
(3) Vehicle-to-vehicle distance
The Smart Cruise Control System
allows you to program the vehicle to
help maintain the desired speed and
minimum distance between the vehicle ahead.
The Smart Cruise Control System
will automatically adjust your vehicle
speed to maintain your programmed
speed and following distance without
requiring you to depress the accelerator or brake pedals.
WARNING
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
Take the following precautions :
• Always set the vehicle speed
under the speed limit in your
country.
• If the Smart Cruise Control is
left on, (cruise (
)
indicator light in the instrument cluster is illuminated)
the Smart Cruise Control can
be activated unintentionally.
Keep the Smart Cruise
Control System off (cruise
(
) indicator light
OFF) when the Smart Cruise
Control is not in use, to avoid
inadvertently setting a speed.
• Use the Smart Cruise Control
System only when traveling
on open highways in good
weather.
(Continued)
5-98
(Continued)
• Do not use the Smart Cruise
Control when it may not be
safe to keep the vehicle at a
constant speed:
- When driving in heavy traffic
or when traffic conditions
make it difficult to drive at a
constant speed
- When driving on rainy, icy, or
snow-covered roads
- When driving on a steep
downhill or uphill
- When driving in windy areas
- When driving in parking lots
- When driving near crash
barriers
- When driving on a sharp
curve
- When driving with limited
view (possibly due to bad
weather, such as fog, snow,
rain or sandstorm)
(Continued)
(Continued)
- When the vehicle sensing
ability decreases due to
vehicle modification resulting level difference of the
vehicle's front and rear
Smart cruise control switch
To adjust the sensitivity of
Smart Cruise Control
■ Type A
■ Type B
OAE056068L
OAE056169L
i Information
First, switch the mode to Smart
Cruise Control by pressing the
button if equipped with the Speed
Limit Control System.
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
Smart Cruise Control
OOSEV058091L
The sensitivity of vehicle speed
when following the front vehicle to
maintain the set distance can be
adjusted. Select 'User settings →
Driver assistance → SCC response
→ Fast/ Normal/Slow' in the cluster
LCD display.
Speed Limit Control
5-99
5
Driving your vehicle
CANCEL / O : Cancels cruise control operation.
CRUISE /
: Turns cruise control
system on or off.
RES+: Resumes or increases cruise
control speed.
SET-: Sets or decreases cruise control speed.
: Sets vehicle-to-vehicle distance.
Driving your vehicle
You may select one of the three
stages you prefer.
- Fast:
Vehicle speed following the front
vehicle to maintain the set distance
is faster than normal speed.
- Normal:
Vehicle speed following the front
vehicle to maintain the set distance
is normal.
- Slow:
Vehicle speed following the front
vehicle to maintain the set distance
is slower than normal speed.
i Information
The last selected speed sensitivity of
the smart cruise control is remained in
the system.
5-100
To convert to Cruise Control
mode
The driver may choose to only use
the conventional Cruise Control
mode (speed control function) by
doing as follows:
1. Turn the Smart Cruise Control
System on (the cruise indicator
light will be on but the system will
not be activated).
2. Push and hold the Vehicle-toVehicle Distance button for more
than 2 seconds.
3. Choose between "Smart Cruise
Control" and "Cruise Control".
When the system is cancelled using
theCRUISE/
button or the
CRUISE/
button is used after the
vehicle is in the ready (
) mode,
the Smart Cruise Control mode will
turn on.
WARNING
When using the Cruise Control
mode, you must manually
adjust the distance to other
vehicles by depressing the
accelerator or brake pedal. The
system does not automatically
adjust the distance to vehicles
in front of you.
Smart Cruise Control speed
To set Smart Cruise Control
speed
■ Type A
■ Type A
■ Type B
i Information
• Vehicle speed may decrease on an
upward slope and increase on a
downward slope.
• When you are setting the cruise control speed with a vehicle in front and
your vehicle speed is between 0-30
km/h (0-20 mph), the speed will set
to 30 km/h (20 mph).
■ Type B
OAE056155L
OAE056154L
5
Driving your vehicle
1. Push the
button on the steering wheel to turn the system on.
The cruise (
) indicator
will illuminate.
2. Accelerate to the desired speed.
The Smart Cruise Control speed
can be set when vehicle speed is
between as follows.
• 10 ~ 180 km/h (5 ~ 110 mph) :
when there is no vehicle in front
• 0 ~ 180 km/h (0 ~ 110 mph) :
when there is a vehicle in front
3. Push the toggle switch down
(SET-). The Set Speed and
Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance on the
LCD display will illuminate.
4. Release the accelerator pedal.
The desired speed will automatically be maintained.
If there is a vehicle in front of you, the
speed may decrease to maintain the
distance to the vehicle ahead.
On a steep grade, the vehicle may
slow down or speed up slightly while
going uphill or downhill.
5-101
Driving your vehicle
To increase Smart Cruise
Control set speed
■ Type A
■ Type B
CAUTION
Check the driving condition
before using the toggle switch.
Driving speed sharply increases, when you push up and hold
the toggle switch.
To decrease the Smart Cruise
Control set speed
■ Type A
■ Type B
OAE056156L
OAE056155L
Follow either of these procedures:
• Push the toggle switch up (RES+),
and release it immediately. The
cruising speed will increase by 1
km/h (1 mph) each time you move
the toggle switch up in this manner.
• Push the toggle switch up (RES+),
and hold it. Your vehicle set speed
will increase by 10 km/h (5 mph).
Release the toggle switch at the
speed you want.
• You can set the speed to 180 km/h
(110 mph).
Follow either of these procedures:
• Push the toggle switch down (SET-),
and release it immediately. The
cruising speed will decrease by 1
km/h (1 mph) each time you move
the toggle switch down in this manner.
• Push the toggle switch down (SET-),
and hold it. Your vehicle set speed
will decrease by 10 km/h (5 mph).
Release the toggle switch at the
speed you want.
• You can set the speed to 30 km/h
(20 mph).
5-102
To temporarily accelerate with
the Smart Cruise Control on
If you want to speed up temporarily
when the Smart Cruise Control is on,
depress the accelerator pedal.
Increased speed will not interfere
with Smart Cruise Control operation
or change the set speed.
To return to the set speed, take your
foot off the accelerator pedal.
If you push the toggle switch down
(SET-) at increased speed, the set
speed is updated.
Smart Cruise Control will be
temporarily cancelled when:
■ Type A
■ Type B
OAE056157L
Be careful when accelerating temporarily, because the speed is not controlled automatically at this time even
if there is a vehicle in front of you.
Cancelled manually
• Depressing the brake pedal.
• Pressing the CANCEL/
button
located on the steering wheel.
The Smart Cruise Control turns off
temporarily when the Set Speed and
Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance indicator
on the cluster LCD display turns off.
The cruise (
) indicator is
illuminated continuously.
5-103
5
Driving your vehicle
i Information
Cancelled automatically
• The driver's door is opened.
• The shift lever is shifted to N
(Neutral), R (Reverse) or P (Park).
• The parking brake is applied.
• The vehicle speed is over 190
km/h (120 mph).
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control),
TCS (Traction Control System) or
ABS is operating.
• ESC is turned off.
• The sensor or the cover is dirty or
blocked with foreign matter.
• The vehicle is stopped for more
than 5 minutes.
• The vehicle stops and goes repeatedly for a long period of time.
• The accelerator pedal is continuously depressed for a long period
of time.
• The SCC system has malfunctioned.
• The motor performance is abnormal.
Driving your vehicle
• The braking control is operated for
FCA (Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist)
• The driver starts driving by pushing
the toggle switch up (RES+)/down
(SET-) or depressing the accelerator pedal, after the vehicle is
stopped by the Smart Cruise
Control system with no other vehicle ahead.
• The driver starts driving by pushing
the toggle switch up (RES+)/down
(SET-) or depressing the accelerator pedal, after stopping the vehicle
with a vehicle stopped far away in
front.
• When motor is stopped by ISG
(Idle Stop & Go).
5-104
Each of these actions will cancel the
Smart Cruise Control operation. The
Set Speed and Vehicle-to-Vehicle
Distance on the LCD display will go
off.
In a condition the Smart Cruise
Control is cancelled automatically,
the Smart Cruise Control will not
resume even though the RES+ or
SET- toggle switch is pushed.
Also, if the Smart Cruise Control is
cancelled automatically while the
vehicle is at a standstill, the EPB
(Electronic Parking Brake) will be
applied.
i Information
If the Smart Cruise Control is cancelled by other than the reasons mentioned, we recommend that the system
be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
OOSEV058090L
SCC (Smart Cruise Control) cancelled
If the system is cancelled, the warning chime will sound and a message
will appear for a few seconds.
You must adjust the vehicle speed by
depressing the accelerator or brake
pedal according to the road condition
ahead and driving condition.
Always check the road conditions.
Do not rely on the warning chime.
To resume Smart Cruise Control
set speed
If any method other than the cruise
toggle switch was used to cancel
cruising speed and the system is still
activated, the cruising speed will
automatically resume when you
push the toggle switch up (RES+) or
down (SET-).
If you push the toggle switch up
(RES+), the speed will resume to the
recently set speed. However, if vehicle speed drops under 10km/h
(5mph), it will resume when there is
a vehicle in front of your vehicle.
Always check the road conditions
when you push the toggle switch up
(RES+) to resume speed.
■ Type A
i Information
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
■ Type B
Smart Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
OAE056154L
5
• Press the CRUISE/
button (the
cruise (
) indicator light
will go off).
• Press the
button (The
(
) indicator light will go
off.). (if equipped with Speed Limit
Control)
- With the Smart Cruise Control
on, pressing the button once will
turn Off the Smart Cruise Control
and turn on the Speed Limit
Control.
- With the Smart Cruise Control off
and Speed Limit Control on,
pressing the button will turn off
both system.
Driving your vehicle
i Information
To turn Cruise Control off
5-105
Driving your vehicle
Smart Cruise Control Vehicleto-Vehicle Distance
To set Vehicle-to-Vehicle
Distance
Each time the button is pressed, the
vehicle to vehicle distance changes
as follows:
Distance 4
Distance 3
Distance 2
■ Type A
Distance 1
■ Type B
OAE056158L
When the Smart Cruise Control
System is ON, you can set and maintain the distance from the vehicle
ahead of you without pressing the
accelerator or brake pedal.
5-106
For example, if you drive at 90 km/h
(56 mph), the distance is maintained
as follows:
Distance
Distance
Distance
Distance
4
3
2
1
-
approximately
approximately
approximately
approximately
52.5 m
40 m
32.5 m
25 m
i Information
The distance is set to the last set distance when the system is used for the
first time after starting the vehicle.
When the lane ahead is clear:
When there is a vehicle ahead
of you in your lane:
Distance 4
Distance 3
Distance 2
Distance 1
WARNING
OAEPH059587L
OPD056084
OAEPH058615/OAEPH058614/OAEPH058613/OAEPH058612
• Your vehicle speed will slow down
or speed up to maintain the selected distance.
• If the vehicle ahead speeds up,
your vehicle will travel at a steady
cruising speed after accelerating to
the set speed.
• If distance from the front vehicle has
been changed due to accelerating
or decelerating of the front vehicle,
the distance on the LCD display
may change. (Only when there is a
vehicle in front, the front vehicle
appears in the LCD display.)
When using the Smart Cruise
Control System:
• The
warning
message
appears and warning chime
sounds if the vehicle is unable
to maintain the selected distance from the vehicle ahead.
• If the warning message
appears and warning chime
sounds, depress the brake
pedal to actively adjust the
vehicle speed, and the distance to the vehicle ahead.
(Continued)
5-107
5
Driving your vehicle
The vehicle speed will maintain the
set speed.
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• Even if the warning message
does not appear and warning
chime does not sound, always
pay attention to the driving
conditions to prevent dangerous situations from occurring.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may prevent occupants from hearing
the system warning sounds.
CAUTION
In traffic situation
OAEPH059168L
OIK057107L
If the vehicle ahead (vehicle
speed: less than 30km/h) disappears to the next lane, the warning chime will sound and a message "Watch for surrounding
vehicles" will appear. Adjust
your vehicle speed for vehicles
or objects that can suddenly
appear in front of you by
depressing the brake pedal.
Always pay attention to the road
condition ahead.
5-108
Use switch or pedal to accelerate
• In traffic, your vehicle will stop if the
vehicle ahead of you stops. Also, if
the vehicle ahead of you starts
moving, your vehicle will start as
well. However, if the vehicle stops
for more than 3 seconds, you must
depress the accelerator pedal or
push up the toggle switch (RES+)
to start driving.
• If you push the smart cruise control
toggle switch (RES+ or SET-) while
Auto Hold and smart cruise control
is operating the Auto Hold will be
released regardless of accelerator
pedal operation and the vehicle will
start to move. The AUTO HOLD
indicator changes from green to
white.
Sensor to detect distance to
the vehicle ahead
Warning message
OOSEV058052L
OAEE059654L
5-109
5
Driving your vehicle
The Smart Cruise Control uses a
sensor to detect distance to the vehicle ahead.
If the sensor is covered with dirt or
other foreign matter, the vehicle to
vehicle distance control may not
operate correctly. Always keep the
sensor clean.
SCC (Smart Cruise Control) disabled. Radar blocked
When the sensor lens cover is
blocked with dirt, snow, or debris, the
Smart Cruise Control System operation may stop temporarily. If this
occurs, a warning message will
appear on the cluster LCD display.
Remove any dirt, snow, or debris and
clean the radar sensor lens cover
before operating the Smart Cruise
Control System. The Smart Cruise
Control system may not properly
activate, if the radar is totally covered,
or if any substance is not detected
after the vehicle is in the ready (
)
mode (e.g. in an open terrain).
Driving your vehicle
i Information
For the SCC operation is temporarily
stopped if the radar is blocked, but
you wish to use cruise control mode
(speed control function), you must
convert to the cruise control mode
(refer to "To convert to Cruise
Control mode" in the following page.
CAUTION
• Do not apply license plate
frame or foreign objects such
as a bumper sticker or a
bumper guard near the radar
sensor. Doing
so
may
adversely affect the sensing
performance of the radar.
• Always keep the radar sensor
and lens cover clean and free
of dirt and debris.
• Use only a soft cloth to wash
the vehicle. Do not spray pressurized water directly on the
sensor or sensor cover.
(Continued)
5-110
(Continued)
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary force on the radar sensor or sensor cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved out of
proper alignment, the Smart
Cruise Control System may
not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may
not be displayed. Have the
vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the front bumper becomes
damaged in the area around
the radar sensor, the Smart
Cruise Control System may
not operate properly. We recommend you to have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Use only genuine HYUNDAI
parts to repair or replace a
damaged sensor or sensor
cover. Do not apply paint to
the sensor cover.
OOSEV058092L
Check SCC (Smart Cruise Control)
system
The message will appear when the
vehicle to vehicle distance control
system is not functioning normally.
We recommend that you take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked.
Limitations of the system
On curves
The Smart Cruise Control System
may have limits to its ability to detect
distance to the vehicle ahead due to
road and traffic conditions.
OAD058166L
OAD058165L
5-111
5
Driving your vehicle
• The Smart Cruise Control System
may not detect a moving vehicle in
your lane, and then your vehicle
could accelerate to the set speed.
Also, the vehicle speed will
decrease when the vehicle ahead
is recognized suddenly.
• Select the appropriate set speed
on curves and apply the brakes or
accelerator pedal if necessary.
Your vehicle speed can be reduced
due to a vehicle in the adjacent lane.
Apply the accelerator pedal and
select the appropriate set speed.
Check to be sure that the road conditions permit safe operation of the
Smart Cruise Control.
Driving your vehicle
On inclines
Lane changing
Vehicle recognition
OAEE059617
OAD058167L
OAD058173N
• During uphill or downhill driving,
the Smart Cruise Control System
may not detect a moving vehicle in
your lane, and cause your vehicle
to accelerate to the set speed.
Also, the vehicle speed will rapidly
decrease when the vehicle ahead
is recognized suddenly.
• Select the appropriate set speed
on inclines and apply the brake or
accelerator pedal if necessary.
• A vehicle which moves into your
lane from an adjacent lane cannot
be recognized by the sensor until it
is in the sensor's detection range.
• The radar may not detect immediately when a vehicle cuts in suddenly. Always pay attention to the
traffic, road and driving conditions.
• If a slower vehicle moves into your
lane, your speed may decrease to
maintain the distance to the vehicle
ahead.
• If a faster vehicle which moves into
your lane, your vehicle will accelerate to the set speed.
Some vehicles in your lane cannot
be recognized by the sensor:
- Narrow vehicles such as motorcycles or bicycles
- Vehicles offset to one side
- Slow-moving vehicles or suddendecelerating vehicles
- Stopped vehicles
- Vehicles with small rear profile
such as trailers with no loads
5-112
A vehicle ahead cannot be recognized correctly by the sensor if any of
following occurs:
- When the vehicle is pointing
upwards due to overloading in the
luggage compartment
- While the steering wheel is operating
- When driving to one side of the
lane
- When driving on narrow lanes or
on curves
Apply the brake or accelerator pedal
if necessary.
OAD058168L
• Your vehicle may accelerate when
a vehicle ahead of you disappears.
• When you are warned that the
vehicle ahead of you is not detected, drive with caution.
• When driving in stop-and-go traffic,
and a vehicle in front of you
merges out of the lane, the system
may not immediately detect the
new vehicle that is now in front of
you. In this case, you must maintain a safe braking distance, and if
necessary, depress the brake
pedal to reduce your driving speed
in order to maintain a safe distance.
5-113
5
Driving your vehicle
OAD058174N
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
OAE056110
OAEE059620
• Always look out for pedestrians
when your vehicle is maintaining a
distance with the vehicle ahead.
• Always be cautious for vehicles
with higher height or vehicles carrying loads that sticks out from the
back of the vehicle.
5-114
When using the Smart Cruise
Control take the following precautions:
• If an emergency stop is necessary, you must apply the
brakes. The vehicle cannot be
stopped at every emergency
situation by using the Smart
Cruise Control System.
• Keep a safe distance according to road conditions and
vehicle speed. If the vehicle to
vehicle distance is too close
during a high-speed driving, a
serious collision may result.
• Always maintain sufficient
braking distance and decelerate your vehicle by applying
the brakes if necessary.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• The Smart Cruise Control
System may not recognize
complex driving situations so
always pay attention to driving conditions and control
your vehicle speed.
• The Smart Cruise Control system may recognize a pedestrian, bicycle, motorcycle, etc. as
a vehicle. Always, look ahead
cautiously to prevent unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring.
• Turn off the Smart Cruise
Control system when the
vehicle is being towed.
• The Smart Cruise Control system may operate limitedly
when towing a trailer or vehicle so always drive cautiously
to prevent unexpected and
sudden situations from occurring.
NOTICE
The Smart Cruise Control System
may not operate temporarily due
to:
• Electrical interference
• Modifying the suspension
• Differences of tire abrasion or
tire pressure
• Installing different type of tires
5
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• The Smart Cruise Control
System cannot recognize a
stopped vehicle, pedestrians
or an oncoming vehicle.
Always look ahead cautiously
to prevent unexpected and
sudden situations from occurring.
• Vehicles moving in front of
you with a frequent lane
change may cause a delay in
the system's reaction or may
cause the system to react to a
vehicle actually in an adjacent
lane. Always drive cautiously
to prevent unexpected and
sudden situations from occurring.
• Always be aware of the selected speed and vehicle to vehicle distance. The driver
should not solely rely on the
system but always pay attention to driving conditions and
control your vehicle speed.
(Continued)
5-115
Driving your vehicle
LANE FOLLOWING ASSIST (LFA) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
The Lane Following Assist
(LFA) system is not a substitute
for safe driving practices, but a
convenience function. It is the
responsibility of the driver to
always be aware of the surroundings and steer the vehicle.
OAEE059013L
The Lane Following Assist (LFA) system helps detect lane markers on the
road with a front view camera at the
front windshield, and assists the driver's steering to help keep the vehicle between lanes.
5-116
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when using the Lane Following
Assist (LFA) system:
• Do not turn the steering wheel
suddenly when the steering
wheel is being assisted by the
system.
• LFA system helps the driver
to keep the vehicle in the center of the lane by assisting the
driver's steering. However, the
driver should not solely rely
on the system but always pay
attention on the steering
wheel to stay in the lane.
• The operation of the LFA system can be canceled or not
work properly according to
road condition and surroundings. Always be cautious
when driving.
(Continued)
(Continued)
Please refer to "Limitations of
the System".
• Do not remove or damage the
related parts of LFA system.
• You may not hear a warning
sound of LFA system if the
audio volume is high.
• Do not place objects on the
dashboard that reflects light
such as mirrors, white paper,
etc. This may prevent the LFA
system from functioning
properly.
• Always have your hands on
the steering wheel while the
LFA system is activated. If you
continue to drive with your
hands off the steering wheel
after the "Keep hands on
steering wheel" warning message appears, the system will
turn off automatically.
However, if the driver has their
hands on the steering wheel
again, the system will start
controlling the steering wheel.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• The steering wheel is not continuously controlled so if the
vehicle speed is at a higher
rate when leaving a lane the
vehicle may not be controlled
by the system. The driver
must always follow the speed
limit when using the system.
• If you attach objects to the
steering wheel, the system
may not assist steering or the
hands off alarm may not work
properly.
• When you tow a trailer, make
sure that you turn off the LFA
system.
5-117
5
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• Do not disassemble the front
view camera temporarily to
tint the window or attach any
types of coatings and accessories. If you disassemble the
camera and assemble it again,
we recommend that you take
your vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the
system checked for calibration.
• When you replace the windshield glass, front view camera or related parts of the
steering wheel, we recommend that you take your vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system
checked for calibration.
• The system helps detect lane
markers and controls the
steering wheel by a camera,
therefore, if the lane markers
are hard to detect, the system
may not work properly.
(Continued)
Driving your vehicle
LFA operation
System setting
• With the ignition switch is in the ON
position, Lane Following Assist can
be activated by selecting 'User settings → Driver assistance →
Driving assist → Lane following
assist' in the cluster LCD display.
Deselect the setting to turn off the
system.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the
last setting.
5-118
Operating conditions
LFA system operation
Select 'Lane following assist' from
the User settings mode in the cluster
LCD display and meet the following
conditions for the system to operate.
- The Smart Cruise Control is operating
- Vehicle speed is lower than 180
km/h (110 mph)
When the system is activated, the
indicator ( ) on the cluster will illuminate. The color of the indicator will
change depending on the condition
of the LFA system.
- Green : Steering assist mode is
ON
- White : Steering assist mode is
OFF
OAEE059127L
If the vehicle is inside the lane with
both lanes detected by the
system(lane color changes from gray
to white), and there is no abrupt
steering made by the driver, the LFA
system changes to steering assist
mode. The
indicator light will
come on green, and the system
helps the vehicle stay in line by controlling the steering wheel. If the lane
markers are hard to detect, steering
wheel will be able to be controlled
depending on front vehicle and front
vehicle driving conditions. When the
steering wheel is not controlled temporarily, the
indicator light will
flash green and change to white.
Warning message
WARNING
The warning message may
appear late according to road
conditions. Therefore, always
have your hands on the steering
wheel while driving.
OOSEV058104L
OAEPH059625L
i Information
Hold the steering wheel tight.
Otherwise, the LFA system could misjudge that the driver's hands are off
the steering wheel, and the above
warning may occur.
5-119
5
Driving your vehicle
Keep hands on steering wheel
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds
while the LFA system is activated,
the system will warn the driver.
Driver's hands not detected.
LFA system is disabled temporarily
If the driver still does not have their
hands on the steering wheel after the
message "Keep hands on steering
wheel", the system will not control
the steering wheel and warn the driver only when the driver crosses the
lane markers.
However, if the driver has their hands
on the steering wheel again, the system will start controlling the steering
wheel.
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
• The LFA system is a supplemental system only. It is the
responsibility of the driver to
safely steer the vehicle and to
maintain it in its lane.
• Turn off the LFA system and
drive without using the system in the following situations:
- In bad weather
- In bad road conditions
- When the steering wheel
needs to be controlled by the
driver frequently.
i Information
• Even though the steering is assisted
by the system, the driver may control the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel may feel heavier
when the steering wheel is assisted
by the system than when it is not.
5-120
OOSEV058105L
Check LFA (Lane Following Assist)
system
If there is a problem with the system
a message will appear for a few seconds. If the problem continues the
LFA system failure indicator will illuminate.
The LFA system will not be in the
ENABLED state and/or the steering
wheel will not be assisted when:
• The turn signal is turned on before
changing a lane. If you change
lanes without the turn signal on,
the steering wheel might be controlled.
• The vehicle is not driven in the middle of the lane when the system is
turned on or right after changing a
lane.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) or
VSM (Vehicle Stability Management)
is activated.
• The vehicle is driven on a sharp
curve.
• Vehicle speed is over 180km/h (110
mph).
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle brakes suddenly.
• Only one lane marker is detected.
• The lane is very wide or narrow.
• There are more than two lane
markers on the road (e.g. construction area).
• Radius of a curve is too small.
• The vehicle is driven on a steep
incline.
• The steering wheel is turned suddenly.
• The system may not operate for 15
seconds after the vehicle is started
or the camera is initialized or
rebooting of the front view camera.
Limitations of the system
The LFA system may operate prematurely even if the vehicle does not
depart from the intended lane, OR,
the LFA system may not assist your
steering or warn you if the vehicle
leaves the intended lane under the
following circumstances:
5-121
5
Driving your vehicle
When the lane and road conditions are poor
• It is difficult to distinguish the lane
marking from the road surface or
the lane marking is faded or not
clearly marked.
• It is difficult to distinguish the color
of the lane marker from the road.
• There are markings on the road
surface that look like a lane marker
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• The lane marker is indistinct or
damaged.
• The lane marker is merged or
divided. (e.g. tollgate)
• The lane number increases or
decreases or the lane marker are
crossing complicatedly.
• There are more than two lane
markers on the road in front of you.
Driving your vehicle
• The lane marker is very thick or
thin.
• The lane is very wide or narrow.
• The lane marker ahead is not visible due to rain, snow, water on the
road, damaged or stained road
surface, or other factors.
• The shadow is on the lane marker
by a median strip, trees, guardrail,
noise barriers, etc.
• The lane markers are complicated
or a structure substitutes for the
lines such as a construction area.
• There are crosswalk signs or other
symbols on the road.
• The lane marker in a tunnel is
stained with oil, etc.
• The lane suddenly disappears
such as at the intersection.
5-122
When external condition is intervened
• The brightness outside changes
suddenly such as when entering or
exiting a tunnel, or when passing
under a bridge.
• The brightness outside is too low
such as when the headlamps are
not on at night or the vehicle is
going through a tunnel.
• There is a boundary structure in
the roadway such as a concrete
barrier, guardrail and reflector post
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• When light coming from a street
light or an oncoming vehicle is
reflected on a wet road surface
such as a puddle in the road.
• The field of view in front is
obstructed by sun glare.
• There is not enough distance
between you and the vehicle in
front to be able to detect the lane
marker or the vehicle ahead is driving on the lane marker.
• Driving on a steep grade, over a
hill, or when driving on a curved
road.
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving.
• The surrounding of the inside rear
view mirror temperature is high
due to direct sunlight, etc.
When front visibility is poor
• The windshield or the camera lens
is blocked with dirt or debris.
• The windshield glass is fogged up;
a clear view of the road is obstructed.
• Placing objects on the dashboard,
etc.
• The sensor cannot detect the lane
because of fog, heavy rain or snow.
REAR CROSS-TRAFFIC COLLISION WARNING (RCCW) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
System description
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) System
OAD058158N
• Always be aware of road and
traffic conditions while driving and be alert for unexpected situations even though the
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) System is
operating.
• The Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) System is
supplemental systems to assist
you. Do not entirely rely on the
systems. Always pay attention,
while driving, for your safety.
• The Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) System is not
substitutes for proper and safe
driving. Always drive safely and
use caution when backing up
the vehicle.
System setting and operation
System setting
OAEPH059653L
• Setting Parking Safety function
The driver can activate the systems by placing the ignition switch
to the ON position and by selecting
'User settings → Driver assistance
→ Parking safety'. The system
turns on and is ready to be operated when 'Rear cross-traffic safety'
is selected.
• When the vehicle is turned off then
on again, the system will be ready
to be operated.
5-123
5
Driving your vehicle
The Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) System uses radar
sensors to monitor the approaching
cross traffic from the left and right
side of the vehicle when your vehicle
is in reverse.
The blind spot detection range varies
relative to the approaching vehicle
speed.
WARNING
Driving your vehicle
• When the system is initially turned
on and when the vehicle is turned
off then on again, the warning light
will illuminate for 3 seconds on the
outside rearview mirror.
OAEPH059650L
• Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time from the
User Settings in the cluster LCD
display by selecting 'User settings
→ Driver assistance → Warning
timing → Normal/Later'.
The options for the initial Rear
Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
includes the following:
- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning is activated normally. If
this setting feels too sensitive
change the option to 'late'.
The warning activation time may
feel late if the side/rear vehicle
abruptly accelerates.
- Later:
Select this warning activation time
when the traffic is light and you are
driving at low speeds.
i Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change.
Alaways be aware before changing the
warning timing.
5-124
Operating conditions
OAEPH059652L
i Information
If you change the warning volume, the
warning volume of other systems may
change.
Alaways be aware before changing the
warning volume.
For more information refer to
"LCD Display Modes" in chapter 3.
The system's detecting range is
approximately 0.5 m ~ 20 m (1 ft ~ 65
ft). An approaching vehicle will be
detected if their vehicle speed is
within 8 km/h ~ 36 km/h (5 ~ 22.5
mph).
Note that the detecting range and
operating speed may vary under certain conditions. As always, use caution and pay close attention to your
surroundings when backing up your
vehicle.
Warning message and system
control
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) System
■ Left
■ Right
5
OAEE059046/OAEE059047
If the vehicle detected by the sensors
approaches from the rear left/right
side of your vehicle, the warning
chime will sound, the warning light
on the outside rearview mirror will
blink and a message will appear on
the LCD display. If the rear view monitor system is in activation, a message will also appear on the audio or
infotainment system screen.
5-125
Driving your vehicle
• Setting Warning Volume
The driver can select the warning
volume from the User Settings in
the LCD display by selecting 'User
settings → Driver assistance →
Warning volume → High/Medium/
Low'.
To operate:
1. Go to the 'User settings → Driver
assistance → Parking safety →
Rear Cross-Traffic Safety' on the
LCD display. The system will turn
on and standby to operate.
2. The system will operate when
vehicle speed is below 10 km/h (7
mph) and with the shift lever in R
(Reverse).
* The system will not operate when
the vehicle speed exceeds 10 km/h
(7 mph). The system will activate
again when the speed is below 10
km/h (7 mph).
Driving your vehicle
The warning will stop when:
- The detected vehicle moves out of
the sensing area or
- When the vehicle is right behind
your vehicle or
- When the vehicle is not approaching your vehicle or
- When the other vehicle slows
down.
- The vehicle's approaching speed is
decreased.
5-126
CAUTION
• When the operation condition
of the Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning (RCCW)
System is satisfied the warning will occur every time a
vehicle
approaches
the
side/rear of your stopped (0
km/h vehicle speed) vehicle.
• The system's warning may
not operate properly if the
left/right of your vehicle's rear
bumper is blocked by a vehicle or obstacle.
• Always pay attention to road
and traffic conditions while
driving, whether or not the
warning light on the outside
rearview mirror illuminates or
there is a warning alarm.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may prevent occupants from hearing
the system's warning sounds.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• The warning of the Rear CrossTraffic Collision Warning
(RCCW) System may not sound
while other system's warning
sounds.
WARNING
• If any other warning sound
such as seat belt warning
chime is already generated,
the
Rear
Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning (RCCW) system warning may not sound.
• Drive safely even though the
vehicle is equipped with a
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning System. Do not solely rely on the system but
check your surrounding when
backing the vehicle up.
• The driver is responsible for
accurate brake control.
(Continued)
Detecting Sensor
NOTICE
OAEE059012
The rear radars are located inside
the rear bumper for detecting the
side and rear. Always keep the rear
bumper clean for proper operation of
the system.
• The system may not work properly when the bumper has been
damaged, or if the rear bumper
has been replaced or repaired.
• The system may turn off if interfered by strong electromagnetic
waves.
• Always keep the sensors clean.
• NEVER disassemble the sensor
component or apply any impact
on the sensor component.
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary force on the radar sensor or
sensor cover. If the sensor is
forcibly moved out of proper
alignment, the system may not
operate correctly. In this case, a
warning message may not be displayed. We recommend that you
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
(Continued)
5-127
5
Driving your vehicle
(Continued)
• Always pay extreme caution
while driving. The Rear CrossTraffic Collision Warning
(RCCW) System may not operate properly or unnecessarily
operate depending on traffic
and driving conditions.
• The
Rear
Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning (RCCW)
System is not a substitute for
safe driving practices, but a
convenience function only. It
is the responsibility of the
driver to always drive cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
Driving your vehicle
i Information
(Continued)
• Do not apply foreign objects
such as a bumper sticker or a
bumper guard near the radar
sensor or apply paint to the sensor area. Doing so may adversely affect the performance of the
sensor.
OOSEV058035L
BCW (Blind-Spot Collision
Warning) system disabled.
Radar blocked
• This warning message may appear
when:
- One or both of the sensors on the
rear bumper is blocked by dirt or
snow or a foreign object.
- Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle for an extended period of
time.
- When there is inclement weather
such as heavy snow or rain.
If any of these conditions occur, the
light on the BCW switch and the system will turn off automatically.
5-128
Turn off the BCW and RCCW system
(if equipped) when a trailer or carrier
is installed.
- Press the BCW button (the indicator on the button will turn off)
- Deactivate the RCCW system by
deselecting
'User settings → Driver assistance
→ Parking safety → Rear crosstraffic safety'
Limitations of the system
OOSEV048203L
Check BCW (Blind-Spot Collision
Warning) system
If there is a problem with the BCW
system, a warning message will
appear and the light on the button
will turn off. The system will turn off
automatically. RCCW will not operate
also if the BCW system turns off due
to malfunction. We recommend that
you have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The driver must be cautious in the
below situations because the system
may not detect other vehicles or
objects in certain circumstances:
• The vehicle drives in inclement
weather such as heavy rain or
snow.
• The sensor is polluted with rain,
snow, mud, etc.
• The rear bumper where the sensor
is located is covered with a foreign
object such as a bumper sticker, a
bumper guard, a bike rack, etc.
• The rear bumper is damaged, or
the sensor is out of the original
default position.
• The vehicle height gets lower or
higher due to heavy loading in a
tailgate, abnormal tire pressure,
etc.
• When the temperature of the rear
bumper is high.
• When the sensors are blocked by
other vehicles, walls or parking-lot
pillars.
5-129
5
Driving your vehicle
When the BCW canceled warning
message is displayed in the cluster,
check to make sure that the rear
bumper is free from any dirt or snow
in the areas where the sensor is
located. Remove any dirt, snow, or
foreign material that could interfere
with the radar sensors.
After any dirt or debris is removed,
the RCCW system should operate
normally after about 10 minutes of
driving the vehicle.
If the system still does not operate
normally, we recommend that the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Driving your vehicle
• The vehicle is driven on a curved
road.
• The road pavement (or the peripheral ground) abnormally contains
metallic components (i.e. possibly
due to subway construction).
• There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as a guardrail.
• While going down or up a steep
road where the height of the lane is
different.
• Driving on a narrow road where
trees or grass or overgrown.
• Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle for an extended period of
time.
• Driving on a wet road.
• Driving on a road where the
guardrail or wall is in double structure.
• A big vehicle is near such as a bus
or truck.
• When the other vehicle approaches very close.
• When the other vehicle passes at a
very fast speed.
5-130
• While changing lanes.
• If the vehicle has started at the
same time as the vehicle next to
you and has accelerated.
• When the vehicle in the next lane
moves two lanes away from you
OR when the vehicle two lanes
away moves to the next lane from
you.
• A motorcycle or bicycle is near.
• A flat trailer is near.
• If there are small objects in the
detecting area such as a shopping
cart or a baby stroller.
• If there is a low height vehicle such
as a sports car.
• Temperature is extremely low
around the vehicle.
• The vehicle severely vibrates while
driving over a bumpy road,
uneven/bumpy road, or concrete
patch.
• The vehicle is driven on a slippery
surface due to snow, water puddle,
or ice.
OAD058159N
[A] : Structure
• Driving where there is a vehicle or
structure near
The system may not operate properly when driving where there is a
vehicle or structure near.
In certain instances, the system
may not detect the vehicle
approaching from behind and the
warning may not operate properly.
Always pay attention to your surrounding while driving.
OAD058160N
• When the vehicle is parked diagonally
The system may not operate properly when the vehicle is parked
diagonally.
In certain instances, when the
diagonally parked vehicle is pulled
out of the parking space, the system may not detect the vehicle
approaching from the rear left/right
of your vehicle. In this case, the
warning may not operate properly.
Always pay attention to your surrounding while driving.
OAD058152N
• When the vehicle is on/near a
slope
The system may not operate properly when the vehicle is on/near a
slope.
In certain instances, the system
may not detect the vehicle
approaching from the rear left/right
and the warning may not operate
properly.
Always pay attention to your surrounding while driving.
5-131
5
Driving your vehicle
• When the vehicle is in a complex
parking environment
The system may not operate properly when the vehicle is in a complex parking environment.
In certain instances, the system
may not be able to exactly determine the risk of collision for the
vehicles which are parking or
pulling out near your vehicle (e.g. a
vehicle escaping beside your vehicle, a vehicle parking or pulling out
in the rear area, a vehicle
approaching your vehicle making a
turn, etc.).
In this case, the warning may not
operate properly.
OAD058162L
[A] : Vehicle
Driving your vehicle
OAD058161L
[A] : Structure, [B] : Wall
• Pulling into the parking space
where there is a structure
The system may not operate properly when pulling in the vehicle to
the parking space where there is a
structure at the back or side of your
vehicle.
In certain instances, when backing
into the parking space, the system
may falsely detect the vehicle moving in front of your vehicle. In this
case, the warning may operate.
Always pay attention to the parking
space while driving.
5-132
OAD058163N
• When the vehicle is parked rearward
If the vehicle is parked rearward
and the sensor detects the another
vehicle in the rear area of the parking space, warning may operate.
Always pay attention to the parking
space while driving.
SPEED LIMIT CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
Speed Limit Control operation
Speed limit control switch
To set speed limit
You can set the speed limit when you
do not want to drive over a specific
speed.
If you drive over the preset speed
limit, the warning system operates
(set speed limit will blink and chime
will sound) until the vehicle speed
returns within the speed limit.
i Information
While speed limit control is in operation, the cruise control system cannot
be activated.
OAE056068L
: Changes mode between cruise
control/smart cruise control
system and speed limit control
system.
1. Press the
button to turn the
system on. The speed limit indicator in the instrument cluster will
illuminate.
System off
Cruise Control/Smart
Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
RES+: Resumes or increases speed
limit control speed.
SET-: Sets or decreases speed limit
control speed.
O: Cancels set speed limit.
5-133
5
Driving your vehicle
OAE056152L
Driving your vehicle
To turn off the speed limit control, do one of the following:
OAE056069L
OOSEV058037
2. Push the toggle switch down
(SET-).
3. • Push the toggle switch up
(RES+) or down (SET-), and
release it at the desired speed.
• Push the toggle switch up
(RES+) or down (SET-) and hold
it. The speed will increase or
decrease by 5 km/h.
The set speed limit will display on the
instrument cluster.
If you would like to drive over the preset speed limit when you depress the
accelerator pedal less than approximately 50%, the vehicle speed will
maintain within speed limit.
However if you depress the accelerator pedal more than approximately
70%, you can drive over the speed
limit. Then the set speed limit will
blink and chime will sound until you
return the vehicle speed within the
speed limit.
5-134
OAE056068L
• Press the
button. The speed
limit (
) indicator will go off.
• If you press O (cancel) button
once, the set speed limit will cancel, but it will not turn the system
off. If you wish to resume the speed
limit, push the +RES or SET- toggle switch on your steering wheel
to your desired speed.
INTELLIGENT SPEED LIMIT WARNING (ISLW) (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
• Intelligent
OAEE059013L
5-135
5
Driving your vehicle
The Intelligent Speed Limit Warning
(ISLW) system displays the speed
limit information and overtaking
restriction of the current road
through the instrument cluster and
the navigation. The ISLW reads the
traffic signs through the front view
camera, which is attached on the
upper part of the inner front windshield.
The ISLW also utilizes the navigation
and vehicle information to display the
speed limit information.
Speed
Limit
Warning (ISLW) system is
only a supplemental system
and is not always able to correctly display speed limits
and overtaking restrictions.
• The driver still holds the
responsibility not to exceed
the maximum speed limit.
• The ISLW detects the traffic
signs through the front view
camera to display the speed
limit information.
Therefore, the ISLW may not
properly operate, when it is
hard to detect the traffic signs.
For further details, please
refer to the "Limitations of the
system".
• Pay extreme caution to keep
the front view camera sensor
out of water.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not disassemble the camera assembly, or apply any
impact on the front view camera assembly.
• Do not disassemble the camera temporarily to tint the window or attach any types of
coatings and accessories. If
you disassemble the front
view camera and assemble it
again, we recommend that
you take your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer
and have the system checked
for calibration.
• Do not place any reflective
objects (i.e. white paper, mirror) over the dashboard. Any
light reflection may cause a
malfunction system.
• The system is not available in
all countries.
Driving your vehicle
i Information
We recommend that you have the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer when:
• The windshield glass is replaced.
• The front view front view camera or
related parts are repaired or
removed.
System setting and operation
System setting
• The driver can activate the ISLW by
selecting 'User settings → Driver
assistance → SLW (Speed Limit
Warning)'.
• When the ISLW is activated, the
symbols appear on the instrument
cluster to display the speed limit
information and overtaking restriction.
• When the ISLW is activated in the
navigation setting, the above information and the restriction are also
displayed on the navigation.
System activation
• The ISLW displays the speed limit
information and displays the overtaking restriction, when your vehicle passes by the relevant traffic
signs.
• The ISLW displays the previous
speed limit information, right after
the ignition switch is placed to the
ON position.
• You may find different speed limit
information for the same road. The
information is displayed depending
on the driving situations. Because,
traffic signs with additional sign
(e.g. rainy, arrow, etc.) are also
detected and compared with vehicle internal data (e.g. wiper operation, turn signal, etc.).
i Information
The speed limit information on the
instrument cluster may differ from
the one on the navigation. In this case,
check the speed unit setting on the
navigation.
5-136
Display
Display in cluster
■ No reliable speed limit information
OAEE059632L
WTL-220
Conditional road sign
If the ISLW detects the conditional
road sign, the symbol of road sign is
overlapped at the bottom or left of
the speed limit on the cluster.
There may be signs with different
speed limits on the same road. For
example, normally, the speed limit is
120 km/h, however the speed limit is
90 km/h when it is raining or snowing.
The conditional road sign means that
you observe the speed limit and
overtaking prohibition on certain
conditions, such as when rain or
snow.
Additional road signs
• The symbol is displayed on the
instrument cluster and the navigation, when the ISLW does not have
any reliable speed limit information.
5-137
5
Driving your vehicle
The cluster displays the speed limit
information, overtaking restriction
and conditional road sign.
OAEE059634L
Driving your vehicle
■ No passing information
■ Unlimited speed (only in Germany)
■ End of a speed limit
WTL-222/WTL-221
WUM-207/WUM-208
WUM-205
• The symbol is displayed on the
instrument cluster and the navigation, when the ISLW detects a noovertaking sign.
• After the vehicle passes a 'end of
speed limit' sign, the ISLW system
informs the driver of the next applicable speed limit based on the
information received from the navigation.
• The symbol, 'end of limitation', is
displayed on the instrument cluster
for the roads in Germany, which
have no speed limit applicable. It is
displayed, until the vehicle passes
by another speed limit sign.
5-138
Display in the Assist mode of
the cluster
i Information
OAEPH059658L
OAEE059655L
1. Speed limit and overtaking restriction of current road
2. Conditional speed limit or overtaking restriction
3. Conditional road sign : Trailer, rain,
snow or empty space
❈ Empty space : other conditional
road sign (time etc.)
5
Driving your vehicle
The driver can monitor the information provided from the ISLW system
on the LCD display.
The ISLW screen will appear when
you select the Driving Assist mode
tab (
) on the LCD display if the
system is activated. For more details,
refer to "LCD Display Modes" in
chapter 3.
The conditional speed limit and overtaking restriction may be different
from the speed limit and overtaking
restriction of current road.
And, the conditional speed limit and
overtaking restriction displayed on
the cluster will disappear after driving
for a certain distance.
If ISLW don't recognize the road sign,
nothing is displayed.
5-139
Driving your vehicle
To turn ISLW off
Warning message
OOSEV058082L
OOSEV048212L
OOSEV058081L
SLW (Speed Limit Warning) system
off
If the system is turned off from the
User Settings mode, this message is
displayed on the cluster LCD display
when the ISLW screen is selected
from the Driving Assist mode (
).
SLW (Speed Limit Warning) system
disabled. Camera obscured
The warning message appears,
when the camera lens is blocked by
some objects. The Intelligent Speed
Limit Warning (ISLW) system does
not operate until the objects are
removed. Check the windshield glass
around the camera area. If the problem persists after removing the
objects, we recommend that you
have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-140
Check SLW (Speed Limit Warning)
system
The warning message appears for a
few seconds, when the ISLW does
not properly operate. Then, the master warning light (
) will illuminate.
We recommend that you have the
system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Limitations of the System
The Intelligent Speed Limit Warning
(ISLW) system may not operate or
may not provide correct information
in the following situations.
When front visibility is poor
• There is something wrong with
GPS.
• The vehicle information such as
outside temperature is not accurate.
When front visibility is poor
• The weather is bad, such as raining, snowing, and fogging.
• There is dirt, ice or frost on the
front windshield, where the camera
is installed.
• The camera lens is blocked by an
object, such as sticker, paper, or
fallen leaf.
WARNING
• The ISLW is only to assist the
driver. The driver should pay
great caution to the vehicle
operation.
• The driver always holds the
responsibility of safe driving
by following the applicable
road traffic rule(s) and regulation(s).
5-141
5
Driving your vehicle
When the traffic sign condition is
poor
• The traffic sign is located on a
sharp curve.
• The traffic sign is improperly positioned (i.e. turned over, blocked by
an object, and damaged).
• Another vehicle blocks the traffic
sign.
• The LED light of the traffic sign is
broken.
• There is sunlight glare around the
traffic sign due to low solar altitude.
• It is dark at night.
• There is bright light around the traffic sign.
When external condition is intervened
• Your vehicle drives right after
another vehicle.
• The bus or truck, on which the
speed sticker is attached, passes
by your vehicle.
• Your vehicle drives in an area,
which is uncovered by the navigation system.
• There is a malfunction with the
navigation
• Your navigation has not been
updated.
• Your navigation is being updated.
• As a result of incorrect detection by
the camera.
• The top speed limitations stored in
the navigation system are incorrect.
• The road signs do not correspond
to the standard.
• The camera is calibrated right after
the vehicle is delivered.
Driving your vehicle
SPECIAL DRIVING CONDITIONS
Hazardous driving conditions
Rocking the vehicle
When hazardous driving elements
are encountered such as water,
snow, ice, mud and sand, take the
bellow suggestions:
• Drive cautiously and keep a longer
braking distance.
• Avoid abrupt braking or steering.
• When your vehicle is stuck in snow,
mud, or sand, use second gear.
Accelerate slowly to avoid unnecessary wheel spin.
• Put sand, rock salt, tire chains or
other non-slip materials under the
wheels to provide additional traction while the vehicle becomes
stuck in ice, snow, or mud.
If it is necessary to rock the vehicle
to free it from snow, sand, or mud,
first turn the steering wheel right and
left to clear the area around your
front wheels. Then, shift back and
forth between R (Reverse) and a forward gear.
Try to avoid spinning the wheels, and
do not race the vehicle.
To prevent reduction gear wear, wait
until the wheels stop spinning before
shifting gears. Release the accelerator pedal while shifting, and press
lightly on the accelerator pedal while
the reduction gear is in gear. Slowly
spinning the wheels in forward and
reverse directions causes a rocking
motion that may free the vehicle.
5-142
WARNING
If the vehicle is stuck and
excessive wheel spin occurs,
the temperature in the tires can
increase very quickly. If the tires
become damaged, a tire blow
out or tire explosion can occur.
This condition is dangerous you and others may be injured.
Do not attempt this procedure if
people or objects are anywhere
near the vehicle.
If you attempt to free the vehicle, the vehicle can overheat
quickly, possibly causing an
motor compartment fire or
other damage. Try to avoid spinning the wheels as much as
possible to prevent overheating
of either the tires or the vehicle.
DO NOT allow the vehicle to
spin the wheels above 56 km/h
(35 mph).
i Information
The ESC system (if equipped) must be
turned OFF before rocking the vehicle.
Driving in the rain
Avoid braking or gear changing in
corners, especially when roads are
wet. Ideally, corners should always
be taken under gentle acceleration.
Rain and wet roads can make driving
dangerous. Here are a few things to
consider when driving in the rain or
on slick pavement:
• Slow down and allow extra following distance. A heavy rainfall
makes it harder to see and increases the distance needed to stop
your vehicle.
• Turn OFF your Cruise Control. (if
equipped)
• Replace your windshield wiper
blades when they show signs of
streaking or missing areas on the
windshield.
• Be sure your tires have enough
tread. If your tires do not have
enough tread, making a quick stop
on wet pavement can cause a skid
and possibly lead to an accident.
See "Tire Tread" in chapter 7.
• Turn on your headlamps to make it
easier for others to see you.
• Driving too fast through large puddles can affect your brakes. If you
must go through puddles, try to
drive through them slowly.
NOTICE
If you are still stuck after rocking
the vehicle a few times, have the
vehicle pulled out by a tow vehicle
to avoid vehicle overheating, possible damage to the reduction
gear and tire damage. See
"Towing" in chapter 6.
Driving at night
Night driving presents more hazards
than driving in the daylight. Here are
some important tips to remember:
• Slow down and keep more distance between you and other vehicles, as it may be more difficult to
see at night, especially in areas
where there may not be any street
lights.
• Adjust your mirrors to reduce the
glare from other driver's headlamps.
• Keep your headlamps clean and
properly aimed. Dirty or improperly
aimed headlamps will make it
much more difficult to see at night.
• Avoid staring directly at the headlamps of oncoming vehicles. You
could be temporarily blinded, and it
will take several seconds for your
eyes to readjust to the darkness.
5-143
5
Driving your vehicle
Smooth cornering
Driving your vehicle
• If you believe your brakes may be
wet, apply them lightly while driving until normal braking operation
returns.
Hydroplaning
If the road is wet enough and you are
going fast enough, your vehicle may
have little or no contact with the road
surface and actually ride on the
water. The best advice is SLOW
DOWN when the road is wet.
The risk of hydroplaning increases as the depth of tire tread
decreases, refer to "Tire Tread" in
chapter 7.
5-144
Driving in flooded areas
Avoid driving through flooded areas
unless you are sure the water is no
higher than the bottom of the wheel
hub. Drive through any water slowly.
Allow adequate stopping distance
because brake performance may be
reduced.
After driving through water, dry the
brakes by gently applying them several times while the vehicle is moving
slowly.
Highway driving
Tires
Adjust the tire inflation, as specified.
Under-inflation may overheat or
damage the tires.
Do not install worn-out or damaged
tires, which may reduce traction or
fail the braking operation.
i Information
Never over-inflate your tires above the
maximum inflation pressure, as specified on your tires.
Coolant and high voltage battery
Be sure to check both the coolant
level and the high voltage battery
level before driving.
WINTER DRIVING
The severe weather conditions of
winter quickly wear out tires and
cause other problems. To minimize
winter driving problems, you should
take the following suggestions:
i Information
Information for Snow Tires and Tire
Chains in the national language
(Bulgarian, Hungarian, Icelandic,
Polish) is provided in the Appendix.
Snow or icy conditions
WARNING
Snow tires should be equivalent
in size and type to the vehicle's
standard tires. Otherwise, the
safety and handling of your vehicle may be adversely affected.
If you mount snow tires on your vehicle, make sure to use radial tires of
the same size and load range as the
original tires. Mount snow tires on all
four wheels to balance your vehicle’s
handling in all weather conditions.
The traction provided by snow tires
on dry roads may not be as high as
your vehicle's original equipment
tires. Check with the tire dealer for
maximum speed recommendations.
i Information
Do not install studded tires without first
checking local and municipal regulations for possible restrictions against
their use.
5-145
5
Driving your vehicle
You need to keep sufficient distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle
in front of you.
Apply the brakes gently. Speeding,
rapid acceleration, sudden brake
applications, and sharp turns are
potentially very hazardous practices.
During deceleration use the paddle
shifter (left side lever) to increase
regenerative braking. However, avoid
increasing the regenerative braking
level suddenly. Sudden change of the
regenerative braking level on snowy
or icy roads may cause the vehicle to
skid and may cause loss of vehicle
control leading to an accident.
To drive your vehicle in deep snow, it
may be necessary to use snow tires
or to install tire chains on your tires.
Always carry emergency equipment.
Some of the items you may want to
carry include tire chains, tow straps
or chains, a flashlight, emergency
flares, sand, a shovel, jumper cables,
a window scraper, gloves, ground
cloth, coveralls, a blanket, etc.
Snow tires
Driving your vehicle
Tire chains
WARNING
OAEE059015
Since the sidewalls of radial tires are
thinner than other types of tires, they
may be damaged by mounting some
types of tire chains on them.
Therefore, the use of snow tires is
recommended instead of tire chains.
Do not mount tire chains on vehicles
equipped with aluminum wheels; if
unavoidable use a wire type chain. If
tire chains must be used, use genuine HYUNDAI parts and install the
tire chain after reviewing the instructions provided with the tire chains.
Damage to your vehicle caused by
improper tire chain use is not covered by your vehicle manufacturer’s
warranty.
5-146
The use of tire chains may
adversely affect vehicle handling:
• Drive less than 30 km/h (20
mph) or the chain manufacturer's recommended speed
limit, whichever is lower.
• Drive carefully and avoid
bumps, holes, sharp turns,
and other road hazards, which
may cause the vehicle to
bounce.
• Avoid sharp turns or locked
wheel braking.
i Information
• Install tire chains only in pairs and
on the front tires. It should be noted
that installing tire chains on the
tires will provide a greater driving
force, but will not prevent side
skids.
• Do not install studded tires without
first checking local and municipal
regulations for possible restrictions
against their use.
NOTICE
When using tire chains:
• Wrong size chains or improperly
installed chains can damage
your vehicle's brake lines, suspension, body and wheels.
• Use SAE "S" class or wire
chains.
• If you hear noise caused by
chains contacting the body,
retighten the chain to prevent
contact with the vehicle body.
• To prevent body damage,
retighten the chains after driving
0.5~1.0 km (0.3~0.6 miles).
• Do not use tire chains on vehicles equipped with aluminum
wheels. If unavoidable, use a
wire type chain.
• Use wire chains less than 12 mm
(0.47 in) thick to prevent damage
to the chain's connection.
Winter precautions
Check battery and cables
The winter temperature increases
the battery consumption. Inspect
the battery and cables, as specified in the chapter 7. The battery
charging level can be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer or in a
service station.
Change to "winter weight" oil if
necessary
In some regions during winter, it is
recommended to use the "winter
weight" oil with lower viscosity. For
further information, refer to the chapter 8. When you are not sure about a
type of winter weight oil, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-147
5
Driving your vehicle
Chain Installation
When installing tire chains, follow the
manufacturer's instructions and
mount them as tightly possible. Drive
slowly (less than 30 km/h (20 mph))
with chains installed. If you hear the
chains contacting the body or chassis, stop and tighten them. If they still
make contact, slow down until the
noise stops. Remove the tire chains
as soon as you begin driving on
cleared roads.
When mounting snow chains, park
the vehicle on level ground away
from traffic. Turn on the vehicle
Hazard Warning Flasher and place a
triangular emergency warning device
behind the vehicle (if available).
Always place the vehicle in P (Park),
apply the parking brake and turn off
the vehicle before installing snow
chains.
Driving your vehicle
To prevent locks from freezing
To prevent the locks from being
frozen, spray approved de-icing fluid
or glycerin into key holes. When a
lock opening is already covered with
ice, spray approved de-icing fluid
over the ice to remove it. When an
internal part of a lock freezes, try to
thaw it with a heated key. Carefully
use the heated key to avoid an injury.
Use approved window washer
anti-freeze solution in system
To prevent the window washer from
being frozen, add authorized window
washer anti-freeze solution, as specified on the window washer container. Window washer anti-freeze solution is available from an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer, and so are the
most vehicle accessory outlets. Do
not use coolant or other types of antifreeze solution to prevent any damage to the vehicle paint.
5-148
Do not let your parking brake
freeze
Under some conditions your parking
brake can freeze in the engaged
position. This is most likely to happen
when there is an accumulation of
snow or ice around or near the rear
brakes or if the brakes are wet. When
there is the risk that your parking
brake may freeze, temporarily shift to
P (Park). Also, block the rear wheels
in advance, so the vehicle may not
roll. Then, release the parking brake.
Do not let ice and snow accumulate underneath
Under some conditions, snow and
ice can build up under the fenders
and interfere with the steering. When
driving in such conditions during the
severe winter, you should check
underneath the vehicle on a regular
basis, so that moving the front
wheels and the steering components
is unblocked.
Carry emergency equipment
In accordance with weather conditions, you should carry appropriate
emergency equipment, while driving.
Some of the items you may want to
carry include tire chains, tow straps
or chains, flashlight, emergency
flares, sand, shovel, jumper cables,
window scraper, gloves, ground
cloth, coveralls, blanket, etc.
Do not place objects or materials
in the motor compartment
Putting objects or materials in the
motor compartment may cause an
vehicle failure, because those may
block cooling the parts in the motor
compartment. Such damage will not
be covered by the manufacturer's
warranty.
VEHICLE WEIGHT
Two labels on your driver’s door sill
show how much weight your vehicle
was designed to carry: the Tire and
Loading Information Label and the
Certification Label.
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms
for determining your vehicle's weight
ratings, from the vehicle's specifications and the Certification Label:
Vehicle Curb Weight
This is the weight of your new vehicle
when you picked it up from your dealer plus any aftermarket equipment.
Cargo Weight
This figure includes all weight added
to the Base Curb Weight, including
cargo and optional equipment.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable
weight that can be carried by a single
axle (front or rear). These numbers
are shown on the Certification Label.
The total load on each axle must
never exceed its GAWR.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
This is the Base Curb Weight plus
actual Cargo Weight plus passengers.
Overloading
WARNING
The Gross Axle Weight Rating
(GAWR) and the Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating (GVWR) for your
vehicle are on the Certification
Label attached to the driver's
(or front passenger’s) door.
Exceeding these ratings can
cause an accident or vehicle
damage. You can calculate the
weight of your load by weighing
the items (and people) before
putting them in the vehicle. Be
careful not to overload your
vehicle.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight
Rating)
This is the maximum allowable
weight of the fully loaded vehicle
(including all options, equipment,
passengers and cargo). The GVWR
is shown on the Certification Label
located on the driver’s door sill.
5-149
5
Driving your vehicle
Base Curb Weight
This is the weight of the vehicle
including a full tank of fuel and all
standard equipment. It does not
include passengers, cargo, or optional equipment.
GAW (Gross Axle Weight)
This is the total weight placed on
each axle (front and rear) - including
vehicle curb weight and all payload.
Driving your vehicle
TRAILER TOWING
We do not recommend using this vehicle for trailer towing.
5-150
What to do in an emergency
Hazard warning flasher ........................................6-2
In case of an emergency while driving ..............6-2
If the vehicle stalls while driving...................................6-2
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or crossing .......6-2
If you have a flat tire while driving ............................6-3
If the vehicle will not start...................................6-4
Confirm the EV battery is not low on the charge
gauge....................................................................................6-4
Towing ...................................................................6-22
Towing service .................................................................6-22
Removable towing hook ...............................................6-23
Emergency towing .........................................................6-24
Pan-European eCall System...............................6-26
Information on data processing ..................................6-28
Pan-European eCall System.........................................6-30
Jump starting (12V battery) .................................6-4
If the vehicle overheats........................................6-8
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).........6-9
Check tire pressure...........................................................6-9
Tire pressure monitoring system ................................6-10
Low tire pressure telltale ..............................................6-11
Low tire pressure position and
tire pressure telltale .......................................................6-11
TPMS (Tire Pressure Monitoring System)
malfunction indicator .....................................................6-12
Changing a tire with TPMS...........................................6-13
If you have a flat tire..........................................6-15
With Tire Mobility Kit (TMK) ........................................6-15
6
What to do in an emergency
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER
OAEE049016
The hazard warning flasher serves as
a warning to other drivers to exercise
extreme caution when approaching,
overtaking, or passing your vehicle.
It should be used whenever emergency repairs are being made or
when the vehicle is stopped near the
edge of a roadway.
6-2
To turn the hazard warning flasher
on or off, press the hazard warning
flasher button with the POWER button in any position. The button is
located in the center fascia panel. All
turn signal lights will flash simultaneously.
• The hazard warning flasher operates whether your vehicle is running or not.
• The turn signals do not work when
the hazard flasher is on.
IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCY
WHILE DRIVING
If the vehicle stalls while driving
• Reduce your speed gradually,
keeping a straight line. Move cautiously off the road to a safe place.
• Turn on your hazard warning flasher.
• Try to start the vehicle again. If
your vehicle will not start, we recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or crossing
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or
crossing, if safe to do so, shift to the
N (Neutral) position and then push
the vehicle to a safe location.
If you have a flat tire while
driving
What to do in an emergency
If a tire goes flat while you are driving:
• Take your foot off the accelerator
pedal and let the vehicle slow
down while driving straight ahead.
Do not apply the brakes immediately to slow down the vehicle, but
use the paddle shifter (left side
lever) to increase regenerative
braking control. Also, do not
attempt to pull off the road as this
may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident. When the
vehicle has slowed to such a
speed that it is safe to do so, brake
carefully and pull off the road.
Drive off the road as far as possible
and park on firm, level ground. If
you are on a divided highway, do
not park in the median area
between the two traffic lanes.
• When the vehicle is stopped, press
the hazard warning flasher button,
shift to P (Park), apply the parking
brake, and place the POWER button in the OFF position.
• Have all passengers get out of the
vehicle. Be sure they all get out on
the side of the vehicle that is away
from traffic.
• Follow the instructions provided
later in this chapter. (Refer to "If
You Have a Flat Tire" provided in
this chapter.)
6
6-3
What to do in an emergency
IF THE VEHICLE WILL NOT
START
Confirm the EV battery is not
low on the charge gauge
• Be sure the gear is in P (Park). The
vehicle starts only when the gear is
in P (Park).
• Check the 12-volt battery connections to be sure they are clean and
tight.
• Turn on the interior light. If the light
dims or goes out when you operate
the starter, the battery is drained.
Do not push or pull the vehicle to
start it. This could cause damage to
your vehicle. See instructions for
"Jump Starting" provided in this
chapter.
6-4
JUMP STARTING (12V BATTERY)
Jump starting can be dangerous if
done incorrectly. Follow the jump
starting procedure in this section to
avoid serious injury or damage to
your vehicle. If in doubt about how to
properly jump start your vehicle, we
strongly recommend that you have a
service technician or towing service
do it for you.
WARNING
To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH to you or bystanders,
always follow these precautions
when working near or handling
the battery:
Always read and follow
instructions
carefully
when handling a battery.
Wear eye protection
designed to protect the
eyes from acid splashes.
Keep all flames, sparks,
or smoking materials
away from the battery.
Hydrogen is always present in battery cells, is
highly combustible, and
may explode if ignited.
Keep batteries out of
reach of children.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• NEVER attempt to recharge
the battery when the vehicle’s
battery cables are connected
to the battery.
• The electrical ignition system
works with high voltage.
NEVER touch these components with the "
" indicator ON or when the POWER
button is in the ON position.
• Do not allow the (+) and (-)
jumper cables to touch. It may
cause sparks.
• The battery may rupture or
explode when you jump start
with a low or frozen battery.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your vehicle:
• Only use a 12-volt power supply
(battery or jumper system) to
jump start your vehicle.
• Do not attempt to jump start
your vehicle by push-starting.
i Information
Pb
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human
health. Dispose the battery
according to your local law(s)
or regulations.
What to do in an emergency
(Continued)
Batteries contain sulfuric acid which is highly
corrosive. Do not allow
acid to contact your
eyes, skin or clothing.
If acid gets into your eyes, flush
your eyes with clean water for at
least 15 minutes and get immediate medical attention. If acid
gets on your skin, thoroughly
wash the area. If you feel pain or
a burning sensation, get medical attention immediately.
• When lifting a plastic-cased
battery, excessive pressure
on the case may cause battery
acid to leak. Lift with a battery
carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
• Do not attempt to jump start
your vehicle if your battery is
frozen.
(Continued)
6
6-5
What to do in an emergency
Jump starting procedure
1. Position the vehicles close enough
that the jumper cables will reach,
but do not allow the vehicles to
touch.
2. Avoid fans or any moving parts in
the motor compartment at all
times, even when the vehicles are
turned off.
3. Turn off all electrical devices such
as radios, lights, air conditioning,
etc. Put the vehicles in P (Park)
and set the parking brakes. Turn
both vehicles OFF.
6-6
1VQA4001
4. Connect the jumper cables in the
exact sequence shown in the illustration. First connect one jumper
cable to the red, positive (+)
jumper terminal of your vehicle
(1).
5. Connect the other end of the
jumper cable to the red, positive
(+) battery/jumper terminal of the
assisting vehicle (2).
6. Connect the second jumper cable
to the black, negative (-) battery/
chassis ground of the assisting
vehicle (3).
7. Connect the other end of the second jumper cable to the black,
negative (-) chassis ground of
your vehicle (4).
Do not allow the jumper cables to
contact anything except the correct battery or jumper terminals or
the correct ground. Do not lean
over the battery when making
connections.
8. Start the engine of the assisting
vehicle and let it run at approximately 2,000 rpm for a few minutes. Then start your vehicle.
If your vehicle will not start after a
few attempts, it probably requires
servicing. In this event please seek
qualified assistance. If the cause of
your battery discharging is not
apparent, have your vehicle checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
What to do in an emergency
Disconnect the jumper cables in the
exact reverse order you connected
them:
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from
the black, negative (-) chassis
ground of your vehicle (4).
2. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the black, negative (-) battery/chassis ground of
the assisting vehicle (3).
3. Disconnect the second jumper
cable from the red, positive (+)
battery/jumper terminal of the
assisting vehicle (2).
4. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the red, positive
(+) jumper terminal of your vehicle
(1).
6
6-7
What to do in an emergency
IF THE VEHICLE OVERHEATS
1. Pull off the road and stop as soon
as it is safe to do so.
2. Shift to P (Park) and set the parking brake. If the air conditioning is
on, turn it off.
3. If coolant is running out under the
vehicle or steam is coming out
from the hood, stop the vehicle.
Do not open the hood until the
coolant has stopped running or
the steaming has stopped. If there
is no visible loss of coolant and no
steam, leave the vehicle running
and check to be sure the cooling
fan is operating. If the fan is not
running, turn the vehicle off.
4. Check for coolant leaking from the
radiator, hoses or under the vehicle. (If the air conditioning had
been in use, it is normal for cold
water to be draining from it when
you stop).
5. If coolant is leaking out, turn off
the vehicle immediately and we
recommend that you call an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
6-8
6. If you cannot find the cause of the
overheating, wait until the radiator
temperature has returned to normal. Then, if coolant has been lost,
call an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for assistance.
NOTICE
Serious loss of coolant indicates
there is a leak in the cooling system and we recommend that the
system be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS) (IF EQUIPPED)
Check tire pressure
(if equipped)
OAEE069048
OAEPH049650L
OAEPH059643L
(1) Low Tire Pressure Telltale/TPMS
Malfunction Indicator
(2) Low Tire Pressure Position
Telltale and Tire Pressure Telltale
(Shown on the LCD display)
• You can check the tire pressure in
the Assist Mode on the cluster.
Refer to the “LCD display
modes” in chapter 3.
• Tire pressure is displayed after a
few minutes of driving after initial
vehicle start up.
• If tire pressure is not displayed
when the vehicle is stopped, "Drive
to display" message will appear.
After driving, check the tire pressure.
What to do in an emergency
• The displayed tire pressure values
may differ from those measured
with a tire pressure gauge.
• You can change the tire pressure
unit in the User Settings mode in
the LCD display.
- psi, kpa, bar (Refer to the "User
Settings Mode" in chapter 3).
6
6-9
What to do in an emergency
Tire pressure monitoring system
WARNING
Over-inflation or under-inflation
can reduce tire life, adversely
affect vehicle handling, and
lead to sudden tire failure that
may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Each tire should be checked monthly
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If
your vehicle has tires of a different
size than the size indicated on the
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the
proper tire inflation pressure for
those tires.)
6-10
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your
tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should
stop and check your tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the
proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the
tire to overheat and can lead to tire
failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not
reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure
telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped
with a TPMS malfunction indicator to
indicate when the system is not
operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with
the low tire pressure telltale. When
the system detects a malfunction,
the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence
will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able
to detect or signal low tire pressure
as intended. TPMS malfunctions may
occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or
alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more
tires or wheels on your vehicle to
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS
to continue to function properly.
NOTICE
Low tire pressure position and
tire pressure telltale
OAEPH059643L
When the tire pressure monitoring
system warning indicators are illuminated and warning message displayed on the cluster LCD display,
one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. The Low Tire
Pressure Position Telltale will indicate which tire is significantly underinflated by illuminating the corresponding position light.
If either telltale illuminates, immediately reduce your speed, avoid hard
cornering and anticipate increased
stopping distances. You should stop
and check your tires as soon as possible. Inflate the tires to the proper
pressure as indicated on the vehicle’s placard or tire inflation pressure
label located on the driver’s side center pillar outer panel.
If you cannot reach a service station
or if the tire cannot hold the newly
added air, replace the low pressure
tire with the spare tire.
The Low Tire Pressure Telltale will
remain on and the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator may blink for one minute
and then remain illuminated (when
the vehicle is driven approximately
10 minutes at speed above 25 km/h
(15.5 mph)) until you have the low
pressure tire repaired and replaced
on the vehicle.
6-11
What to do in an emergency
If any of the below happens, have
the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
1. The Low Tire Pressure Telltale/
TPMS Malfunction Indicator
does not illuminate for 3 seconds when the vehicle is ON.
2. The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
remains illuminated after blinking for approximately 1 minute.
3. The Low Tire Pressure Position
Telltale remains illuminated.
Low tire pressure
telltale
6
What to do in an emergency
CAUTION
In winter or cold weather, the
Low Tire Pressure Telltale may
be illuminated if the tire pressure was adjusted to the recommended tire inflation pressure
in warm weather. It does not
mean your TPMS is malfunctioning because the decreased
temperature leads to a proportional lowering of tire pressure.
When you drive your vehicle
from a warm area to a cold area
or from a cold area to a warm
area, or the outside temperature
is greatly higher or lower, you
should check the tire inflation
pressure and adjust the tires to
the recommended tire inflation
pressure.
6-12
TPMS (Tire Pressure
Monitoring System)
malfunction indicator
WARNING
Low pressure damage
Significantly low tire pressure
makes the vehicle unstable and
can contribute to loss of vehicle
control and increased braking
distances.
Continued driving on low pressure tires can cause the tires to
overheat and fail.
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator will
illuminate after it blinks for approximately one minute when there is a
problem with the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System.
We recommend that the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the
TPMS, the Low Tire Pressure
Position Telltale will not be displayed even though the vehicle
has an under-inflated tire.
NOTICE
If you have a flat tire, the Low Tire
Pressure and Position telltales will
come on. We recommend that the
flat tire be repaired by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible or replace the flat tire with the
spare tire.
CAUTION
It is recommended that you do
not use a puncture-repairing
agent not approved by a
HYUNDAI dealer to repair and/or
inflate a low pressure tire. Tire
sealant not approved by a
HYUNDAI dealer may damage
the tire pressure sensor.
Once the original tire equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring sensor is
reinflated to the recommended pressure and reinstalled on the vehicle,
the Low Tire Pressure Telltale and
TPMS Malfunction Indicator will go
off within a few minutes of driving.
If the indicators do not extinguish
after a few minutes, please visit an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Each wheel is equipped with a tire
pressure sensor mounted inside the
tire behind the valve stem. You must
use TPMS specific wheels. It is recommended that you always have
your tires serviced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
You may not be able to identify a tire
with low pressure by simply looking
at it. Always use a good quality tire
pressure gauge to measure. Please
note that a tire that is hot (from being
driven) will have a higher pressure
measurement than a tire that is cold.
A cold tire means the vehicle has
been sitting for 3 hours and driven for
less than 1.6 km (1 mile) in that 3
hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring the inflation pressure. Always be
sure the tire is cold before inflating to
the recommended pressure.
6-13
What to do in an emergency
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
may illuminate after blinking for
one minute if the vehicle is near
electric power supply cables or
radio transmitters such as police
stations, government and public
offices, broadcasting stations,
military installations, airports,
transmitting towers, etc.
Additionally, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator may illuminate if snow
chains are used or electronic
devices such as computers, chargers, remote starters, navigation,
etc. This may interfere with normal
operation of the TPMS.
Changing a tire with TPMS
6
What to do in an emergency
WARNING
• The TPMS cannot alert you to
severe and sudden tire damage caused by external factors such as nails or road
debris.
• If you feel any vehicle instability, immediately take your foot
off the accelerator, apply the
brakes gradually with light
force, and slowly move to a
safe position off the road.
6-14
WARNING
Tampering with, modifying, or
disabling the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) components may interfere with the
system's ability to warn the driver of low tire pressure conditions and/or TPMS malfunctions.
Tampering with, modifying, or
disabling the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) components may void the warranty
for that portion of the vehicle.
WARNING
For EUROPE
• Do not modify the vehicle; it
may interfere with the TPMS
function.
• The wheels on the market do
not have a TPMS sensor.
For your safety, we recommend that you use parts for
replacement from an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If you use the wheels on the market, use a TPMS sensor approved
by a HYUNDAI dealer. If your
vehicle is not equipped with a
TPMS sensor or TPMS does not
work properly, you may fail the
periodic vehicle inspection conducted in your country.
❈All vehicles sold in the EUROPE
market during below period
must be equipped with TPMS.
- New model vehicle :
Nov. 1, 2012 ~
- Current model vehicle :
Nov. 1, 2014~ (Based on vehicle registrations)
IF YOU HAVE A FLAT TIRE
With Tire Mobility Kit (TMK)
CAUTION
WARNING
OAEE069001
For safe operation, carefully read
and follow the instructions in this
manual before use.
Tire Mobility Kit is placed under the
luggage tray.
(1) Compressor
(2) Sealant bottle
The Tire Mobility Kit is a temporary fix
to the tire and the tire should be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit
to repair punctures in the tire
walls. This can result in an accident due to tire failure.
WARNING
Have your tire repaired as soon
as possible. The tire may lose
air pressure at any time after
inflating with the Tire Mobility
Kit.
With the Tire Mobility Kit you stay
mobile even after experiencing a tire
puncture.
The compressor and sealing compound system effectively and comfortably seals most punctures in a
passenger car tire caused by nails or
similar objects and reinflates the tire.
After you ensure that the tire is properly sealed you can drive cautiously
on the tire (distance up to 200 km
(120 miles)) at a max. speed of (80
km/h (50mph)) in order to reach a
service station or tire dealer for the
tire replacement.
It is possible that some tires, especially with larger punctures or damage to the sidewall, cannot be sealed
completely.
Air pressure loss in the tire may
adversely affect tire performance.
For this reason, you should avoid
abrupt steering or other driving
maneuvers, especially if the vehicle is
heavily loaded or if a trailer is in use.
6-15
What to do in an emergency
When two or more tires are flat,
do not use the tire mobility kit
because the supported one
sealant of Tire Mobility Kit is
only used for one flat tire.
Introduction
6
What to do in an emergency
The Tire Mobility Kit is not designed
or intended as a permanent tire
repair method and is to be used for
one tire only.
This instruction shows you step by
step how to temporarily seal the
puncture simply and reliably.
Read the section "Notes on the safe
use of the Tire Mobility Kit".
Notes on the safe use of the
Tire Mobility Kit
• Park your car at the side of the
road so that you can work with the
Tire Mobility Kit away from moving
traffic.
• To be sure your vehicle will not
move, even when you’re on fairly
level ground, always set your parking brake.
• Only use the Tire Mobility Kit for
sealing/inflation passenger car
tires. Only punctured areas located
within the tread region of the tire
can be sealed using the tire mobility kit.
• Do not use on motorcycles, bicycles or any other type of tires.
6-16
• When the tire and wheel are damaged, do not use Tire Mobility Kit
for your safety.
• Use of the Tire Mobility Kit may not
be effective for tire damage larger
than approximately 6 mm (0.24 inch).
Please contact the nearest
HYUNDAI dealership if the tire cannot be made roadworthy with the
Tire Mobility Kit.
• Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit if a
tire is severely damaged by driving
run flat or with insufficient air pressure.
• Do not remove any foreign objects
such as nails or screws that have
penetrated the tire.
• Provided the car is outdoors, leave
the vehicle ON (
) indicator
ON). Otherwise operating the compressor may eventually drain the
car battery.
• Never leave the Tire Mobility Kit
unattended while it is being used.
• Do not leave the compressor running for more than 10 minutes at a
time or it may overheat.
• Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit if
the ambient temperature is below
-30°C (-22°F).
• In case of skin contact with the
sealant, wash the area thoroughly
with plenty of water. If the irritation
persists, seek medical attention.
• In case of eye contact with the
sealant, flush your eyes for at least
15 minutes. If the irritation persists,
seek medical attention.
• In case of swallowing the sealant,
rinse the mouth and drink plenty of
water. However, never give anything to an unconscious person
and seek medical attention immediately.
• Long time exposure to the sealant
may cause damage to bodily tissue
such as kidney, etc.
Components of the Tire Mobility Kit
Connectors, cable and connection
hose are stored in the compressor
housing.
ODE067044
Strictly
follow
the
specified
sequence, otherwise the sealant
may escape under high pressure.
6-17
What to do in an emergency
1. Speed restriction label
2. Sealant bottle and label with
speed restriction
3. Filling hose from sealant bottle to
wheel
4. Connectors and cable for power
outlet direct connection
5. Holder for the sealant bottle
6. Compressor
7. ON/OFF switch
8. Pressure gauge for displaying the
tire inflation pressure
9. Button for reducing tire inflation
pressure
6
What to do in an emergency
WARNING
Do not use the tire sealant after
the sealant has expired (i.e.
past the expiration date on the
sealant container). This can
increase the risk of tire failure.
Using the Tire Mobility Kit
WARNING
WARNING
• Keep out of reach of children.
• Avoid contact with eyes.
• Do not swallow.
6-18
OIGH067042
OAEPH068014
Detach the speed restriction
label (0) from the sealant bottle
(1), and place it in a highly visible place inside the vehicle
such as on the steering wheel
to remind the driver not to drive
too fast.
1. Shake the sealant bottle (1).
2. Screw the filling hose (2) onto the
connector of the sealant bottle.
3. Ensure that the ON/OFF switch
on the compressor is in the OFF
position.
NOTICE
4. Unscrew the valve cap from the
valve of the flat tire and screw the
filling hose (2) of the sealant bottle
onto the valve.
OAEE069006
Securely install the sealant filling
hose to the valve. If not, sealant
may flow backward, possibly clogging the filling hose.
OAEE069008
5. Plug the compressor power cord
(3) into the vehicle power outlet.
6. With the POWER button in the ON
position, switch on the compressor and let it run for approximately
5~7 minutes to fill the sealant up
to proper pressure. (Refer to the
Tire and Wheels, chapter 8). The
inflation pressure of the tire after
filling is unimportant and will be
checked/corrected later.
Be careful not to overinflate the
tire and stay away from the tire
when filling it.
6-19
What to do in an emergency
OAEE069005
6
What to do in an emergency
CAUTION
Distributing the sealant
Checking the tire inflation
pressure
Do not attempt to drive your
vehicle if the tire pressure is
below 200 kpa (29 psi). This
could result in an accident due
to sudden tire failure.
7. Switch off the compressor.
8. Detach the hoses from the sealant
bottle connector and from the tire
valve.
Return the Tire Mobility Kit to its storage location in the vehicle.
6-20
OLMF064106
9. Immediately drive approximately
7~10 km (4~6 miles or about 10
minutes) to evenly distribute the
sealant in the tire.
Do not exceed a speed of 80 km/h
(50 mph). If possible, do not fall
below a speed of 20 km/h (12 mph).
While driving, if you experience any
unusual vibration, ride disturbance or
noise, reduce your speed and drive
with caution until you can safely pull
off of the side of the road.
Call for road side service or towing.
OAEE069005
1. After driving approximately 7~10 km
(4~6 miles or about 10 minutes),
stop at a safe location.
2. Connect the filling hose (2) of the
compressor directly to the tire
valve.
3. Plug the compressor power cord
into the vehicle power outlet.
- To increase the inflation pressure:
Switch on the compressor, position to "I". To check the current
inflation pressure setting, briefly
switch off the compressor.
- To reduce the inflation pressure:
Press the button (8) on the compressor.
i Information
The pressure gauge may show higher
than actual reading when the compressor is running. To get an accurate
tire pressure, the compressor needs to
be turned off.
CAUTION
Tire pressure sensor
(if equipped with TPMS)
When you use the Tire Mobility
Kit including sealant not
approved by HYUNDAI, the tire
pressure sensors may be damaged by sealant. The sealant on
the tire pressure sensor and
wheel should be removed when
you replace the tire with a new
one and inspect the tire pressure sensors at an authorized
dealer.
What to do in an emergency
4. Adjust the tire inflation pressure to
the recommended tire inflation.
With the POWER button ON, proceed as follows.
i Information
6
When reinstalling the repaired or
replaced tire and wheel on the vehicle,
tighten the wheel lug nut to 11~13
kgf·m (79~94 lbf·ft).
6-21
What to do in an emergency
TOWING
Towing service
Dolly
It is acceptable to tow the vehicle
with the rear wheels on the ground
(without dollies) and the front wheels
off the ground.
If any of the loaded wheels or suspension components are damaged
or the vehicle is being towed with the
front wheels on the ground, use a
towing dolly under the front wheels.
When being towed by a commercial
tow truck and wheel dollies are not
used, the front of the vehicle should
always be lifted, not the rear.
OAEE069016R
Dolly
OAEE069018
If emergency towing is necessary,
we recommend having it done by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer or a
commercial tow-truck service.
Proper lifting and towing procedures
are necessary to prevent damage to
the vehicle. The use of wheel dollies
or flatbed is recommended.
6-22
OAEE069019
CAUTION
• Do not tow the vehicle with the
front wheels on the ground as
this may cause damage to the
vehicle.
• Do not tow with sling-type
equipment. Use wheel lift or
flatbed equipment.
Removable towing hook
■ Front
NOTICE
Failure to shift to N (Neutral) may
cause internal damage to the vehicle.
OAEE066011
■ Rear
OAEE066010
1. Open the tailgate and remove the
towing hook from the tool case.
The tool case is placed under the
luggage tray.
What to do in an emergency
When towing your vehicle in an
emergency without wheel dollies:
1. While depressing the brake pedal
shift to the N (Neutral) position
and turn the vehicle off. The
POWER button will be in the ACC
position.
2. Release the parking brake.
6
OAE066028
2. Remove the hole cover by pressing
the lower part of the cover on the
bumper.
3. Install the towing hook by turning it
clockwise into the hole until it is
fully secured.
4. Remove the towing hook and
install the cover after use.
6-23
What to do in an emergency
Emergency towing
If towing is necessary, we recommend you have it done by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or a commercial tow truck service.
If towing service is not available in an
emergency, your vehicle may be
temporarily towed using a cable or
chain secured to the emergency towing hook at the front (or rear) of the
vehicle.
Use extreme caution when towing
the vehicle with a cable or chain. A
driver must be in the vehicle to steer
it and operate the brakes.
Towing in this manner may be done
only on hard-surfaced roads for a
short distance and at low speeds.
Also, the wheels, axles, power train,
steering and brakes must all be in
good condition.
6-24
CAUTION
The driver must be in the vehicle for steering and braking
operations when the vehicle is
being towed. Passengers other
than the driver must not be in
the vehicle.
Always follow these emergency towing precautions:
• While depressing the brake pedal
shift to the N (Neutral) position and
turn the vehicle off. The POWER
button will be in the ACC position.
• Release the parking brake.
• Depress the brake pedal with more
force than normal since you will
have reduced braking performance.
• More steering effort will be required
because the power steering system
will be disabled.
• Use a vehicle heavier than your
own to tow your vehicle.
• The drivers of both vehicles should
communicate with each other frequently.
• Before emergency towing, check
that the hook is not broken or damaged.
• Fasten the towing cable or chain
securely to the hook.
• Do not jerk the hook. Apply steady
and even force.
NOTICE
What to do in an emergency
Accelerate or decelerate the vehicle in a slow and gradual manner
while maintaining tension on the
tow rope or chain to start or drive
the vehicle, otherwise tow hooks
and the vehicle may be damaged.
NOTICE
OAEE066017
• Use a towing cable or chain less
than 5 m (16 feet) long. Attach a
white or red cloth (about 30 cm (12
inches) wide) in the middle of the
cable or chain for easy visibility.
• Drive carefully so the towing cable
or chain remains tight during towing.
• Before towing, check the reduction
gear for fluid leaks under your vehicle. If the reduction gear fluid is
leaking, flatbed equipment or a towing dolly must be used.
To avoid damage to your vehicle
and vehicle components when
towing:
• Always pull straight ahead when
using the towing hooks. Do not
pull from the side or at a vertical
angle.
• Do not use the towing hooks to
pull a vehicle out of mud, sand
or other conditions from which
the vehicle cannot be driven out
under its own power.
• Limit the vehicle speed to
15 km/h (10 mph) and drive less
than 1.5 km (1 mile) when towing
to avoid serious damage to the
reduction gear.
6
6-25
What to do in an emergency
PAN-EUROPEAN ECALL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
The vehicle is equipped with a
device* connected with the PanEuropean eCall system for making
emergency call to response teams.
The Pan-European eCall system is
an automatic emergency call service
made in event of a traffic accident or
other** accidents on the roads of
Europe. (only in countries with regulation on this system)
The system allows contacting with
an officer of the single duty dispatch
service in case of accidents on the
roads of Europe. (only in countries
with regulation on this system)
The Pan-European eCall system
given conditions, stated in the
Owner's Manual as well as Warranty
and Service book transmits data to
the Public Safety Answering Point
(PSAP) including such information
as vehicle location, vehicle type, VIN
(vehicle identification number of the
vehicle).
OAEE069045L
➀ Road accident
➁ Wireless network
➂ Public Safety Answering Point (PSAP)
➃ Rescue
* Pan-European eCall device in the Owner's Manual means equipment, installed in the vehicle, which provides connection with the Pan-European
eCall system.
** "Other accidents" mean any accidents on the roads of Europe (only in countries with regulation on this system) resulted in injured people and/or
necessity of provision of assistance. In case of registration of any accident, it is necessary to stop a vehicle, press button SOS (location of the button is specified on the picture in the chapter "Pan-European eCall (IF EQUIPPED)") of the Owner's Manual. When making a call, the system gathers information about the vehicle (from which a call was made), after which connects the car with an officer of the Public Safety Answering Point
(PSAP) to tell about the reason of the emergency call.
6-26
Description of the ecall in-vehicle system
What to do in an emergency
Once the data which is stored in the
Pan-European eCall system is delivered to the rescue center to assist
the driver and passengers with proper rescue operations, the data will be
deleted after rescue operation is
completed.
6
ESKEV-501
Overview of the 112-based eCall in-vehicle system, its operation and functionalities: refer to this section. The 112-based eCall service is a public service of general interest and is accessible free of charge.
The 112-based eCall in-vehicle system is activated by default. It is activated
automatically by means of in- vehicle sensors in the event of a severe accident.
6-27
What to do in an emergency
It will also be triggered automatically
when the vehicle is equipped with a
TPS system which does not function
in the event of a severe accident.
The 112-based eCall in-vehicle system can also be triggered manually,
if needed. Instructions for manual
activation of the system: refer to this
section.
In the event of a critical system failure that would disable the 112-based
eCall in-vehicle system, the following
warning will be given to the occupants of the vehicle: refer to this section.
6-28
Information on data processing
Any processing of personal data
through the 112-based eCall in-vehicle system shall comply with the personal data protection rules provided
for in Directives 95/46/EC (1) and
2002/58/EC (2) of the European
Parliament and of the Council, and in
particular, shall be based on the
necessity to protect the vital interests
of the individuals in accordance with
Article 7(d) of Directive 95/46/EC (3).
Processing of such data is strictly
limited to the purpose of handling the
emergency eCall to the single
European emergency number 112.
Types of data and its recipients
The 112-based eCall in-vehicle system may collect and process only the
following data:
- Vehicle Identification Number
- Vehicle type (passenger vehicle or
light commercial vehicle)
- Vehicle propulsion storage type
(gasoline/diesel/CNG/LPG/electric/hydrogen)
- Vehicle recent locations and direction of travel
- Log file of the automatic activation
of the system and its timestamp
- Any additional data (if applicable):
Not applicable
Recipients of data processed by the
112-based eCall in-vehicle system
are the relevant public safety
answering points designated by the
respective public authorities of the
country on which territory they are
located, to first receive and handle
eCalls to the single European emergency number 112. Additional information (if available): Not applicable
Arrangements for data processing
The 112-based eCall in-vehicle system is designed in such a way as to
ensure that the data contained in the
system memory is not available outside the system before an eCall is
triggered. Additional remarks (if any):
Not applicable
The 112-based eCall in-vehicle system is designed in such a way as to
ensure that it is not traceable and not
subject to any constant tracking in its
normal operation status. Additional
remarks (if any): Not applicable
The 112-based eCall in-vehicle system is designed in such a way as to
ensure that data in the system internal memory is automatically and
continuously removed.
The vehicle location data is constantly overwritten in the internal memory
of the system so as always to keep
maximum of the last three up-to-date
locations of the vehicle necessary for
the normal functioning of the system.
The log of activity data in the 112based eCall in-vehicle system is kept
for no longer than necessary for
attaining the purpose of handling the
emergency eCall and in any case not
beyond 13 hours from the moment
an emergency eCall was initiated.
Additional remarks (if any): Not applicable
What to do in an emergency
(1) Directive 95/46/EC of the
European Parliament and of the
Council of 24 October 1995 on
the protection of individuals with
regard to the processing of personal data and on the free movement of such data (OJ L 281,
23.11.1995, p. 31).
(2) Directive 2002/58/EC of the
European Parliament and of the
Council of 12 July 2002 concerning the processing of personal
data and the protection of privacy
in the electronic communications
sector (Directive on privacy and
electronic communications) (OJ L
201, 31.7.2002, p. 37).
(3) Directive 95/46/EC is repealed by
Regulation (EU) 2016/679 of the
European Parliament and of the
Council of 27 April 2016 on the
protection of natural persons with
regard to the processing of personal data and on the free movement of such data (General Data
Protection Regulation) (OJ L 119,
4.5.2016, p. 1). The Regulation
applies from 25 May 2018.
6
6-29
What to do in an emergency
Modalities for exercising data
subject's rights
The data subject (the vehicle's
owner) has a right of access to data
and as appropriate to request the
rectification, erasure or blocking of
data, concerning him or her, the processing of which does not comply
with the provisions of Directive
95/46/EC. Any third parties to whom
the data have been disclosed have to
be notified of such rectification, erasure or blocking carried out in compliance with this Directive, unless it
proves impossible or involves a disproportionate effort.
The data subject has a right to complain to the competent data protection authority if he or she considers
that his or her rights have been
infringed as a result of the processing of his or her personal data.
Contact service responsible for handling access requests (if any): Not
applicable
6-30
Pan-European eCall System
SOS button: the driver/passenger
makes an emergency call to the single duty dispatch service by pressing
the button.
LED: The red and green LED illuminates for 3 seconds when the ignition
switch is in the ON position. After that
they will switch off at normal operation of the system.
If there are some problems in the
system, the LED remains in red.
OAEPH069046L
Elements of the Pan-European eCall
system, installed in passenger compartment:
➀ SOS button
➁ LED
Automatic accident reporting
System operation in the
event of a traffic accident
Connection with the Public
Safety Answering Point
(PSAP)
Emergency services
CAUTION
OAEE069047L
The Pan-European eCall device automatically makes an emergency call to
the Public Safety Answering Point (PSAP) for proper rescuing operations in
event of vehicle accident.
For proper emergency services and support the Pan-European eCall system
automatically transmits the accident data to the Public Safety Answering
Point (PSAP) when a traffic accident is detected.
In this case, the emergency call cannot be hung up by pressing the SOS button and the Pan-European eCall system remains connected until the emergency service officer, receiving the call, disconnects the emergency call.
Operation of the system is
impossible in case of absence
of mobile transmission and
GPS and Galileo signals.
What to do in an emergency
In minor traffic accidents the PanEuropean eCall system may not execute an emergency call. However, an
emergency call may be made manually by pressing the SOS button.
6
6-31
What to do in an emergency
Manual accident reporting
OAEE069047L
The driver or passenger manually can make an emergency call in the Public
Safety Answering Point(PSAP), by pressing SOS button to call the necessary
emergency services.
A call to the emergency services through the Pan-European eCall system
can be cancelled by pressing the SOS button again only before the call connection.
After activation of emergency call in the manual mode (for proper emergency
services and support), the Pan-European eCall system automatically transmits the road accident data / or data on other accident to the officer of the
Public Safety Answering Point(PSAP) (during emergency call) by pressing
the SOS button.
If the driver or passenger accidentally presses the SOS button, it can be canceled by pressing the button again.
In case of road accident or other accident for activation of emergency call in
manual mode it is necessary:
6-32
1. Stop the vehicle in accordance
with traffic rules to ensure safety to
yourself and other participants of
road traffic;
2. Press the SOS button, when
pressing the button SOS registration of the device in the wireless
telephonic communication networks is carried out, minimum
data set about vehicle and its location is collected in accordance with
of the technical requirements of
the device. After that connection
with the officer of the PanEuropean eCall system is made for
clearing up reasons (conditions) of
the emergency call.
3. After clearing up reasons of the
emergency call, the officer of the
Public Safety Answering Point
(PSAP) sends emergency services and completes the emergency
call.
If the emergency call is not carried
out in accordance with the procedure,
mentioned above, the emergency call
will be considered as erroneous.
WARNING
• The Pan-European eCall system battery supplies power
during 1 hour in case main
power source of the vehicle is
cut off due to the collision
during the emergency situations.
• The Pan-European eCall system battery should be
replaced every 3 years. For
more information refer to the
Maintenance Schedule in
chapter 7.
(Continued)
(Continued)
Arbitrary Removal or
Modification
If red LED illuminates in normal
driving conditions, this can
indicate malfunction of the PanEuropean eCall system. Please,
have the Pan-European eCall
system checked at an authorized HYUNDAI dealer immediately. Otherwise correct operation of the Pan-European eCall
system device, installed in your
vehicle is not guaranteed. Owner
of the vehicle incurs liability for
consequences, occurred as a
result of nonobservance of conditions, mentioned above.
(Continued)
The Pan-European eCall system
calls emergency services for
assistance. Thus, any arbitrary
removal or changes to the PanEuropean eCall system settings
may affect your driving safety.
Also, it may even make an erroneous emergency call to the
Public Safety Answering Point
(PSAP). Thereby, we kindly ask
you not to make any changes by
yourself or by the third parties
in the settings of the equipment
of the Pan-European eCall system, installed in your vehicle.
6-33
What to do in an emergency
Emergency power supply of the
Pan-European eCall system
from the battery
(Continued)
LED illumination in red
(system malfunction)
6
Maintenance
Motor compartment...............................................7-3
Maintenance services ...........................................7-4
Owner's responsibility......................................................7-4
Owner maintenance precautions ..................................7-4
Owner maintenance...............................................7-5
Owner maintenance schedule........................................7-5
Scheduled maintenance services.........................7-7
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items..7-16
Coolant...................................................................7-17
Brake fluid ............................................................7-18
Checking the brake fluid level .....................................7-18
Washer fluid .........................................................7-19
Checking the washer fluid level ..................................7-19
Climate control air filter .....................................7-20
Filter inspection...............................................................7-20
Blade inspection ..............................................................7-22
Blade replacement ..........................................................7-22
Battery (12 Volt) ..................................................7-24
For best battery service................................................7-25
Battery capacity label ...................................................7-25
Battery recharging .........................................................7-26
Reset features .................................................................7-27
Tires and wheels ..................................................7-28
Tire care ............................................................................7-28
Recommended cold tire inflation pressures.............7-29
Check tire inflation pressure........................................7-30
Tire rotation ...................................................................7-31
Wheel alignment and tire balance ..............................7-32
Tire replacement ............................................................7-32
Wheel replacement .........................................................7-33
Tire traction ....................................................................7-33
Tire maintenance ............................................................7-33
Tire sidewall labeling......................................................7-33
Low aspect ratio tires ....................................................7-37
Fuses......................................................................7-39
Instrument panel fuse replacement ...........................7-40
Motor compartment panel fuse replacement..........7-41
Fuse/relay panel description .......................................7-42
Maintenance
Normal maintenance schedule
- For Europe ......................................................................7-8
Maintenance under severe usage conditions
- For Europe ....................................................................7-10
Normal maintenance schedule
- Except Europe..............................................................7-12
Maintenance under severe usage conditions
- Except Europe..............................................................7-14
Wiper blades .........................................................7-22
7
Light bulbs.............................................................7-54
Headlamp, position lamp, turn signal lamp
bulb replacement.............................................................7-55
Headlamp aiming (For Europe) ....................................7-59
Daytime running lamp ....................................................7-63
Side repeater lamp replacement .................................7-63
Rear combination lamp bulb replacement ................7-63
Rear fog lamp ..................................................................7-66
High mounted stop lamp ...............................................7-66
License plate light bulb replacement .........................7-66
Interior light bulb replacement ....................................7-66
Appearance care ..................................................7-68
Exterior care ....................................................................7-68
Interior care......................................................................7-74
MOTOR COMPARTMENT
1. Coolant reservoir
2. Brake fluid reservoir
3. Fuse box
4. Battery (12 volt)
Maintenance
5. Coolant cap
6. Windshield washer fluid reservoir
7
The actual motor compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OAEE076001N
7-3
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE SERVICES
You should exercise the utmost care
to prevent damage to your vehicle
and injury to yourself whenever performing any maintenance or inspection procedures.
We recommend you have your vehicle maintained and repaired by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer. An
authorized HYUNDAI dealer meets
HYUNDAI’s high service quality
standards and receives technical
support from HYUNDAI in order to
provide you with a high level of service satisfaction.
Owner’s responsibility
Maintenance service and record retention are the owner’s responsibility.
You should retain documents that
show proper maintenance has been
performed on your vehicle in accordance with the scheduled maintenance service charts shown on the
following pages. You need this information to establish your compliance
with the servicing and maintenance
requirements of your vehicle warranties.
Detailed warranty information is provided in your Service Passport.
Repairs and adjustments required as
a result of improper maintenance or
a lack of required maintenance are
not covered.
Owner maintenance precautions
Inadequate, incomplete or insufficient servicing may result in operational problems with your vehicle that
could lead to vehicle damage, an
accident, or personal injury. This
chapter provides instructions only for
the maintenance items that are easy
to perform. Several procedures can
be done only by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer with special tools.
Your vehicle should not be modified
in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance,
safety or durability of your vehicle
and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limited warranties covering the vehicle.
NOTICE
Improper owner maintenance during the warranty period may affect
warranty coverage. For details, read
the separate Service Passport provided with the vehicle. If you’re
unsure about any service or maintenance procedure, have it done by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
7-4
OWNER MAINTENANCE
WARNING
Owner maintenance schedule
When you stop for fuel:
• Check coolant level in the coolant
reservoir.
• Check the windshield washer fluid
level.
• Check for low or under-inflated
tires.
WARNING
Be careful when checking your
coolant level when the parts in
the motor compartment are hot.
This may result in coolant being
blown out of the opening and
cause serious burns and other
injuries.
7-5
Maintenance
Performing maintenance work
on a vehicle can be dangerous.
If you lack sufficient knowledge
and experience or the proper
tools and equipment to do the
work, have it done by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. ALWAYS
follow these precautions for
performing maintenance work:
• Park your vehicle on level
ground, shift to P (Park) position, apply the parking brake,
place the POWER button in
the OFF position.
• Block the tires (front and back)
to prevent the vehicle from
moving.
Remove loose clothing or jewelry that can become entangled in moving parts.
• Keep flames, sparks, or smoking materials away from the
battery related parts.
The following lists are vehicle checks
and inspections that should be performed by the owner or an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer at the frequencies
indicated to help ensure safe,
dependable operation of your vehicle.
Any adverse conditions should be
brought to the attention of your dealer as soon as possible.
These Owner Maintenance vehicle
checks are generally not covered by
warranties and you may be charged
for labor, parts and lubricants used.
7
Maintenance
While operating your vehicle:
At least monthly:
At least once a year:
• Check for vibrations in the steering
wheel. Notice if there is any
increased steering effort or looseness in the steering wheel, or
change in its straight-ahead position.
• Notice if your vehicle constantly
turns slightly or “pulls” to one side
when traveling on smooth, level
road.
• When stopping, listen and check
for unusual sounds, pulling to one
side, increased brake pedal travel
or “hard-to-push” brake pedal.
• If any slipping or changes in the
operation of your reduction gear
occurs, check the reduction gear
fluid level.
• Check the reduction gear P (Park)
function.
• Check the parking brake.
• Check for fluid leaks under your
vehicle (water dripping from the air
conditioning system during or after
use is normal).
• Check coolant level in the coolant
reservoir.
• Check the operation of all exterior
lights, including the stoplights, turn
signals and hazard warning flashers.
• Check the inflation pressures of all
tires including the spare for tires
that are worn, show uneven wear,
or are damaged.
• Check for loose wheel lug nuts.
• Clean body and door drain holes.
• Lubricate door hinges and hood
hinges.
• Lubricate door and hood locks and
latches.
• Lubricate door rubber weather
strips.
• Check the air conditioning system.
• Inspect and lubricate reduction
gear linkage and controls.
• Clean the battery and terminals.
• Check the brake fluid level.
7-6
At least twice a year:
(i.e., every Spring and Fall)
• Check radiator, heater and air conditioning hoses for leaks or damage.
• Check windshield washer spray
and wiper operation. Clean wiper
blades with clean cloth dampened
with washer fluid.
• Check headlamp alignment.
• Check the seat belts for wear and
function.
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE SERVICES
If your vehicle is operated under the above conditions, you should inspect, replace or refill more frequently than the
following Normal Maintenance Schedule. After the periods or distance shown in the chart, continue to follow the prescribed maintenance intervals.
7-7
Maintenance
Follow Normal Maintenance Schedule if the vehicle is usually operated where none of the following conditions apply. If any
of the following conditions apply, you must follow the Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions.
• Repeated driving short distance of less than 8 km (5 miles) in normal temperature or less than 16 km (10miles) in
freezing temperature
• Low speed driving for long distances
• Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt-spread roads
• Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold weather
• Driving in heavy dust conditions
• Driving in heavy traffic area
• Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain road repeatedly
• Towing a trailer or using a camper, or roof rack
• Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use of vehicle towing
• Driving over 170 km/h (106 miles/h)
• Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions
7
Maintenance
Normal maintenance schedule - For Europe
The following maintenance services must be performed to ensure good vehicle performance.
Keep receipts for all vehicle services to protect your warranty. Where both mileage and time are shown, the frequency of service is determined by whichever occurs first.
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
Miles×1,000
MAINTENANCE
Km×1,000
ITEM
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
15
30
45
60
75
90
105
At first, inspect 60,000 km (40,000 miles) or 48 months
after that, inspect every 30,000 km (20,000 miles) or 24 months
Cooling system
Coolant *1
Reduction gear fluid
Battery condition
Brake lines, hoses and connections
Brake pedal
Parking brake
Brake fluid
Brake discs and pads
I
R
*1
*2
I
I
I
I
Replace every 60,000 km (40,000 miles) or 36 months *2
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
R
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
: Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
: Replace or change.
: When replacing or adding coolant, we recommend that you visit an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
: For your convenience, it can be replaced prior to it's interval when you do maintenance of other items.
7-8
96
80
120
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
Normal maintenance schedule - For Europe
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
15
30
45
60
75
90
105
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
R
R
Replace every 3 years.
96
80
120
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
Miles×1,000
MAINTENANCE
ITEM
Km×1,000
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots
Driveshaft and boots
Tire (pressure & tread wear)
Front suspension ball joints
Bolt and nuts on chassis and body
Air conditioner refrigerant
Air conditioner compressor
Climate control air filter
ERA-GLONASS system battery (if equipped)
7
7-9
Maintenance
Maintenance under severe usage conditions - For Europe
The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars mainly used under severe driving conditions.
Refer to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance intervals.
R : Replace
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace
Maintenance
operation
Maintenance intervals
Driving condition
Reduction gear fluid
R
Every 120,000 km (80,000 miles)
C, D, E, F,
G, H, I, J
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, F, G
Front suspension ball joints
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, F, G
Disc brakes and pads, calipers and rotors
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, G, H
Driveshaft and boots
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, F, G, H, I
Climate control air filter
R
Replace more frequently
depending on the condition
C, E
Maintenance item
7-10
Severe driving conditions
A : Repeatedly driving short distance of less than 8 km (5 miles)
in normal temperature or less than 16 km (10 miles) in freezing temperature
B : Low speed driving for long distances
C : Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt
spread roads
D : Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in
very cold weather
F : Driving in heavy traffic area
G : Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain roads repeatedly
H : Towing a trailer, or using a camper or roof rack
I : Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use or vehicle
towing
J : Driving over 170 km/h (106 mile/h)
K : Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions
E : Driving in heavy dust conditions
Maintenance
7
7-11
Maintenance
Normal maintenance schedule - Except Europe
The following maintenance services must be performed to ensure good vehicle performance.
Keep receipts for all vehicle services to protect your warranty. Where both mileage and time are shown, the frequency of service is determined by whichever occurs first.
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
Miles×1,000
MAINTENANCE
Km×1,000
ITEM
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
15
30
45
60
75
90
105
At first, inspect 60,000 km (40,000 miles) or 48 months
after that, inspect every 30,000 km (20,000 miles) or 24 months
Cooling system
Coolant *1
Reduction gear fluid
For Middle East
Battery condition
Except Middle East
Brake lines, hoses and connections
Brake pedal
Parking brake
I
R
*1
*2
I
I
Replace every 60,000 km (40,000 miles) or 36 months *2
I
Inspect 10,000 km (6,200 miles) or 6 months
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
: Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
: Replace or change.
: When replacing or adding coolant, we recommend that you visit an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
: For your convenience, it can be replaced prior to it's interval when you do maintenance of other items.
7-12
96
80
120
I
I
I
I
I
Normal maintenance schedule - Except Europe
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
15
30
45
60
75
90
105
I
R
I
R
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Replace every 3 years.
96
80
120
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
Miles×1,000
MAINTENANCE
ITEM
Km×1,000
Brake fluid
Brake discs and pads
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots
Driveshaft and boots
Tire (pressure & tread wear)
Front suspension ball joints
Bolt and nuts on chassis and body
Air conditioner refrigerant
Air conditioner compressor
Climate control air filter
ERA-GLONASS system battery (if equipped)
7
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
7-13
Maintenance
Maintenance under severe usage conditions - Except Europe
The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars mainly used under severe driving conditions.
Refer to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance intervals.
R : Replace
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace
Maintenance
operation
Maintenance intervals
Driving condition
Reduction gear fluid
R
Every 120,000 km (80,000 miles)
C, D, E, F,
G, H, I, J
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, F, G
Front suspension ball joints
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, F, G
Disc brakes and pads, calipers and rotors
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, G, H
Driveshaft and boots
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, F, G, H, I
Climate control air filter
R
Replace more frequently
depending on the condition
C, E
Maintenance item
7-14
Severe driving conditions
A : Repeatedly driving short distance of less than 8 km (5 miles)
in normal temperature or less than 16 km (10 miles) in freezing temperature
B : Low speed driving for long distances
C : Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt
spread roads
D : Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in
very cold weather
F : Driving in heavy traffic area
G : Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain roads repeatedly
H : Towing a trailer, or using a camper or roof rack
I : Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use or vehicle
towing
J : Driving over 170 km/h (106 mile/h)
K : Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions
E : Driving in heavy dust condition
Maintenance
7
7-15
Maintenance
EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Cooling system
Brake fluid
Check cooling system components,
such as radiator, coolant reservoir,
hoses and connections for leakage
and damage. Replace any damaged
parts.
Check brake fluid level in the brake
fluid reservoir. The level should be
between the MIN and the MAX
marks on the side of the reservoir.
Use only hydraulic brake fluid conforming to DOT 4 specification.
Coolant
The coolant should be changed at
the intervals specified in the maintenance schedule.
Brake discs, pads, calipers
and rotors
Steering gear box, linkage &
boots/lower arm ball joint
With the vehicle stopped and the
hybrid system off, check for excessive free-play in the steering wheel.
Check the linkage for bends or damage. Check the dust boots and ball
joints for deterioration, cracks, or
damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
The reduction gear fluid should be
inspected according to the intervals
specified in the maintenance schedule.
Check the pads, the disc, and the
rotor for any excessive wear-out.
Inspect calipers for any fluid leakage
For more information on checking
the pads or lining wear limit, refer to
the HYUNDAI web site.
(http://service.hyundai-motor.com)
Brake hoses and lines
Suspension mounting bolts
Air conditioning refrigerant
Visually check for proper installation,
chafing, cracks, deterioration and
any leakage. Replace any deteriorated or damaged parts immediately.
Check the suspension connections
for looseness or damage. Retighten
to the specified torque.
Check the air conditioning lines and
connections for leakage and damage.
Reduction gear fluid
7-16
Drive shafts and boots
Check the drive shafts, boots and
clamps for cracks, deterioration, or
damage. Replace any damaged
parts and, if necessary, repack the
grease.
COOLANT
WARNING
Since a specific coolant water is
applied for electric vehicles,
replenishment
of
other
antifreeze or water may cause
problems to the vehicle.
The electric motor for the cooling fan
is controlled by coolant temperature,
refrigerant pressure and vehicle
speed. As the coolant temperature
decreases, the electric motor will
automatically shut off. This is a normal condition.
WARNING
OAEE076002L
The electric motor for the cooling fan may continue to operate
or start up when the vehicle is
not operating and can cause
serious injury.
Keep hands, clothing and tools
away from the rotating fan
blades of the cooling fan.
Maintenance
Check the condition and connections
of all cooling system hoses and
heater hoses. Replace any swollen
or deteriorated hoses.
The coolant level should be filled
between the MAX and the MIN
marks on the side of the coolant
reservoir when the parts in the motor
compartment is cool.
If the coolant level is low, have your
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer. Use only designated coolant water for electric vehicles,
adding other types of water or
antifreeze can damage the vehicle.
7
7-17
Maintenance
BRAKE FLUID
Checking the brake fluid level
If the level is low, add the specified
brake fluid to the MAX level. The level
will fall with accumulated mileage.
This is a normal condition associated
with the wear of the brake linings. If
the fluid level is excessively low, we
recommend that the brake system
be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
OAEE076003
Check the fluid level in the reservoir
periodically. The fluid level should be
between MAX and MIN marks on the
side of the reservoir.
Before removing the reservoir cap
and adding brake fluid, clean the
area around the reservoir cap thoroughly to prevent brake fluid contamination.
7-18
If the brake system requires frequent additions of fluid this
could indicate a leak in the
brake system. We recommend
that the vehicle be inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Do not allow brake fluid to come
in contact with your eyes. If
brake fluid comes in contact
with your eyes, flush your eyes
with clean water for at least 15
minutes and get immediate
medical attention.
NOTICE
• Do not allow brake fluid to contact the vehicle’s body paint, as
paint damage will result.
• Brake fluid, which has been
exposed to open air for an
extended time should NEVER be
used as its quality cannot be
guaranteed. It should be disposed of properly.
• Do not use the wrong kind of
brake fluid. A few drops of mineral based oil, such as engine oil, in
your brake system can damage
brake system parts.
i Information
Use only the specified brake fluid
(Refer to “Recommended Lubricants
and Capacities” in chapter 8).
WASHER FLUID
Checking the washer fluid
level
To prevent serious injury or
death, take the following safety
precautions when using washer
fluid:
• Do not use coolant or
antifreeze in the washer fluid
reservoir. Coolant can severely obscure visibility when
sprayed on the windshield
and may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident or damage to paint and
body trim.
• Do not allow sparks or flame
to contact the washer fluid or
the washer fluid reservoir.
Washer fluid may contain
alcohol and can be flammable.
• Do not drink washer fluid and
avoid contact with skin.
Washer fluid is poisonous to
humans and animals.
• Keep washer fluid away from
children and animals.
Maintenance
OAEE076004
Check the fluid level in the washer
fluid reservoir and add fluid if necessary. Plain water may be used if washer fluid is not available. However, use
washer solvent with antifreeze characteristics in cold climates to prevent
freezing.
WARNING
7
7-19
Maintenance
CLIMATE CONTROL AIR FILTER
Filter inspection
The climate control air filter should be
replaced according to the Maintenance
Schedule. If the vehicle is operated in
severely air-polluted cities or on
dusty rough roads for a long period,
it should be inspected more frequently and replaced sooner.
Replace the climate control air filter
by following the procedure below and
be careful to avoid damaging other
components.
OAEE076006
1. With the glove box open, remove
the stoppers on both sides to allow
the glove box to hang freely on the
hinges.
7-20
OAEE076005
2. Remove the support rod (1).
NOTICE
Install a new climate control air filter in the correct direction with the
arrow symbol (↓) facing downwards to prevent noise and
reduced effectiveness.
OHG070041
3. Press and hold the lock (1) on
both sides of the cover.
4. Pull out (2) the cover.
5. Replace the climate control air filter.
6. Reassemble in the reverse order
of disassembly.
Maintenance
OAEE076029
7
7-21
Maintenance
WIPER BLADES
Blade inspection
Blade replacement
Contamination of either the windshield or the wiper blades with foreign matter can reduce the effectiveness of the windshield wipers.
Common sources of contamination
are insects, tree sap, and hot wax
treatments used by some commercial car washes. If the blades are not
wiping properly, clean both the window and the blades with a good
cleaner or mild detergent, and rinse
thoroughly with clean water.
When the wipers no longer clean
adequately, the blades may be worn
or cracked, and require replacement.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper
blades, arms or other components, do not:
• Use gasoline, kerosene, paint
thinner, or other solvents on or
near them.
• Attempt to move the wipers
manually.
• Use non-specified wiper blades.
i Information
Commercial hot waxes applied by automatic car washes have been known to
make the windshield difficult to clean.
7-22
NOTICE
• In order to prevent damage to
the hood and the wiper arms, the
wiper arms should only be lifted
when in the top wiping position.
• Always return the wiper arms to
the windshield before driving.
OLF074017
1. Raise the wiper arm.
OAD075075L
OAD075076L
2. Lift up the wiper blade clip (1).
Then lift up the wiper blade (2).
3. While pushing the lock (3), pull
down the wiper blade (4).
4. Remove the wiper blade from the
wiper arm (5).
5. Install a new wiper blade assembly in the reverse order of removal.
6. Return the wiper arm on the windshield.
Maintenance
OAD075074L
7
7-23
Maintenance
BATTERY (12 VOLT)
WARNING
To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH to you or bystanders,
always follow these precautions
when working near or handling
the battery:
Always read and follow
instructions
carefully
when handling a battery.
Wear eye protection
designed to protect the
eyes from acid splashes.
Keep all flames, sparks,
or smoking materials
away from the battery.
Hydrogen is always present in battery cells, is
highly combustible, and
may explode if ignited.
Keep batteries out of
reach of children.
(Continued)
7-24
(Continued)
Batteries contain sulfuric acid which is highly
corrosive. Do not allow
acid to contact your
eyes, skin or clothing.
If acid gets into your eyes, flush
your eyes with clean water for at
least 15 minutes and get immediate medical attention. If acid
gets on your skin, thoroughly
wash the area. If you feel pain or
a burning sensation, get medical attention immediately.
• When lifting a plastic-cased
battery, excessive pressure
on the case may cause battery
acid to leak. Lift with a battery
carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
• Do not attempt to jump start
your vehicle if your battery is
frozen.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• NEVER attempt to recharge
the battery when the vehicle’s
battery cables are connected
to the battery.
• The electrical ignition switch
works with high voltage.
NEVER touch these components with the “
” indicator
ON or when the POWER button is in the ON position.
NOTICE
For best battery service
Battery capacity label
■ Example
• When you do not use the vehicle
for a long time in a low temperature area, disconnect the battery
and keep it indoors.
• Always charge the battery fully
to prevent battery case damage
in low temperature areas.
OAEE076007
1. AGM60L-DIN : The HYUNDAI
model name of battery
2. 12V : The nominal voltage
3. 60Ah(20HR) : The nominal capacity
(in Ampere hours)
4. 100RC : The nominal reserve
capacity (in min.)
5. 640CCA : The cold-test current in
amperes by SAE
6. 512A : The cold-test current in
amperes by EN
7-25
Maintenance
• Keep the battery securely mounted.
• Keep the battery top clean and dry.
• Keep the terminals and connections clean, tight, and coated with
petroleum jelly or terminal grease.
• Rinse any spilled acid from the battery immediately with a solution of
water and baking soda.
OLMB073072
❈ The actual battery label in the vehicle
may differ from the illustration.
7
Maintenance
Battery recharging
By battery charger
Your vehicle has a maintenance-free,
calcium-based battery.
• If the battery becomes discharged
in a short time (because, for example, the headlights or interior lights
were left on while the vehicle was
not in use), recharge it by slow
charging (trickle) for 10 hours.
• If the battery gradually discharges
because of high electric load while
the vehicle is being used, recharge
it at 20-30A for two hours.
7-26
WARNING
Always follow these instructions
when recharging your vehicle’s
battery to avoid the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH from
explosions or acid burns:
• Before performing maintenance or recharging the battery, turn off all accessories
and place the POWER button
to the OFF position.
• Keep all flames, sparks, or
smoking materials away from
the battery.
• Always work outdoors or in an
area with plenty of ventilation.
• Wear eye protection when
checking the battery during
charging.
• The battery must be removed
from the vehicle and placed in
a well ventilated area.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Watch the battery during
charging, and stop or reduce
the charging rate if the battery
cells begin boiling violently.
• The negative battery cable
must be removed first and
installed last when the battery
is disconnected. Disconnect
the battery charger in the following order:
(1) Turn off the battery charger
main switch.
(2) Unhook
the
negative
clamp from the negative
battery terminal.
(3) Unhook the positive clamp
from the positive battery
terminal.
• Always use a genuine HYUNDAI
approved battery when you
replace the battery.
By jump starting
Reset features
After a jump start from a good battery, drive the vehicle for 20-30 minutes before it is shutoff. The vehicle
may not restart if you shut it off
before the battery had a chance to
adequately recharge. See “Jump
Starting” in chapter 6 for more information on jump starting procedures.
Some items need to be reset after
the battery has been discharged or
the battery has been disconnected.
See chapter 3 for:
• Power Windows
• Trip Computer
• Climate Control System
• Clock
• Audio System
• Sunroof
• Driver Position Memory System
i Information
Maintenance
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health.
Dispose the battery according to your
local law(s) or regulation.
7
7-27
Maintenance
TIRES AND WHEELS
WARNING
Tire failure may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident. To reduce risk of
SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH,
take the following precautions:
• Inspect your tires monthly for
proper inflation as well as
wear and damage.
• The recommended cold tire
pressure for your vehicle can
be found in this manual and on
the tire label located on the driver’s side center pillar. Always
use a tire pressure gauge to
measure tire pressure. Tires
with too much or too little
pressure wear unevenly causing poor handling.
• Check the pressure of the
spare every time you check
the pressure of the other tires
on your vehicle.
(Continued)
7-28
(Continued)
• Replace tires that are worn,
show uneven wear, or are damaged. Worn tires can cause
loss of braking effectiveness,
steering) control, or traction.
• Always use tires of the same
type, size, brand, construction
and tread pattern all four tires.
Using tires and wheels other
than the recommended sizes
could cause unusual handling
characteristics, poor vehicle
control, or negatively affect
your vehicle’s Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) resulting
in a serious accident.
Tire care
For proper maintenance, safety, and
maximum fuel economy, you must
always maintain recommended tire
inflation pressures and stay within the
load limits and weight distribution recommended for your vehicle.
Recommended cold tire inflation pressures
OAE086002L
Recommended pressures must
be maintained for the best ride,
vehicle handling, and minimum
tire wear.
Over-inflation or under-inflation
can reduce tire life, adversely
affect vehicle handling, and
lead to sudden tire failure that
could result in loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
Severe under-inflation can lead
to severe heat build-up, causing
blowouts, tread separation and
other tire failures that can result
in the loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident. This
risk is much higher on hot days
and when driving for long periods at high speeds.
7-29
Maintenance
All specifications (sizes and pressures)
can be found on a label attached to the
driver’s side center pillar.
All tire pressures (including the
spare) should be checked when the
tires are cold. “Cold tires” means the
vehicle has not been driven for at
least three hours or driven less than
1.6 km (one mile).
Warm tires normally exceed recommended cold tire pressures by 28 to
41 kPa (4 to 6 psi). Do not release air
from warm tires to adjust the pressure or the tires will be under-inflated. For recommended inflation pressure, refer to “Tire and Wheels” in
chapter 8.
WARNING
7
Maintenance
CAUTION
• Under-inflation
results in
excessive wear, poor handling
and reduced fuel economy.
Wheel deformation is also
possible. Keep your tire pressures at the proper levels. If a
tire frequently needs refilling,
we recommend it be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
• Over-inflation produces a
harsh ride, excessive wear at
the center of the tire tread,
and a greater possibility of
damage from road hazards.
7-30
Check tire inflation pressure
Check your tires, including the spare
tire, once a month or more.
How to check
Use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to check tire pressure. You
can not tell if your tires are properly
inflated simply by looking at them.
Radial tires may look properly inflated when they are under-inflated.
Remove the valve cap from the tire
valve stem. Press the tire gauge firmly onto the valve to get a pressure
measurement. If the cold tire inflation
pressure matches the recommended
pressure on the tire and loading
information label, no further adjustment is necessary. If the pressure is
low, add air until you reach the recommended pressure. Make sure to
put the valve caps back on the valve
stems. Without the valve cap, dirt or
moisture could get into the valve
core and cause air leakage. If a valve
cap is missing, install a new one as
soon as possible.
If you overfill the tire, release air by
pushing on the metal stem in the
center of the tire valve. Recheck the
tire pressure with the tire gauge. Be
sure to put the valve caps back on
the valve stems. Without the valve
cap, dirt or moisture could get into
the valve core and cause air leakage.
If a valve cap is missing, install a new
one as soon as possible.
Tire rotation
i Information
The outside and inside of the unsymmetrical tire is distinguishable. When
installing an unsymmetrical tire, be
sure to install the side marked "outside" face the outside. If the side
marked "inside" is installed on the
outside, it will have a bad effect on
vehicle performance.
CBGQ0706
■ Without a spare tire
WARNING
• Do not use the compact spare
tire for tire rotation.
• Do not mix bias ply and radial
ODH073802
Disc brake pads should be inspected
for wear whenever tires are rotated.
ply tires under any circumstances. This may cause
unusual handling characteristics that may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
7-31
Maintenance
To equalize tread wear, HYUNDAI
recommends that the tires be rotated
every 10,000 km (6,000 miles) or
sooner if irregular wear develops.
During rotation, check the tires for
correct balance.
When rotating tires, check for uneven
wear and damage. Abnormal wear is
usually caused by incorrect tire pressure, improper wheel alignment, outof-balance wheels, severe braking or
severe cornering. Look for bumps or
bulges in the tread or side of tire.
Replace the tire if you find either of
these conditions. Replace the tire if
fabric or cord is visible. After rotation,
be sure to bring the front and rear tire
pressures to specification and check
lug nut tightness (proper torque is
11~13 kgf·m [79~94 lbf·ft]).
■ With a full-size spare tire (if equipped)
7
Maintenance
Wheel alignment and tire balance
The wheels on your vehicle were
aligned and balanced carefully at the
factory to give you the longest tire life
and best overall performance.
In most cases, you will not need to
have your wheels aligned again.
However, if you notice unusual tire
wear or your vehicle pulling one way
or the other, the alignment may need
to be reset.
If you notice your vehicle vibrating
when driving on a smooth road, your
wheels may need to be rebalanced.
NOTICE
Improper wheel weights can damage your vehicle’s aluminum
wheels. Use only approved wheel
weights.
7-32
Tire replacement
WARNING
Tread wear indicator
OLMB073027
If the tire is worn evenly, a tread wear
indicator will appear as a solid band
across the tread. This shows there is
less than 1.6 mm (1/16 in.) of tread
left on the tire. Replace the tire when
this happens.
Do not wait for the band to appear
across the entire tread before replacing the tire.
To reduce the risk of DEATH or
SERIOUS INJURY:
• Replace tires that are worn,
show uneven wear, or are
damaged. Worn tires can
cause loss of braking effectiveness, steering control, and
traction.
• Always replace tires with the
same size as each tire that
was originally supplied with
this vehicle. Using tires and
wheels other than the recommended sizes could cause
unusual handling characteristics, poor vehicle control, or
negatively affect your vehicle’s Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS) resulting in a serious
accident.
(Continued)
Wheel replacement
Tire maintenance
When replacing the metal wheels for
any reason, make sure the new
wheels are equivalent to the original
factory units in diameter, rim width
and offset.
In addition to proper inflation, correct
wheel alignment helps to decrease
tire wear. If you find a tire is worn
unevenly, have your dealer check the
wheel alignment.
When you have new tires installed,
make sure they are balanced. This
will increase vehicle ride comfort and
tire life. Additionally, a tire should
always be rebalanced if it is removed
from the wheel.
Tire traction
Tire traction can be reduced if you
drive on worn tires, tires that are
improperly inflated or on slippery
road surfaces. Tires should be
replaced when tread wear indicators
appear. To reduce the possibility of
losing control, slow down whenever
there is rain, snow or ice on the road.
Tire sidewall labeling
This information identifies and
describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also provides
the tire identification number (TIN)
for safety standard certification. The
TIN can be used to identify the tire in
case of a recall.
7-33
Maintenance
(Continued)
• When replacing tires (or
wheels), it is recommended to
replace the two front or two
rear tires (or wheels) as a pair.
Replacing just one tire can
seriously affect your vehicle’s
handling.
• Tires degrade over time, even
when they are not being used.
Regardless of the remaining
tread, HYUNDAI recommends
that tires be replaced after six
(6) years of normal service.
• Heat caused by hot climates or
frequent high loading conditions can accelerate the aging
process. Failure to follow this
warning may cause sudden
tire failure, which could lead to
a loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
7
Maintenance
1
5,6
7
4
2
3
1
OLMB073028
1. Manufacturer or brand name
Manufacturer or brand name is
shown.
2. Tire size designation
A tire’s sidewall is marked with a tire
size designation. You will need this
information when selecting replacement tires for your car. The following
explains what the letters and numbers in the tire size designation
mean.
7-34
Example tire size designation:
(These numbers are provided as an
example only; your tire size designator could vary depending on your
vehicle.)
205/55 R16 91H
205 - Tire width in millimeters.
55 - Aspect ratio. The tire’s section
height as a percentage of its
width.
R - Tire construction code (Radial).
16 - Rim diameter in inches.
91 - Load Index, a numerical code
associated with the maximum
load the tire can carry.
H - Speed Rating Symbol. See the
speed rating chart in this section
for additional information.
Wheel size designation
Wheels are also marked with important information that you need if you
ever have to replace one. The following explains what the letters and
numbers in the wheel size designation mean.
Example wheel size designation:
6.5JX16
6.5 - Rim width in inches.
J - Rim contour designation.
16 - Rim diameter in inches.
Tire speed ratings
The chart below lists many of the different speed ratings currently being
used for passenger car tires. The
speed rating is part of the tire size
designation on the sidewall of the
tire. This symbol corresponds to that
tire’s designed maximum safe operating speed.
Maximum Speed
180 km/h (112 mph)
190 km/h (118 mph)
210 km/h (130 mph)
240 km/h (149 mph)
Above 240 km/h (149 mph)
4. Tire ply composition and
material
Any tires that are over six years old,
based on the manufacturing date,
(including the spare tire) should be
replaced by new ones. You can find
the manufacturing date on the tire
sidewall (possibly on the inside of the
wheel), displaying the DOT Code.
The DOT Code is a series of numbers on a tire consisting of numbers
and English letters. The manufacturing date is designated by the last four
digits (characters) of the DOT code.
The number of layers or plies of rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire
manufacturers also must indicate the
materials in the tire, which include
steel, nylon, polyester, and others.
The letter "R" means radial ply construction; the letter "D“ means diagonal or bias ply construction; and the
letter "B" means belted-bias ply construction.
DOT : XXXX XXXX OOOO
The front part of the DOT means a
plant code number, tire size and
tread pattern and the last four numbers indicate week and year manufactured.
For example:
DOT XXXX XXXX 1519 represents
that the tire was produced in the 15th
week of 2019.
5. Maximum permissible inflation pressure
This number is the greatest amount
of air pressure that should be put in
the tire. Do not exceed the maximum
permissible inflation pressure. Refer
to the Tire and Loading Information
label for recommended inflation
pressure.
7-35
Maintenance
Speed
Rating
Symbol
S
T
H
V
Z
3. Checking tire life (TIN : Tire
Identification Number)
7
Maintenance
6. Maximum load rating
This number indicates the maximum
load in kilograms and pounds that
can be carried by the tire. When
replacing the tires on the vehicle,
always use a tire that has the same
load rating as the factory installed
tire.
7. Uniform tire quality grading
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
For example:
TREADWEAR 200
TRACTION AA
TEMPERATURE A
7-36
Tread wear
The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of
the tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire
graded 150 would wear one-and-ahalf times (1½) as well on the government course as a tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires
depends upon the actual conditions
of their use, however, and may
depart significantly from the norm
due to variations in driving habits,
service practices and differences in
road characteristics and climate.
These grades are molded on the
sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires.
The tires available as standard or
optional equipment on your vehicle
may vary with respect to grade.
Traction - AA, A, B & C
The traction grades, from highest to
lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those
grades represent the tire’s ability to
stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked
C may have poor traction performance.
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to
this tire is based on straightahead braking traction tests,
and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning,
or peak traction characteristics.
WARNING
The temperature grade for this
tire is established for a tire that
is properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
under-inflation, over-inflation,
or excessive loading, either
separately or in combination,
can cause heat build-up and
possible sudden tire failure.
This may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
Low aspect ratio tires
(if equipped)
A low aspect ratio tire, of which the
aspect ratio is lower than 50, is
designed for a sporty-look vehicle.
The low aspect ratio is to optimize
handling and braking. Thus, it may
be uncomfortable to ride and it may
generate noises, in comparison with
a normal tire.
Maintenance
Temperature - A, B & C
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B and C representing the
tire’s resistance to the generation of
heat and its ability to dissipate heat
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel.
Sustained high temperature can
cause the material of the tire to
degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to
sudden tire failure. Grades B and A
represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel
than the minimum required by law.
7
7-37
Maintenance
CAUTION
The side wall of a low aspect
ratio tire is shorter than the normal one. Thus, the low-aspect
wheel and tire are easily damaged. Follow the below instructions.
• When driving on a rough road
or driving off a road, be careful not to damage the tires
and wheels. After driving,
inspect the tires and wheels.
• When passing over a pothole,
speed bump, manhole, or
curb stone, slowly drive the
vehicle not to damage the
tires and wheels.
• When there is an impact on a
tire, inspect the tire condition.
Or, contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
(Continued)
7-38
(Continued)
• Inspect the tire condition and
pressure every 3,000 km
(1,800 miles) to prevent a tire
damage.
• It is difficult to recognize a tire
damage only with your eyes.
When there is a slight hint of a
tire damage, check and replace
the tire to prevent the damage
caused by air leakage.
• When a tire is damaged while
driving on a rough road, off a
road, or over obstacles, such
as a pothole, manhole, or curb
stone, your warranty does not
cover the damage.
• The tire information is specified on the tire side wall.
FUSES
■ Blade type
Normal
Blown
■ Cartridge type
Normal
Blown
■ Multi fuse
Blown
OAEE076008
A vehicle’s electrical system is protected from electrical overload damage by fuses.
This vehicle has 2 (or 3) fuse panels,
one located in the driver’s side panel
bolster, the other in the motor compartment.
i Information
Three kinds of fuses are used: blade
type for lower amperage rating, cartridge type, and multi fuse for higher
amperage ratings.
WARNING
NEVER replace a fuse with anything but another fuse of the
same rating.
• A higher capacity fuse could
cause damage and possibly
cause a fire.
• Do not install a wire or aluminum foil instead of the
proper fuse - even as a temporary repair. It may cause
extensive wiring damage and
possibly a fire.
NOTICE
Do not use a screwdriver or any
other metal object to remove
fuses because it may cause a
short circuit and damage the system.
7-39
Maintenance
Normal
If any of your vehicle’s lights, accessories, or controls do not work, check
the appropriate circuit fuse. If a fuse
has blown, the element inside the
fuse will be melted or broken.
If the electrical system does not
work, first check the driver’s side
fuse panel. Before replacing a blown
fuse, turn the vehicle and all switches off, and then disconnect the negative battery cable. Always replace a
blown fuse with one of the same rating.
If the replacement fuse blows, this indicates an electrical problem. Avoid
using the system involved and immediately consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
7
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse replacement
In an emergency, if you do not have
a spare fuse, use a fuse of the same
rating from a circuit you may not
need for operating the vehicle, such
as the cigarette lighter fuse.
If the headlamps or other electrical
components do not work and the
fuses are OK, check the fuse panel
in the motor compartment. If a fuse is
blown, it must be replaced with the
same rating.
OAEE076010
OAEE079009
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Turn all other switches off.
3. Open the fuse panel cover.
4. Refer to the label on the inside of
the fuse panel cover to locate the
suspected fuse location.
7-40
5. Pull the suspected fuse straight
out. Use the removal tool provided
in the motor compartment fuses
panel.
6. Check the removed fuse; replace it
if it is blown. Spare fuses are provided in the instrument panel fuse
panels (or in the motor compartment fuse panel).
7. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly
in the clips. If it fits loosely, we recommended that you consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Fuse switch
i Information
Motor compartment panel fuse
replacement
■ Blade type fuse
OAEE079011
OAEE076033
■ Cartridge type fuse
Maintenance
Always, place the fuse switch to the
ON position.
If you move the switch to the OFF
position, some items such as the
audio system and digital clock must
be reset and the smart key may not
work properly.
OIK057165L
If the fuse switch is OFF, “Turn on
FUSE SWITCH” message will appear.
NOTICE
• Always place the fuse switch in
the ON position while driving the
vehicle.
• Do not move the transportation
fuse switch repeatedly. The fuse
switch may be damaged.
7
OAEE076045L
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Turn all other switches off.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tap and pulling up.
7-41
Maintenance
4. Check the removed fuse; replace it
if it is blown. To remove or insert
the fuse, use the fuse puller in the
motor compartment fuse panel.
5. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly
in the clips. If it fits loosely, consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Multi fuse
Fuse/relay panel description
Instrument panel fuse panel
NOTICE
After checking the fuse panel in
the motor compartment, securely
install the fuse panel cover. You
may hear a clicking sound if the
cover is securely latched. If it is
not securely latched, electrical
failure may occur from water contact.
OAEE076013
If the multi fuse is blown, we recommend that you consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
OAEE079014
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you
can find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/relay name and capacity.
i Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your
vehicle; the information is accurate at
the time of printing. When you inspect
the fuse box on your vehicle, refer to
the fuse box label.
7-42
Maintenance
7
OAEE076047L
7-43
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Symbol
Fuse Rating
Circuit Protected
10A
Electro Chromic Mirror, A/V & Navigation Head Unit, Audio, Driver IMS Module,
Rear Seat Warmer Module, Auto Head Lamp Leveling Device Module,
Head Lamp Leveling Device Actuator LH/RH, Vess Unit,
Front Air Ventilation Seat Control Module, Front Seat Warmer Control Module
10A
Lane Keeping Assist Unit, Crash Pad Switch, FCA Unit,
Blind-Spot Collision Warning Radar LH/RH, Electronic Parking Brake Switch
Interior Lamp
10A
Front Vanity Lamp LH/RH, Room Lamp, Overhead Console Lamp,
Luggage Lamp, Wireless Charger Unit, Rain Sensor
Air bag
15A
SRS Control Module
E- Shifter 1
10A
SBW Switch, Front Console Switch
5
Module 5
MODULE
Module 4
MODULE
4
Ignition 1
IG1
25A
PCB Block
Cluster
CLUSTER
10A
Instrument Cluster
10A
IPS Control Module, Main Battery Charging Switch, Charge Lamp, PTC Heater,
A/V & Navigation Head Unit, Instrument Cluster, A/C Control Module
7.5A
Active Air Flap LH/RH
10A
Active Air Flap LH/RH, Electric Water Pump (Engine), VPD Sensor, BMS Control Module,
E/R Junction Block
7.5A
Instrument Cluster
7.5A
EPCU, Smart Key Control Module
Ignition 3 2
Memory 2
Module 8
Air bag Indicator
Start
7-44
2
MEMORY
8
MODULE
IND
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Symbol
Module 2
MODULE
Fuse Rating
Circuit Protected
E/R Junction Block, Wireless Charger Unit, SBW (Shift-by-wire) Switch, BCM, USB
Charging Connector, Smart Key Control Module, Audio, A/V & Navigation Head Unit,
Power Outside Mirror Switch, AMP
7.5A
Smart Key Control Module
MEMORY
10A
Instrument Cluster, Driver IMS Module, BCM, A/C Control Module,
Auto Light & Photo Sensor, Driver Door Module,
Passenger Door Module, ICM Relay Box (Outside Mirror Folding/Unfolding Relay)
MULTI
MEDIA
10A
Audio, A/V & Navigation Head Unit
Ignition 3 3
10A
CCM Unit
Ignition 3 1
10A
ICM Relay Box
7.5A
EPS Unit
10A
Tail Gate Relay, Main Battery Charging Switch, Quick Charging Connector Door
Lock/Unlock Actuator(Except Europe), Charging Connector Door Lock/Unlock Actuator (for
Europe)
15A
Smart Key Control Module
7.5A
Front Seat Warmer Control Module, Front Air Ventilation Seat Control Module,
Rear Seat Warmer Module
3
Button Start 3
Memory 1
1
Multi Media
Electric
Power Steering 1
1
Tailgate
Button Start 1
Module 7
1
7
MODULE
Maintenance
10A
2
7-45
7
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Symbol
Fuse Rating
Circuit Protected
Heated Steering
15A
BCM
Sunroof
20A
Sunroof Motor
RH
25A
Power Window (RH) Relay, Passenger Power Window Switch, Driver Safety Power Window
LH
25A
Power Window (LH) Relay, Driver Power Window Switch,
Passenger Safety Power Window Module
7.5A
Immobilizer Module, Smart Key Control Module, Start/Stop Button Switch
7.5A
Stop Lamp Switch, Smart Key Control Module
OBC
10A
OBC
Air conditioner
7.5A
Ionizer, A/C Control Module, Electronic A/C Compressor, E/R Junction Block
Washer
15A
Multifunction Switch
25A
Rear Seat Warmer Module
10A
CCM Unit(for Europe), Normal Charging Connector Lamp(except Europe),
ICM Relay Box (Charging Connector Lock/Unlock Relay)
30A
Driver Seat Manual Switch, Driver IMS Module
Power Window
Right-hand
Power Window
Left-hand
Button Start 2
Brake Switch
Seat Heater Rear
2
BRAKE
SWITCH
RR
Charger
Power Seat Driver
7-46
DRV
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Symbol
AMP
Fuse Rating
Circuit Protected
AMP
10A
Driver Power Outside Mirror, Passenger Power Outside Mirror, Data Link Connector,
FCA Unit
20A
Door Lock/Unlock Relay, ICM Relay Box (Dead Lock Relay),
Driver/Passenger Smart Key Outside Handle, Driver/Passenger Door Module
10A
Wiper Motor, PCB Block (Front Wiper (Low) Relay)
7.5A
BCM, Smart Key Control Module
25A
Front Seat Warmer Control Module, Front Air Ventilation Seat Control Module
Heated Mirror
10A
Driver Power Outside Mirror, Passenger Power Outside Mirror, A/C Control Module
Rear Heated
25A
Rear Defogger (+) (Upper)
30A
Wiper Motor, PCB Block (Front Wiper (Low) Relay)
Module 1
1
MODULE
Door Lock
Wiper Front 2
Module 6
Seat Heater Front
Wiper Front 1
FRT2
6
MODULE
FRT
FRT1
Maintenance
30A
7
7-47
Maintenance
Motor compartment fuse panel
OAEE076016
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you
can find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/relay name and capacity.
i Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your
vehicle; the information is accurate at
the time of printing. When you inspect
the fuse panel in your vehicle, refer to
the fuse panel label.
7-48
OAEE076048L
Motor compartment fuse panel
Type
Fuse Rating
MAIN
150A
Low Voltage DC-DC Converter, E/R Junction Block
60A
PCB Block
60A
IGPM
60A
IGPM
50A
IGPM
60A
Engine Room Junction Block
40A
Engine Room Junction Block
40A
Engine Room Junction Block
IG1
40A
E/R Junction Block
IG2
40A
E/R Junction Block
80A
EPS Unit
5
2
3
4
Multi Fuse
1
Circuit Protected
Maintenance
Symbol
7
7-49
Maintenance
Motor compartment fuse panel
Type
Symbol
Engine Room Junction Block
10A
E/R Junction Block, Multipurpose Check Connector
40A
IGPM
30A
Electronic Parking Brake Switch
30A
Electronic Parking Brake Switch
1 ACTIVE
HYDRAULIC
BOSSTER
40A
Multipurpose Check Connector, IBAU
2 ACTIVE
HYDRAULIC
BOSSTER
30A
Multipurpose Check Connector, IBAU
40A
Engine Room Junction Block
20A
Cigarette Lighter
20A
Power Outlet
15A
IGPM, Rear Defogger (+) (Lower)
1
POWER
OUTLET
3
POWER
OUTLET
2
POWER
OUTLET
2
7-50
Circuit Protected
25A
1
Fuse
Fuse Rating
Motor compartment fuse panel
Type
Symbol
Fuse Rating
Circuit Protected
10A
SCU, SBW Switch, Front Console Switch
10A
Engine Room Junction Block, Electronic A/C Compressor
10A
Electric Water Pump (EV)
15A
ICM Relay Box
15A
Active Air Flap, E/R Junction Block
15A
BMS Control Module
10A
Burglar Alarm Horn Relay
10A
EPCU
10A
Multipurpose Check Connector, IBAU
10A
EPCU, OBC, VPD Relay, BMS Control Module
Maintenance
Fuse
7
7-51
Maintenance
Motor compartment fuse panel
Type
Fuse
7-52
Symbol
Fuse Rating
Circuit Protected
15A
EPCU
20A
PCB Block
20A
Horn Relay
Motor compartment fuse panel
(Battery terminal cover)
Maintenance
OAEE076018
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you
can find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/relay name and capacity.
i Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your
vehicle; the information is accurate at
the time of printing. When you inspect
the fuse panel in your vehicle, refer to
the fuse panel label.
7
OAEE076043
NOTICE
After checking the fuse panel in the motor compartment, securely
install the cover. If it is not securely latched, electrical failure may occur
from water contact.
7-53
Maintenance
LIGHT BULBS
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer to replace most vehicle light
bulbs. It is difficult to replace vehicle
light bulbs because other parts of the
vehicle must be removed before you
can get to the bulb. This is especially
true for removing the headlamp
assembly to get to the bulb(s).
Removing/installing the headlamp
assembly can result in damage to
the vehicle.
i Information
The headlamp and tail lamp lenses
could appear frosty if the vehicle is
washed after driving or the vehicle is
driven at night in wet weather. This
condition is caused by temperature difference between the lamp inside and
outside and, it does not indicate a problem with your vehicle. When moisture
condenses in the lamp, it will be
removed after driving with the headlamp on. The removable level may differ depending on lamp size, lamp position and environmental condition.
However, if moisture is not removed, we
recommend that your vehicle is inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
7-54
WARNING
• Prior to replacing a lamp,
depress the foot brake, shift
to P (Park), apply the parking
brake, place the POWER button in the OFF position and
take the key with you when
leaving the vehicle to avoid
sudden movement of the vehicle and to prevent possible
electric shock.
• Be aware the bulbs may be hot
and may burn your fingers.
i Information
• A normally functioning lamp may
flicker momentarily to stabilize the
vehicle’s electrical control system.
However, if the lamp goes out after
flickering momentarily, or continues to flicker, we recommend the
system be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• The position lamp may not turn on
when the position lamp switch is
turned on, but the position lamp and
headlamp switch may turn on when
the headlamp switch is turned on.
This may be caused by network failure or vehicle electrical control system malfunction. If this occurs, we
recommend the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Headlamp, position lamp,
turn signal lamp bulb replacement
Type A
WARNING
OAE076052
OAE076028
(1) Headlamp (Low)
(2) Headlamp (High)
(3) Turn signal lamp
(4) Position lamp
care. Halogen bulbs contain
pressurized gas that will produce flying pieces of glass
that could cause injuries if
broken.
• Wear eye protection when
changing a bulb. Allow the
bulb to cool down before handling it.
i Information
Traffic Change (For Europe)
The low beam light distribution is
asymmetric. If you go abroad to a
country with opposite traffic direction, this asymmetric part will dazzle
oncoming car driver. To prevent dazzle, ECE regulation demand several
technical solutions (ex. automatic
change system, adhesive sheet, down
aiming). This headlamps are designed
not to dazzle opposite drivers. So, you
need not change your headlamps in a
country with opposite traffic direction.
7-55
Maintenance
• Handle halogen bulbs with
• Always handle them carefully, and
avoid scratches and abrasions. If
the bulbs are lit, avoid contact with
liquids.
• Never touch the glass with bare
hands. Residual oil may cause the
bulb to overheat and burst when lit.
• A bulb should be operated only
when installed in a headlamp.
• If a bulb becomes damaged or
cracked, replace it immediately
and carefully dispose of it.
7
Maintenance
Position lamp Low beam
i Information
The headlamp aiming should be
adjusted after an accident or after the
headlamp assembly is reinstalled at an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
High beam
OAE076030
OAE076031
Headlamp and position lamp
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3. Remove the bulb cover (1) by turning it counterclockwise.
4. Disconnect the bulb socket-connector. (for low beam and high
beam)
5. Remove the bulb from the headlamp assembly.
6. Install a new bulb.
7. Connect the bulb socket-connector. (for low beam and high beam)
8. Install the bulb cover (1) by turning
it clockwise.
Turn signal lamp
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3.Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on
the assembly.
4.Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the bulb align with the slots in the
socket. Pull the bulb out of the
socket.
7-56
5.Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it
locks into place.
6.Install the socket into the assembly
by aligning the tabs on the socket
with the slots in the assembly.
7.Push the socket into the assembly
and turn the socket clockwise.
Type B
WARNING
HID headlamp
Do not attempt to replace or
inspect the low beam (XENON
bulb) due to electric shock danger. If the low beam (XENON
bulb) is not working, have your
vehicle checked by an authorized HYUNDAI Dealer.
OAE078052
Headlamp and position lamp
If the light bulb does not operate, we
recommend that you have the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
i Information
If your vehicle is equipped with High
Intensity Discharge (HID) headlamps,
these headlamps contain mercury. So
if you need to have your vehicle disposed, you should remove the HID
Headlamps before disposal. The
removed HID headlamps should be
recycled, re-used or disposed as hazardous waste.
7-57
Maintenance
(1) Headlamp (high)
(2) Headlamp (low)
(3) Turn signal lamp
(4) Position lamp
7
Maintenance
i Information
HID lamps have superior performance vs. halogen bulbs.
HID lamps are estimated by the manufacturer to last twice as long or
longer than halogen bulbs depending
on their frequency of use. They will
probably require replacement at some
point in the life of the vehicle. Cycling
the headlamps on and off more than
typical use will shorten HID lamps
life. HID lamps do not fail in the same
manner as halogen incandescent
lamps. If a headlamp goes out after a
period of operation but will immediately relight when the headlamp
switch is cycled it is likely the HID
lamp needs to be replaced. HID lighting components are more complex
than conventional halogen bulbs thus
have higher replacement cost.
i Information
The headlamp aiming should be
adjusted after an accident or after the
headlamp assembly is reinstalled at an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
7-58
i Information
Traffic Change (For Europe)
The low beam light distribution is
asymmetric. If you go abroad to a
country with opposite traffic direction,
this asymmetric part will dazzle
oncoming car driver. To prevent dazzle, ECE regulation demand several
technical solutions (ex. automatic
change system, adhesive sheet, down
aiming). This headlamps are designed
not to dazzle opposite drivers. So, you
need not change your headlamps in a
country with opposite traffic direction.
OAEPH078041
Turn signal lamp
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3.Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on
the assembly.
4.Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the bulb align with the slots in the
socket. Pull the bulb out of the
socket.
5.Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it
locks into place.
6.Install the socket into the assembly
by aligning the tabs on the socket
with the slots in the assembly.
7.Push the socket into the assembly
and turn the socket clockwise.
Headlamp aiming (For Europe)
Headlamp aiming
■ Without headlight leveling device
• Type B
• Type A
OAE076057L/OAEE076050L
1. Inflate the tires
to the specified pressure and
remove any loads from the vehicle
except the driver, spare tire, and
tools.
7-59
Maintenance
OAE076056L/OAEE076049L
■ With headlight leveling device
• Type B
• Type A
2. The vehicle should be placed on a
flat floor.
3. Draw vertical lines (Vertical lines
passing through respective head
lamp centers) and a horizontal line
(Horizontal line passing through
center of head lamps) on the
screen.
4. With the headlamp and battery in
normal condition, aim the headlamps so the brightest portion falls
on the horizontal and vertical
lines.
5. To aim the low beam left or right,
turn the driver clockwise or counterclockwise. To aim the low beam
up or down, turn the driver clockwise or counterclockwise.
To aim the high beam up or down,
turn the driver clockwise or counterclockwise.
7
Maintenance
Aiming point
H1 : Height between the head lamp bulb center and ground (Low beam)
H2 : Height between the head lamp bulb center and ground (High beam)
W1 : Distance between the two head lamp bulbs centers (Low beam)
W2 : Distance between the two head lamp bulbs centers (High beam)
OAEE079068L
■ Type A
■ Type B
Vehicle condition
H1
H2
W1
W2
Without driver
738.6
(29.08)
712.8
(28.06)
1,465
(57.67)
1,238
(48.74)
With driver
731.6
(28.80)
705.8
(27.78)
1,465
(57.67)
1,238
(48.74)
7-60
Unit: mm (in)
Vehicle condition
H1
H2
Without driver
724.6
(28.52)
706.2
(27.80)
With driver
717.6
(28.25)
699.2
(27.53)
W1
W2
1400.8
(55.14)
1175.2
(46.26)
Headlamp low beam (LHD side)
■ Based on 10m screen
&DUD[LV
9HUWLFDOOLQHRIOHIW
KHDGODPSEXOEFHQWHU
9HUWLFDOOLQHRIULJKW
KHDGODPSEXOEFHQWHU
+RUL]RQWDOOLQHRI
KHDGODPSEXOEFHQWHU
&XWRIIOLQH
Maintenance
:
/RZEHDP
+
/RZEHDP
7
*5281'
OAEE076052L
1. Turn the low beam on without driver aboard.
2. The cut-off line should be projected in the cut-off line shown in the picture.
3. When aiming the low beam, vertical aiming should be adjusted after adjusting the horizontal aiming.
4. If headlamp leveling device is equipped, adjust the head lamp leveling device switch to “0”.
7-61
Maintenance
Headlamp low beam (RHD side)
■ Based on 10m screen
&DUD[LV
9HUWLFDOOLQHRIOHIW
KHDGODPSEXOEFHQWHU
9HUWLFDOOLQHRIULJKW
KHDGODPSEXOEFHQWHU
+RUL]RQWDOOLQHRI
KHDGODPSEXOEFHQWHU
&XWRIIOLQH
:
/RZEHDP
+
/RZEHDP
*5281'
OAEE076053L
1. Turn the low beam on without driver aboard.
2. The cut-off line should be projected in the cut-off line shown in the picture.
3. When aiming the low beam, vertical aiming should be adjusted after adjusting the horizontal aiming.
4. If headlamp leveling device is equipped, adjust the head lamp leveling device switch to “0”.
7-62
Daytime running lamp
Side repeater lamp replacement
Rear combination lamp bulb
replacement
OAE078049
OAE076034
If the LED lamp does not operate, we
recommend that you have the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
OAE078053
(1) Stop/Tail lamp
(2) Turn signal lamp
(3) Tail lamp
(4) Backup lamp
(5) Stop lamp
Maintenance
If the LED lamp does not operate, we
recommend that you have the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
7
Stop/Tail lamp
If the LED lamp does not operate, we
recommend that you have the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
7-63
Maintenance
Turn signal lamp
OAE076037
OAE076038
OAEPH078031
Turn signal lamp
1. Turn off the vehicle.
2. Open the tailgate.
3. Open the lamp assembly retaining
screw covers.
4. Loosen the lamp assembly retaining screws with a cross-tip screwdriver.
5. Remove the rear combination
lamp assembly from the body of
the vehicle.
6. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
7. Remove the bulb from the socket by
pressing it in and rotating it counterclockwise until the tabs on the bulb
align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
8. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it
locks into place.
9. Install the socket into the assembly
by aligning the tabs on the socket
with the slots in the assembly. Push
the socket into the assembly and
turn the socket clockwise.
7-64
10. Reinstall the lamp assembly to
the body of the vehicle
Back up lamp
6. Insert a new bulb by inserting it
into the socket and rotating it until
it locks into place.
7. Install the socket into the assembly
by aligning the tabs on the socket
with the slots in the assembly.
Push the socket into the assembly
and turn the socket clockwise.
8. Reinstall the service cover.
OAEPH078040
Backup lamp
1. Turn off the vehicle.
2. Open the tailgate.
3. Remove the service cover using a
flat-blade screwdriver.
Maintenance
OAEE079025
4. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on
the assembly.
5. Remove the bulb by pulling it
straight out.
7
7-65
Maintenance
Rear fog lamp (if equipped)
If the LED lamp does not operate, we
recommend that you have the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
License plate light bulb
replacement
Interior light bulb replacement
Map lamp and room lamp
■ Map lamp (LED type)
High mounted stop lamp
OAE076044
OAE079043
If the high mounted stop lamp does not
operate, we recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
1. Using a flat-blade screwdriver,
gently pry the lens cover from the
lamp housing.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it
straight out.
3. Install a new bulb.
4. Reinstall in the reverse order.
OAEE076026
■ Room lamp (LED type)
OAEE076027
If the LED lamp does not operate, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
7-66
Map lamp, room lamp, vanity mirror lamp and luggage compartment
lamp
■ Map lamp (Bulb type)
■ Vanity mirror lamp
1. Using a flat-head screwdriver,
gently pry the lens from the interior light housing.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it
straight out.
3. Install a new bulb into the socket.
4. Align the lens tabs with the interior
light housing notches and snap
the lens into place.
NOTICE
■ Luggage compartment lamp
Maintenance
OAE076048
OAE076045
■ Room lamp (Bulb type)
Use care not to dirty or damage
lenses, lens tabs, and plastic
housings.
7
OAE076046
OAE076047
7-67
Maintenance
APPEARANCE CARE
Exterior care
Exterior general caution
Finish maintenance
Washing
It is very important to follow the label
directions when using any chemical
cleaner or polish. Read all warning
and caution statements that appear
on the label.
To help protect your vehicle’s finish
from rust and deterioration, wash it
thoroughly and frequently at least
once a month with lukewarm or cold
water.
If you use your vehicle for off-road
driving, you should wash it after each
off-road trip. Pay special attention to
the removal of any accumulation of
salt, dirt, mud, and other foreign
materials. Make sure the drain holes
in the lower edges of the doors and
rocker panels are kept clear and
clean.
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,
industrial pollution and similar
deposits can damage your vehicle’s
finish if not removed immediately.
Even prompt washing with plain
water may not completely remove all
these deposits. A mild soap, safe for
use on painted surfaces, should be
used.
After washing, rinse the vehicle thoroughly with lukewarm or cold water.
Do not allow soap to dry on the finish.
High-pressure washing
• When using high-pressure washers, make sure to maintain sufficient distance from the vehicle.
Insufficient clearance or excessive
pressure can lead to component
damage or water penetration.
• Do not spray the camera, sensors
or its surrounding area directly with
a high pressure washer. Shock
applied from high pressure water
may cause the device to not operate normally.
• Do not bring the nozzle tip close to
boots (rubber or plastic covers) or
connectors as they may be damaged if they come into contact with
high pressure water.
7-68
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test
the brakes while driving slowly
to see if they have been affected
by water before getting on the
road. If braking performance is
impaired, dry the brakes by
applying them lightly while maintaining a slow forward speed.
NOTICE
• Do not use strong soap, chemical detergents or hot water, and
do not wash the vehicle in direct
sunlight or when the body of the
vehicle is warm.
• Be careful when washing the
side windows of your vehicle.
Especially, with high-pressure
water, water may leak through
the windows and wet the interior.
• To prevent damage to the plastic
parts, do not clean with chemical solvents or strong detergents.
• To prevent damage to the charging door, make sure to close and
lock the vehicle doors when
washing (high-pressure washing,
automatic car washing, etc.) the
vehicle.
OAEE079046L
NOTICE
• Water washing in the motor compartment including high pressure
water washing may cause the failure of electrical circuits located in
the motor compartment.
• Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/electronic components inside
the vehicle as this may damage
them.
7-69
Maintenance
High-pressure washing
• When using high-pressure washers, make sure to maintain sufficient distance from the vehicle.
Insufficient clearance or excessive
pressure can lead to component
damage or water penetration.
• Do not spray the camera, sensors
or its surrounding area directly with
a high pressure washer. Shock
applied from high pressure water
may cause the device to not operate normally.
• Do not bring the nozzle tip close to
boots (rubber or plastic covers) or
connectors as they may be damaged if they come into contact with
high pressure water.
7
Maintenance
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle
Automatic car wash which uses
rotating brushes should not be
used as this can damage the surface of your vehicle. A steam
cleaner which washes the vehicle
surface at high temperature may
result the oil to adhere and leave
stains that is difficult to remove.
Use a soft cloth (e.g. microfiber
towel or sponge) when washing
your vehicle and dry with a
microfiber towel. When you hand
wash your vehicle, you should not
use a cleaner that finishes with
wax. If the vehicle surface is too
dirty (sand, dirt, dust, contaminant, etc.), clean the surface with
water before washing the vehicle.
7-70
Waxing
A good coat of wax is a barrier between
your paint and contaminate. Keeping a
good coat of wax on your vehicle will
help protect it.
Wax the vehicle when water will no
longer bead on the paint.
Always wash and dry the vehicle before
waxing. Use a good quality liquid or
paste wax, and follow the manufacturer’s instructions. Wax all metal trim to
protect it and to maintain its luster.
Removing oil, tar, and similar materials
with a spot remover will usually strip the
wax from the finish. Be sure to re-wax
these areas even if the rest of the vehicle does not yet need waxing.
NOTICE
• Wiping dust or dirt off the body
with a dry cloth will scratch the
finish.
• Do not use steel wool, abrasive
cleaners, or strong detergents
containing highly alkaline or
caustic agents on chrome-plated
or anodized aluminum parts.This
may result in damage to the protective coating and cause discoloration or paint deterioration.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle
Do not use any polish protector
such as a detergent, an abrasive
and a polish. In case wax is
applied, remove the wax immediately using a silicon remover and
if any tar or tar contaminant is on
the surface use a tar remover to
clean. However, be careful not to
apply too much pressure on the
painted area.
Bright-metal maintenance
Deep scratches or stone chips in the
painted surface must be repaired
promptly. Exposed metal will quickly
rust and may develop into a major
repair expense.
• To remove road tar and insects,
use a tar remover, not a scraper or
other sharp object.
• To protect the surfaces of brightmetal parts from corrosion, apply a
coating of wax or chrome preservative and rub to a high luster.
• During winter weather or in coastal
areas, cover the bright metal parts
with a heavier coating of wax or
preservative. If necessary, coat the
parts with non-corrosive petroleum
jelly or other protective compound.
NOTICE
If your vehicle is damaged and
requires any metal repair or
replacement, be sure the body
shop applies anti-corrosion materials to the parts repaired or
replaced.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle
In case of matte paint finish vehicles, it is impossible to modify only
the damaged area and repair of the
whole part is necessary. If the vehicle is damaged and painting is
required, we recommend that you
have your vehicle maintained and
repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer. Take extreme care, as it is
difficult to restore the quality after
the repair.
Thoroughly flush the vehicle underbody and wheel openings with lukewarm or cold water once a month,
after off-road driving and at the end of
each winter. Pay special attention to
these areas because it is difficult to
see all the mud and dirt. It will do
more harm than good to wet down the
road grime without removing it. The
lower edges of doors, rocker panels,
and frame members have drain holes
that should not be allowed to clog with
dirt; trapped water in these areas can
cause rusting.
WARNING
Underbody maintenance
Corrosive materials used for ice and
snow removal and dust control may
collect on the underbody. If these
materials are not removed, accelerated rusting can occur on underbody
parts such as the fuel lines, frame,
floor pan and exhaust system, even
though they have been treated with
rust protection.
After washing the vehicle, test
the brakes while driving slowly
to see if they have been affected
by water. If braking performance
is impaired, dry the brakes by
applying them lightly while
maintaining a slow forward
speed.
7-71
Maintenance
Finish damage repair
7
Maintenance
Aluminum wheel maintenance
The aluminum wheels are coated with
a clear protective finish.
NOTICE
• Do not use abrasive cleaner, polishing compound, solvent, or
wire brushes on aluminum
wheels.
• Clean the wheel when it has
cooled.
• Use only a mild soap or neutral
detergent, and rinse thoroughly
with water. Also, clean the
wheels after driving on salted
roads.
• Do not wash the wheels with
high-speed car wash brushes.
• Do not use any cleaners containing acid or alkaline detergents.
7-72
Corrosion protection
Protecting your vehicle from corrosion
By using the most advanced design
and construction practices to combat
corrosion, HYUNDAI produces vehicles of the highest quality. However,
this is only part of the job. To achieve
the long-term corrosion resistance
your vehicle can deliver, the owner’s
cooperation and assistance is also
required.
Common causes of corrosion
The most common causes of corrosion on your vehicle are:
• Road salt, dirt and moisture that is
allowed to accumulate underneath
the vehicle.
• Removal of paint or protective
coatings by stones, gravel, abrasion or minor scrapes and dents
which leave unprotected metal
exposed to corrosion.
High-corrosion areas
If you live in an area where your vehicle is regularly exposed to corrosive
materials, corrosion protection is
particularly important. Some of the
common causes of accelerated corrosion are road salts, dust control
chemicals, ocean air and industrial
pollution.
Moisture breeds corrosion
Moisture creates the conditions in
which corrosion is most likely to
occur. For example, corrosion is
accelerated by high humidity, particularly when temperatures are just
above freezing. In such conditions,
the corrosive material is kept in contact with the vehicle surfaces by
moisture that is slow to evaporate.
Mud is particularly corrosive because
it is slow to dry and holds moisture in
contact with the vehicle. Although the
mud appears to be dry, it can still
retain moisture and promote corrosion.
High temperatures can also accelerate corrosion of parts that are not
properly ventilated so the moisture
can be dispersed. For all these reasons, it is particularly important to
keep your vehicle clean and free of
mud or accumulations of other materials. This applies not only to the visible surfaces but particularly to the
underside of the vehicle.
• If you live in a high-corrosion area
— where road salts are used, near
the ocean, areas with industrial
pollution, acid rain, etc.—, you
should take extra care to prevent
corrosion. In winter, hose off the
underside of your vehicle at least
once a month and be sure to clean
the underside thoroughly when
winter is over.
Keep your garage dry
Don’t park your vehicle in a damp,
poorly ventilated garage. This creates a favorable environment for corrosion. This is particularly true if you
wash your vehicle in the garage or
drive it into the garage when it is still
wet or covered with snow, ice or
mud. Even a heated garage can contribute to corrosion unless it is well
ventilated so moisture is dispersed.
Keep paint and trim in good condition
Scratches or chips in the finish
should be covered with "touch-up"
paint as soon as possible to reduce
the possibility of corrosion. If bare
metal is showing through, the attention of a qualified body and paint
shop is recommended.
Bird droppings are highly corrosive
and may damage painted surfaces in
just a few hours. Always remove bird
droppings as soon as possible.
7-73
Maintenance
To help prevent corrosion
Keep your vehicle clean
The best way to prevent corrosion is
to keep your vehicle clean and free
of corrosive materials. Attention to
the underside of the vehicle is particularly important.
• When cleaning underneath the
vehicle, pay particular attention to
the components under the fenders
and other areas that are hidden
from view. Do a thorough job; just
dampening the accumulated mud
rather than washing it away will
accelerate corrosion rather than
prevent it. Water under high pressure and steam are particularly
effective in removing accumulated
mud and corrosive materials.
• When cleaning lower door panels,
rocker panels and frame members,
be sure that drain holes are kept
open so that moisture can escape
and not be trapped inside to accelerate corrosion.
7
Maintenance
Interior care
Interior general precautions
Prevent caustic solutions such as
perfume and cosmetic oil, from contacting the interior parts because
they may cause damage or discoloration. If they do contact the interior
parts, wipe them off immediately.
See the instructions for the proper
way to clean vinyl.
NOTICE
• Never allow water or other liquids to come in contact with
electrical/electronic
components inside the vehicle as this
may damage them.
• When cleaning leather products
(steering wheel, seats etc.), use
neutral detergents or low alcohol content solutions. If you use
high alcohol content solutions
or acid/ alkaline detergents, the
color of the leather may fade or
the surface may get stripped off.
7-74
Cleaning the upholstery and
interior trim
Vinyl (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from
vinyl with a whisk broom or vacuum
cleaner. Clean vinyl surfaces with a
vinyl cleaner.
Fabric (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from fabric
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.
Clean with a mild soap solution recommended for upholstery or carpets.
Remove fresh spots immediately with
a fabric spot cleaner. If fresh spots do
not receive immediate attention, the
fabric can be stained and its color can
be affected. Also, its fire-resistant properties can be reduced if the material is
not properly maintained.
NOTICE
Using anything but recommended
cleaners and procedures may
affect the fabric’s appearance and
fire-resistant properties.
Leather (if equipped)
• Features of seat leather
- Leather is made from the outer
skin of an animal, which goes
through a special process to be
available for use. Since it is a natural product, each part differs in
thickness or density.
Wrinkles may appear as a natural
result of stretching and shrinking
depending on the temperature
and humidity.
- The seat is made of stretchable
fabric to improve comfort.
- The parts contacting the body are
curved and the side supporting
area is high which provides driving comfort and stability.
- Wrinkles may appear naturally
from usage. It is not a fault of the
products.
NOTICE
• Cleaning the leather seats
- Remove all contaminations instantly. Refer to instructions below for
removal of each contaminant.
- Cosmetic products (sunscreen,
foundation, etc.)
Apply cleansing cream on a cloth
and wipe the contaminated spot.
Wipe off the cream with a wet cloth
and remove water with a dry cloth.
- Beverages (coffee, soft drink, etc.)
Apply a small amount of neutral
detergent and wipe until contaminations do not smear.
- Oil
Remove oil instantly with
absorbable cloth and wipe with
stain remover used only for natural leather.
- Chewing gum
Harden the gum with ice and
remove gradually.
7-75
Maintenance
• Wrinkles or abrasions which
appear naturally from usage are
not covered by warranty.
• Belts with metallic accessories,
zippers or keys inside the back
pocket may damage the seat
fabric.
• Make sure not to wet the seat. It
may change the nature of natural leather.
• Jeans or clothes which could
bleach may contaminate the surface of the seat covering fabric.
• Caring for the leather seats
- Vacuum the seat periodically to
remove dust and sand on the seat.
It will prevent abrasion or damage
of the leather and maintain its quality.
- Wipe the natural leather seat cover
often with dry or soft cloth.
- Use of proper leather protector
may prevent abrasion of the cover
and helps maintain the color. Be
sure to read the instructions and
consult a specialist when using
leather coating or protective agent.
- Light colored (beige, cream beige)
leather is easily contaminated and
the stain is noticeable. Clean the
seats frequently.
- Avoid wiping with wet cloth. It may
cause the surface to crack.
7
Maintenance
Cleaning the seat belt webbing
Clean the belt webbing with any mild
soap solution recommended for
cleaning upholstery or carpet. Follow
the instructions provided with the
soap. Do not bleach or re-dye the
webbing because this may weaken
the seat belt.
Cleaning the interior window
glass
If the interior glass surfaces of the
vehicle become fogged (that is, covered with an oily, greasy or waxy
film), they should be cleaned with
glass cleaner. Follow the directions
on the glass cleaner container.
NOTICE
Do not scrape or scratch the
inside of the rear window. This
may result in damage to the rear
window defroster grid.
7-76
Specifications & Consumer information
Specifications & Consumer information
Dimensions ..............................................................8-2
Electric vehicle specifications..............................8-2
Bulb wattage...........................................................8-3
Tires and wheels ....................................................8-4
Tire load and speed capacity ...............................8-5
Air conditioning system ........................................8-5
Volume and weight ................................................8-5
Recommended lubricants and capacities ...........8-6
Vehicle identification number (VIN)....................8-7
Vehicle certification label .....................................8-7
Tire specification and pressure label .................8-8
Motor number.........................................................8-8
Air conditioner compressor label ........................8-8
Declaration of conformity ....................................8-9
8
Specifications & Consumer information
DIMENSIONS
Items
mm (in)
Overall length
4,470 (175.9)
Overall width
1,820 (71.6)
Overall height
For Europe
1,475 (58)
Except Europe
1,475 (58)
Front tread
1,552 (61.1)
Rear tread
1,564 (61.5)
Wheelbase
2,700 (106.3)
ELECTRIC VEHICLE SPECIFICATIONS
Motor
Max. Output (kW)
100
Max. Torque (Nm)
295
OBC : On-Board Battery Chargers
8-2
Battery (Lithium-Ion Polymer)
Capacity (kWh)
38.3
Power Output (kW)
113
Charger (OBC)
Voltage (V)
319
Max. Output (kW)
7.2
BULB WATTAGE
Light bulb
Low
High
Headlamp
Type A
Front
Map lamp
Interior
Room lamp
Vanity mirror lamp
Luggage compartment lamp
Low/High
Type
Type
Type
Type
A
B
A
B
Wattage
55
60
5
21
LED
LED
21
LED
LED
LED
21
LED
16
LED
LED
5
10
LED
8
LED
5
10
Specifications & Consumer information
Rear
Position lamp
Turn signal lamp
Headlamp
Type B
Position lamp
Turn signal lamp
Daytime running light (DRL)
Side repeater lamp
Tail/Stop lamp
Turn signal lamp
Tail lamp
Backup lamp
Fog lamp
High mounted stop lamp
License plate lamp
Bulb type
H7LL
9005HL+
W5W
PY21W
LED
LED
PY21W
LED
LED
LED
PY21W
LED
W16W
LED
LED
W5W
W10W
LED
FESTOON
LED
FESTOON
FESTOON
8
8-3
Specifications & Consumer information
TIRES AND WHEELS
Item
Tire size
Full size tire
205/60 R16
Wheel
size
Inflation pressure, bar (kPa, psi)
Normal load *1
Front
Rear
6.5J X 16 2.5 (250, 36)
2.5 (250, 36)
Maximum load
Front
Rear
2.5 (250, 36)
2.5 (250, 36)
Wheel lug nut
torque
kgf·m (lbf·ft, N•m)
11~13
(79~94, 107~127)
*1 : Normal load : Up to 3 persons
NOTICE
• It is permissible to add 20 kPa (3 psi) to the standard tire pressure specification if colder temperatures are
expected soon. Tires typically lose 7 kPa (1 psi) for every 7°C (12°F) temperature drop. If extreme temperature
variations are expected, recheck your tire pressure as necessary to keep them properly inflated.
• An air pressure generally decreases, as you drive up to a high-altitude area above sea level. Thus, if you plan
to drive a high-altitude area, check the tire pressures in advance. If necessary, inflate them to a proper level
(Air inflation per altitude: +10 kPa/1 km (+2.4 psi/1 mile).
CAUTION
When replacing tires, use the same size originally supplied with the vehicle.
Using tires of a different size can damage the related parts or not work properly.
8-4
TIRE LOAD AND SPEED CAPACITY
Item
Full size tire
*1 LI : LOAD INDEX
Tire size
Wheel size
205/60 R16
6.5J X 16
Load Capacity
Speed Capacity
LI *
kg
SS *2
km/h
92
630
H
210
1
*2 SS : SPEED SYMBOL
Specifications & Consumer information
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Items
without heat pump
Refrigerant
g (oz.) with heat pump
Compressor lubricant
g (oz.)
Weight of Volume
Classification
550±25 (19.40±0.88)
1,100±25 (38.80±0.88)
R-1234yf (For Europe)
R-134a (Except Europe)
180±10 (6.34±0.35)
POE
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for more details.
VOLUME AND WEIGHT
Luggage volume l (cu ft)
Gross vehicle weight
1,970 (4,343)
8
kg (lbs.)
Min.
Max.
455 (16.0)
1,410 (49.8)
Min : Behind rear seat to roof
Max : Behind front seat to roof
8-5
Specifications & Consumer information
RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
To help achieve proper vehicle performance and durability, use only lubricants of the proper quality.
These lubricants and fluids are recommended for use in your vehicle.
Lubricant
Reduction gear fluid
Volume
1.0 ~ 1.1 l
(1.0 ~ 1.1 US qt.)
without heat pump
4.1 ~ 4.2 l
(4.33 ~ 4.44 US qt.)
with heat pump
4.6 ~ 4.7 l
(4.86 ~ 4.97 US qt.)
Coolant
Brake fluid
8-6
Classification
70W, API GL-4, TCGO-9(MS517-14)
Designated coolant water for electric vehicles
0.7 ~ 0.8 l
DOT 4
(0.74 ~ 0.85 US qt.) (SAE J1704 DOT-4 LV, ISO4925 CLASS-6, FMVSS 116 DOT-4)
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN)
■ Frame number
VEHICLE CERTIFICATION
LABEL
■ VIN label (if equipped)
OAEPH089004L
The vehicle identification number
(VIN) is the number used in registering your vehicle and in all legal matters pertaining to its ownership, etc.
The number is punched on the floor
under the passenger's (or driver's)
seat. To check the number, open the
cover.
The VIN is also on a plate attached
to the top of the dashboard. The
number on the plate can easily be
seen through the windshield from
outside.
OAE086002
The vehicle certification label
attached on the driver’s (or front passenger’s) side center pillar gives the
vehicle identification number (VIN).
Specifications & Consumer information
OAE086001
8
8-7
Specifications & Consumer information
TIRE SPECIFICATION AND
PRESSURE LABEL
AIR CONDITIONER
COMPRESSOR LABEL
MOTOR NUMBER
■ Left-hand drive
OAE086002L
■ Right-hand drive
The motor number is stamped on the
motor block as shown in the drawing.
The motor number can be seen from
under the vehicle.
OAE086002R
The tires supplied on your new vehicle are chosen to provide the best
performance for normal driving.
The tire label located on the driver's
side center pillar gives the tire pressures recommended for your vehicle.
8-8
OAEE086001
OHC081001
A compressor label informs you the
type of compressor your vehicle is
equipped with such as model, supplier part number, production number,
refrigerant (1) and refrigerant oil (2).
DECLARATION OF
CONFORMITY
■ Example
Specifications & Consumer information
CE0678
The radio frequency components of
the vehicle comply with requirements
and other relevant provisions of
Directive 1995/5/EC.
Further information including the
manufacturer's declaration of conformity is available on HYUNDAI
web site as follows:
http://service.hyundai-motor.com
8
8-9
Appendix
Шофиране през зимата (Bulgarian)..................9-2
Téli vezetés (Hungarian) .....................................9-6
Vetrarakstur (Icelandic) .....................................9-10
Jazda zimą (Polish)...........................................9-14
Appendix
AI
Appendix
ШОФИРАНЕ ПРЕЗ ЗИМАТА (BULGARIAN)
Тежките зимни атмосферни условия
могат да предизвикат по-голямо
износване и други проблеми. За да
сведете до минимум проблемите,
свързани с шофирането през
зимата, следвайте препоръките подолу:
9-2
Сняг или поледица
За да карате своето превозно
средство при дълбока снежна
покривка може да се наложи да
използвате зимни гуми или да
поставите вериги върху тях. Ако са
необ ходими зимни гуми, трябва
да изберете гуми със същия
размер и вид като тези на
оригиналните гуми.
В противен случай това може да
се отрази неблагоприятно на
безопасността и експлоатацията
на Вашия автомобил. Освен това
карането с висока скорост,
бързото ускорение, внезапното
натискане на спирачки и резките
завои крият сериозни опасности.
При забавяне на скоростта,
използвайте
доколкото
е
възможно спирачките на дви
гателя. Внезапното натискане на
спирачки на заснежена или
заледена настилка може да
предизвика занасяне. Трябва да
под
държате
достатъчна
дистанция между автомобила,
който се движи пред Вас, и Вашия
автомобил.
Освен това натискайте спирачката
леко. Следва да се отбележи че
инсталирането на веригите върху
гума та ще позволи прилагането
на по-голяма движеща сила, но
няма да предотврати занасянето
встрани.
К СВЕДЕНИЮ
Веригите за гуми не са
позволени във всички държави.
Проверете
норма
тивната
уредба в своята страна преди
да поставите вериги за гуми.
Г уми за сняг
Ако поставите гуми за сняг на своя
авто- мобил се уверете, че това са
радиалнигуми със същия размер и
товарен индекс като тези на
оригиналните гуми. Поставете гуми
за сняг на всичките четири колела,
за да балансирате експлоатацията
на своя автомобил във всякакви
атмос- ферни условия. Имайте
предвид, че тягата на гумите за сняг
върху суха настилка не може да
бъде толкова голяма колкото тази
на оригиналните гуми. Следва да
карате внимателно, дори когато
пътищата
са
почистени.
Консултирайте се с доставчика на
гуми
за
максималната
препоръчителна скорост.
ОСТОРОЖНО
Вериги за гуми
Размер на гумите за сняг
Г умите за сняг следва да са
равностойни по размер и тип на
тези на стандартните гуми на
автомобила. В противен случай
това може да се отрази
неблагоприятно на безопасността
и експлоатацията на Вашия
автомобил.
Не монтирайте гуми с шипове,
преди
да
сте
проверили
местните, национални и общински
разпоредби за възможни ограничения в тяхната употреба.
OAEE059015
9-3
Appendix
Тъй
като
страниците
на
радиалните гуми са по-тънки, те
могат да се повредят, ако върху
тях се монтират някои видове
вери- ги за сняг. Ето защо се
препоръчва изпол- зването на
гуми за сняг, а не на вериги за сняг.
Не поставяйте вериги върху
автомо- били, чиито колела са с
алуминиеви джан- ти; веригите за
сняг могат да повредят колелата.
Ако трябва да се използват вериги
за сняг, използвайте телени вериги
с дебелина от поне 12 мм.
A
Appendix
Повредата на Вашия автомобил
вследствие на непра- вилната
употреба на вериги за сняг не е в
обхвата
на
гаранцията
на
производителя
на
Вашия
автомобил.
Поставяйте веригите винаги по
две, на предните гуми. Обърнете
внимание, че поставянето на
вериги на гумите на автомобила
осигурява по-добра задвижваща
сила, но не предпазва от
странични поднасяния.
9-4
ВНИМАНИЕ
• Уверете се, че размерът и
видът
на
веригите
са
правилните за Вашите гуми.
Неправилните вериги за сняг
могат
да
повредят
каросерията и окачването на
автомобила и този тип повреда
може да не е в обхвата на
производствената гаранция за
Вашия автомобил. Също така
куките за свързване на
веригите за сняг могат да се
повредят от намиращите се в
контакт с тях автомобилни
части, като това може да
доведе до разхлабването им.
Уверете се, че веригите за сняг
са
от
клас
S
според
класификацията
на
Дружеството на автомобилните
инженери (SAE).
(продолжение)
(продолжение)
• Винаги проверявайте дали
веригите
са
били
поставени правилно след
като изминете около 0,5 до 1
км, за да се уверите в
безопасното им поставяне.
Затегнете веригите или ги
поставете отново, ако са се
разхлабили.
Монтиране на вериги
Когато инсталирате веригите,
следвайте
инструкциите
на
производителя и ги затег- нете
максимално. Карайте бавно с
инста- лирани вериги. Ако чуете, че
веригите са навлезли в контакт с
каросерията или шасито, спрете и
ги затегнете. Ако те все още са в
контакт, намалете скоростта до
преустановяване на контакта.
Свалете веригите веднага, щом
започнете да кара- те по
почистените пътища.
ОСТОРОЖНО
Поставяне на вериги
Когато поставяте вериги за
сняг, паркирайте автомобила
на равно място далеч от
пътното движение. Включете
аварийните
светлини
и
поставете зад автомобила
светлоотразителен
триъгълник, ако разполагате
с такъв. Винаги поставяйте
скоростния лост в положение
„P” (Паркиране), задействайте
ръчната спирачка и изгасете
двигателя на автомобила,
преди да поставяте вериги за
сняг.
ОСТОРОЖНО
• Веригите с грешен размер
или
тези,
които
са
неправилно инсталирани,
могат
да
повредят
спирачните
накладки,
окачването, каросерията и
колелата.
• Спрете и затегнете веригите
повтор- но винаги, щом ги
чуете да удрят автомобила.
Appendix
Вериги за гуми
• Използването на вериги може
да се отрази неблагоприятно
на работата на Вашия
автомобил.
• Не надвишавайте пределната
ско- рост, препоръчана от
производителя,
или
скоростта от 30 км/ч, което е
по- ниско.
• Карайте
внимателно
и
избягвайте
неравности,
дупки, резки завои и други
опасности на пътя, които
могат да накарат автомобила
да подскача.
• Избягвайте резките завои или
изпол- зването на спирачки,
ако колелата са блокирани.
ВНИМАНИЕ
A
9-5
Appendix
TÉLI VEZETÉS (HUNGARIAN)
Télen a nehéz időjárási feltételek
nagyobb elhasználódást és más
problémákat eredményezhetnek. A
téli
vezetés
problémáinak
csökkentése érdekében célszerű
követnie a következő javaslatokat:
9-6
Havas vagy jeges útviszonyok
Mély hóban közlekedéshez szükség
lehet téli gumiabroncsok használatára
vagy kerekeire hólánc felszerelésére.
Ha téli gumiabroncsokra van
szüksége, a gyárilag felszerelttel
megegyező méretű és típusú
gumiabroncsot kell választani. Ennek
figyelmen kívül hagyása hátrányosan
befolyásolja gépkocsija biztonságát és
vezethetőségét. Ezen túlmenően a
nagy sebességű haladás, a hirtelen
gyorsítás, a hirtelen fékezés és a
gyors kanyarvétel nagyon veszélyes
gyakorlat.
Lassításkor a lehető legjobban
használja ki motorja fékhatását.
Havas vagy jeges úton a hirtelen
fékezés megcsúszást okozhat.
Elegendően
nagy
követési
távolságot kell tartania saját
gépkocsija és az Ön előtt haladó
jármű között. Tehát óvatosan
fékezzen. Jegyezze meg, hogy
hólánc használatakor megnő a
hajtóerő, de nem segít az oldalra
kicsúszás elkerülésében.
MEGJEGYZÉS
A hólánc nem legális minden
országban. Ellenőrizze az Ön
országának törvényeit, mielőtt
felszereli a hóláncot.
Téli gumiabroncs
Ha téli gumiabroncsot akar használni,
először győződjön meg arról, hogy
ezek
megfelelő
méretű
és
terhelhetőségű radiál abroncsok.
Kifejezetten javasoljuk, hogy mind a
négy kerékre szereltessen téli
gumiabroncsot, hogy biztosítsa
gépkocsija jó vezethetőségét. Ne
feledje, hogy a téli gumiabroncsok
tapadása száraz úton nem olyan jó,
mint a gépkocsira eredetileg felszerelt
gumiabroncsoké. Még tiszta úton is
óvatosan kell vezetnie. Tájékozódjon a
gumiszerelőnél a megengedett
legnagyobb
sebességgel
kapcsolatban.
VIGYÁZAT!
A téli gumiabroncsok mérete
Hólánc
OAEE059015
Mivel a radiál gumiabroncsok oldalfala
vékonyabb, megsérülhetnek bizonyos
fajtájú hólánc felszerelésétől. Ezért
inkább javasoljuk a téli gumiabroncsok
használatát,
mint
a
hólánc
használatát. Ne szereljen fel hóláncot
alumínium keréktárcsás kerékre, mivel
a hólánc sérüléseket okozhat a
keréktárcsán. Ha mégis hóláncot
kellene használnia, használjon 12
mm-es átmérőnél kisebb, kábeltípusú
hóláncot. Gépkocsijának a hólánc
helytelen használatából eredő káraira
nem vonatkozik a garancia.
9-7
Appendix
A téli gumiabroncsnak mind
méretében, mind szerkezetében
meg kell egyeznie az eredeti
nyárival. Ellenkező
esetben
gépkocsija
biztonsága
és
vezethetősége
kedvezőtlenül
változhat.
Ne
szereltessen
fel
szöges
gumiabroncsot, mielőtt tájékozódna
a használatukra, illetve esetleges
tiltásukra vonatkozó helyi előírásokról.
A
Appendix
A hóláncot mindig párban szerelje fel
az
első
kerekekre.
Fontos
megjegyezni, hogy a kerekekre
felszerelt hólánc nagyobb tapadóerőt
biztosít, azonban nem akadályozza
meg a kicsúszást oldalra.
9-8
FIGYELEM!
• Ügyeljen arra, hogy a hólánc a
gumiabroncsaihoz megfelelő
méretű és típusú legyen. A
nem megfelelő méretű hólánc
megrongálhatja gépkocsija
karosszériáját
és
felfüggesztéseit, és erre nem
vonatkozik
a
gépkocsi
garanciája.
Ezenkívül
a
hólánc összekötő kapcsai
megsérülhetnek
a
karosszériához
ütődéstől,
amitől a hólánc meglazulhat,
és
leeshet
a
kerékről.
Kizárólag az SAE szabvány
szerinti „S” osztályú hóláncot
használjon.
• 0,5 - 1km megtétele után
ellenőrizze
megfelelő
elhelyezkedésüket
a
biztonságos
felszerelésük
érdekében. Ha meglazultak,
húzza meg újra, vagy szerelje
fel ismét a hóláncokat.
A hуlбnc felszerelйse
A hólánc felszerelésekor figyelmesen
kövesse gyártójának utasításait, és a
lehető legfeszesebbre húzza meg a
láncot. A felszerelt hólánccal lassan
közlekedjen. Ha a lánc hozzáverődik
a karosszériához vagy az alvázhoz,
álljon meg és feszítsen rajta. Ha még
mindig hozzáér, lassítson le annyira,
hogy megszűnjön a kontaktus.
Haladéktalanul távolítsa el a
láncokat, amint tiszta útra ér.
VIGYÁZAT!
Hólánc felszerelése
Hólánc
felszerelésekor
forgalomtól távol eső sík
felületen álljon félre. Kapcsolja
be a vészvillogót, és tegyen ki
elakadásjelző háromszöget a
gépkocsi mögé. A hólánc
felszerelése
előtt
mindig
kapcsolja P állásba (Parkolás) a
sebességváltó választókarját,
működtesse a rögzítőféket, majd
állítsa le a gépkocsit.
VIGYÁZAT!
Hólánc
• A hólánc használata jelentősen
• A nem megfelelő méretű vagy
rosszul felszerelt hólánc
megrongálhatja gépkocsija
féktömlőit, felfüggesztéseit,
karosszériáját és a kerekeit.
• Álljon
meg
és
húzza
feszesebbre a hóláncokat, ha
beleütnek
a
gépkocsi
valamelyik alkatrészébe.
Appendix
korlátozza
a
gépkocsi
kezelhetőségét.
• Ne lépje túl a 30 km/h
sebességet, vagy a hólánc
gyártója által meghatározott
maximális sebességet. Mindig a
kettő közül alacsonyabb értéket
tartsa be.
• Vezessen óvatosan, kerülje a
bukkanókat, lyukakat, éles
kanyarokat és az úton előforduló
egyéb veszélyforrásokat, melyek
a gépkocsi erős berugózását
okozzák.
• Tartózkodjon
az
éles
kanyarvételtől és a blokkoló
kerekekkel történő fékezéstől.
FIGYELEM!
A
9-9
Appendix
VETRARAKSTUR (ICELANDIC)
Akstur í þungri færð og vetrarveðri
leiðir til aukins slits á ökutækinu og
skapar ýmis vandamál. Hægt er að
draga úr erfiðleikum sem fylgja
vetrarakstri ef farið er að þessum
ráðleggingum:
9-10
Akstur í snjó eða hálku
Við akstur í djúpum snjó kann að vera
nauðsynlegt að nota vetrarhjólbarða
eða setja keðjur á hjólbarðana.
Reynist nauðsynlegt að nota
vetrarhjólbarða þarf að velja hjólbarða
af sömu stærð og gerð og venjulegu
hjólbarðarnir. Sé það ekki gert getur
það dregið úr öryggi og skert
aksturseiginleika ökutækisins.
Hraðakstur,
skyndileg
hröðun,
nauðhemlun og krappar beygjur geta
enn fremur falið í sér mikla hættu.
Þegar dregið er úr hraða er ráðlegt
að beita vélarhemlun sem kostur er.
Við nauðhemlun á snævi þöktum
eða hálum vegum getur ökutækið
hæglega runnið til. Nauðsynlegt er
að halda hæfilegri fjarlægð á milli
þíns ökutækis og ökutækisins fyrir
framan. Alltaf ætti að beita hemlinum
mjúklega. Hafa ber í huga að ef
keðjur eru settar á hjólbarða fæst
aukinn drifkraftur en það hindrar þó
ekki að ökutækið renni til hliðanna.
ATHUGIÐ
Notkun snjókeðja er ólögleg í
sumum ríkjum. Kynnið ykkur
gildandi landslög áður en keðjur
eru settar upp.
Vetrarhjólbarðar
Ef vetrarhjólbarðar eru settir á
ökutækið þarf að gæta þess að nota
þverofna hjól- barða af sömu stærð og
ásþunga
og
upprunalegu
hjólbarðarnir. Setjið vetrarhjólbarða á
öll fjögur hjólin til að tryggja örugga
stýringu
ökutækisins
við
öll
veðurskilyrði. Hafið í huga að á auðum
vegi kunna vetrarhjólbarðar að hafa
minna grip en hjólbarðarnir sem fylgdu
ökutækinu. Því þarf að aka af gætni,
jafnvel á auðum vegum. Ráðfærið
ykkur við söluaðila hjólbarðanna um
ráðlagðan hámarkshraða.
VIÐVÖRUN
Keðjur á hjólbarða
OAEE059015
Hliðar þverofinna hjólbarða eru þynnri
en á öðrum hjólbörðum og sumar gerðir
snjókeðja geta því valdið skemmdum á
þeim. Því er ráðlegt að nota
vetrarhjólbarða fremur en keðjur, ef
þess er kostur.
Setjið aldrei keðjur á hjólbarða
ökutækja sem búin eru álfelgum þar
sem keðjurnar geta valdið skemmdum
á felgunum. Ef óhjákvæmilegt reynist
að nota keðjur skal nota vírkeðjur sem
eru innan við 12 mm á þykkt.
Ábyrgðartrygging söluaðila ökutækisins
tekur ekki til skemmda sem orsakast af
rangri notkun snjókeðja.
9-11
Appendix
Stærðir vetrarhjólbarða
Vetrarhjólbarðar ættu að vera af
sömu stærð og gerð og
hjólbarðarnir
sem
fylgdu
ökutækinu.
Misræmi á því getur dregið úr
öryggi og skert aksturseiginleika
ökutækisins.
Áður en negldir hjólbarðar eru settir
upp er rétt að kynna sér reglugerðir um
notkun slíkra hjólbarða í viðkomandi
landi, fylki eða sveitarfélagi.
A
Appendix
Aðeins skal setja keðjur á í pörum og
aðeins á framhjólbarðana. Hafa ber í
huga að ef keðjur eru settar á
hjólbarða fæst aukinn drifkraftur. Það
hindrar þó ekki að ökutækið renni til
hliðanna.
9-12
VARÚÐ
• Gætið þess að snjókeðjurnar
séu af þeirri stærð og gerð
sem hæfir hjólbörðunum.
Notkun snjókeðja af rangri
gerð getur valdið skemmdum
á yfirbyggingu og fjöðrun
ökutækisins og kann að falla
utan
ábyrgðartryggingar
söluaðila ökutækisins. Þá
geta festikrókar keðjanna
skemmst vegan núnings við
íhluti
ökutækisins
og
snjókeðjurnar
losnað
af
hjólbarðanum. Gætið þess að
snjókeðjurnar séu með SAEvottun í S-flokki.
• Eftir um það bil 0,5-1 km
akstur skal ævinlega skoða
keðjurnar aftur til að tryggja
að þær hafi verið settar upp á
réttan og öruggan hátt. Herðið
keðjurnar eða setjið þær aftur
á ef þær hafa losnað.
Uppsetning б keрjum
Þegar keðjur eru settar á skal fylgja
leiðbeiningum framleiðanda og herða
keðjurnar eins mikið og unnt er. Þegar
keðjur hafa verið settar á skal aka
hægt. Ef hljóð heyrist sem bendir til að
keðjurnar séu í snertingu við
yfirbyggingu eða undirvagn er rétt að
nema staðar og herða keðjurnar. Ef
snerting virðist enn eiga sér stað skal
hægja aksturinn þar til hljóðið þagnar.
Takið keðjurnar niður um leið og
komið er á rudda og snjólausa vegi.
VIÐVÖRUN
VIÐVÖRUN
VARÚÐ
Uppsetning á keðjum
Keðjur á hjólbarða
• Séu snjókeðjur af rangri stærð
Þegar snjókeðjur eru settar upp
skal leggja ökutækinu á sléttum
fleti fjarri umferð. Kveikið á
viðvörunarljósum ökutækisins
og
setjið
þríhyrningslaga
viðvörunarskilti upp fyrir aftan
ökutækið, ef það er tiltækt.
Hafið ökutækið ævinlega í
stöðuhemli
og
drepið
á
ökutækinu áður en snjókeðjur
eru settar upp.
• Notkun keðja getur skert
eða rangt upp settar geta þær
valdið skemmdum á hemlalögn,
fjöðrun, yfirbyggingu og hjólum
ökutækisins.
• Hvenær sem hljóð bendir til
þess að keðjurnar sláist við
ökutækið skal stöðva akstur
og herða keðjurnar.
aksturs- eiginleika ökutækisins.
• Akið ekki hraðar en 30 km/klst.
eða samkvæmt ráðlögðum
hámarkshraða framleiðanda
keðjanna, hvort sem reynist
lægra.
• Akið gætilega og sneiðið hjá
þústum, holum, kröppum
beygjum og öðrum hættum á
veginum, sem gætu valdið
hristingi ökutækisins.
• Forðist krappar beygjur eða
læsta hemlun.
Appendix
A
9-13
Appendix
JAZDA ZIMĄ (POLISH)
Surowe warunki pogodowe zimą
powodują większe zużycie pojazdu i
inne problemy. Aby zminimalizować
problemy związane z jazdą w zimie,
postępuj zgodnie z poniższymi
sugestiami:
9-14
Jazda w warunkach
śniegowych i przy oblodzeniu
Aby prowadzić pojazd w głębokim
śniegu, może okazać się niezbędne
użycie
opon
zimowych
lub
zainstalowanie
łańcuchów
śniegowych. Jeśli potrzebne okażą
się opony zimowe, konieczne jest
wybranie opon o rozmiarze i typie
odpowiadających oponom, w jakie
pojazd był pierwotnie wyposażony.
Jeśli
założone
zostaną
nieodpowiednie opony, będzie to
miało
negatywny
wpływ
na
bezpieczeństwo i prowadzenie
pojazdu. Ponadto jazda z nadmierną
prędkością,
gwałtowne
przyspieszanie, nagłe hamowanie i
ostre
skręty
będą
stanowiły
potencjalnie
bardzo
duże
niebezpieczeństwo.
Podczas zwalniania należy w pełni
wykorzystać hamowanie silnikiem.
Nagłe hamowanie na zaśnieżonej
lub oblodzonej drodze może
spowodować poślizg pojazdu.
Należy utrzymywać odpowiedni
odstęp od pojazdu jadącego z
przodu. Hamulców należy używać
ostrożnie. Należy pamiętać, że
założenie łańcuchów śniegowych
zapewni większą siłę napędową, ale
nie zapobiegnie ślizganiu się na
boki.
UWAGA
Stosowanie łańcuchów śniegowych
nie jest zgodne z prawem we
wszystkich krajach. Przed założeniem
łańcuchów
śniegowych
należy
sprawdzić przepisy danego kraju.
Opony zimowe
Kiedy zakładane są opony zimowe,
należy upewnić się, że są to opony
radialne o takim samym rozmiarze i
zakresie obciążeń co pierwotne
opony pojazdu. Opony zimowe należy
zakładać na wszystkie cztery koła
pojazdu,
by
we
wszystkich
warunkach pogodowych pojazd
pozwalał się prowadzić równomiernie.
Należy pamiętać, że przyczepność
zapewniana przez opony zimowe na
suchej drodze może nie być równie
wysoka
jak
przyczepność
pierwotnych opon pojazdu. Pojazd
należy prowadzić ostrożnie nawet
wtedy, gdy drogi są oczyszczone. Aby
poznać
informacje
na
temat
zalecanych ograniczeń prędkości dla
danych opon, należy skontaktować
się ze sprzedawcą opon.
OSTRZEŻENIE
Łańcuchy śniegowe
(przeciwpoślizgowe)
Rozmiar opon zimowych
Opony zimowe powinny mieć
rozmiar i typ odpowiadający
standardowym oponom pojazdu.
Jeśli tak nie jest, może to mieć
negatywny
wpływ
na
bezpieczeństwo i prowadzenie
pojazdu.
Opon okolcowanych nie należy
zakładać
bez
uprzedniego
sprawdzenia w przepisach lokalnych,
stanowych i miejskich, czy na ich
użycie nie są nałożone ograniczenia.
OAEE059015
9-15
Appendix
Ponieważ ścianki boczne opon
radialnych są cieńsze, założenie
niektórych rodzajów łańcuchów
śniegowych może spowodować ich
uszkodzenie. Z tego względu zaleca
się korzystanie z opon zimowych
zamiast łańcuchów śniegowych.
Łańcuchów śniegowych nie należy
zakładać w pojazdach, które są
wyposażone w felgi aluminiowe,
ponieważ mogą one powodować
uszkodzenia felg. Jeśli użycie
łańcuchów śniegowych jest niezbędne,
należy zastosować łańcuchy drutowe o
grubości poniżej 12 mm.
A
Appendix
Uszkodzenia pojazdu spowodowane
użyciem niewłaściwych łańcuchów
śniegowych nie jest objęte gwarancją
producenta pojazdu.
Łańcuchy na opony należy zakładać
jedynie parami i na przednich
oponach. Należy pamiętać, że
założenie łańcuchów na oponach
zwiększy siłę napędową, ale nie
zapobiegnie poślizgowi bocznemu.
OSTROŻNIE
• Należy
upewnić się, że
łańcuchy śniegowe mają
odpowiedni rozmiar i typ dla
opon pojazdu. Zastosowanie
niewłaściwych
łańcuchów
śniegowych może spowodować
uszkodzenie nadwozia oraz
zawieszenia, a zniszczenia
powstałe w ten sposób mogą
nie być objęte gwarancją
producenta pojazdu.
(Ciąg dalszy)
9-16
(Ciąg dalszy)
Ponadto, haczyki
łączące
łańcuchów śniegowych mogą
zostać zniszczone na skutek
stykania się z elementami
samochodu,
co
może
spowodować zsunięcie się
łańcuchów z opon. Należy
upewnić się, że łańcuchy
śniegowe są klasy “S” SAE i
posiadają certyfikat.
• Po przejechaniu ok. 0,5 do 1
km (0,3 do 0,6 mil), dla
zachowania bezpieczeństwa,
należy zawsze sprawdzić, czy
łańcuchy śniegowe zostały
poprawnie założone. Jeśli
łańcuchy poluzowały się,
należy je zacisnąć lub założyć
ponownie.
Zakіadanie іaсcuchуw њniegowych
Zakładając łańcuchy śniegowe należy
postępować zgodnie z instrukcjami
podanymi
przez
producenta.
Łańcuchy należy założyć tak ciasno,
jak to tylko możliwe. Kiedy łańcuchy są
już założone, pojazd należy prowadzić
powoli. Jeśli dadzą się słyszeć dźwięki
świadczące o tym, że łańcuchy stykają
się z nadwoziem lub podwoziem,
należy zatrzymać samochód i
zacisnąć je. Jeśli łańcuchy wciąż
stykają się z elementami pojazdu,
należy zmniejszać prędkość, aż
łańcuchy przestaną uderzać w
samochód. Łańcuchy należy zdjąć jak
tylko rozpocznie się jazdę po
oczyszczonej drodze.
OSTRZEŻENIE
Zakładanie łańcuchów
śniegowych
Aby założyć łańcuchy śniegowe,
należy zatrzymać pojazd na
płaskim podłożu, z dala od ruchu
drogowego. Włączyć światła
awaryjne pojazdu i umieścić za
nim trójkąt ostrzegawczy, jeśli
jest
on
dostępny.
Przed
rozpoczęciem
zakładania
łańcuchów śniegowych należy
zawsze
umieścić
dźwignię
zmiany biegów w położeniu P
(Postój), zaciągnąć hamulec
postojowy i wyłączyć silnik
pojazdu.
OSTRZEŻENIE
• Łańcuchy o niewłaściwym
rozmiarze lub niepoprawnie
założone mogą uszkodzić
linki hamulcowe pojazdu,
zawieszenie, nadwozie oraz
koła.
• Za każdym razem, kiedy da się
usłyszeć,
że
łańcuchy
uderzają w samochód, należy
zatrzymać się i zacisnąć je.
Appendix
Łańcuchy śniegowe
• Użycie łańcuchów śniegowych
może mieć negatywny wpływ
na prowadzenie pojazdu.
• Pojazdu nie należy prowadzić
szybciej niż 30 km/h (20 mil/h)
lub z prędkością większą, niż
zalecana przez producenta,
którakolwiek z tych wartości
okaże się mniejsza.
• Pojazd należy prowadzić
ostrożnie i unikać wybojów,
dziur, ostrych skrętów i innych
zagrożeń drogowych, które
mogą
powodować
podskakiwanie pojazdu.
• Należy
unikać
ostrych
zakrętów lub hamowania z
zablokowanymi kołami.
OSTROŻNIE
A
9-17